NPOI Common abstract class for {@link EscherOptRecord} and {@link EscherTertiaryOptRecord} @author Sergey Vladimirov (vlsergey {at} gmail {dot} com) @author Glen Stampoultzis Add a property to this record. The list of properties stored by this record. The list of properties stored by this record. Records should be sorted by property number before being stored. * Set an escher property. If a property with given propId already exists it is replaced. * * @param value the property to set. Retrieve the string representation of this record. Generates escher records when provided the byte array containing those records. @author Glen Stampoultzis @author Nick Burch (nick at torchbox . com) Initializes a new instance of the class. Generates an escher record including the any children contained under that record. An exception is thrown if the record could not be generated. The byte array containing the records The starting offset into the byte array The generated escher record Converts from a list of classes into a map that Contains the record id as the key and the Constructor in the value part of the map. It does this by using reflection to look up the RECORD_ID field then using reflection again to find a reference to the constructor. The records to convert The map containing the id/constructor pairs. Escher array properties are the most wierd construction ever invented with all sorts of special cases. I'm hopeful I've got them all. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at superlinksoftware.com) The size of the header that goes at the start of the array, before the data Normally, the size recorded in the simple data (for the complex data) includes the size of the header. There are a few cases when it doesn't though... When Reading a property from data stream remeber if the complex part is empty and Set this flag. Gets the element. The index. Sets the element. The index. The element. Retrieves the string representation for this property. We have this method because the way in which arrays in escher works is screwed for seemly arbitary reasons. While most properties are fairly consistent and have a predictable array size, escher arrays have special cases. The data array containing the escher array information The offset into the array to start Reading from. the number of bytes used by this complex property. Serializes the simple part of this property. ie the first 6 bytes. Needs special code to handle the case when the size doesn't include the size of the header block Sometimes the element size is stored as a negative number. We negate it and shift it to Get the real value. The size of elements. @author Glen Stampoultzis @version $Id: EscherBitmapBlip.java 569827 2007-08-26 15:26:29Z yegor $ This method deSerializes the record from a byte array. The byte array containing the escher record information The starting offset into May be null since this is not a container record. The number of bytes Read from the byte array. Serializes the record to an existing byte array. the offset within the byte array the data array to Serialize to a listener for begin and end serialization events. the number of bytes written. Returns the number of bytes that are required to Serialize this record. Number of bytes Gets or sets the UID. The UID. Gets or sets the marker. The marker. Toes the string. @author Glen Stampoultzis @version $Id: EscherBlipRecord.java 569827 2007-08-26 15:26:29Z yegor $ This method deSerializes the record from a byte array. The byte array containing the escher record information The starting offset into May be null since this is not a container record. The number of bytes Read from the byte array. Serializes the record to an existing byte array. the offset within the byte array the data array to Serialize to a listener for begin and end serialization events. the number of bytes written. Returns the number of bytes that are required to Serialize this record. Number of bytes The short name for this record Gets or sets the picture data. The picture data. Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . The blip record is used to hold details about large binary objects that occur in escher such as JPEG, GIF, PICT and WMF files. The contents of the stream is usually compressed. Inflate can be used to decompress the data. @author Glen Stampoultzis This method deserializes the record from a byte array. The byte array containing the escher record information The starting offset into May be null since this is not a container record. The number of bytes Read from the byte array. This method Serializes this escher record into a byte array. @param offset The offset into data to start writing the record data to. the data array to Serialize to a listener for begin and end serialization events. the number of bytes written. Returns the number of bytes that are required to Serialize this record. Number of bytes The short name for this record Gets or sets the secondary UID. The secondary UID. Gets or sets the size of the cache of. The size of the cache of. Gets or sets the top boundary of the metafile drawing commands The boundary top. Gets or sets the left boundary of the metafile drawing commands The boundary left. Gets or sets the boundary width of the metafile drawing commands The width of the boundary. Gets or sets the boundary height of the metafile drawing commands The height of the boundary. Gets or sets the width of the metafile in EMU's (English Metric Units). The width. Gets or sets the height of the metafile in EMU's (English Metric Units). The height. Gets or sets the cache of the saved size the cache of the saved size. Is the contents of the blip compressed? The compression flag. Gets or sets the filter. The filter. Gets or sets The BLIP data The data. Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Compress the contents of the provided array An uncompressed byte array Decompresses the specified data. The compressed byte array. The starting position into the byte array. The number of compressed bytes to decompress. An uncompressed byte array Represents a bool property. The actual utility of this property is in doubt because many of the properties marked as bool seem to actually contain special values. In other words they're not true bools. @author Glen Stampoultzis Create an instance of an escher bool property. The property number (or id) The 32 bit value of this bool property Whether this bool property is true true if this instance is true; otherwise, false. Whether this bool property is false true if this instance is false; otherwise, false. The BSE record is related closely to the EscherBlipRecord and stores extra information about the blip. A blip record is actually stored inside the BSE record even though the BSE record isn't actually a container record. @author Glen Stampoultzis @see EscherBlipRecord This method deSerializes the record from a byte array. The byte array containing the escher record information The starting offset into data May be null since this is not a container record. The number of bytes Read from the byte array. This method Serializes this escher record into a byte array. The offset into data to start writing the record data to The byte array to Serialize to. a listener for begin and end serialization events. The number of bytes written. Returns the number of bytes that are required to Serialize this record. Number of bytes The short name for this record Gets or sets the expected blip type under windows (failure to match this blip type will result in Excel converting to this format). The blip type win32. Gets or sets the expected blip type under MacOS (failure to match this blip type will result in Excel converting to this format). The blip type mac OS. Gets or sets 16 byte MD4 checksum. The UID. Gets or sets the tag. (Unused) The tag. Gets or sets Blip size in stream.. The size. Gets or sets the reference count of this blip. The ref. Gets or sets the offset in the delay stream.. The offset. Defines the way this blip is used. The usage. Gets or sets the blip name. The name. Gets or sets the unused2. The unused2. Gets or sets the unused3. The unused3. Gets or sets the blip record. The blip record. Gets or sets any remaining data in this record. The remaining data. Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Retrieve the string representation given a blip id. The b. The escher child achor record is used to specify the position of a shape under an existing group. The first level of shape records use a EscherClientAnchor record instead. @author Glen Stampoultzis This method deSerializes the record from a byte array. The byte array containing the escher record information The starting offset into data May be null since this is not a container record. The number of bytes Read from the byte array. This method Serializes this escher record into a byte array. The offset into data to start writing the record data to. The byte array to Serialize to. a listener for begin and end serialization events. The number of bytes written. Returns the number of bytes that are required to Serialize this record. Number of bytes The record id for the EscherChildAnchorRecord. The short name for this record Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Gets or sets offset within the parent coordinate space for the top left point. The DX1. Gets or sets the offset within the parent coordinate space for the top left point. The dy1. Gets or sets the offset within the parent coordinate space for the bottom right point. The DX2. Gets or sets the offset within the parent coordinate space for the bottom right point. The dy2. The escher client anchor specifies which rows and cells the shape is bound to as well as the offsets within those cells. Each cell is 1024 units wide by 256 units long regardless of the actual size of the cell. The EscherClientAnchorRecord only applies to the top-most shapes. Shapes contained in groups are bound using the EscherChildAnchorRecords. @author Glen Stampoultzis bit[0] - fMove (1 bit): A bit that specifies whether the shape will be kept intact when the cells are moved. bit[1] - fSize (1 bit): A bit that specifies whether the shape will be kept intact when the cells are resized. If fMove is 1, the value MUST be 1. bit[2-4] - reserved, MUST be 0 and MUST be ignored bit[5-15]- Undefined and MUST be ignored. it can take values: 0, 2, 3 This method deSerializes the record from a byte array. The byte array containing the escher record information The starting offset into data May be null since this is not a container record. The number of bytes Read from the byte array. This method Serializes this escher record into a byte array. The offset into data to start writing the record data to. The byte array to Serialize to. a listener for begin and end serialization events. The number of bytes written. Returns the number of bytes that are required to Serialize this record. Number of bytes The record id for this record. The short name for this record Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Gets or sets the flag. 0 = Move and size with Cells, 2 = Move but don't size with cells, 3 = Don't move or size with cells. Gets or sets The column number for the top-left position. 0 based. The col1. Gets or sets The x offset within the top-left cell. Range is from 0 to 1023. The DX1. Gets or sets The row number for the top-left corner of the shape. The row1. Gets or sets The y offset within the top-left corner of the current shape. The dy1. Gets or sets The column of the bottom right corner of this shape. The col2. Gets or sets The x offset withing the cell for the bottom-right corner of this shape. The DX2. Gets or sets The row number for the bottom-right corner of the current shape. The row2. Gets or sets The y offset withing the cell for the bottom-right corner of this shape. The dy2. Gets or sets the remaining data. The remaining data. The EscherClientDataRecord is used to store client specific data about the position of a shape within a container. @author Glen Stampoultzis This method deSerializes the record from a byte array. The byte array containing the escher record information The starting offset into data May be null since this is not a container record. The number of bytes Read from the byte array. This method Serializes this escher record into a byte array. @param offset The offset into data to start writing the record data to. @param data The byte array to Serialize to. @param listener A listener to retrieve start and end callbacks. Use a NullEscherSerailizationListener to ignore these events. @return The number of bytes written. @see NullEscherSerializationListener Returns the number of bytes that are required to Serialize this record. @return Number of bytes Returns the identifier of this record. The short name for this record Returns the string representation of this record. Any data recording this record. The following enum specifies values that indicate special procedural properties that are used to modify the color components of another color. These values are combined with those of the {@link SysIndexSource} enum or with a user-specified color. The first six values are mutually exclusive. An OfficeArtCOLORREF structure entry which also handles color extension opid data @return {@link SysIndexSource} if {@link #hasSysIndexFlag()} is {@code true}, otherwise null Return the {@link SysIndexProcedure} - for invert flag use {@link #getSysIndexInvert()} @return {@link SysIndexProcedure} if {@link #hasSysIndexFlag()} is {@code true}, otherwise null @return 0 for no invert flag, 1 for {@link SysIndexProcedure#INVERT_AFTER} and 2 for {@link SysIndexProcedure#INVERT_HIGHBIT_AFTER} @return index of the scheme color or -1 if {@link #hasSchemeIndexFlag()} is {@code false} @see NPOI.HSLF.Record.ColorSchemeAtom#getColor(int) @return index of current palette (color) or -1 if {@link #hasPaletteIndexFlag()} is {@code false} A complex property differs from a simple property in that the data can not fit inside a 32 bit integer. See the specification for more detailed information regarding exactly what is stored here. @author Glen Stampoultzis Create a complex property using the property id and a byte array containing the complex data value. The id consists of the property number, a flag indicating whether this is a blip id and a flag indicating that this is a complex property. The value of this property. Create a complex property using the property number, a flag to indicate whether this is a blip reference and the complex property data. The property number. Whether this is a blip id. Should be false. The value of this complex property. Serializes the simple part of this property. ie the first 6 bytes. Serializes the complex part of this property The data array to Serialize to The offset within data to start serializing to. The number of bytes Serialized. Gets the complex data. The complex data. Determine whether this property is equal to another property. The object to compare to. True if the objects are equal. Caclulates the number of bytes required to Serialize this property. Number of bytes Serves as a hash function for a particular type. A hash code for the current . Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Escher container records store other escher records as children. The container records themselves never store any information beyond the standard header used by all escher records. This one record is used to represent many different types of records. @author Glen Stampoultzis in case if document contains any charts we have such document structure: BOF ... DrawingRecord ... ObjRecord|TxtObjRecord ... EOF ... BOF(Chart begin) ... DrawingRecord ... ObjRecord|TxtObjRecord ... EOF So, when we call EscherAggregate.createAggregate() we have not all needed data. When we got warning "WARNING: " + bytesRemaining + " bytes remaining but no space left" we should save value of bytesRemaining and add it to container size when we serialize it The contract of this method is to deSerialize an escher record including it's children. The byte array containing the Serialized escher records. The offset into the byte array. A factory for creating new escher records The number of bytes written. Serializes to an existing byte array without serialization listener. This is done by delegating to Serialize(int, byte[], EscherSerializationListener). the offset within the data byte array. the data array to Serialize to. a listener for begin and end serialization events. The number of bytes written. Subclasses should effeciently return the number of bytes required to Serialize the record. number of bytes Do any of our (top level) children have the given recordId? The record id. true if [has child of type] [the specified record id]; otherwise, false. Returns a list of all the child (escher) records of the container. Returns all of our children which are also EscherContainers (may be 0, 1, or vary rarely 2 or 3) The child containers. Subclasses should return the short name for this escher record. The display methods allows escher variables to print the record names according to their hierarchy. The current indent level. Adds the child record. The record. Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Gets the child by id. The record id. Recursively find records with the specified record ID list to store found records This record defines the drawing groups used for a particular sheet. This method deSerializes the record from a byte array. The byte array containing the escher record information The starting offset into data May be null since this is not a container record. The number of bytes Read from the byte array. This method Serializes this escher record into a byte array. The offset into data to start writing the record data to. The byte array to Serialize to. a listener for begin and end serialization events. The number of bytes written. Returns the number of bytes that are required to Serialize this record. Number of bytes Return the current record id. The 16 bit record id. The short name for this record Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Gets or sets the shape id max. The shape id max. Gets the Number of id clusters + 1 The num id clusters. Gets or sets the num shapes saved. The num shapes saved. Gets or sets the drawings saved. The drawings saved. Gets or sets the max drawing group id. The max drawing group id. Gets or sets the file id clusters. The file id clusters. Adds the cluster. The dg id. The num shaped used. Adds the cluster. id of the drawing group (stored in the record options) initial value of the numShapedUsed field if set to true if true then sort clusters by drawing group id.( In Excel the clusters are sorted but in PPT they are not). This record simply holds the number of shapes in the drawing group and the last shape id used for this drawing group. @author Glen Stampoultzis This method deSerializes the record from a byte array. The byte array containing the escher record information The starting offset into data May be null since this is not a container record. The number of bytes Read from the byte array. This method Serializes this escher record into a byte array. The offset into data to start writing the record data to. The byte array to Serialize to. The number of bytes written. a listener for begin and end serialization events. Returns the number of bytes that are required to Serialize this record. Number of bytes Return the current record id. The 16 bit record id. The short name for this record Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Gets or sets The number of shapes in this drawing group. The num shapes. Gets or sets The last shape id used in this drawing group. The last MSOSPID. Gets the drawing group id for this record. This is encoded in the instance part of the option record. The drawing group id. Increments the shape count. Used to dump the contents of escher records to a PrintStream. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Decodes the escher stream from a byte array and dumps the results to a print stream. The data array containing the escher records. The starting offset within the data array. The number of bytes to Read. This version of dump is a translation from the open office escher dump routine. The number of bytes to Read An input stream to Read from. Returns a property name given a property id. This is used only by the old escher dump routine. The property number for the name A descriptive name. Returns the blip description given a blip id. blip id A description. Straight conversion from OO. Converts a type of float. The N32. Dumps out a hex value by Reading from a input stream. How many bytes this hex value consists of. The stream to Read the hex value from. Dumps the specified record size. Size of the record. The data. @author Daniel Noll BLIP signatures as defined in the escher spec The primary UID is only saved to disk if (blip_instance ^ blip_signature == 1) This method deSerializes the record from a byte array. The byte array containing the escher record information The starting offset into May be null since this is not a container record. The number of bytes Read from the byte array. Serializes the record to an existing byte array. the offset within the byte array the data array to Serialize to a listener for begin and end serialization events. the number of bytes written. Decompresses the provided data, returning the inflated result. the deflated picture data. the inflated picture data. Returns the number of bytes that are required to Serialize this record. Number of bytes Gets or sets the UID. The UID. Gets or sets the primary UID. The primary UID. Gets or sets the size of the uncompressed. The size of the uncompressed. Gets or sets the bounds. The bounds. Gets or sets the size EMU. The size EMU. Gets or sets the size of the compressed. The size of the compressed. Gets or sets a value indicating whether this instance is compressed. true if this instance is compressed; otherwise, false. Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Return the blip signature the blip signature The opt record is used to store property values for a shape. It is the key to determining the attributes of a shape. Properties can be of two types: simple or complex. Simple types are fixed Length. Complex properties are variable Length. @author Glen Stampoultzis Automatically recalculate the correct option The short name for this record @author Daniel Noll This method deSerializes the record from a byte array. The byte array containing the escher record information The starting offset into May be null since this is not a container record. The number of bytes Read from the byte array. Serializes the record to an existing byte array. the offset within the byte array the data array to Serialize to a listener for begin and end serialization events. the number of bytes written. Decompresses the provided data, returning the inflated result. the deflated picture data. the inflated picture data. Returns the number of bytes that are required to Serialize this record. Number of bytes Gets or sets the UID. The UID. Gets or sets the size of the uncompressed. The size of the uncompressed. Gets or sets the bounds. The bounds. Gets or sets the size EMU. The size EMU. Gets or sets the size of the compressed. The size of the compressed. Gets a value indicating whether this instance is compressed. true if this instance is compressed; otherwise, false. Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Provides a list of all known escher properties including the description and type. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Inits the props. Adds the prop. The s. The data. Gets the data. Name of the prop. The type. Gets the data. Name of the prop. Gets the name of the property. The property id. Gets the type of the property. The property id. This is the abstract base class for all escher properties. @see EscherOptRecord @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Initializes a new instance of the class. The id is distinct from the actual property number. The id includes the property number the blip id flag and an indicator whether the property is complex or not. Initializes a new instance of the class.The three parameters are combined to form a property id. The property number. if set to true [is complex]. if set to true [is blip id]. Gets the id. The id. Gets the property number. The property number. Gets a value indicating whether this instance is complex. true if this instance is complex; otherwise, false. Gets a value indicating whether this instance is blip id. true if this instance is blip id; otherwise, false. Gets the name. The name. Most properties are just 6 bytes in Length. Override this if we're dealing with complex properties. The size of the property. Escher properties consist of a simple fixed Length part and a complex variable Length part. The fixed Length part is Serialized first. The data. The pos. Escher properties consist of a simple fixed Length part and a complex variable Length part. The fixed Length part is Serialized first. The data. The pos. Generates a property given a reference into the byte array storing that property. @author Glen Stampoultzis Create new properties from a byte array. The byte array containing the property The starting offset into the byte array The new properties This class stores the type and description of an escher property. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Initializes a new instance of the class. The description of the escher property. Initializes a new instance of the class. The description of the escher property. The type of the property. Gets the description. The description. Gets the type. The type. The base abstract record from which all escher records are defined. Subclasses will need to define methods for serialization/deserialization and for determining the record size. @author Glen Stampoultzis Initializes a new instance of the class. Delegates to FillFields(byte[], int, EscherRecordFactory) The data. The f. The contract of this method is to deSerialize an escher record including it's children. The byte array containing the Serialized escher records. The offset into the byte array. A factory for creating new escher records. The number of bytes written. Reads the 8 byte header information and populates the options and recordId records. the byte array to Read from the offset to start Reading from the number of bytes remaining in this record. This Read the options field from header and return instance part of it. the byte array to read from the offset to start reading from value of instance part of options field Determine whether this is a container record by inspecting the option field. true if this instance is container record; otherwise, false. Gets or sets the options field for this record. All records have one The options. Serializes to a new byte array. This is done by delegating to Serialize(int, byte[]); the Serialized record. Serializes to an existing byte array without serialization listener. This is done by delegating to Serialize(int, byte[], EscherSerializationListener). the offset within the data byte array. the data array to Serialize to. The number of bytes written. Serializes the record to an existing byte array. the offset within the byte array. the offset within the byte array a listener for begin and end serialization events. This. is useful because the serialization is hierarchical/recursive and sometimes you need to be able break into that. Subclasses should effeciently return the number of bytes required to Serialize the record. number of bytes Return the current record id. The 16 bit record id. Gets or sets the child records. Returns the children of this record. By default this will be an empty list. EscherCotainerRecord is the only record that may contain children. Creates a new object that is a copy of the current instance. A new object that is a copy of this instance. Returns the indexed child record. The index. The display methods allows escher variables to print the record names according to their hierarchy. The current indent level. Gets the name of the record. The name of the record. This class Reads the standard escher header. Reads the header. The data. The off set. Gets the options. The options. Gets the record id. The record id. Gets the remaining bytes. The remaining bytes. Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Get or set the instance part of the option record. Get or set the version part of the option record. @param tab - each children must be a right of his parent @return xml representation of this record The escher record factory interface allows for the creation of escher records from a pointer into a data array. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Create a new escher record from the data provided. Does not attempt to Fill the contents of the record however. The data. The off set. A color property. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Initializes a new instance of the class. The property number. Color of the RGB. Gets the color of the RGB. The color of the RGB. Gets the red. The red. Gets the green. The green. Gets the blue. The blue. Interface for listening to escher serialization events. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Fired before a given escher record is Serialized. @param offset The position in the data array at which the record will be Serialized. @param recordId The id of the record about to be Serialized. Fired after a record has been Serialized. @param offset The position of the end of the Serialized record + 1 @param recordId The id of the record about to be Serialized @param size The number of bytes written for this record. If it is a container record then this will include the size of any included records. Defines the constants for the various possible shape paths. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Initializes a new instance of the class. The property number. The shape path. A simple property is of fixed Length and as a property number in Addition to a 32-bit value. Properties that can't be stored in only 32-bits are stored as EscherComplexProperty objects. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) The id is distinct from the actual property number. The id includes the property number the blip id flag and an indicator whether the property is complex or not. The id. The property value. Constructs a new escher property. The three parameters are combined to form a property id. The property number. if set to true [is complex]. if set to true [is blip id]. The property value. Serialize the simple part of the escher record. The data. The off set. the number of bytes Serialized. Escher properties consist of a simple fixed Length part and a complex variable Length part. The fixed Length part is Serialized first. Return the 32 bit value of this property. The property value. Returns true if one escher property is equal to another. The o. Serves as a hash function for a particular type. A hash code for the current . Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . The spgr record defines information about a shape group. Groups in escher are simply another form of shape that you can't physically see. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) This method deSerializes the record from a byte array. The byte array containing the escher record information The starting offset into data May be null since this is not a container record. The number of bytes Read from the byte array. This method Serializes this escher record into a byte array The offset into data to start writing the record data to. The byte array to Serialize to. a listener for begin and end serialization events. The number of bytes written. Returns the number of bytes that are required to Serialize this record. Number of bytes Return the current record id. The 16 bit identifier of this shape group record. The short name for this record Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Gets or sets the starting top-left coordinate of child records. The rect x1. Gets or sets the starting bottom-right coordinate of child records. The rect x2. Gets or sets the starting top-left coordinate of child records. The rect y1. Gets or sets the starting bottom-right coordinate of child records. The rect y2. A list of the most recently used colours for the drawings contained in this document. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) This method deSerializes the record from a byte array. The byte array containing the escher record information The starting offset into data May be null since this is not a container record. The number of bytes Read from the byte array. This method Serializes this escher record into a byte array The offset into data to start writing the record data to. The byte array to Serialize to. a listener for begin and end serialization events. The number of bytes written. Returns the number of bytes that are required to Serialize this record. number of bytes Return the current record id. the 16 bit identifer for this record. Gets the short name for this record The name of the record. Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . @return a string representation of this record. Gets or sets the color1. The color1. Gets or sets the color2. The color2. Gets or sets the color3. The color3. Gets or sets the color4. The color4. ToGether the the EscherOptRecord this record defines some of the basic properties of a shape. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) The contract of this method is to deSerialize an escher record including it's children. The byte array containing the Serialized escher records. The offset into the byte array. A factory for creating new escher records The number of bytes written. Serializes to an existing byte array without serialization listener. This is done by delegating to Serialize(int, byte[], EscherSerializationListener). the offset within the data byte array. the data array to Serialize to. a listener for begin and end serialization events. The number of bytes written. Returns the number of bytes that are required to Serialize this record. Number of bytes @return the 16 bit identifier for this record. The short name for this record Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Converts the shape flags into a more descriptive name. The flags. Gets or sets A number that identifies this shape The shape id. The flags that apply to this shape. The flags. Get or set shape type. Must be one of MSOSPT values (see [MS-ODRAW] for details). "The OfficeArtTertiaryFOPT record specifies a table of OfficeArtRGFOPTE properties, as defined in section 2.3.1." -- [MS-ODRAW] -- v20110608; Office Drawing Binary File Format @author Sergey Vladimirov (vlsergey {at} gmail {dot} com) Holds data from the parent application. Most commonly used to store text in the format of the parent application, rather than in Escher format. We don't attempt to understand the contents, since they will be in the parent's format, not Escher format. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) @author Nick Burch (nick at torchbox dot com) The data for this record not including the the 8 byte header This method deserializes the record from a byte array. @param data The byte array containing the escher record information @param offset The starting offset into data. @param recordFactory May be null since this is not a container record. @return The number of bytes Read from the byte array. Writes this record and any contained records to the supplied byte a listener for begin and end serialization events. the number of bytes written. Returns any extra data associated with this record. In practice excel does not seem to put anything here, but with PowerPoint this will contain the bytes that make up a TextHeaderAtom followed by a TextBytesAtom/TextCharsAtom The data. Sets the extra data (in the parent application's format) to be contained by the record. Used when the parent application changes the contents. The b. The start. The length. Sets the data. The b. Returns the number of bytes that are required to serialize this record. Number of bytes The short name for this record Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . This record is used whenever a escher record is encountered that we do not explicitly support. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) The data for this record not including the the 8 byte header This method deSerializes the record from a byte array. The byte array containing the escher record information The starting offset into data May be null since this is not a container record. The number of bytes Read from the byte array. Writes this record and any contained records to the supplied byte array. a listener for begin and end serialization events. the number of bytes written. Gets the data. The data. Returns the number of bytes that are required to Serialize this record. Number of bytes Returns the children of this record. By default this will be an empty list. EscherCotainerRecord is the only record that may contain children. The short name for this record Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Adds the child record. The child record. Defines constants of general use. @author Rainer Klute klute@rainer-klute.de @since 2004-06-20 Allow accessing the Initial value. Codepage 037, a special case Codepage for SJIS Codepage for GBK, aka MS936 Codepage for MS949 Codepage for UTF-16 Codepage for UTF-16 big-endian Codepage for Windows 1250 Codepage for Windows 1251 Codepage for Windows 1252 Codepage for Windows 1253 Codepage for Windows 1254 Codepage for Windows 1255 Codepage for Windows 1256 Codepage for Windows 1257 Codepage for Windows 1258 Codepage for Johab Codepage for Macintosh Roman (Java: MacRoman) Codepage for Macintosh Japan (Java: unknown - use SJIS, cp942 or cp943) Codepage for Macintosh Chinese Traditional (Java: unknown - use Big5, MS950, or cp937) Codepage for Macintosh Korean (Java: unknown - use EUC_KR or cp949) Codepage for Macintosh Arabic (Java: MacArabic) Codepage for Macintosh Hebrew (Java: MacHebrew) Codepage for Macintosh Greek (Java: MacGreek) Codepage for Macintosh Cyrillic (Java: MacCyrillic) Codepage for Macintosh Chinese Simplified (Java: unknown - use EUC_CN, ISO2022_CN_GB, MS936 or cp935) Codepage for Macintosh Romanian (Java: MacRomania) Codepage for Macintosh Ukrainian (Java: MacUkraine) Codepage for Macintosh Thai (Java: MacThai) Codepage for Macintosh Central Europe (Latin-2) (Java: MacCentralEurope) Codepage for Macintosh Iceland (Java: MacIceland) Codepage for Macintosh Turkish (Java: MacTurkish) Codepage for Macintosh Croatian (Java: MacCroatian) Codepage for US-ASCII Codepage for KOI8-R Codepage for ISO-8859-1 Codepage for ISO-8859-2 Codepage for ISO-8859-3 Codepage for ISO-8859-4 Codepage for ISO-8859-5 Codepage for ISO-8859-6 Codepage for ISO-8859-7 Codepage for ISO-8859-8 Codepage for ISO-8859-9 Codepage for ISO-2022-JP Another codepage for ISO-2022-JP Yet another codepage for ISO-2022-JP Codepage for ISO-2022-KR Codepage for EUC-JP Codepage for EUC-KR Codepage for GB2312 Codepage for GB18030 Another codepage for US-ASCII Codepage for UTF-8 Codepage for Unicode Maintains the instances of {@link CustomProperty} that belong To a {@link DocumentSummaryInformation}. The class maintains the names of the custom properties in a dictionary. It implements the {@link Map} interface and by this provides a simplified view on custom properties: A property's name is the key that maps To a typed value. This implementation hides property IDs from the developer and regards the property names as keys To typed values. While this class provides a simple API To custom properties, it ignores the fact that not names, but IDs are the real keys To properties. Under the hood this class maintains a 1:1 relationship between IDs and names. Therefore you should not use this class To process property Sets with several IDs mapping To the same name or with properties without a name: the result will contain only a subSet of the original properties. If you really need To deal such property Sets, use HPSF's low-level access methods. An application can call the {@link #isPure} method To check whether a property Set parsed by {@link CustomProperties} is still pure (i.e. unmodified) or whether one or more properties have been dropped. This class is not thRead-safe; concurrent access To instances of this class must be syncronized. @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @since 2006-02-09 Maps property IDs To property names. Maps property names To property IDs. Tells whether this object is pure or not. Puts a {@link CustomProperty} into this map. It is assumed that the {@link CustomProperty} alReady has a valid ID. Otherwise use {@link #Put(CustomProperty)}. The name. The custom property. Returns a set of all the names of our custom properties. Equivalent to {@link #nameSet()} Returns a set of all the names of our custom properties Returns a set of all the IDs of our custom properties Puts a {@link CustomProperty} that has not yet a valid ID into this map. The method will allocate a suitable ID for the custom property:
  • If there is alReady a property with the same name, take the ID of that property.
  • Otherwise Find the highest ID and use its value plus one.
The custom property. If the was alReady a property with the same name, the
Removes a custom property. The name of the custom property To Remove The Removed property or null if the specified property was not found. Adds a named string property. The property's name. The property's value. the property that was stored under the specified name before, or null if there was no such property before. Adds a named long property The property's name. The property's value. the property that was stored under the specified name before, or null if there was no such property before. Adds a named double property. The property's name. The property's value. the property that was stored under the specified name before, or null if there was no such property before. Adds a named integer property. The property's name. The property's value. the property that was stored under the specified name before, or null if there was no such property before. Adds a named bool property. The property's name. The property's value. the property that was stored under the specified name before, or null if there was no such property before. Adds a named date property. The property's name. The property's value. the property that was stored under the specified name before, or null if there was no such property before. Gets the with the specified name. the value or null if a value with the specified name is not found in the custom properties. Checks against both String Name and Long ID Checks against both the property, and its values. Gets the dictionary which Contains IDs and names of the named custom properties. The dictionary. Gets or sets the codepage. The codepage. Tells whether this {@link CustomProperties} instance is pure or one or more properties of the underlying low-level property Set has been dropped. true if this instance is pure; otherwise, false. This class represents custum properties in the document summary information stream. The difference To normal properties is that custom properties have an optional name. If the name is not null it will be maintained in the section's dictionary. @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @since 2006-02-09 Initializes a new instance of the class. Initializes a new instance of the class. the property To copy Initializes a new instance of the class. This property's attributes are copied To the new custom property. The new custom property's name. Gets or sets the property's name. the property's name. Compares two custom properties for equality. The method returns true if all attributes of the two custom properties are equal. The custom property To Compare with. true if both custom properties are equal, else false @see Object#GetHashCode() Convenience class representing a DocumentSummary Information stream in a Microsoft Office document. @author Rainer Klute klute@rainer-klute.de @author Drew Varner (Drew.Varner cloSeto sc.edu) @author robert_flaherty@hyperion.com @since 2002-02-09 The document name a document summary information stream usually has in a POIFS filesystem. Initializes a new instance of the class. A property Set which should be Created from a document summary information stream. Gets or sets the category. The category value Removes the category. Gets or sets the presentation format (or null). The presentation format value Removes the presentation format. Gets or sets the byte count or 0 if the {@link DocumentSummaryInformation} does not contain a byte count. The byteCount value Removes the byte count. Gets or sets the line count or 0 if the {@link DocumentSummaryInformation} does not contain a line count. The line count value. Removes the line count. Gets or sets the par count or 0 if the {@link DocumentSummaryInformation} does not contain a par count. The par count value Removes the par count. Gets or sets the slide count or 0 if the {@link DocumentSummaryInformation} does not contain a slide count. The slide count value Removes the slide count. Gets or sets the note count or 0 if the {@link DocumentSummaryInformation} does not contain a note count The note count value Removes the note count. Gets or sets the hidden count or 0 if the {@link DocumentSummaryInformation} does not contain a hidden count. The hidden count value. Removes the hidden count. Returns the mmclip count or 0 if the {@link DocumentSummaryInformation} does not contain a mmclip count. The mmclip count value. Removes the MMClip count. Gets or sets a value indicating whether this is scale. true if cropping is desired; otherwise, false. Removes the scale. Gets or sets the heading pair (or null) The heading pair value. Removes the heading pair. Gets or sets the doc parts. The doc parts value Removes the doc parts. Gets or sets the manager (or null). The manager value Removes the manager. Gets or sets the company (or null). The company value Removes the company. Gets or sets a value indicating whether [links dirty]. true if the custom links are dirty.; otherwise, false. Removes the links dirty. Gets or sets the custom properties. The custom properties. Creates section 2 if it is not alReady present. Removes the custom properties. Extracts all of the HPSF properties, both build in and custom, returning them in textual form. Gets the document summary information text. The document summary information text. Gets the summary information text. The summary information text. Gets the properties text. The ps. Return the text of all the properties defined in the document. All the text from the document. Returns another text extractor, which is able to output the textual content of the document metadata / properties, such as author and title. The metadata text extractor. This exception is the superclass of all other checked exceptions thrown in this package. It supports a nested "reason" throwable, i.e. an exception that caused this one To be thrown. @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @since 2002-02-09 Initializes a new instance of the class. Initializes a new instance of the class. The message string. Initializes a new instance of the class. The reason, i.e. a throwable that indirectly caused this exception. Initializes a new instance of the class. The message string. The reason, i.e. a throwable that indirectly caused this exception. Returns the {@link Exception} that caused this exception To be thrown or null if there was no such {@link Exception}. The reason. A version of {@link POIDocument} which allows access to the HPSF Properties, but no other document contents. Normally used when you want to read or alter the Document Properties, without affecting the rest of the file Write out, with any properties changes, but nothing else This exception is the superclass of all other unchecked exceptions thrown in this package. It supports a nested "reason" throwable, i.e. an exception that caused this one To be thrown. @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @since 2002-02-09 Initializes a new instance of the class. Initializes a new instance of the class. The message string. Initializes a new instance of the class. The reason, i.e. a throwable that indirectly caused this exception. Initializes a new instance of the class. The message string. The reason, i.e. a throwable that indirectly caused this exception. This exception is thrown when there is an illegal value Set in a {@link PropertySet}. For example, a {@link Variant#VT_BOOL} must have a value of -1 (true) or 0 (false). Any other value would trigger this exception. It supports a nested "reason" throwable, i.e. an exception that caused this one To be thrown. @author Drew Varner(Drew.Varner atDomain sc.edu) @since 2002-05-26 Initializes a new instance of the class. Initializes a new instance of the class. The exception's message string Initializes a new instance of the class. This exception's underlying reason Initializes a new instance of the class. The exception's message string This exception's underlying reason This exception is thrown if HPSF encounters a variant type that is illegal in the current context. @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @since 2004-06-21 Initializes a new instance of the class. The unsupported variant type The value A message string Initializes a new instance of the class. The unsupported variant type The value. This exception is thrown if an {@link java.io.InputStream} does not support the {@link java.io.InputStream#mark} operation. @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @since 2002-02-09 Initializes a new instance of the class. Initializes a new instance of the class. The exception's message string. Initializes a new instance of the class. This exception's underlying reason. Initializes a new instance of the class. The exception's message string This exception's underlying reason This exception is thrown if one of the {@link PropertySet}'s convenience methods does not Find a required {@link Section}. The constructors of this class are analogous To those of its superclass and documented there. @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @since 2006-02-08 Initializes a new instance of the class. Initializes a new instance of the class. The exception's message string Initializes a new instance of the class. This exception's underlying reason. Initializes a new instance of the class. The exception's message string This exception's underlying reason Adds writing capability To the {@link Property} class. Please be aware that this class' functionality will be merged into the {@link Property} class at a later time, so the API will Change. @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @since 2003-08-03 Creates an empty property. It must be Filled using the Set method To be usable. Initializes a new instance of the class. The property To copy. Writes the property To an output stream. The output stream To Write To. The codepage To use for writing non-wide strings the number of bytes written To the stream Adds writing support To the {@link PropertySet} class. Please be aware that this class' functionality will be merged into the {@link PropertySet} class at a later time, so the API will Change. @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @since 2003-02-19 Initializes a new instance of the class. Its primary task is To initialize the immutable field with their proper values. It also Sets fields that might Change To reasonable defaults. Initializes a new instance of the class. All nested elements, i.e.Sections and Property instances, will be their mutable counterparts in the new MutablePropertySet. The property Set To copy The Length of the property Set stream header. Gets or sets the "byteOrder" property. the byteOrder value To Set Gets or sets the "format" property. the format value To Set Gets or sets the "osVersion" property the osVersion value To Set. Gets or sets the property Set stream's low-level "class ID" The property Set stream's low-level "class ID" field. Removes all sections from this property Set. Adds a section To this property Set. section The {@link Section} To Add. It will be Appended after any sections that are alReady present in the property Set and thus become the last section. Writes the property Set To an output stream. the output stream To Write the section To Returns the contents of this property set stream as an input stream. The latter can be used for example to write the property set into a POIFS document. The input stream represents a snapshot of the property set. If the latter is modified while the input stream is still being read, the modifications will not be reflected in the input stream but in the {@link MutablePropertySet} only. the contents of this property set stream Writes a property Set To a document in a POI filesystem directory The directory in the POI filesystem To Write the document To. The document's name. If there is alReady a document with the same name in the directory the latter will be overwritten. Adds writing capability To the {@link Section} class. Please be aware that this class' functionality will be merged into the {@link Section} class at a later time, so the API will Change. @since 2002-02-20 If the "dirty" flag is true, the section's size must be (re-)calculated before the section is written. List To assemble the properties. Unfortunately a wrong decision has been taken when specifying the "properties" field as an Property[]. It should have been a {@link java.util.List}. Contains the bytes making out the section. This byte array is established when the section's size is calculated and can be reused later. It is valid only if the "dirty" flag is false. Initializes a new instance of the class. Constructs a MutableSection by doing a deep copy of an existing Section. All nested Property instances, will be their mutable counterparts in the new MutableSection. The section Set To copy Sets the section's format ID. The section's format ID Sets the section's format ID. The section's format ID as a byte array. It components are in big-endian format. Sets this section's properties. Any former values are overwritten. This section's new properties. Sets the string value of the property with the specified ID. The property's ID The property's value. It will be written as a Unicode string. Sets the int value of the property with the specified ID. The property's ID The property's value. Sets the long value of the property with the specified ID. The property's ID The property's value. Sets the bool value of the property with the specified ID. The property's ID The property's value. Sets the value and the variant type of the property with the specified ID. If a property with this ID is not yet present in the section, it will be Added. An alReady present property with the specified ID will be overwritten. A default mapping will be used To choose the property's type. The property's ID. The property's variant type. The property's value. Sets the property. The property To be Set. Removes the property. The ID of the property To be Removed Sets the value of the bool property with the specified ID. The property's ID The property's value Returns the section's size in bytes. The section's size in bytes. Calculates the section's size. It is the sum of the Lengths of the section's header (8), the properties list (16 times the number of properties) and the properties themselves. the section's Length in bytes. Writes this section into an output stream. Internally this is done by writing into three byte array output streams: one for the properties, one for the property list and one for the section as such. The two former are Appended To the latter when they have received all their data. The stream To Write into. The number of bytes written, i.e. the section's size. Writes the section's dictionary The output stream To Write To. The dictionary. The codepage to be used to Write the dictionary items. The number of bytes written see MSDN KB: http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa380065(VS.85).aspx OverWrites the base class' method To cope with a redundancy: the property count is maintained in a separate member variable, but shouldn't. The number of properties in this section. Returns this section's properties. This section's properties. Ensures the properties. Gets a property. The ID of the property To Get The property or null if there is no such property Sets the section's dictionary. All keys in the dictionary must be {@link java.lang.long} instances, all values must be {@link java.lang.String}s. This method overWrites the properties with IDs 0 and 1 since they are reserved for the dictionary and the dictionary's codepage. Setting these properties explicitly might have surprising effects. An application should never do this but always use this method. the dictionary Sets the property. The property ID. The property's value. The value's class must be one of those supported by HPSF. Removes all properties from the section including 0 (dictionary) and 1 (codepage). Gets the section's codepage, if any. The section's codepage if one is defined, else -1. This exception is thrown if a {@link MutablePropertySet} is To be written but does not have a formatID Set (see {@link MutableSection#SetFormatID(ClassID)} or {@link org.apache.poi.hpsf.MutableSection#SetFormatID(byte[])}. @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @since 2002-09-03 Initializes a new instance of the class. Initializes a new instance of the class. The exception's message string Initializes a new instance of the class. This exception's underlying reason Initializes a new instance of the class. The exception's message string This exception's underlying reason This exception is thrown if a format error in a property Set stream Is detected or when the input data do not constitute a property Set stream. The constructors of this class are analogous To those of its superclass and are documented there. @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @since 2002-02-09 Initializes a new instance of the class. Initializes a new instance of the class. The exception's message string Initializes a new instance of the class. This exception's underlying reason Initializes a new instance of the class. The exception's message string This exception's underlying reason This exception is thrown if one of the {@link PropertySet}'s convenience methods that require a single {@link Section} is called and the {@link PropertySet} does not contain exactly one {@link Section}. The constructors of this class are analogous To those of its superclass and documented there. @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @since 2002-02-09 Initializes a new instance of the class. Initializes a new instance of the class. The exception's message string Initializes a new instance of the class. This exception's underlying reason Initializes a new instance of the class. The exception's message string This exception's underlying reason A property in a {@link Section} of a {@link PropertySet}. The property's ID gives the property a meaning in the context of its {@link Section}. Each {@link Section} spans its own name space of property IDs. The property's type determines how its value is interpreted. For example, if the type Is {@link Variant#VT_LPSTR} (byte string), the value consists of a DWord telling how many bytes the string Contains. The bytes follow immediately, including any null bytes that terminate the string. The type {@link Variant#VT_I4} denotes a four-byte integer value, {@link Variant#VT_FILETIME} some DateTime and time (of a file). Please note that not all {@link Variant} types yet. This might Change over time but largely depends on your feedback so that the POI team knows which variant types are really needed. So please feel free To submit error reports or patches for the types you need. Microsoft documentation: Property Set Display Name Dictionary . @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @author Drew Varner (Drew.Varner InAndAround sc.edu) @see Section @see Variant @since 2002-02-09 The property's ID. Returns the property's ID. @return The ID value The property's type. Returns the property's type. @return The type value The property's value. Gets the property's value. The property's value Initializes a new instance of the class. the property's ID. the property's type, see {@link Variant}. the property's value. Only certain types are allowed, see {@link Variant}. Initializes a new instance of the class. The property's ID. The bytes the property Set stream consists of. The property's type/value pair's offset in the section. The property's type/value pair's Length in bytes. The section's and thus the property's codepage. It is needed only when Reading string values Initializes a new instance of the class. Reads the dictionary. The byte array containing the bytes making out the dictionary. At this offset within src the dictionary starts. The dictionary Contains at most this many bytes. The codepage of the string values. The dictonary Gets the property's size in bytes. This is always a multiple of 4. the property's size in bytes Compares two properties. Please beware that a property with ID == 0 is a special case: It does not have a type, and its value is the section's dictionary. Another special case are strings: Two properties may have the different types Variant.VT_LPSTR and Variant.VT_LPWSTR; The o. Typeses the are equal. The t1. The t2. Serves as a hash function for a particular type. A hash code for the current . Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Represents a property Set in the Horrible Property Set Format (HPSF). These are usually metadata of a Microsoft Office document. An application that wants To access these metadata should Create an instance of this class or one of its subclasses by calling the factory method {@link PropertySetFactory#Create} and then retrieve the information its needs by calling appropriate methods. {@link PropertySetFactory#Create} does its work by calling one of the constructors {@link PropertySet#PropertySet(InputStream)} or {@link PropertySet#PropertySet(byte[])}. If the constructor's argument is not in the Horrible Property Set Format, i.e. not a property Set stream, or if any other error occurs, an appropriate exception is thrown. A {@link PropertySet} has a list of {@link Section}s, and each {@link Section} has a {@link Property} array. Use {@link #GetSections} To retrieve the {@link Section}s, then call {@link Section#GetProperties} for each {@link Section} To Get hold of the {@link Property} arrays. Since the vast majority of {@link PropertySet}s Contains only a single {@link Section}, the convenience method {@link #GetProperties} returns the properties of a {@link PropertySet}'s {@link Section} (throwing a {@link NoSingleSectionException} if the {@link PropertySet} Contains more (or less) than exactly one {@link Section}). @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @author Drew Varner (Drew.Varner hanginIn sc.edu) @since 2002-02-09 The "byteOrder" field must equal this value. Specifies this {@link PropertySet}'s byte order. See the HPFS documentation for details! Gets or sets the property Set stream's low-level "byte order" field. It is always 0xFFFE The property Set stream's low-level "byte order" field.. The "format" field must equal this value. Specifies this {@link PropertySet}'s format. See the HPFS documentation for details! Gets or sets the property Set stream's low-level "format" field. It is always 0x0000 The property Set stream's low-level "format" field. Specifies the version of the operating system that Created this {@link PropertySet}. See the HPFS documentation for details! If the OS version field holds this value the property Set stream Was Created on a 16-bit Windows system. If the OS version field holds this value the property Set stream Was Created on a Macintosh system. If the OS version field holds this value the property Set stream Was Created on a 32-bit Windows system. Returns the property Set stream's low-level "OS version" field. The property Set stream's low-level "OS version" field. Specifies this {@link PropertySet}'s "classID" field. See the HPFS documentation for details! Gets or sets the property Set stream's low-level "class ID" The property Set stream's low-level "class ID" field. Returns the number of {@link Section}s in the property Set. The number of {@link Section}s in the property Set. The sections in this {@link PropertySet}. Returns the {@link Section}s in the property Set. {@link Section}s in the property Set. Creates an empty (uninitialized) {@link PropertySet} Please note: For the time being this constructor is protected since it is used for internal purposes only, but expect it To become public once the property Set's writing functionality is implemented. Creates a {@link PropertySet} instance from an {@link InputStream} in the Horrible Property Set Format. The constructor Reads the first few bytes from the stream and determines whether it is really a property Set stream. If it Is, it parses the rest of the stream. If it is not, it Resets the stream To its beginning in order To let other components mess around with the data and throws an exception. Holds the data making out the property Set stream. Creates a {@link PropertySet} instance from a byte array that represents a stream in the Horrible Property Set Format. The byte array holding the stream data. The offset in stream where the stream data begin. If the stream data begin with the first byte in the array, the offset is 0. The Length of the stream data. Creates a {@link PropertySet} instance from a byte array that represents a stream in the Horrible Property Set Format. The byte array holding the stream data. The complete byte array contents is the stream data. Checks whether an {@link InputStream} is in the Horrible Property Set Format. The {@link InputStream} To check. In order To perform the check, the method Reads the first bytes from the stream. After Reading, the stream is Reset To the position it had before Reading. The {@link InputStream} must support the {@link InputStream#mark} method. true if the stream is a property Set stream; otherwise, false. Checks whether a byte array is in the Horrible Property Set Format. The byte array To check. The offset in the byte array. The significant number of bytes in the byte array. Only this number of bytes will be checked. true if the byte array is a property Set stream; otherwise, false. Initializes this {@link PropertySet} instance from a byte array. The method assumes that it has been checked alReady that the byte array indeed represents a property Set stream. It does no more checks on its own. Byte array containing the property Set stream The property Set stream starts at this offset Length of the property Set stream. Checks whether this {@link PropertySet} represents a Summary Information. true Checks whether this {@link PropertySet} represents a Summary Information; otherwise, false. Gets a value indicating whether this instance is document summary information. true if this instance is document summary information; otherwise, false. Checks whether this {@link PropertySet} is a Document Summary Information. @return true if this {@link PropertySet} represents a Document Summary Information, else false Convenience method returning the {@link Property} array contained in this property Set. It is a shortcut for Getting the {@link PropertySet}'s {@link Section}s list and then Getting the {@link Property} array from the first {@link Section}. The properties of the only {@link Section} of this {@link PropertySet}. Convenience method returning the value of the property with the specified ID. If the property is not available, null is returned and a subsequent call To {@link #WasNull} will return true . The property ID The property value Convenience method returning the value of a bool property with the specified ID. If the property is not available, false is returned. A subsequent call To {@link #WasNull} will return true To let the caller distinguish that case from a real property value of false. The property ID The property value Convenience method returning the value of the numeric property with the specified ID. If the property is not available, 0 is returned. A subsequent call To {@link #WasNull} will return true To let the caller distinguish that case from a real property value of 0. The property ID The propertyIntValue value Checks whether the property which the last call To {@link #GetPropertyIntValue} or {@link #GetProperty} tried To access Was available or not. This information might be important for callers of {@link #GetPropertyIntValue} since the latter returns 0 if the property does not exist. Using {@link #WasNull}, the caller can distiguish this case from a property's real value of 0. true if the last call To {@link #GetPropertyIntValue} or {@link #GetProperty} tried To access a property that Was not available; otherwise, false. Gets the first section. The first section. If the {@link PropertySet} has only a single section this method returns it. The singleSection value Returns true if the PropertySet is equal To the specified parameter, else false. the object To Compare this PropertySet with true if the objects are equal, false if not Serves as a hash function for a particular type. A hash code for the current . Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Factory class To Create instances of {@link SummaryInformation}, {@link DocumentSummaryInformation} and {@link PropertySet}. @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @since 2002-02-09

Creates the most specific {@link PropertySet} from an entry in the specified POIFS Directory. This is preferrably a {@link DocumentSummaryInformation} or a {@link SummaryInformation}. If the specified entry does not contain a property Set stream, an exception is thrown. If no entry is found with the given name, an exception is thrown.

@param dir The directory to find the PropertySet in @param name The name of the entry Containing the PropertySet @return The Created {@link PropertySet}. @if there is no entry with that name @if the stream does not contain a property Set. @if some I/O problem occurs. @exception EncoderFallbackException if the specified codepage is not supported.
Creates the most specific {@link PropertySet} from an {@link InputStream}. This is preferrably a {@link DocumentSummaryInformation} or a {@link SummaryInformation}. If the specified {@link InputStream} does not contain a property Set stream, an exception is thrown and the {@link InputStream} is repositioned at its beginning. Contains the property set stream's data. The Created {@link PropertySet}. Creates a new summary information the new summary information. Creates a new document summary information. the new document summary information. This exception is thrown when HPSF tries To Read a (yet) unsupported variant type. @see WritingNotSupportedException @see UnsupportedVariantTypeException @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @since 2003-08-08 Initializes a new instance of the class. The unsupported variant type The value who's variant type is not yet supported Represents a section in a {@link PropertySet}. @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @author Drew Varner (Drew.Varner allUpIn sc.edu) @since 2002-02-09 Maps property IDs To section-private PID strings. These strings can be found in the property with ID 0. The section's format ID, {@link #GetFormatID}. Returns the format ID. The format ID is the "type" of the section. For example, if the format ID of the first {@link Section} Contains the bytes specified by org.apache.poi.hpsf.wellknown.SectionIDMap.SUMMARY_INFORMATION_ID the section (and thus the property Set) is a SummaryInformation. The format ID. Gets the offset of the section in the stream. The offset of the section in the stream Returns the section's size in bytes. The section's size in bytes. Returns the number of properties in this section. The number of properties in this section. Returns this section's properties. This section's properties. Creates an empty and uninitialized {@link Section}. Creates a {@link Section} instance from a byte array. Contains the complete property Set stream. The position in the stream that points To the section's format ID. Represents an entry in the property list and holds a property's ID and its offset from the section's beginning. Compares this {@link PropertyListEntry} with another one by their offsets. A {@link PropertyListEntry} is "smaller" than another one if its offset from the section's begin is smaller. @see Comparable#CompareTo(java.lang.Object) Returns the value of the property with the specified ID. If the property is not available, null is returned and a subsequent call To {@link #wasNull} will return true. @param id The property's ID @return The property's value Returns the value of the numeric property with the specified ID. If the property is not available, 0 is returned. A subsequent call To {@link #wasNull} will return true To let the caller distinguish that case from a real property value of 0. @param id The property's ID @return The property's value Returns the value of the bool property with the specified ID. If the property is not available, false Is returned. A subsequent call To {@link #wasNull} will return true To let the caller distinguish that case from a real property value of false. @param id The property's ID @return The property's value This member is true if the last call To {@link #GetPropertyIntValue} or {@link #GetProperty} tried To access a property that was not available, else false. Checks whether the property which the last call To {@link #GetPropertyIntValue} or {@link #GetProperty} tried To access was available or not. This information might be important for callers of {@link #GetPropertyIntValue} since the latter returns 0 if the property does not exist. Using {@link #wasNull} the caller can distiguish this case from a property's real value of 0. true if the last call To {@link #GetPropertyIntValue} or {@link #GetProperty} tried To access a property that was not available; otherwise, false. Returns the PID string associated with a property ID. The ID is first looked up in the {@link Section}'s private dictionary. If it is not found there, the method calls {@link SectionIDMap#GetPIDString}. The property ID. The property ID's string value Checks whether this section is equal To another object. The result Is false if one of the the following conditions holds:
  • The other object is not a {@link Section}.
  • The format IDs of the two sections are not equal.
  • The sections have a different number of properties. However, properties with ID 1 (codepage) are not counted.
  • The other object is not a {@link Section}.
  • The properties have different values. The order of the properties is irrelevant.
@param o The object To Compare this section with @return true if the objects are equal, false if not
Removes a field from a property array. The resulting array Is compactified and returned. The property array. The index of the field To be Removed. the compactified array. Serves as a hash function for a particular type. A hash code for the current . Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Gets the section's dictionary. A dictionary allows an application To use human-Readable property names instead of numeric property IDs. It Contains mappings from property IDs To their associated string values. The dictionary is stored as the property with ID 0. The codepage for the strings in the dictionary is defined by property with ID 1. the dictionary or null if the section does not have a dictionary. Gets the section's codepage, if any. The section's codepage if one is defined, else -1. Abstract superclass for the convenience classes {@link SummaryInformation} and {@link DocumentSummaryInformation}. The motivation behind this class is quite nasty if you look behind the scenes, but it serves the application programmer well by providing him with the easy-to-use {@link SummaryInformation} and {@link DocumentSummaryInformation} classes. When parsing the data a property Set stream consists of (possibly coming from an {@link java.io.Stream}) we want To Read and process each byte only once. Since we don't know in advance which kind of property Set we have, we can expect only the most general {@link PropertySet}. Creating a special subclass should be as easy as calling the special subclass' constructor and pass the general {@link PropertySet} in. To make things easy internally, the special class just holds a reference To the general {@link PropertySet} and delegates all method calls To it. A cleaner implementation would have been like this: The {@link PropertySetFactory} parses the stream data into some internal object first. Then it Finds out whether the stream is a {@link SummaryInformation}, a {@link DocumentSummaryInformation} or a general {@link PropertySet}. However, the current implementation went the other way round historically: the convenience classes came only late To my mind. @author Rainer Klute klute@rainer-klute.de @since 2002-02-09 The id to name mapping of the properties in this set. The "real" property Set SpecialPropertySet delegates To. Initializes a new instance of the class. The property Set To be encapsulated by the SpecialPropertySet Initializes a new instance of the class. The mutable property Set To be encapsulated by the SpecialPropertySet gets or sets the "byteOrder" property. the byteOrder value To Set gets or sets the "format" property the format value To Set gets or sets the property Set stream's low-level "class ID" field. The property Set stream's low-level "class ID" field Returns the number of {@link Section}s in the property Set. The number of {@link Section}s in the property Set. Checks whether this {@link PropertySet} represents a Summary Information. true Checks whether this {@link PropertySet} represents a Summary Information; otherwise, false. Gets a value indicating whether this instance is document summary information. true if this instance is document summary information; otherwise, false. Checks whether this {@link PropertySet} is a Document Summary Information. @return true if this {@link PropertySet} represents a Document Summary Information, else false Gets the PropertySet's first section. The {@link PropertySet}'s first section. Adds a section To this property set. The {@link Section} To Add. It will be Appended after any sections that are alReady present in the property Set and thus become the last section. Removes all sections from this property Set. gets or sets the "osVersion" property the osVersion value To Set Writes a property Set To a document in a POI filesystem directory. The directory in the POI filesystem To Write the document To The document's name. If there is alReady a document with the same name in the directory the latter will be overwritten. Writes the property Set To an output stream. the output stream To Write the section To Returns true if the PropertySet is equal To the specified parameter, else false. the object To Compare this PropertySet with true if the objects are equal, false if not Convenience method returning the {@link Property} array contained in this property Set. It is a shortcut for Getting the {@link PropertySet}'s {@link Section}s list and then Getting the {@link Property} array from the first {@link Section}. The properties of the only {@link Section} of this {@link PropertySet}. Convenience method returning the value of the property with the specified ID. If the property is not available, null is returned and a subsequent call To {@link #WasNull} will return true . The property ID The property value Convenience method returning the value of a bool property with the specified ID. If the property is not available, false is returned. A subsequent call To {@link #WasNull} will return true To let the caller distinguish that case from a real property value of false. The property ID The property value Convenience method returning the value of the numeric property with the specified ID. If the property is not available, 0 is returned. A subsequent call To {@link #WasNull} will return true To let the caller distinguish that case from a real property value of 0. The property ID The propertyIntValue value Fetches the property with the given ID, then does its best to return it as a String @return The property as a String, or null if unavailable Serves as a hash function for a particular type. A hash code for the current . Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Checks whether the property which the last call To {@link #GetPropertyIntValue} or {@link #GetProperty} tried To access Was available or not. This information might be important for callers of {@link #GetPropertyIntValue} since the latter returns 0 if the property does not exist. Using {@link #WasNull}, the caller can distiguish this case from a property's real value of 0. true if the last call To {@link #GetPropertyIntValue} or {@link #GetProperty} tried To access a property that Was not available; otherwise, false. Convenience class representing a Summary Information stream in a Microsoft Office document. @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @see DocumentSummaryInformation @since 2002-02-09 The document name a summary information stream usually has in a POIFS filesystem. Initializes a new instance of the class. A property Set which should be Created from a summary information stream. Gets or sets the title. The title. Removes the title. Gets or sets the subject. The subject. Removes the subject. Gets or sets the author. The author. Removes the author. Gets or sets the keywords. The keywords. Removes the keywords. Gets or sets the comments. The comments. Removes the comments. Gets or sets the template. The template. Removes the template. Gets or sets the last author. The last author. Removes the last author. Gets or sets the rev number. The rev number. Removes the rev number. Returns the Total time spent in editing the document (or 0). The Total time spent in editing the document or 0 if the {@link SummaryInformation} does not contain this information. Removes the edit time. Gets or sets the last printed time The last printed time Returns the last printed time (or null). Removes the last printed. Gets or sets the create date time. The create date time. Removes the create date time. Gets or sets the last save date time. The last save date time. Removes the last save date time. Gets or sets the page count or 0 if the {@link SummaryInformation} does not contain a page count. The page count or 0 if the {@link SummaryInformation} does not contain a page count. Removes the page count. Gets or sets the word count or 0 if the {@link SummaryInformation} does not contain a word count. The word count. Removes the word count. Gets or sets the character count or 0 if the {@link SummaryInformation} does not contain a char count. The character count. Removes the char count. Gets or sets the thumbnail (or null) when this method is implemented. Please note that the return type is likely To Change! Hint To developers: Drew Varner <Drew.Varner -at- sc.edu> said that this is an image in WMF or Clipboard (BMP?) format. However, we won't do any conversion into any image type but instead just return a byte array. The thumbnail. Removes the thumbnail. Gets or sets the name of the application. The name of the application. Removes the name of the application. Gets or sets a security code which is one of the following values:
  • 0 if the {@link SummaryInformation} does not contain a security field or if there is no security on the document. Use {@link PropertySet#wasNull()} To distinguish between the two cases!
  • 1 if the document is password protected
  • 2 if the document is Read-only recommended
  • 4 if the document is Read-only enforced
  • 8 if the document is locked for annotations
The security code
Removes the security code. Class To manipulate data in the Clipboard Variant (Variant#VT_CF VT_CF) format. @author Drew Varner (Drew.Varner inOrAround sc.edu) @since 2002-04-29 OffSet in bytes where the Clipboard Format Tag starts in the byte[] returned by SummaryInformation#GetThumbnail() OffSet in bytes where the Clipboard Format starts in the byte[] returned by SummaryInformation#GetThumbnail() This is only valid if the Clipboard Format Tag is CFTAG_WINDOWS OffSet in bytes where the Windows Metafile (WMF) image data starts in the byte[] returned by SummaryInformation#GetThumbnail() There is only WMF data at this point in the byte[] if the Clipboard Format Tag is CFTAG_WINDOWS and the Clipboard Format is CF_METAFILEPICT. Note: The byte[] that starts at OFFSet_WMFDATA and ends at GetThumbnail().Length - 1 forms a complete WMF image. It can be saved To disk with a .wmf file type and Read using a WMF-capable image viewer. Clipboard Format Tag - Windows clipboard format A DWORD indicating a built-in Windows clipboard format value Clipboard Format Tag - Macintosh clipboard format A DWORD indicating a Macintosh clipboard format value Clipboard Format Tag - Format ID A GUID containing a format identifier (FMTID). This is rarely used. Clipboard Format Tag - No Data A DWORD indicating No data. This is rarely used. Clipboard Format - Windows metafile format. This is the recommended way To store thumbnails in Property Streams. Note:This is not the same format used in regular WMF images. The clipboard version of this format has an extra clipboard-specific header. Clipboard Format - Device Independent Bitmap Clipboard Format - Enhanced Windows metafile format Clipboard Format - Bitmap see msdn.microsoft.com/library/en-us/dnw98bk/html/clipboardoperations.asp A byte[] To hold a thumbnail image in ( Variant#VT_CF VT_CF) format. Default Constructor. If you use it then one you'll have To Add the thumbnail byte[] from {@link SummaryInformation#GetThumbnail()} To do any useful manipulations, otherwise you'll Get a NullPointerException. Initializes a new instance of the class. The thumbnail data. Gets or sets the thumbnail as a byte[] in {@link Variant#VT_CF VT_CF} format. The thumbnail value Returns an int representing the Clipboard Format Tag Possible return values are:
  • {@link #CFTAG_WINDOWS CFTAG_WINDOWS}
  • {@link #CFTAG_MACINTOSH CFTAG_MACINTOSH}
  • {@link #CFTAG_FMTID CFTAG_FMTID}
  • {@link #CFTAG_NODATA CFTAG_NODATA}
A flag indicating the Clipboard Format Tag
Returns an int representing the Clipboard Format Will throw an exception if the Thumbnail's Clipboard Format Tag is not {@link Thumbnail#CFTAG_WINDOWS CFTAG_WINDOWS}. Possible return values are:
  • {@link #CF_METAFILEPICT CF_METAFILEPICT}
  • {@link #CF_DIB CF_DIB}
  • {@link #CF_ENHMETAFILE CF_ENHMETAFILE}
  • {@link #CF_BITMAP CF_BITMAP}
a flag indicating the Clipboard Format
Returns the Thumbnail as a byte[] of WMF data if the Thumbnail's Clipboard Format Tag is {@link #CFTAG_WINDOWS CFTAG_WINDOWS} and its Clipboard Format is {@link #CF_METAFILEPICT CF_METAFILEPICT} This byte[] is in the traditional WMF file, not the clipboard-specific version with special headers. See http://www.wvware.com/caolan/ora-wmf.html for more information on the WMF image format. @return A WMF image of the Thumbnail @throws HPSFException if the Thumbnail isn't CFTAG_WINDOWS and CF_METAFILEPICT Class for writing little-endian data and more. @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @since 2003-02-20 Writes a two-byte value (short) To an output stream. The stream To Write To.. The number of bytes that have been written. Writes a four-byte value To an output stream. @param out The stream To Write To. @param n The value To Write. @exception IOException if an I/O error occurs @return The number of bytes written To the output stream. Writes a four-byte value To an output stream. @param out The stream To Write To. @param n The value To Write. @exception IOException if an I/O error occurs @return The number of bytes written To the output stream. Writes a eight-byte value To an output stream. @param out The stream To Write To. @param n The value To Write. @exception IOException if an I/O error occurs @return The number of bytes written To the output stream. Writes an unsigned two-byte value To an output stream. @param out The stream To Write To @param n The value To Write @exception IOException if an I/O error occurs Writes an unsigned four-byte value To an output stream. @param out The stream To Write To. @param n The value To Write. @return The number of bytes that have been written To the output stream. @exception IOException if an I/O error occurs Writes a 16-byte {@link ClassID} To an output stream. @param out The stream To Write To @param n The value To Write @return The number of bytes written @exception IOException if an I/O error occurs Writes an array of {@link Property} instances To an output stream according To the Horrible Property Format. @param out The stream To Write To @param properties The array To Write To the stream @param codepage The codepage number To use for writing strings @exception IOException if an I/O error occurs @throws UnsupportedVariantTypeException if HPSF does not support some variant type. Writes a double value value To an output stream. @param out The stream To Write To. @param n The value To Write. @exception IOException if an I/O error occurs @return The number of bytes written To the output stream. This exception is thrown if a certain type of property Set Is expected (e.g. a Document Summary Information) but the provided property Set is not of that type. The constructors of this class are analogous To those of its superclass and documented there. @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @since 2002-02-09 Initializes a new instance of the class. Initializes a new instance of the class. The message string. Initializes a new instance of the class. The reason, i.e. a throwable that indirectly caused this exception. Initializes a new instance of the class. The message string. The reason, i.e. a throwable that indirectly caused this exception. Checks to see if the specified length seems valid, given the amount of data available still to read, and the requirement that the string be NULL-terminated The Character Encoding is not supported. @author Asmus Freytag @since JDK1.1 Constructs an UnsupportedEncodingException without a detail message. Constructs an UnsupportedEncodingException with a detail message. @param s Describes the reason for the exception. This exception is thrown if HPSF encounters a variant type that isn't supported yet. Although a variant type is unsupported the value can still be retrieved using the {@link VariantTypeException#GetValue} method. Obviously this class should disappear some day. @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @since 2003-08-05 Initializes a new instance of the class. The unsupported variant type The value who's variant type is not yet supported Provides various static utility methods. @author Rainer Klute (klute@rainer-klute.de) @since 2002-02-09 Copies a part of a byte array into another byte array. The source byte array. OffSet in the source byte array. The number of bytes To Copy. The destination byte array. OffSet in the destination byte array. Concatenates the contents of several byte arrays into a single one. The byte arrays To be conCatened. A new byte array containing the conCatenated byte arrays. Copies bytes from a source byte array into a new byte array. Copy from this byte array. Start Copying here. Copy this many bytes. The new byte array. Its Length is number of copied bytes. The difference between the Windows epoch (1601-01-01 00:00:00) and the Unix epoch (1970-01-01 00:00:00) in milliseconds: 11644473600000L. (Use your favorite spReadsheet program To verify the correctness of this value. By the way, did you notice that you can tell from the epochs which operating system is the modern one? :-)) Converts a Windows FILETIME into a {@link DateTime}. The Windows FILETIME structure holds a DateTime and time associated with a file. The structure identifies a 64-bit integer specifying the number of 100-nanosecond intervals which have passed since January 1, 1601. This 64-bit value is split into the two double words stored in the structure. The higher double word of the FILETIME structure. The lower double word of the FILETIME structure. The Windows FILETIME as a {@link DateTime}. Converts a Windows FILETIME into a {@link DateTime}. The Windows FILETIME structure holds a DateTime and time associated with a file. The structure identifies a 64-bit integer specifying the number of 100-nanosecond intervals which have passed since January 1, 1601. The filetime To Convert. The Windows FILETIME as a {@link DateTime}. Converts a {@link DateTime} into a filetime. The DateTime To be Converted The filetime Compares To object arrays with regarding the objects' order. For example, [1, 2, 3] and [2, 1, 3] are equal. The first object array. The second object array. true if the object arrays are equal, false if they are not. Internals the equals. The c1. The c2. Pads a byte array with 0x00 bytes so that its Length is a multiple of 4. The byte array To pad. The padded byte array. Pads a character array with 0x0000 characters so that its Length is a multiple of 4. The character array To pad. The padded character array. Pads a string with 0x0000 characters so that its Length is a multiple of 4. The string To pad. The padded string as a character array. The Variant types as defined by Microsoft's COM. I found this information in http://www.marin.clara.net/COM/variant_type_definitions.htm. In the variant types descriptions the following shortcuts are used: [V] - may appear in a VARIANT, [T] - may appear in a TYPEDESC, [P] - may appear in an OLE property Set, [S] - may appear in a Safe Array. @author Rainer Klute (klute@rainer-klute.de) @since 2002-02-09 [V][P] Nothing, i.e. not a single byte of data. [V][P] SQL style Null. [V][T][P][S] 2 byte signed int. [V][T][P][S] 4 byte signed int. [V][T][P][S] 4 byte real. [V][T][P][S] 8 byte real. [V][T][P][S] currency. How long is this? How is it To be interpreted? [V][T][P][S] DateTime. How long is this? How is it To be interpreted? [V][T][P][S] OLE Automation string. How long is this? How is it To be interpreted? [V][T][P][S] IDispatch *. How long is this? How is it To be interpreted? [V][T][S] SCODE. How long is this? How is it To be interpreted? [V][T][P][S] True=-1, False=0. [V][T][P][S] VARIANT *. How long is this? How is it To be interpreted? [V][T][S] IUnknown *. How long is this? How is it To be interpreted? [V][T][S] 16 byte fixed point. [T] signed char. [V][T][P][S] unsigned char. [T][P] unsigned short. [T][P] unsigned int. [T][P] signed 64-bit int. [T][P] unsigned 64-bit int. [T] signed machine int. [T] unsigned machine int. [T] C style void. [T] Standard return type. How long is this? How is it To be interpreted? [T] pointer type. How long is this? How is it To be interpreted? [T] (use VT_ARRAY in VARIANT). [T] C style array. How long is this? How is it To be interpreted? [T] user defined type. How long is this? How is it To be interpreted? [T][P] null terminated string. [T][P] wide (Unicode) null terminated string. [P] FILETIME. The FILETIME structure holds a DateTime and time associated with a file. The structure identifies a 64-bit integer specifying the number of 100-nanosecond intervals which have passed since January 1, 1601. This 64-bit value is split into the two dwords stored in the structure. [P] Length prefixed bytes. [P] Name of the stream follows. [P] Name of the storage follows. [P] Stream Contains an object. How long is this? How is it To be interpreted? [P] Storage Contains an object. How long is this? How is it To be interpreted? [P] Blob Contains an object. How long is this? How is it To be interpreted? [P] Clipboard format. How long is this? How is it To be interpreted? [P] A Class ID. It consists of a 32 bit unsigned integer indicating the size of the structure, a 32 bit signed integer indicating (Clipboard Format Tag) indicating the type of data that it Contains, and then a byte array containing the data. The valid Clipboard Format Tags are:
  • {@link Thumbnail#CFTAG_WINDOWS}
  • {@link Thumbnail#CFTAG_MACINTOSH}
  • {@link Thumbnail#CFTAG_NODATA}
  • {@link Thumbnail#CFTAG_FMTID}
typedef struct tagCLIPDATA {
             // cbSize is the size of the buffer pointed To
             // by pClipData, plus sizeof(ulClipFmt)
             ULONG              cbSize;
             long               ulClipFmt;
             BYTE*              pClipData;
             } CLIPDATA;
See msdn.microsoft.com/library/en-us/com/stgrstrc_0uwk.asp.
"MUST be a VersionedStream. The storage representing the (non-simple) property set MUST have a stream element with the name in the StreamName field." -- [MS-OLEPS] -- v20110920; Object Linking and Embedding (OLE) Property Set Data Structures; page 24 / 63 [P] simple counted array. How long is this? How is it To be interpreted? [V] SAFEARRAY*. How long is this? How is it To be interpreted? [V] void* for local use. How long is this? How is it To be interpreted? FIXME (3): Document this! FIXME (3): Document this! FIXME (3): Document this! FIXME (3): Document this! Maps the numbers denoting the variant types To their corresponding variant type names. Denotes a variant type with a Length that is unknown To HPSF yet. Denotes a variant type with a variable Length. Denotes a variant type with a Length of 0 bytes. Denotes a variant type with a Length of 2 bytes. Denotes a variant type with a Length of 4 bytes. Denotes a variant type with a Length of 8 bytes. Returns the variant type name associated with a variant type number. The variant type number. The variant type name or the string "unknown variant type" Returns a variant type's Length. The variant type number. The Length of the variant type's data in bytes. If the Length Is variable, i.e. the Length of a string, -1 is returned. If HPSF does not know the Length, -2 is returned. The latter usually indicates an unsupported variant type. Supports Reading and writing of variant data. FIXME (3): Reading and writing should be made more uniform than it is now. The following items should be resolved: Reading requires a Length parameter that is 4 byte greater than the actual data, because the variant type field is included. Reading Reads from a byte array while writing Writes To an byte array output stream. @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @since 2003-08-08 Checks whether logging of unsupported variant types warning is turned on or off. true if logging is turned on; otherwise, false. Keeps a list of the variant types an "unsupported" message has alReady been issued for. Writes a warning To System.err that a variant type Is unsupported by HPSF. Such a warning is written only once for each variant type. Log messages can be turned on or off by The exception To log HPSF is able To Read these {@link Variant} types. Checks whether HPSF supports the specified variant type. Unsupported types should be implemented included in the {@link #SUPPORTED_TYPES} array. the variant type To check true if HPFS supports this type,otherwise, false. Reads a variant type from a byte array The byte array The offset in the byte array where the variant starts The Length of the variant including the variant type field The variant type To Read The codepage To use for non-wide strings A Java object that corresponds best To the variant field. For example, a VT_I4 is returned as a {@link long}, a VT_LPSTR as a {@link String}.

Turns a codepage number into the equivalent character encoding's name.

@param codepage The codepage number @return The character encoding's name. If the codepage number is 65001, the encoding name is "UTF-8". All other positive numbers are mapped to "cp" followed by the number, e.g. if the codepage number is 1252 the returned character encoding name will be "cp1252". @exception UnsupportedEncodingException if the specified codepage is less than zero.
Writes a variant value To an output stream. This method ensures that always a multiple of 4 bytes is written. If the codepage is UTF-16, which is encouraged, strings must always be written as {@link Variant#VT_LPWSTR} strings, not as {@link Variant#VT_LPSTR} strings. This method ensure this by Converting strings appropriately, if needed. The stream To Write the value To. The variant's type. The variant's value. The codepage To use To Write non-wide strings The number of entities that have been written. In many cases an "entity" is a byte but this is not always the case. This exception is thrown if HPSF encounters a problem with a variant type. Concrete subclasses specifiy the problem further. @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @since 2004-06-21 Initializes a new instance of the class. The variant type causing the problem The value who's variant type causes the problem A message text describing the problem Gets the offending variant type the offending variant type. Returns the value who's variant type caused the problem. the value who's variant type caused the problem. This is a dictionary which maps property ID values To property ID strings. The methods {@link #GetSummaryInformationProperties} and {@link #GetDocumentSummaryInformationProperties} return singleton {@link PropertyIDMap}s. An application that wants To extend these maps should treat them as unmodifiable, copy them and modifiy the copies. @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @since 2002-02-09 ID of the property that denotes the document's title ID of the property that denotes the document's subject ID of the property that denotes the document's author ID of the property that denotes the document's keywords ID of the property that denotes the document's comments ID of the property that denotes the document's template ID of the property that denotes the document's last author ID of the property that denotes the document's revision number ID of the property that denotes the document's edit time ID of the property that denotes the DateTime and time the document was last printed ID of the property that denotes the DateTime and time the document was Created. ID of the property that denotes the DateTime and time the document was saved ID of the property that denotes the number of pages in the document ID of the property that denotes the number of words in the document ID of the property that denotes the number of characters in the document ID of the property that denotes the document's thumbnail ID of the property that denotes the application that Created the document ID of the property that denotes whether Read/Write access To the document is allowed or whether is should be opened as Read-only. It can have the following values:
Value Description
0 No restriction
2 Read-only recommended
4 Read-only enforced
The entry is a dictionary. The entry denotes a code page. The entry is a string denoting the category the file belongs To, e.g. review, memo, etc. This is useful To Find documents of same type. TarGet format for power point presentation, e.g. 35mm, printer, video etc. Number of bytes. Number of lines. Number of paragraphs. Number of slides in a power point presentation. Number of slides with notes. Number of hidden slides. Number of multimedia clips, e.g. sound or video. This entry is Set To -1 when scaling of the thumbnail Is desired. Otherwise the thumbnail should be cropped. This entry denotes an internally used property. It is a vector of variants consisting of pairs of a string (VT_LPSTR) and a number (VT_I4). The string is a heading name, and the number tells how many document parts are under that heading. This entry Contains the names of document parts (word: names of the documents in the master document, excel: sheet names, power point: slide titles, binder: document names). This entry Contains the name of the project manager. This entry Contains the company name. If this entry is -1 the links are dirty and should be re-evaluated. The highest well-known property ID. Applications are free To use higher values for custom purposes. Contains the summary information property ID values and associated strings. See the overall HPSF documentation for details! Contains the summary information property ID values and associated strings. See the overall HPSF documentation for details! Initializes a new instance of the class. initialCapacity The initial capacity as defined for {@link HashMap} The load factor as defined for {@link HashMap} Initializes a new instance of the class. The instance To be Created is backed by this map. Puts a ID string for an ID into the {@link PropertyIDMap}. The ID string. The id string. As specified by the {@link java.util.Map} interface, this method returns the previous value associated with the specified id Gets the ID string for an ID from the {@link PropertyIDMap}. The ID. The ID string associated with id Gets the Summary Information properties singleton Gets the Document Summary Information properties singleton. The Document Summary Information properties singleton. Maps section format IDs To {@link PropertyIDMap}s. It Is initialized with two well-known section format IDs: those of the \005SummaryInformation stream and the \005DocumentSummaryInformation stream. If you have a section format ID you can use it as a key To query this map. If you Get a {@link PropertyIDMap} returned your section is well-known and you can query the {@link PropertyIDMap} for PID strings. If you Get back null you are on your own. This {@link java.util.Map} expects the byte arrays of section format IDs as keys. A key maps To a {@link PropertyIDMap} describing the property IDs in sections with the specified section format ID. @author Rainer Klute (klute@rainer-klute.de) @since 2002-02-09 The SummaryInformation's section's format ID. The DocumentSummaryInformation's first and second sections' format ID. A property without a known name is described by this string. The default section ID map. It maps section format IDs To {@link PropertyIDMap}s. Returns the singleton instance of the default {@link SectionIDMap}. The instance value Returns the property ID string that is associated with a given property ID in a section format ID's namespace. Each section format ID has its own name space of property ID strings and thus must be specified. The property ID The well-known property ID string associated with the property ID pid in the name space spanned by sectionFormatID If the pid sectionFormatID combination is not well-known, the string "[undefined]" is returned. Returns the {@link PropertyIDMap} for a given section format ID. The section format ID. the property ID map Returns the {@link PropertyIDMap} for a given section format ID. A section format ID as a byte[] the property ID map Associates a section format ID with a {@link PropertyIDMap}. the section format ID The property ID map. Puts the specified key. This parameter remains undocumented since the method Is deprecated. This parameter remains undocumented since the method Is deprecated. The return value remains undocumented since the method Is deprecated. This exception is thrown when trying To Write a (yet) unsupported variant type. @see ReadingNotSupportedException @see UnsupportedVariantTypeException @author Rainer Klute <klute@rainer-klute.de> @since 2003-08-08 Initializes a new instance of the class. The unsupported variant type. The value An ERFListener Is registered with the EventRecordFactory. An ERFListener listens for Records coming from the stream via the EventRecordFactory @see EventRecordFactory @author Andrew C. Oliver acoliver@apache.org Process a Record. This method Is called by the EventRecordFactory when a record Is returned. @return bool specifying whether the effort was a success. Event-based record factory. As opposed to RecordFactory this refactored version throws record events as it comes accross the records. I throws the "lazily" one record behind to ensure that ContinueRecords are Processed first. @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver@apache.org) - probably to blame for the bugs (so yank his chain on the list) @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) - methods taken from RecordFactory @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) - methods taken from RecordFactory @author Csaba Nagy (ncsaba at yahoo dot com) Create an EventRecordFactory @param abortable specifies whether the return from the listener handler functions are obeyed. False means they are ignored. True means the event loop exits on error. sends the record event to all registered listeners. @param record the record to be thrown. @return false to abort. This aborts out of the event loop should the listener return false Create an array of records from an input stream @param in the InputStream from which the records will be obtained @exception RecordFormatException on error Processing the InputStream Interface for use with the HSSFRequest and HSSFEventFactory. Users should Create a listener supporting this interface and register it with the HSSFRequest (associating it with Record SID's). @see org.apache.poi.hssf.eventusermodel.HSSFEventFactory @see org.apache.poi.hssf.eventusermodel.HSSFRequest @see org.apache.poi.hssf.eventusermodel.HSSFUserException @author Carey Sublette (careysub@earthling.net) This method, inherited from HSSFListener Is implemented as a stub. It Is never called by HSSFEventFActory or HSSFRequest. Process an HSSF Record. Called when a record occurs in an HSSF file. Provides two options for halting the Processing of the HSSF file. The return value provides a means of non-error termination with a user-defined result code. A value of zero must be returned to continue Processing, any other value will halt Processing by HSSFEventFactory with the code being passed back by its abortable Process events methods. Error termination can be done by throwing the HSSFUserException. Note that HSSFEventFactory will not call the inherited Process @return result code of zero for continued Processing. @throws HSSFUserException User code can throw this to abort file Processing by HSSFEventFactory and return diagnostic information. A dummy record to indicate that we've now had the last cell record for this row. Returns the (0 based) number of the row we are currently working on. Returns the (0 based) number of the last column seen for this row. You should have alReady been called with that record. This Is -1 in the case of there being no columns for the row. A dummy record for when we're missing a cell in a row, but still want to trigger something A dummy record for when we're missing a row, but still want to trigger something When working with the EventUserModel, if you want to Process formulas, you need an instance of Workbook to pass to a HSSFWorkbook, to finally give to HSSFFormulaParser, and this will build you stub ones. Since you're working with the EventUserModel, you wouldn't want to Get a full Workbook and HSSFWorkbook, as they would eat too much memory. Instead, you should collect a few key records as they go past, then call this once you have them to build a stub Workbook, and from that a stub HSSFWorkbook, to use with the HSSFFormulaParser. The records you should collect are: ExternSheetRecord BoundSheetRecord You should probably also collect SSTRecord, but it's not required to pass this in. To help, this class includes a HSSFListener wrapper that will do the collecting for you. Creates a stub Workbook from the supplied records, suitable for use with the {@link HSSFFormulaParser} The ExternSheetRecords in your file The BoundSheetRecords in your file TThe SSTRecord in your file. A stub Workbook suitable for use with HSSFFormulaParser Creates a stub workbook from the supplied records, suitable for use with the HSSFFormulaParser The ExternSheetRecords in your file A stub Workbook suitable for use with HSSFFormulaParser A stub Workbook suitable for use with {@link HSSFFormulaParser} A wrapping HSSFListener which will collect BoundSheetRecords and {@link ExternSheetRecord}s as they go past, so you can Create a Stub {@link Workbook} from them once required. Initializes a new instance of the class. The child listener. Gets the bound sheet records. Gets the extern sheet records. Gets the SST record. Gets the stub HSSF workbook. Gets the stub workbook. Process this record ourselves, and then pass it on to our child listener The record. Process the record ourselves, but do not pass it on to the child Listener. The record. A proxy HSSFListener that keeps track of the document formatting records, and provides an easy way to look up the format strings used by cells from their ids. Process this record ourselves, and then pass it on to our child listener Process the record ourselves, but do not pass it on to the child Listener. @param record Formats the given numeric of date Cell's contents as a String, in as close as we can to the way that Excel would do so. Uses the various format records to manage this. TODO - move this to a central class in such a way that hssf.usermodel can make use of it too Returns the format string, eg $##.##, for the given number format index. Returns the format string, eg $##.##, used by your cell Returns the index of the format string, used by your cell, or -1 if none found Low level event based HSSF Reader. Pass either a DocumentInputStream to Process events along with a request object or pass a POIFS POIFSFileSystem to ProcessWorkbookEvents along with a request. This will cause your file to be Processed a record at a time. Each record with a static id matching one that you have registed in your HSSFRequest will be passed to your associated HSSFListener. @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Carey Sublette (careysub@earthling.net) Creates a new instance of HSSFEventFactory Processes a file into essentially record events. an Instance of HSSFRequest which has your registered listeners a POIFS filesystem containing your workbook Processes a file into essentially record events. an Instance of HSSFRequest which has your registered listeners a POIFS filesystem containing your workbook numeric user-specified result code. Processes a DocumentInputStream into essentially Record events. If an AbortableHSSFListener causes a halt to Processing during this call the method will return just as with abortableProcessEvents , but no user code or HSSFUserException will be passed back. an Instance of HSSFRequest which has your registered listeners a DocumentInputStream obtained from POIFS's POIFSFileSystem object Processes a DocumentInputStream into essentially Record events. an Instance of HSSFRequest which has your registered listeners a DocumentInputStream obtained from POIFS's POIFSFileSystem object numeric user-specified result code. Processes a DocumentInputStream into essentially Record events. an Instance of HSSFRequest which has your registered listeners a DocumentInputStream obtained from POIFS's POIFSFileSystem object numeric user-specified result code. Interface for use with the HSSFRequest and HSSFEventFactory. Users should Create a listener supporting this interface and register it with the HSSFRequest (associating it with Record SID's). @author acoliver@apache.org Process an HSSF Record. Called when a record occurs in an HSSF file. The record. A stream based way to Get at complete records, with as low a memory footprint as possible. This handles Reading from a RecordInputStream, turning the data into full records, Processing continue records etc. Most users should use HSSFEventFactory HSSFListener and have new records pushed to them, but this does allow for a "pull" style of coding. Have we run out of records on the stream? Have we returned all the records there are? Sometimes we end up with a bunch of records. When we do, these should be returned before the next normal record Processing occurs (i.e. before we Check for continue records and return rec) The next record to return, which may need to have its continue records passed to it before we do The most recent record that we gave to the user The most recent DrawingRecord seen Returns the next (complete) record from the stream, or null if there are no more. If there are any "bonus" records, that should be returned before Processing new ones, grabs the next and returns it. If not, returns null; Returns the next available record, or null if this pass didn't return a record that's suitable for returning (eg was a continue record). An HSSFRequest object should be constructed registering an instance or multiple instances of HSSFListener with each Record.sid you wish to listen for. @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Carey Sublette (careysub@earthling.net) Creates a new instance of HSSFRequest Add an event listener for a particular record type. The trick Is you have to know what the records are for or just start with our examples and build on them. Alternatively, you CAN call AddListenerForAllRecords and you'll recieve ALL record events in one listener, but if you like to squeeze every last byte of efficiency out of life you my not like this. (its sure as heck what I plan to do) for the event identifier for the record type this Is the .sid static member on the individual records This Is the equivilent of calling AddListener(myListener, sid) for EVERY record in the org.apache.poi.hssf.record package. This Is for lazy people like me. You can call this more than once with more than one listener, but that seems like a bad thing to do from a practice-perspective Unless you have a compelling reason to do so (like maybe you send the event two places or log it or something?). a single listener to associate with ALL records Called by HSSFEventFactory, passes the Record to each listener associated with a record.sid. Exception and return value Added 2002-04-19 by Carey Sublette The record. numeric user-specified result code. If zero continue Processing. This exception Is provided as a way for API users to throw exceptions from their event handling code. By doing so they abort file Processing by the HSSFEventFactory and by catching it from outside the HSSFEventFactory.ProcessEvents method they can diagnose the cause for the abort. The HSSFUserException supports a nested "reason" throwable, i.e. an exception that caused this one to be thrown. The HSSF package does not itself throw any of these exceptions. @author Rainer Klute (klute@rainer-klute.de) @author Carey Sublette (careysub@earthling.net) Creates a new HSSFUserException Creates a new HSSFUserException with a message string. The MSG. Creates a new HSSFUserException with a reason. The reason. Creates a new HSSFUserException with a message string and a reason. The MSG. The reason. A HSSFListener which tracks rows and columns, and will trigger your HSSFListener for all rows and cells, even the ones that aren't actually stored in the file. This allows your code to have a more "Excel" like view of the data in the file, and not have to worry (as much) about if a particular row/cell Is in the file, or was skipped from being written as it was blank. Constructs a new MissingRecordAwareHSSFListener, which will fire ProcessRecord on the supplied child HSSFListener for all Records, and missing records. The HSSFListener to pass records on to Process an HSSF Record. Called when a record occurs in an HSSF file. A text extractor for Excel files, that is based on the hssf eventusermodel api. It will typically use less memory than ExcelExtractor, but may not provide the same richness of formatting. Returns the textual content of the file, suitable for indexing by something like Lucene, but not really intended for display to the user. Would return the document information metadata for the document, if we supported it The doc summary information. Would return the summary information metadata for the document, if we supported it The summary information. Should sheet names be included? Default is true if set to true [include sheet names]. Should we return the formula itself, and not the result it produces? Default is false if set to true [formulas not results]. Retreives the text contents of the file All the text from the document. Triggers the extraction. Process an HSSF Record. Called when a record occurs in an HSSF file. Formats a number or date cell, be that a real number, or the answer to a formula The cell. The value. A text extractor for Excel files. Returns the textual content of the file, suitable for indexing by something like Lucene, but not really intended for display to the user. Initializes a new instance of the class. The wb. Initializes a new instance of the class. The fs. Should header and footer be included? Default is true Should sheet names be included? Default is true if set to true [include sheet names]. Should we return the formula itself, and not the result it produces? Default is false if set to true [formulas not results]. Should cell comments be included? Default is false if set to true [include cell comments]. Should blank cells be output? Default is to only output cells that are present in the file and are non-blank. if set to true [include blank cells]. Retreives the text contents of the file All the text from the document. Extracts the header footer. The header or footer A text extractor for old Excel files, which are too old for HSSFWorkbook to handle. This includes Excel 95, and very old (pre-OLE2) Excel files, such as Excel 4 files.

Returns much (but not all) of the textual content of the file, suitable for indexing by something like Apache Lucene, or used by Apache Tika, but not really intended for display to the user.

The Biff version, largely corresponding to the Excel version The kind of the file, one of {@link BOFRecord#TYPE_WORKSHEET}, {@link BOFRecord#TYPE_CHART}, {@link BOFRecord#TYPE_EXCEL_4_MACRO} or {@link BOFRecord#TYPE_WORKSPACE_FILE} Retrieves the text contents of the file, as best we can for these old file formats An abstract shape Is the lowlevel model for a shape. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Create a new shape object used to Create the escher records. The simple shape this Is based on. The shape id. The shape container and it's children that can represent this shape. The sp container. The object record that Is associated with this shape. The obj record. Creates an escher anchor record from a HSSFAnchor. The high level anchor to Convert. An escher anchor record. Add standard properties to the opt record. These properties effect all records. The user model shape. The opt record to Add the properties to. The number of options Added. Generate id for the CommonObjectDataSubRecord that stands behind this shape shape id as generated by drawing manager object id that will be assigned to the Obj record Creates the low evel records for a combobox. @param hssfShape The highlevel shape. @param shapeId The shape id to use for this shape. Creates the low level OBJ record for this shape. Generates the escher shape records for this shape. Represents a cell comment. This class Converts highlevel model data from HSSFComment to low-level records. @author Yegor Kozlov Creates the low-level records for a comment. The highlevel shape. The shape id to use for this shape. Creates the low level NoteRecord which holds the comment attributes. The shape. The shape id. Sets standard escher options for a comment. This method is responsible for Setting default background, shading and other comment properties. The highlevel shape. The escher records holding the proerties The number of escher options added Gets the NoteRecord holding the comment attributes The NoteRecord Creates the anchor. The user anchor. Provides utilities to manage drawing Groups. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Allocates new shape id for the new drawing Group id. @return a new shape id. Provides utilities to manage drawing Groups. Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Clears the cached list of drawing Groups Allocates new shape id for the new drawing Group id. a new shape id. Allocates new shape id for the new drawing group id. a new shape id. Finds the next available (1 based) drawing Group id HSSF wrapper for the {@link FormulaParser} and {@link FormulaRenderer} @author Josh Micich Convenience method for parsing cell formulas. see {@link #parse(String, HSSFWorkbook, int)} @param formulaType a constant from {@link FormulaType} @return the parsed formula tokens @param formula the formula to parse @param workbook the parent workbook @param formulaType a constant from {@link FormulaType} @param sheetIndex the 0-based index of the sheet this formula belongs to. The sheet index is required to resolve sheet-level names. -1 means that the scope of the name will be ignored and the parser will match named ranges only by name @return the parsed formula tokens Static method to convert an array of {@link Ptg}s in RPN order to a human readable string format in infix mode. @param book used for defined names and 3D references @param ptgs must not be null @return a human readable String Gets the size of the margin in inches. @param margin which margin to Get @return the size of the margin Sets the size of the margin in inches. @param margin which margin to Get @param size the size of the margin SERIESDATA = Dimensions 3(SIIndex *(Number / BoolErr / Blank / Label)) AXES = [IVAXIS DVAXIS [SERIESAXIS] / DVAXIS DVAXIS] *3ATTACHEDLABEL [PlotArea FRAME] AXISPARENT = AxisParent Begin Pos [AXES] 1*4CRT End CRT = ChartFormat Begin (Bar / Line / (BopPop [BopPopCustom]) / Pie / Area / Scatter / Radar / RadarArea / Surf) CrtLink [SeriesList] [Chart3d] [LD] [2DROPBAR] *4(CrtLine LineFormat) *2DFTTEXT [DataLabExtContents] [SS] *4SHAPEPROPS End LD = Legend Begin Pos ATTACHEDLABEL [FRAME] [CrtLayout12] [TEXTPROPS] [CRTMLFRT] End DFTTEXT = [DataLabExt StartObject] DefaultText ATTACHEDLABEL [EndObject] ATTACHEDLABEL = Text Begin Pos [FontX] [AlRuns] AI [FRAME] [ObjectLink] [DataLabExtContents] [CrtLayout12] [TEXTPROPS] [CRTMLFRT] End Low level model implementation of a Sheet (one workbook Contains many sheets) This file Contains the low level binary records starting at the sheets BOF and ending with the sheets EOF. Use HSSFSheet for a high level representation. The structures of the highlevel API use references to this to perform most of their operations. Its probably Unwise to use these low level structures directly Unless you really know what you're doing. I recommend you Read the Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (Microsoft Press) and the documentation at http://sc.openoffice.org/excelfileformat.pdf before even attempting to use this. @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) @author Shawn Laubach (slaubach at apache dot org) Gridlines, Headers, Footers, PrintSetup, and Setting Default Column Styles @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) Clone support. DBCell and Index Record writing support @author Brian Sanders (kestrel at burdell dot org) Active Cell support @author Jean-Pierre Paris (jean-pierre.paris at m4x dot org) (Just a little) java object always present, but if empty no BIFF records are written the DimensionsRecord is always present Add an UncalcedRecord if not true indicating formulas have not been calculated Clones the low level records of this sheet and returns the new sheet instance. This method is implemented by Adding methods for deep cloning to all records that can be Added to a sheet. The Record object does not implement Cloneable. When Adding a new record, implement a public Clone method if and only if the record belongs to a sheet. get the NEXT value record (from LOC). The first record that is a value record (starting at LOC) will be returned. This method is "loc" sensitive. Meaning you need to set LOC to where you want it to start searching. If you don't know do this: setLoc(getDimsLoc). When adding several rows you can just start at the last one by leaving loc at what this sets it to. For this method, set loc to dimsloc to start with, subsequent calls will return values in (physical) sequence or NULL when you get to the end. the next value record or NULL if there are no more Creates the sheet. The stream. Initializes a new instance of the class. The stream. Creates a sheet with all the usual records minus values and the "index" record (not required). Sets the location pointer to where the first value records should go. Use this to Create a sheet from "scratch". Sheet object with all values Set to defaults Adds the merged region. the row index From The column index From. The row index To The column To. Removes the merged region. The index. Gets the column infos. The column infos. Gets the merged region at. The index. Gets the number of merged regions. The number merged regions. Gets the number of conditional formattings. The number of conditional formattings. Per an earlier reported bug in working with Andy Khan's excel Read library. This Sets the values in the sheet's DimensionsRecord object to be correct. Excel doesn't really care, but we want to play nice with other libraries. The first row. The first column. The last row. The last column. Gets or Sets the preoffset when using DBCELL records (currently Unused) - this Is the position of this sheet within the whole file. the offset of the sheet's BOF within the file. Create a row record. (does not Add it to the records contained in this sheet) row number RowRecord Created for the passed in row number Create a LABELSST Record (does not Add it to the records contained in this sheet) the row the LabelSST Is a member of the column the LabelSST defines the index of the string within the SST (use workbook AddSSTString method) LabelSSTRecord newly Created containing your SST Index, row,col. Create a NUMBER Record (does not Add it to the records contained in this sheet) the row the NumberRecord is a member of the column the NumberRecord defines value for the number record NumberRecord for that row, col containing that value as Added to the sheet Create a BLANK record (does not Add it to the records contained in this sheet) the row the BlankRecord is a member of the column the BlankRecord is a member of Adds a value record to the sheet's contained binary records (i.e. LabelSSTRecord or NumberRecord). This method is "loc" sensitive. Meaning you need to Set LOC to where you want it to start searching. If you don't know do this: SetLoc(GetDimsLoc). When Adding several rows you can just start at the last one by leaving loc at what this Sets it to. the row to Add the cell value to the cell value record itself. Remove a value record from the records array. This method is not loc sensitive, it Resets loc to = dimsloc so no worries. the row of the value record you wish to Remove a record supporting the CellValueRecordInterface. Replace a value record from the records array. This method is not loc sensitive, it Resets loc to = dimsloc so no worries. a record supporting the CellValueRecordInterface. this will Replace the cell value with the same row and column. If there Isn't one, one will be Added. Adds a row record to the sheet This method is "loc" sensitive. Meaning you need to Set LOC to where you want it to start searching. If you don't know do this: SetLoc(GetDimsLoc). When Adding several rows you can just start at the last one by leaving loc at what this Sets it to. the row record to be Added Removes a row record This method is not loc sensitive, it Resets loc to = dimsloc so no worries. the row record to Remove Get the NEXT RowRecord (from LOC). The first record that is a Row record (starting at LOC) will be returned. This method is "loc" sensitive. Meaning you need to Set LOC to where you want it to start searching. If you don't know do this: SetLoc(GetDimsLoc). When Adding several rows you can just start at the last one by leaving loc at what this Sets it to. For this method, Set loc to dimsloc to start with. subsequent calls will return rows in (physical) sequence or NULL when you Get to the end. RowRecord representing the next row record or NULL if there are no more Get the NEXT (from LOC) RowRecord where rownumber matches the given rownum. The first record that is a Row record (starting at LOC) that has the same rownum as the given rownum will be returned. This method is "loc" sensitive. Meaning you need to Set LOC to where you want it to start searching. If you don't know do this: SetLoc(GetDimsLoc). When Adding several rows you can just start at the last one by leaving loc at what this Sets it to. For this method, Set loc to dimsloc to start with. subsequent calls will return rows in (physical) sequence or NULL when you Get to the end. which row to return (careful with LOC) RowRecord representing the next row record or NULL if there are no more Gets the page settings. Creates the BOF record record containing a BOFRecord Creates the Index record - not currently used record containing a IndexRecord Creates the CalcMode record and Sets it to 1 (automatic formula caculation) record containing a CalcModeRecord Creates the CalcCount record and Sets it to 0x64 (default number of iterations) record containing a CalcCountRecord Creates the RefMode record and Sets it to A1 Mode (default reference mode) record containing a RefModeRecord Creates the Iteration record and Sets it to false (don't iteratively calculate formulas) record containing a IterationRecord Creates the Delta record and Sets it to 0.0010 (default accuracy) record containing a DeltaRecord Creates the SaveRecalc record and Sets it to true (recalculate before saving) record containing a SaveRecalcRecord Creates the PrintHeaders record and Sets it to false (we don't Create headers yet so why print them) record containing a PrintHeadersRecord Creates the PrintGridlines record and Sets it to false (that makes for ugly sheets). As far as I can tell this does the same thing as the GridsetRecord record containing a PrintGridlinesRecord Creates the GridSet record and Sets it to true (user has mucked with the gridlines) record containing a GridsetRecord Creates the Guts record and Sets leftrow/topcol guttter and rowlevelmax/collevelmax to 0 record containing a GutsRecordRecord Creates the DefaultRowHeight Record and Sets its options to 0 and rowheight to 0xff record containing a DefaultRowHeightRecord Creates the WSBoolRecord and Sets its values to defaults @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.WSBoolRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a WSBoolRecord Creates the HCenter Record and Sets it to false (don't horizontally center) @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.HCenterRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a HCenterRecord Creates the VCenter Record and Sets it to false (don't horizontally center) @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.VCenterRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a VCenterRecord Creates the PrintSetup Record and Sets it to defaults and marks it invalid @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.PrintSetupRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a PrintSetupRecord Creates the DefaultColWidth Record and Sets it to 8 @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.DefaultColWidthRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a DefaultColWidthRecord Get the default column width for the sheet (if the columns do not define their own width) @return default column width Get the default row height for the sheet (if the rows do not define their own height) @return default row height Get the width of a given column in Units of 1/256th of a Char width @param column index @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.DefaultColWidthRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.ColumnInfoRecord @see #SetColumnWidth(short,short) @return column width in Units of 1/256th of a Char width Get the index to the ExtendedFormatRecord "associated" with the column at specified 0-based index. (In this case, an ExtendedFormatRecord index is actually associated with a ColumnInfoRecord which spans 1 or more columns)
Returns the index to the default ExtendedFormatRecord (0xF) if no ColumnInfoRecord exists that includes the column index specified. @param column @return index of ExtendedFormatRecord associated with ColumnInfoRecord that includes the column index or the index of the default ExtendedFormatRecord (0xF)
Set the width for a given column in 1/256th of a Char width Units @param column - the column number @param width (in Units of 1/256th of a Char width) Get the hidden property for a given column. @param column index @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.DefaultColWidthRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.ColumnInfoRecord @see #SetColumnHidden(short,bool) @return whether the column is hidden or not. Get the hidden property for a given column. @param column - the column number @param hidden - whether the column is hidden or not Creates an outline Group for the specified columns. @param fromColumn Group from this column (inclusive) @param toColumn Group to this column (inclusive) @param indent if true the Group will be indented by one level, if false indenting will be Removed by one level. Creates the Dimensions Record and Sets it to bogus values (you should Set this yourself or let the high level API do it for you) @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.DimensionsRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a DimensionsRecord Creates the WindowTwo Record and Sets it to: options = 0x6b6 toprow = 0 leftcol = 0 headercolor = 0x40 pagebreakzoom = 0x0 normalzoom = 0x0 @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.WindowTwoRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a WindowTwoRecord Creates the Selection record and Sets it to nothing selected record containing a SelectionRecord Gets or sets the top row. The top row. Gets or sets the left col. The left col. Sets the active cell. The row. The column. Sets the active cell range. The firstrow. The lastrow. The firstcolumn. The lastcolumn. Sets the active cell range. The cellranges. The index of the active range. The active row in the active range The active column in the active range Returns the active row the active row index @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.SelectionRecord Gets the active cell col. the active column index @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.SelectionRecord Creates the EOF record record containing a EOFRecord Gets the gridset record for this sheet. The gridset record. Returns the first occurance of a record matching a particular sid. The sid. Sets the SCL record or Creates it in the correct place if it does not already exist. The record to set. Finds the first occurance of a record matching a particular sid and returns it's position. @param sid the sid to search for @return the record position of the matching record or -1 if no match is made. Gets or sets the header. the HeaderRecord. Gets or sets a value indicating whether this instance is auto tab color. true if this instance is auto tab color; otherwise, false. Gets or sets the footer. FooterRecord for the sheet. Returns the PrintSetupRecord. @return PrintSetupRecord for the sheet. @return true if gridlines are printed Returns the PrintGridlinesRecord. @return PrintGridlinesRecord for the sheet. Sets whether the sheet is selected @param sel True to select the sheet, false otherwise. Creates a split (freezepane). Any existing freezepane or split pane Is overwritten. @param colSplit Horizonatal position of split. @param rowSplit Vertical position of split. @param topRow Top row visible in bottom pane @param leftmostColumn Left column visible in right pane. Creates a split pane. Any existing freezepane or split pane is overwritten. @param xSplitPos Horizonatal position of split (in 1/20th of a point). @param ySplitPos Vertical position of split (in 1/20th of a point). @param topRow Top row visible in bottom pane @param leftmostColumn Left column visible in right pane. @param activePane Active pane. One of: PANE_LOWER_RIGHT, PANE_UPPER_RIGHT, PANE_LOWER_LEFT, PANE_UPPER_LEFT @see #PANE_LOWER_LEFT @see #PANE_LOWER_RIGHT @see #PANE_UPPER_LEFT @see #PANE_UPPER_RIGHT Returns the information regarding the currently configured pane (split or freeze). @return null if no pane configured, or the pane information. creates a Password record with password set to 00. creates a Protect record with protect set to false. Creates an ObjectProtect record with protect Set to false. @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.ObjectProtectRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return an ObjectProtectRecord Creates a ScenarioProtect record with protect Set to false. @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.ScenarioProtectRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return a ScenarioProtectRecord Returns if gridlines are Displayed. @return whether gridlines are Displayed Returns if formulas are Displayed. @return whether formulas are Displayed Returns if RowColHeadings are Displayed. @return whether RowColHeadings are Displayed @return whether an Uncalced record must be Inserted or not at generation Finds the DrawingRecord for our sheet, and attaches it to the DrawingManager (which knows about the overall DrawingGroup for our workbook). If requested, will Create a new DrawRecord if none currently exist The DrawingManager2 for our workbook Should one be Created if missing? location of EscherAggregate record. if no EscherAggregate record is found return -1 Perform any work necessary before the sheet is about to be Serialized. For instance the escher aggregates size needs to be calculated before serialization so that the dgg record (which occurs first) can be written. Shifts all the page breaks in the range "count" number of rows/columns @param breaks The page record to be Shifted @param start Starting "main" value to Shift breaks @param stop Ending "main" value to Shift breaks @param count number of Units (rows/columns) to Shift by Shifts the horizontal page breaks for the indicated count @param startingRow @param endingRow @param count Shifts the vertical page breaks for the indicated count @param startingCol @param endingCol @param count Updates formulas in cells and conditional formats due to moving of cells @param externSheetIndex the externSheet index of this sheet 'initial sheet records' are between INDEX and the 'Row Blocks' @param bofRecordIndex index of record after which INDEX record is to be placed @return count of bytes from end of INDEX record to first ROW record. Get the {@link NoteRecord}s (related to cell comments) for this sheet @return never null, typically empty array Low level model implementation of a Workbook. Provides creational methods for Settings and objects contained in the workbook object. This file Contains the low level binary records starting at the workbook's BOF and ending with the workbook's EOF. Use HSSFWorkbook for a high level representation. The structures of the highlevel API use references to this to perform most of their operations. Its probably Unwise to use these low level structures directly Unless you really know what you're doing. I recommend you Read the Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (Microsoft Press) and the documentation at http://sc.openoffice.org/excelfileformat.pdf before even attempting to use this. @author Luc Girardin (luc dot girardin at macrofocus dot com) @author Sergei Kozello (sergeikozello at mail.ru) @author Shawn Laubach (slaubach at apache dot org) (Data Formats) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Brian Sanders (bsanders at risklabs dot com) - custom palette @author Dan Sherman (dsherman at Isisph.com) @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) @see org.apache.poi.hssf.usermodel.HSSFWorkbook @version 1.0-pre Excel silently truncates long sheet names to 31 chars. This constant is used to ensure uniqueness in the first 31 chars constant used to Set the "codepage" wherever "codepage" is Set in records (which is duplciated in more than one record) this Contains the Worksheet record objects this Contains a reference to the SSTRecord so that new stings can be Added to it. holds the "boundsheet" records (aka bundlesheet) so that they can have their reference to their "BOF" marker Creates new Workbook with no intitialization --useless right now @see #CreateWorkbook(List) Read support for low level API. Pass in an array of Record objects, A Workbook object is constructed and passed back with all of its initialization Set to the passed in records and references to those records held. Unlike Sheet workbook does not use an offset (its assumed to be 0) since its first in a file. If you need an offset then construct a new array with a 0 offset or Write your own ;-p. @param recs an array of Record objects @return Workbook object gets the name comment record @param nameRecord name record who's comment is required. @return name comment record or null if there isn't one for the given name. Creates an empty workbook object with three blank sheets and all the empty fields. Use this to Create a workbook from scratch. Retrieves the Builtin NameRecord that matches the name and index There shouldn't be too many names to make the sequential search too slow @param name byte representation of the builtin name to match @param sheetIndex Index to match @return null if no builtin NameRecord matches Removes the specified Builtin NameRecord that matches the name and index @param name byte representation of the builtin to match @param sheetIndex zero-based sheet reference Gets the font record at the given index in the font table. Remember "There is No Four" (someone at M$ must have gone to Rocky Horror one too many times) @param idx the index to look at (0 or greater but NOT 4) @return FontRecord located at the given index Creates a new font record and Adds it to the "font table". This causes the boundsheets to move down one, extended formats to move down (so this function moves those pointers as well) @return FontRecord that was just Created Check if the cloned sheet has drawings. If yes, then allocate a new drawing group ID and re-generate shape IDs @param sheet the cloned sheet Gets the number of font records @return number of font records in the "font table" Sets the BOF for a given sheet @param sheetnum the number of the sheet to Set the positing of the bof for @param pos the actual bof position Returns the position of the backup record. Sets the name for a given sheet. If the boundsheet record doesn't exist and its only one more than we have, go ahead and Create it. If its > 1 more than we have, except @param sheetnum the sheet number (0 based) @param sheetname the name for the sheet Determines whether a workbook Contains the provided sheet name. @param name the name to test (case insensitive match) @param excludeSheetIdx the sheet to exclude from the Check or -1 to include all sheets in the Check. @return true if the sheet Contains the name, false otherwise. Sets the name for a given sheet forcing the encoding. This is STILL A BAD IDEA. Poi now automatically detects Unicode @deprecated 3-Jan-06 Simply use SetSheetNam e(int sheetnum, String sheetname) @param sheetnum the sheet number (0 based) @param sheetname the name for the sheet Sets the order of appearance for a given sheet. @param sheetname the name of the sheet to reorder @param pos the position that we want to Insert the sheet into (0 based) Gets the name for a given sheet. @param sheetnum the sheet number (0 based) @return sheetname the name for the sheet Gets the hidden flag for a given sheet. @param sheetnum the sheet number (0 based) @return True if sheet is hidden Gets the hidden flag for a given sheet. Note that a sheet could instead be set to be very hidden, which is different ({@link #isSheetVeryHidden(int)}) @param sheetnum the sheet number (0 based) @return True if sheet is hidden Hide or Unhide a sheet @param sheetnum The sheet number @param hidden True to mark the sheet as hidden, false otherwise Hide or unhide a sheet. 0 = not hidden 1 = hidden 2 = very hidden. @param sheetnum The sheet number @param hidden 0 for not hidden, 1 for hidden, 2 for very hidden Get the sheet's index @param name sheet name @return sheet index or -1 if it was not found. if we're trying to Address one more sheet than we have, go ahead and Add it! if we're trying to Address >1 more than we have throw an exception! make the tabid record look like the current situation. number of bytes written in the TabIdRecord returns the number of boundsheet objects contained in this workbook. @return number of BoundSheet records Get the number of ExtendedFormat records contained in this workbook. @return int count of ExtendedFormat records Retrieves the index of the given font Returns the StyleRecord for the given xfIndex, or null if that ExtendedFormat doesn't have a Style set. Gets the ExtendedFormatRecord at the given 0-based index @param index of the Extended format record (0-based) @return ExtendedFormatRecord at the given index Creates a new Cell-type Extneded Format Record and Adds it to the end of ExtendedFormatRecords collection @return ExtendedFormatRecord that was Created Adds a string to the SST table and returns its index (if its a duplicate just returns its index and update the counts) ASSUMES compressed Unicode (meaning 8bit) @param string the string to be Added to the SSTRecord @return index of the string within the SSTRecord given an index into the SST table, this function returns the corresponding String value @return String containing the SST String use this function to Add a Shared String Table to an existing sheet (say generated by a different java api) without an sst.... @see #CreateSST() @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.SSTRecord Serializes all records int the worksheet section into a big byte array. Use this to Write the Workbook out. @param offset of the data to be written @param data array of bytes to Write this to Perform any work necessary before the workbook is about to be serialized. Include in it ant code that modifies the workbook record stream and affects its size. Creates the BOF record @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.BOFRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a BOFRecord Creates the InterfaceHdr record @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.InterfaceHdrRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a InterfaceHdrRecord Creates an MMS record @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.MMSRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a MMSRecord Creates the InterfaceEnd record @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.InterfaceEndRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a InterfaceEndRecord Creates the WriteAccess record containing the logged in user's name @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.WriteAccessRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a WriteAccessRecord Creates the Codepage record containing the constant stored in CODEPAGE @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.CodepageRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a CodepageRecord Creates the DSF record containing a 0 since HSSF can't even Create Dual Stream Files @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.DSFRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a DSFRecord Creates the TabId record containing an array of 0,1,2. This release of HSSF always has the default three sheets, no less, no more. @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.TabIdRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a TabIdRecord Creates the FnGroupCount record containing the Magic number constant of 14. @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.FnGroupCountRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a FnGroupCountRecord Creates the WindowProtect record with protect Set to false. @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.WindowProtectRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a WindowProtectRecord Creates the Protect record with protect Set to false. @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.ProtectRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a ProtectRecord Creates the Password record with password Set to 0. @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.PasswordRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a PasswordRecord Creates the ProtectionRev4 record with protect Set to false. @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.ProtectionRev4Record @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a ProtectionRev4Record Creates the PasswordRev4 record with password Set to 0. @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.PasswordRev4Record @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a PasswordRev4Record Creates the WindowOne record with the following magic values: horizontal hold - 0x168 vertical hold - 0x10e width - 0x3a5c height - 0x23be options - 0x38 selected tab - 0 Displayed tab - 0 num selected tab- 0 tab width ratio - 0x258 @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.WindowOneRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a WindowOneRecord Creates the Backup record with backup Set to 0. (loose the data, who cares) @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.BackupRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a BackupRecord Creates the HideObj record with hide object Set to 0. (don't hide) @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.HideObjRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a HideObjRecord Creates the DateWindow1904 record with windowing Set to 0. (don't window) @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.DateWindow1904Record @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a DateWindow1904Record Creates the Precision record with precision Set to true. (full precision) @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.PrecisionRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a PrecisionRecord Creates the RefreshAll record with refreshAll Set to true. (refresh all calcs) @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.RefreshAllRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a RefreshAllRecord Creates the BookBool record with saveLinkValues Set to 0. (don't save link values) @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.BookBoolRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a BookBoolRecord Creates a Font record with the following magic values: fontheight = 0xc8 attributes = 0x0 color palette index = 0x7fff bold weight = 0x190 Font Name Length = 5 Font Name = Arial @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.FontRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a FontRecord Creates an ExtendedFormatRecord object @param id the number of the extended format record to Create (meaning its position in a file as MS Excel would Create it.) @return record containing an ExtendedFormatRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.ExtendedFormatRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record Creates an default cell type ExtendedFormatRecord object. @return ExtendedFormatRecord with intial defaults (cell-type) Creates a new StyleRecord, for the given Extended Format index, and adds it onto the end of the records collection Creates a StyleRecord object @param id the number of the style record to Create (meaning its position in a file as MS Excel would Create it. @return record containing a StyleRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.StyleRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record Creates a palette record initialized to the default palette @return a PaletteRecord instance populated with the default colors @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.PaletteRecord Creates the UseSelFS object with the use natural language flag Set to 0 (false) @return record containing a UseSelFSRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.UseSelFSRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record Create a "bound sheet" or "bundlesheet" (depending who you ask) record Always Sets the sheet's bof to 0. You'll need to Set that yourself. @param id either sheet 0,1 or 2. @return record containing a BoundSheetRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.BoundSheetRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record Creates the Country record with the default country Set to 1 and current country Set to 7 in case of russian locale ("ru_RU") and 1 otherwise @return record containing a CountryRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.CountryRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record Creates the ExtendedSST record with numstrings per bucket Set to 0x8. HSSF doesn't yet know what to do with this thing, but we Create it with nothing in it hardly just to make Excel happy and our sheets look like Excel's @return record containing an ExtSSTRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.ExtSSTRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record lazy initialization Note - creating the link table causes creation of 1 EXTERNALBOOK and 1 EXTERNALSHEET record Finds the first sheet name by his extern sheet index @param externSheetIndex extern sheet index @return first sheet name. Finds the (first) sheet index for a particular external sheet number. @param externSheetNumber The external sheet number to convert @return The index to the sheet found. Finds the last sheet index for a particular external sheet number, which may be the same as the first (except for multi-sheet references) @param externSheetNumber The external sheet number to convert @return The index to the sheet found. Returns the extern sheet number for specific sheet number. If this sheet doesn't exist in extern sheet, add it @param sheetNumber local sheet number @return index to extern sheet Returns the extern sheet number for specific range of sheets. If this sheet range doesn't exist in extern sheet, add it @param firstSheetNumber first local sheet number @param lastSheetNumber last local sheet number @return index to extern sheet Gets the total number of names @return number of names @param name the name of an external function, typically a name of a UDF @param sheetRefIndex the sheet ref index, or -1 if not known @param udf locator of user-defiend functions to resolve names of VBA and Add-In functions @return the external name or null Gets the name record @param index name index @return name record Creates new name @return new name record Creates new name @return new name record Generates a NameRecord to represent a built-in region @return a new NameRecord Unless the index is invalid Removes the name @param namenum name index If a {@link NameCommentRecord} is added or the name it references is renamed, then this will update the lookup cache for it. Returns a format index that matches the passed in format. It does not tie into HSSFDataFormat. @param format the format string @param CreateIfNotFound Creates a new format if format not found @return the format id of a format that matches or -1 if none found and CreateIfNotFound Returns the list of FormatRecords in the workbook. @return ArrayList of FormatRecords in the notebook Creates a FormatRecord, Inserts it, and returns the index code. @param format the format string @return the index code of the format record. @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.FormatRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record Creates a FormatRecord object @param id the number of the format record to create (meaning its position in a file as M$ Excel would create it.) Returns the first occurance of a record matching a particular sid. Returns the index of a record matching a particular sid. @param sid The sid of the record to match @return The index of -1 if no match made. Returns the next occurance of a record matching a particular sid. Whether date windowing is based on 1/2/1904 or 1/1/1900. Some versions of Excel (Mac) can save workbooks using 1904 date windowing. @return true if using 1904 date windowing Returns the custom palette in use for this workbook; if a custom palette record does not exist, then it is Created. Finds the primary drawing Group, if one already exists Creates a primary drawing Group record. If it already exists then it's modified. Removes the given font record from the file's list. This will make all subsequent font indicies drop by one, so you'll need to update those yourself! Removes the given ExtendedFormatRecord record from the file's list. This will make all subsequent font indicies drop by one, so you'll need to update those yourself! Removes ExtendedFormatRecord record with given index from the file's list. This will make all subsequent font indicies drop by one,so you'll need to update those yourself! index of the Extended format record (0-based) is the workbook protected with a password (not encrypted)? protect a workbook with a password (not encypted, just Sets Writeprotect flags and the password. @param password to Set Removes the Write protect flag @param reFindex Index to REF entry in EXTERNSHEET record in the Link Table @param definedNameIndex zero-based to DEFINEDNAME or EXTERNALNAME record @return the string representation of the defined or external name Updates named ranges due to moving of cells Get or create RecalcIdRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.usermodel.HSSFWorkbook#setForceFormulaRecalculation(boolean) Changes an external referenced file to another file. A formular in Excel which refers a cell in another file is saved in two parts: The referenced file is stored in an reference table. the row/cell information is saved separate. This method invokation will only change the reference in the lookup-table itself. @param oldUrl The old URL to search for and which is to be replaced @param newUrl The URL replacement @return true if the oldUrl was found and replaced with newUrl. Otherwise false Represents a line shape and Creates all the line specific low level records. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Creates the line shape from the highlevel user shape. All low level records are Created at this point. The user model shape The identifier to use for this shape. Creates the lowerlevel escher records for this shape. The HSSF shape. The shape id. Creates the low level OBJ record for this shape. The HSSF shape. The shape id. The shape container and it's children that can represent this shape. The object record that is associated with this shape. Link Table (OOO pdf reference: 4.10.3 )

The main data of all types of references is stored in the Link Table inside the Workbook Globals Substream (4.2.5). The Link Table itself is optional and occurs only, if there are any references in the document.

In BIFF8 the Link Table consists of

  • zero or more EXTERNALBOOK Blocks

    each consisting of

    • exactly one EXTERNALBOOK (0x01AE) record
    • zero or more EXTERNALNAME (0x0023) records
    • zero or more CRN Blocks

      each consisting of

      • exactly one XCT (0x0059)record
      • zero or more CRN (0x005A) records (documentation says one or more)
  • zero or one EXTERNSHEET (0x0017) record
  • zero or more DEFINEDNAME (0x0018) records
@author Josh Micich
Create a new block for registering add-in functions @see org.apache.poi.hssf.model.LinkTable#addNameXPtg(String) Create a new block for external references. Create a new block for internal references. It is called when constructing a new LinkTable. @see org.apache.poi.hssf.model.LinkTable#LinkTable(int, WorkbookRecordList) Performs case-insensitive search @return -1 if not found TODO - would not be required if calling code used RecordStream or similar @param extRefIndex as from a {@link Ref3DPtg} or {@link Area3DPtg} @return -1 if the reference is to an external book @param extRefIndex as from a {@link Ref3DPtg} or {@link Area3DPtg} @return -1 if the reference is to an external book Finds the external name definition for the given name, optionally restricted by externsheet index, and returns (if found) as a NameXPtg. @param sheetRefIndex The Extern Sheet Index to look for, or -1 if any Register an external name in this workbook @param name the name to register @return a NameXPtg describing this name copied from Workbook Changes an external referenced file to another file. A formular in Excel which refers a cell in another file is saved in two parts: The referenced file is stored in an reference table. the row/cell information is saved separate. This method invokation will only change the reference in the lookup-table itself. @param oldUrl The old URL to search for and which is to be replaced @param newUrl The URL replacement @return true if the oldUrl was found and replaced with newUrl. Otherwise false Represents a syntactic element from a formula by encapsulating the corresponding Ptg token. Each ParseNode may have child ParseNodes in the case when the wrapped Ptg is non-atomic. @author Josh Micich Collects the array of Ptg tokens for the specified tree. The root node. The IF() function Gets marked up with two or three tAttr tokens. Similar logic will be required for CHOOSE() when it is supported See excelfileformat.pdf sec 3.10.5 "tAttr (19H) The temp. Represents a picture shape and Creates all specific low level records. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Creates the line shape from the highlevel user shape. All low level records are Created at this point. The user model shape. The identifier to use for this shape. Creates the lowerlevel escher records for this shape. The HSSF shape. The shape id. Creates the low level OBJ record for this shape. The HSSFShape. The shape id. The shape container and it's children that can represent this shape. The object record that is associated with this shape. Creates the low evel records for an polygon. The highlevel shape. The shape id to use for this shape. Creates the lowerlevel escher records for this shape. The HSSF shape. The shape id. Creates the lowerlevel OBJ records for this shape. The HSSF shape. The shape id. The shape container and it's children that can represent this shape. The object record that is associated with this shape. Finds correct insert positions for records in workbook streams

See OOO excelfileformat.pdf sec. 4.2.5 'Record Order in a BIFF8 Workbook Stream' @author Josh Micich Adds the specified new record in the correct place in sheet records list

Finds the index where the protection block should be inserted the records for this sheet + BOF o INDEX o Calculation Settings Block o PRINTHEADERS o PRINTGRIDLINES o GRIDSET o GUTS o DEFAULTROWHEIGHT o SHEETPR o Page Settings Block o Worksheet Protection Block o DEFCOLWIDTH oo COLINFO o SORT + DIMENSION
These records may occur between the 'Worksheet Protection Block' and DIMENSION: o DEFCOLWIDTH oo COLINFO o SORT Find correct position to add new CFHeader record Finds the index where the sheet validations header record should be inserted @param records the records for this sheet + WINDOW2 o SCL o PANE oo SELECTION o STANDARDWIDTH oo MERGEDCELLS o LABELRANGES o PHONETICPR o Conditional Formatting Table o Hyperlink Table o Data Validity Table o SHEETLAYOUT o SHEETPROTECTION o RANGEPROTECTION + EOF DIMENSIONS record is always present if the specified record ID terminates a sequence of Row block records It is assumed that at least one row or cell value record has been found prior to the current record Whether the specified record id normally appears in the row blocks section of the sheet records Simplifies iteration over a sequence of Record objects. @author Josh Micich Determines whether this instance has next. true if this instance has next; otherwise, false. Gets the next record Peeks the next sid. -1 if at end of records Peeks the next class. the class of the next Record.return null if this stream Is exhausted. Segregates the 'Row Blocks' section of a single sheet into plain row/cell records and shared formula records. @author Josh Micich Also collects any loose MergeCellRecords and puts them in the supplied mergedCellsTable Some unconventional apps place {@link MergeCellsRecord}s within the row block. They actually should be in the {@link MergedCellsTable} which is much later (see bug 45699). @return any loose MergeCellsRecords found @return a {@link RecordStream} containing all the non-{@link SharedFormulaRecord} non-{@link ArrayRecord} and non-{@link TableRecord} Records. Creates the low evel records for an oval. The highlevel shape. The shape id to use for this shape. Creates the lowerlevel escher records for this shape. The HSSF shape. The shape id. Creates the lowerlevel OBJ records for this shape. The HSSF shape. The shape id. The shape container and it's children that can represent this shape. The object record that is associated with this shape. Represents an textbox shape and Converts between the highlevel records and lowlevel records for an oval. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Creates the low evel records for a textbox. The highlevel shape. The shape id to use for this shape. Creates the lowerlevel OBJ records for this shape. The HSSF shape. The shape id. Creates the lowerlevel escher records for this shape. The HSSF shape. The shape id. Textboxes also have an extra TXO record associated with them that most other shapes dont have. The HSSF shape. The shape id. The shape container and it's children that can represent this shape. The object record that is associated with this shape. The TextObject record that is associated with this shape. Gets the EscherTextbox record. The EscherTextbox record. List for records in Workbook Gets or sets the records. The records. Gets the count. The count. Gets the at the specified index. Adds the specified pos. The pos. The r. Removes the specified record. The record. Removes the specified position. The position. Gets or sets the protpos. The protpos. Gets or sets the bspos. The bspos. Gets or sets the tabpos. The tabpos. Gets or sets the fontpos. The fontpos. Gets or sets the xfpos. The xfpos. Gets or sets the backuppos. The backuppos. Gets or sets the palettepos. The palettepos. Gets or sets the namepos. The namepos. Gets or sets the supbookpos. The supbookpos. Gets or sets the externsheet pos. The externsheet pos. The escher container record is used to hold escher records. It is abstract and must be subclassed for maximum benefit. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) @author Michael Zalewski (zalewski at optonline.net) Constructs a Bar record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (including 4 byte header) Clone the current record, via a call to serialise it, and another to Create a new record from the bytes. May only be used for classes which don't have internal counts / ids in them. For those which do, a full record-aware serialise is needed, which allocates new ids / counts as needed. If we have a EscherContainerRecord as one of our children (and most top level escher holders do), then return that. Descends into all our children, returning the first EscherRecord with the given id, or null if none found Big drawing Group records are split but it's easier to deal with them as a whole Group so we need to join them toGether. Convert raw data to escher records. CFRecordsAggregate - aggregates Conditional Formatting records CFHeaderRecord and number of up to three CFRuleRecord records toGether to simplify access to them. @author Dmitriy Kumshayev Excel allows up to 3 conditional formating rules List of CFRuleRecord objects Create CFRecordsAggregate from a list of CF Records list of Record objects Create CFRecordsAggregate from a list of CF Records list of Record objects position of CFHeaderRecord object in the list of Record objects Create a deep Clone of the record called by the class that is responsible for writing this sucker. Subclasses should implement this so that their data is passed back in a byte array. The offset to begin writing at The data byte array containing instance data number of bytes written @return false if this whole {@link CFHeaderRecord} / {@link CFRuleRecord}s should be deleted @return sum of sizes of all aggregated records Manages the all the records associated with a chart sub-stream.
Includes the Initial {@link BOFRecord} and {@link EOFRecord}. @author Josh Micich
All the records between BOF and EOF ATTACHEDLABEL = Text Begin Pos [FontX] [AlRuns] AI [FRAME] [ObjectLink] [DataLabExtContents] [CrtLayout12] [TEXTPROPS] [CRTMLFRT] End AI = BRAI [SeriesText] AXES = [IVAXIS DVAXIS [SERIESAXIS] / DVAXIS DVAXIS] *3ATTACHEDLABEL [PlotArea FRAME] AXISPARENT = AxisParent Begin Pos [AXES] 1*4CRT End AXM = YMult StartObject ATTACHEDLABEL EndObject AXS = [IFmtRecord] [Tick] [FontX] *4(AxisLine LineFormat) [AreaFormat] [GELFRAME] *4SHAPEPROPS [TextPropsStream *ContinueFrt12] CHARTFOMATS = Chart Begin *2FONTLIST Scl PlotGrowth [FRAME] *SERIESFORMAT *SS ShtProps *2DFTTEXT AxesUsed 1*2AXISPARENT [CrtLayout12A] [DAT] *ATTACHEDLABEL [CRTMLFRT] *([DataLabExt StartObject] ATTACHEDLABEL [EndObject]) [TEXTPROPS] *2CRTMLFRT End CHARTSHEET = BOF CHARTSHEETCONTENT CHARTSHEETCONTENT = [WriteProtect] [SheetExt] [WebPub] *HFPicture PAGESETUP PrintSize [HeaderFooter] [BACKGROUND] *Fbi *Fbi2 [ClrtClient] [PROTECTION] [Palette] [SXViewLink] [PivotChartBits] [SBaseRef] [MsoDrawingGroup] OBJECTS Units CHARTFOMATS SERIESDATA *WINDOW *CUSTOMVIEW [CodeName] [CRTMLFRT] EOF All the records between BOF and EOF CRT = ChartFormat Begin (Bar / Line / (BopPop [BopPopCustom]) / Pie / Area / Scatter / Radar / RadarArea / Surf) CrtLink [SeriesList] [Chart3d] [LD] [2DROPBAR] *4(CrtLine LineFormat) *2DFTTEXT [DataLabExtContents] [SS] *4SHAPEPROPS End CRTMLFRT = CrtMlFrt *CrtMlFrtContinue DAT = Dat Begin LD End DFTTEXT = [DataLabExt StartObject] DefaultText ATTACHEDLABEL [EndObject] DROPBAR = DropBar Begin LineFormat AreaFormat [GELFRAME] [SHAPEPROPS] End DVAXIS = Axis Begin [ValueRange] [AXM] AXS [CRTMLFRT] End FONTLIST = FrtFontList StartObject *(Font [Fbi]) EndObject FRAME = Frame Begin LineFormat AreaFormat [GELFRAME] [SHAPEPROPS] End GELFRAME = 1*2GelFrame *Continue [PICF] PICF = Begin PicF End IVAXIS = Axis Begin [CatSerRange] AxcExt [CatLab] AXS [CRTMLFRT] End LD = Legend Begin Pos ATTACHEDLABEL [FRAME] [CrtLayout12] [TEXTPROPS] [CRTMLFRT] End SERIESAXIS = Axis Begin [CatSerRange] AXS [CRTMLFRT] End SERIESDATA = Dimensions 3(SIIndex *(Number / BoolErr / Blank / Label)) SERIESFORMAT = Series Begin 4AI *SS (SerToCrt / (SerParent (SerAuxTrend / SerAuxErrBar))) *(LegendException [Begin ATTACHEDLABEL [TEXTPROPS] End]) End LegendException [Begin ATTACHEDLABEL [TEXTPROPS] End] SHAPEPROPS = ShapePropsStream *ContinueFrt12 SS = DataFormat Begin [Chart3DBarShape] [LineFormat AreaFormat PieFormat] [SerFmt] [GELFRAME] [MarkerFormat] [AttachedLabel] *2SHAPEPROPS [CRTMLFRT] End TEXTPROPS = (RichTextStream / TextPropsStream) *ContinueFrt12 @author Glen Stampoultzis Initializes a new instance of the class. Initializes a new instance of the class. The rs. It's an aggregate... just made something up Gets the num columns. The num columns. Gets the size of the record. The size of the record. Performs a deep Clone of the record Inserts a column into the aggregate (at the end of the list). The column. Inserts a column into the aggregate (at the position specified by index The index. The columninfo. called by the class that is responsible for writing this sucker. Subclasses should implement this so that their data is passed back in a byte array. offset to begin writing at byte array containing instance data number of bytes written Visit each of the atomic BIFF records contained in this {@link RecordAggregate} in the order that they should be written to file. Implementors may or may not return the actual Records being used to manage POI's internal implementation. Callers should not assume either way, and therefore only attempt to modify those Records after cloning Finds the start of column outline group. The idx. Finds the end of column outline group. The idx. Gets the col info. The idx. Determines whether [is column group collapsed] [the specified idx]. The idx. true if [is column group collapsed] [the specified idx]; otherwise, false. Determines whether [is column group hidden by parent] [the specified idx]. The idx. true if [is column group hidden by parent] [the specified idx]; otherwise, false. Collapses the column. The column number. Expands the column. The column number. Sets all non null fields into the ci parameter. Attempts to merge the col info record at the specified index with either or both of its neighbours The col info ix. merges two column info records (if they are adjacent and have the same formatting, etc) @return false if the two column records could not be merged Sets all adjacent columns of the same outline level to the specified hidden status. the col info index of the start of the outline group. The level. The hidden. the column index of the last column in the outline group Sets the column. The target column ix. Index of the xf. The width. The level. The hidden. The collapsed. Sets all non null fields into the ci parameter. Collapses the col info records. The column index. Creates an outline Group for the specified columns. Group from this column (inclusive) Group to this column (inclusive) if true the Group will be indented by one level;if false indenting will be Removed by one level. Finds the ColumnInfoRecord which contains the specified columnIndex index of the column (not the index of the ColumnInfoRecord) /// null if no column info found for the specified column Gets the max outline level. The max outline level. Holds all the conditional formatting for a workbook sheet.

See OOO exelfileformat.pdf sec 4.12 'Conditional Formatting Table' @author Josh Micich Creates an empty ConditionalFormattingTable @return index of the newly added CF header aggregate Manages the all the records associated with a 'Custom View Settings' sub-stream.
Includes the Initial USERSVIEWBEGIN(0x01AA) and USERSVIEWEND(0x01AB). @author Josh Micich
All the records between BOF and EOF

Manages the DVALRecord and DVRecords for a single sheet See OOO excelfileformat.pdf section 4.14 @author Josh Micich
The list of data validations for the current sheet. Note - this may be empty (contrary to OOO documentation) The formula record aggregate is used to join toGether the formula record and it's (optional) string record and (optional) Shared Formula Record (template Reads, excel optimization). @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) caches the calculated result of the formula Initializes a new instance of the class. The formula rec. The string rec. The SVM. Should be called by any code which is either deleting this formula cell, or changing its type. This method gives the aggregate a chance to unlink any shared formula that may be involved with this cell formula. called by the class that is responsible for writing this sucker. Subclasses should implement this so that their data is passed back in a byte array. offset to begin writing at byte array containing instance data. number of bytes written Visit each of the atomic BIFF records contained in this {@link RecordAggregate} in the order that they should be written to file. Implementors may or may not return the actual {@link Record}s being used to manage POI's internal implementation. Callers should not assume either way, and therefore only attempt to modify those {@link Record}s after cloning Get the current Serialized size of the record. Should include the sid and recLength (4 bytes). The size of the record. return the non static version of the id for this record. The sid. Sometimes the shared formula flag "seems" to be erroneously set (because the corresponding SharedFormulaRecord does not exist). Normally this would leave no way of determining the Ptg tokens for the formula. However as it turns out in these cases, Excel encodes the unshared Ptg tokens in the right place (inside the FormulaRecord). So the the only thing that needs to be done is to ignore the erroneous shared formula flag. This method may also be used for setting breakpoints to help diagnose issues regarding the abnormally-set 'shared formula' flags. The formula. Gets or sets the formula record. The formula record. Gets or sets the string record. The string record. Determines whether the specified is equal to the current . The to compare with the current . true if the specified is equal to the current ; otherwise, false. The parameter is null. Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Gets the string value. The string value. Sets the cached string result. The value. Sets the cached boolean result. if set to true [value]. Sets the cached error result. The error code. Also checks for a related shared formula and unlinks it if found Removes an array formula @return the range of the array formula containing the specified cell. Never null @author Josh Micich Creates an empty aggregate Reads zero or more consecutive {@link MergeCellsRecord}s @param rs Groups the page settings records for a worksheet.

See OOO excelfileformat.pdf sec 4.4 'Page Settings Block' @author Josh Micich Creates a PageSettingsBlock with default settings @return true if the specified Record sid is one belonging to the 'Page Settings Block'. Sets a page break at the indicated column Removes a page break at the indicated column Creates the HCenter Record and sets it to false (don't horizontally center) Creates the VCenter Record and sets it to false (don't horizontally center) Creates the PrintSetup Record and sets it to defaults and marks it invalid @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.PrintSetupRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @return record containing a PrintSetupRecord Returns the HeaderRecord. @return HeaderRecord for the sheet. Returns the FooterRecord. @return FooterRecord for the sheet. Returns the PrintSetupRecord. @return PrintSetupRecord for the sheet. Gets the size of the margin in inches. @param margin which margin to Get @return the size of the margin Sets the size of the margin in inches. @param margin which margin to Get @param size the size of the margin Shifts all the page breaks in the range "count" number of rows/columns @param breaks The page record to be shifted @param start Starting "main" value to shift breaks @param stop Ending "main" value to shift breaks @param count number of units (rows/columns) to shift by Sets a page break at the indicated row @param row Removes a page break at the indicated row @param row Queries if the specified row has a page break @param row @return true if the specified row has a page break Queries if the specified column has a page break @return true if the specified column has a page break Shifts the horizontal page breaks for the indicated count @param startingRow @param endingRow @param count Shifts the vertical page breaks for the indicated count @param startingCol @param endingCol @param count @return all the horizontal page breaks, never null @return the number of row page breaks @return all the column page breaks, never null @return the number of column page breaks

HEADERFOOTER is new in 2007. Some apps seem to have scattered this record long after the PageSettingsBlock where it belongs.
This method reads PageSettingsBlock records from the supplied RecordStream until the first non-PageSettingsBlock record is encountered. As each record is read, it is incorporated into this PageSettingsBlock. holds any continue records found after the PLS record.
This would not be required if PLS was properly interpreted. Currently, PLS is an {@link UnknownRecord} and does not automatically include any trailing {@link ContinueRecord}s.
Implementors may call non-mutating methods on Record r. @param r must not be null RecordAggregates are groups of of BIFF Records that are typically stored together and/or updated together. Workbook / Sheet records are typically stored in a sequential list, which does not provide much structure to coordinate updates. @author Josh Micich Visit each of the atomic BIFF records contained in this {@link RecordAggregate} in the order that they should be written to file. Implementors may or may not return the actual {@link Record}s being used to manage POI's internal implementation. Callers should not assume either way, and therefore only attempt to modify those {@link Record}s after cloning A wrapper for {@link RecordVisitor} which accumulates the sizes of all records visited. @author andy @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) Creates a new instance of ValueRecordsAggregate @param rs record stream with all {@link SharedFormulaRecord} {@link ArrayRecord}, {@link TableRecord} {@link MergeCellsRecord} Records removed Handles UnknownRecords which appear within the row/cell records Returns the number of row blocks.

The row blocks are goupings of rows that contain the DBCell record after them Returns the number of physical rows within a block Returns the physical row number of the first row in a block Returns the physical row number of the end row in a block Create a row record. @param row number @return RowRecord Created for the passed in row number @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.RowRecord

Manages various auxiliary records while constructing a RowRecordsAggregate @author Josh Micich
Coordinates of the first cell having a formula that uses this shared formula. This is often but not always the top left cell in the range covered by {@link #_sfr} Note - the 'first cell' of a shared formula group is not always the top-left cell of the enclosing range. @return true if the specified coordinates correspond to the 'first cell' of this shared formula group. cached for optimization purposes @param firstCells @param recs list of sheet records (possibly Contains records for other parts of the Excel file) @param startIx index of first row/cell record for current sheet @param endIx one past index of last row/cell record for current sheet. It is important that this code does not inadvertently collect SharedFormulaRecords from any other sheet (which could happen if endIx is chosen poorly). (see bug 44449) @param firstCell as extracted from the {@link ExpPtg} from the cell's formula. @return never null Gets the {@link SharedValueRecordBase} record if it should be encoded immediately after the formula record Contained in the specified {@link FormulaRecordAggregate} agg. Note - the shared value record always appears after the first formula record in the group. For arrays and tables the first formula is always the in the top left cell. However, since shared formula groups can be sparse and/or overlap, the first formula may not actually be in the top left cell. @return the SHRFMLA, TABLE or ARRAY record for the formula cell, if it is the first cell of a table or array region. null if the formula cell is not shared/array/table, or if the specified formula is not the the first in the group. Converts all {@link FormulaRecord}s handled by sharedFormulaRecord to plain unshared formulas Add specified Array Record. Removes the {@link ArrayRecord} for the cell group containing the specified cell. The caller should clear (set blank) all cells in the returned range. @return the range of the array formula which was just removed. Never null. @return the shared ArrayRecord identified by (firstRow, firstColumn). never null. Aggregate value records toGether. Things are easier to handle that way. @author andy @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) Creates a new instance of ValueRecordsAggregate Sometimes the shared formula flag "seems" to be erroneously Set, in which case there is no call to SharedFormulaRecord.ConvertSharedFormulaRecord and hence the ParsedExpression field of this FormulaRecord will not Get updated.
As it turns out, this is not a problem, because in these circumstances, the existing value for ParsedExpression is perfectly OK.

This method may also be used for Setting breakpoints to help diagnose Issues regarding the abnormally-Set 'shared formula' flags. (see TestValueRecordsAggregate.testSpuriousSharedFormulaFlag()).

The method currently does nothing but do not delete it without Finding a nice home for this comment. Tallies a count of the size of the cell records that are attached to the rows in the range specified. Returns true if the row has cells attached to it Serializes the cells that are allocated to a certain row range Groups the sheet protection records for a worksheet.

See OOO excelfileformat.pdf sec 4.18.2 'Sheet Protection in a Workbook (BIFF5-BIFF8)' @author Josh Micich Creates an empty WorksheetProtectionBlock @return true if the specified Record sid is one belonging to the 'Page Settings Block'. This method Reads {@link WorksheetProtectionBlock} records from the supplied RecordStream until the first non-WorksheetProtectionBlock record is encountered. As each record is Read, it is incorporated into this WorksheetProtectionBlock.

As per the OOO documentation, the protection block records can be expected to be written toGether (with no intervening records), but earlier versions of POI (prior to Jun 2009) didn't do this. Workbooks with sheet protection Created by those earlier POI versions seemed to be valid (Excel opens them OK). So PO allows continues to support Reading of files with non continuous worksheet protection blocks.

Note - when POI Writes out this WorksheetProtectionBlock, the records will always be written in one consolidated block (in the standard ordering) regardless of how scattered the records were when they were originally Read.

the ProtectRecord. If one is not contained in the sheet, then one is created.
the PasswordRecord. If one is not Contained in the sheet, then one is Created. protect a spreadsheet with a password (not encrypted, just sets protect flags and the password.) password to set;Pass null to remove all protection shouldProtectObjects are protected shouldProtectScenarios are protected Creates an ObjectProtect record with protect set to false. Creates a ScenarioProtect record with protect set to false. Creates a Password record with password set to 0x0000. ARRAY (0x0221)

Treated in a similar way to SharedFormulaRecord @author Josh Micich

DOPER Structure for AutoFilter record author: Tony Qu
get or set the RK record Gets or sets Length of the string (the string is stored in the rgch field that follows the DOPER structures) Whether the bBoolErr field contains a Boolean value Whether the bBoolErr field contains a Error value Get or sets the boolean value Get or sets the boolean value Title: Backup Record Description: bool specifying whether the GUI should store a backup of the file. REFERENCE: PG 287 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a BackupRecord and Sets its fields appropriately @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the backup flag @return short 0/1 (off/on) Read an unsigned short from the stream without decrypting Read an unsigned short from the stream without decrypting Title: Blank cell record Description: Represents a column in a row with no value but with styling. REFERENCE: PG 287 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre Creates a new instance of BlankRecord Constructs a BlankRecord and Sets its fields appropriately @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the row this cell occurs on @return the row Get the column this cell defines within the row @return the column Set the index of the extended format record to style this cell with @param xf - the 0-based index of the extended format @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.ExtendedFormatRecord return the non static version of the id for this record. called by the class that is responsible for writing this sucker. Subclasses should implement this so that their data is passed back in a byte array. @return byte array containing instance data Title: Beginning Of File Description: Somewhat of a misnomer, its used for the beginning of a Set of records that have a particular pupose or subject. Used in sheets and workbooks. REFERENCE: PG 289 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre for BIFF8 files the BOF is 0x809. For earlier versions see {@link #biff2_sid} {@link #biff3_sid} {@link #biff4_sid} {@link #biff5_sid} suggested default (0x06 - BIFF8) suggested default 0x10d3 suggested default 0x07CC (1996) suggested default for a normal sheet (0x41) Constructs an empty BOFRecord with no fields Set. Constructs a BOFRecord and Sets its fields appropriately @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Version number - for BIFF8 should be 0x06 @see #VERSION @param version version to be Set Set the history bit mask (not very useful) @see #HISTORY_MASK @param bitmask bitmask to Set for the history Set the minimum version required to Read this file @see #VERSION @param version version to Set type of object this marks @see #TYPE_WORKBOOK @see #TYPE_VB_MODULE @see #TYPE_WORKSHEET @see #TYPE_CHART @see #TYPE_EXCEL_4_MACRO @see #TYPE_WORKSPACE_FILE @return short type of object Get the build that wrote this file @see #BUILD @return short build number of the generator of this file Year of the build that wrote this file @see #BUILD_YEAR @return short build year of the generator of this file Title: Save External Links record (BookBool) Description: Contains a flag specifying whether the Gui should save externally linked values from other workbooks. REFERENCE: PG 289 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a BookBoolRecord and Sets its fields appropriately @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the save ext links flag @return short 0/1 (off/on) Creates new BoolErrRecord. REFERENCE: PG ??? Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Michael P. Harhen @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre If true, this record represents an error cell value, otherwise this record represents a boolean cell value Creates new BoolErrRecord Constructs a BoolErr record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Set the bool value for the cell @param value representing the bool value Set the error value for the cell @param value error representing the error value this value can only be 0,7,15,23,29,36 or 42 see bugzilla bug 16560 for an explanation Get the value for the cell @return bool representing the bool value Get the error value for the cell @return byte representing the error value Indicates whether the call holds a boolean value @return boolean true if the cell holds a boolean value Indicates whether the call holds an error value @return bool true if the cell holds an error value Record for the bottom margin. NOTE: This source was automatically generated. @author Shawn Laubach (slaubach at apache dot org) Constructs a BottomMargin record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the margin field for the BottomMargin record. Title: Bound Sheet Record (aka BundleSheet) Description: Defines a sheet within a workbook. Basically stores the sheetname and tells where the Beginning of file record Is within the HSSF file. REFERENCE: PG 291 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Sergei Kozello (sergeikozello at mail.ru) Constructs a BoundSheetRecord and Sets its fields appropriately @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the offset in bytes of the Beginning of File Marker within the HSSF Stream part of the POIFS file @return offset in bytes Is the sheet very hidden? Different from (normal) hidden Get the sheetname for this sheet. (this appears in the tabs at the bottom) @return sheetname the name of the sheet Converts a List of {@link BoundSheetRecord}s to an array and sorts by the position of their BOFs. Title: Calc Count Record Description: Specifies the maximum times the gui should perform a formula recalculation. For instance: in the case a formula includes cells that are themselves a result of a formula and a value Changes. This Is essentially a failsafe against an infinate loop in the event the formulas are not independant. REFERENCE: PG 292 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.CalcModeRecord Constructs a CalcCountRecord and Sets its fields appropriately @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the number of iterations to perform @return iterations Title: Calc Mode Record Description: Tells the gui whether to calculate formulas automatically, manually or automatically except for tables. REFERENCE: PG 292 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.CalcCountRecord manually calculate formulas (0) automatically calculate formulas (1) automatically calculate formulas except for tables (-1) Constructs a CalcModeRecord and Sets its fields appropriately @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Set the calc mode flag for formulas @see #MANUAL @see #AUTOMATIC @see #AUTOMATIC_EXCEPT_TABLES @param calcmode one of the three flags above Get the calc mode flag for formulas @see #MANUAL @see #AUTOMATIC @see #AUTOMATIC_EXCEPT_TABLES @return calcmode one of the three flags above get the index to the ExtendedFormat @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.ExtendedFormatRecord @return index to the XF record Append specific debug info (used by {@link #toString()} for the value contained in this record. Trailing new-line should not be Appended (superclass does that). Gets the debug info BIFF record type name (used by {@link #toString()}. writes out the value data for this cell record @return the size (in bytes) of the value data for this cell record The cell value record interface Is implemented by all classes of type Record that contain cell values. It allows the containing sheet to move through them and Compare them. @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @see org.apache.poi.hssf.model.Sheet @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.Record @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.RecordFactory Get the row this cell occurs on @return the row Get the column this cell defines within the row @return the column Conditional Formatting Header record (CFHEADER) @author Dmitriy Kumshayev Creates new CFHeaderRecord Conditional Formatting Rule Record. @author Dmitriy Kumshayev Creates new CFRuleRecord get the stack of the 1st expression as a list @return list of tokens (casts stack to a list and returns it!) this method can return null is we are unable to create Ptgs from existing excel file callers should check for null! get the stack of the 2nd expression as a list @return list of tokens (casts stack to a list and returns it!) this method can return null is we are unable to create Ptgs from existing excel file callers should check for null! Creates a new comparison operation rule Creates a new comparison operation rule Creates a new comparison operation rule Get the option flags @return bit mask @param ptgs may be null @return encoded size of the formula called by the class that Is responsible for writing this sucker. Subclasses should implement this so that their data Is passed back in a byte array. @param offset to begin writing at @param data byte array containing instance data @return number of bytes written TODO - Parse conditional format formulas properly i.e. produce tRefN and tAreaN instead of tRef and tArea this call will produce the wrong results if the formula Contains any cell references One approach might be to apply the inverse of SharedFormulaRecord.ConvertSharedFormulas(Stack, int, int) Note - two extra parameters (rowIx &colIx) will be required. They probably come from one of the Region objects. @return null if formula was null. TODO - parse conditional format formulas properly i.e. produce tRefN and tAreaN instead of tRef and tArea this call will produce the wrong results if the formula contains any cell references One approach might be to apply the inverse of SharedFormulaRecord.convertSharedFormulas(Stack, int, int) Note - two extra parameters (rowIx & colIx) will be required. They probably come from one of the Region objects. @return null if formula was null. Border Formatting Block of the Conditional Formatting Rule Record. @author Dmitriy Kumshayev Creates new FontFormatting Get the type of border to use for the left border of the cell Get the type of border to use for the right border of the cell Get the type of border to use for the top border of the cell Get the type of border to use for the bottom border of the cell Get the type of border to use for the diagonal border of the cell Get the color to use for the left border Get the color to use for the right border Get the color to use for the top border Get the color to use for the bottom border Get the color to use for the diagonal border true if forward diagonal is on true if backward diagonal Is on @author Dmitriy Kumshayev first range is within the second range first range encloses or is equal to the second Intersect this range with the specified range. @param crB - the specified range @return code which reflects how the specified range is related to this range.
Possible return codes are: NO_INTERSECTION - the specified range is outside of this range;
OVERLAP - both ranges partially overlap;
INSIDE - the specified range is inside of this one
ENCLOSES - the specified range encloses (possibly exactly the same as) this range
Do all possible cell merges between cells of the list so that: if a cell range is completely inside of another cell range, it s removed from the list if two cells have a shared border, merge them into one bigger cell range @param cellRangeList @return updated List of cell ranges @return the new range(s) to replace the supplied ones. null if no merge is possible ** Check if the specified range is located inside of this cell range. @param crB @return true if this cell range Contains the argument range inside if it's area Check if the specified cell range has a shared border with the current range. @return true if the ranges have a complete shared border (i.e. the two ranges toher make a simple rectangular region. Create an enclosing CellRange for the two cell ranges. @return enclosing CellRange @return true if a < b @return true if a <= b @return true if a > b @return true if a >= b Font Formatting Block of the Conditional Formatting Rule Record. @author Dmitriy Kumshayev Normal boldness (not bold) Bold boldness (bold) Creates new FontFormatting Gets the height of the font in 1/20th point Units @return fontheight (in points/20); or -1 if not modified Get whether the font Is to be italics or not @return italics - whether the font Is italics or not @see #GetAttributes() Get whether the font Is to be stricken out or not @return strike - whether the font Is stricken out or not @see #GetAttributes() Get or set the font weight for this font (100-1000dec or 0x64-0x3e8). Default Is 0x190 for normal and 0x2bc for bold Get or set whether the font weight is set to bold or not Get the type of base or subscript for the font @return base or subscript option @see org.apache.poi.hssf.usermodel.HSSFFontFormatting#SS_NONE @see org.apache.poi.hssf.usermodel.HSSFFontFormatting#SS_SUPER @see org.apache.poi.hssf.usermodel.HSSFFontFormatting#SS_SUB Get the type of Underlining for the font @return font Underlining type Pattern Formatting Block of the Conditional Formatting Rule Record. @author Dmitriy Kumshayev Creates new FontFormatting Get the Fill pattern @return Fill pattern Get the background Fill color @see org.apache.poi.hssf.usermodel.HSSFPalette#GetColor(short) @return Fill color Get the foreground Fill color @see org.apache.poi.hssf.usermodel.HSSFPalette#GetColor(short) @return Fill color The AlRuns record specifies Rich Text Formatting within chart titles (section 2.2.3.3), trendline (section 2.2.3.12), and data labels (section 2.2.3.11). * The area format record is used to define the colours and patterns for an area. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a AreaFormat record and s its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) the foreground color field for the AreaFormat record. the background color field for the AreaFormat record. the pattern field for the AreaFormat record. the format flags field for the AreaFormat record. the forecolor index field for the AreaFormat record. the backcolor index field for the AreaFormat record. automatic formatting @return the automatic field value. swap foreground and background colours when data is negative @return the invert field value. * The area record is used to define a area chart. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a Area record and s its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) the format flags field for the Area record. series is stacked @return the stacked field value. results Displayed as percentages @return the Display as percentage field value. Display a shadow for the chart @return the shadow field value. * The series label record defines the type of label associated with the data format record. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a SeriesLabels record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the format flags field for the SeriesLabels record. show actual value of the data point @return the show actual field value. show value as percentage of total (pie charts only) @return the show percent field value. show category label/value as percentage (pie charts only) @return the label as percentage field value. show smooth line @return the smoothed line field value. Display category label @return the show label field value. ?? @return the show bubble sizes field value. The AxcExt record specifies additional extension properties of a date axis (section 2.2.3.6), along with a CatSerRange record (section 2.4.39). specifies the interval at which the major tick marks are displayed on the axis (section 2.2.3.6), in the unit defined by duMajor. specifies the unit of time to use for catMajor when the axis (section 2.2.3.6) is a date axis (section 2.2.3.6). If fDateAxis is set to 0, MUST be ignored. specifies the interval at which the minor tick marks are displayed on the axis (section 2.2.3.6), in a unit defined by duMinor. specifies the smallest unit of time used by the axis (section 2.2.3.6). specifies at which date, as a date in the date system specified by the Date1904 record (section 2.4.77), in the units defined by duBase, the value axis (section 2.2.3.6) crosses this axis (section 2.2.3.6). specifies whether MinimumDate is calculated automatically. specifies whether MaximumDate is calculated automatically. * The number of axes used on a chart. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a AxisUsed record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the num axis field for the AxisUsed record. The axis (section 2.2.3.6) line itself. The major gridlines along the axis The minor gridlines along the axis The walls or floor of a 3-D chart The AxisLine record specifies which part of the axis (section 2.2.3.6) is specified by the LineFormat record (section 2.4.156) that follows. Excel Binary File Format (.xls) Structure Specification Constructs a AxisLineFormat record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) * The axis size and location * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a AxisParent record and s its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) the axis type field for the AxisParent record. @return One of AXIS_TYPE_MAIN AXIS_TYPE_SECONDARY the x field for the AxisParent record. the y field for the AxisParent record. the width field for the AxisParent record. the height field for the AxisParent record. * The axis record defines the type of an axis. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a Axis record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the axis type field for the Axis record. @return One of AXIS_TYPE_CATEGORY_OR_X_AXIS AXIS_TYPE_VALUE_AXIS AXIS_TYPE_SERIES_AXIS Get the reserved1 field for the Axis record. Get the reserved2 field for the Axis record. Get the reserved3 field for the Axis record. Get the reserved4 field for the Axis record. * The number of axes used on a chart. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a AxisUsed record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the num axis field for the AxisUsed record. * The bar record is used to define a bar chart. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a Bar record and s its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) the bar space field for the Bar record. the category space field for the Bar record. the format flags field for the Bar record. true to Display horizontal bar charts, false for vertical @return the horizontal field value. stack Displayed values @return the stacked field value. Display chart values as a percentage @return the Display as percentage field value. Display a shadow for the chart @return the shadow field value. The begin record defines the start of a block of records for a (grpahing data object. This record is matched with a corresponding EndRecord. @see EndRecord @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a BeginRecord record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from The BopPopCustom record specifies which data points in the series are contained in the secondary bar/pie instead of the primary pie. MUST follow a BopPop record that has its split field set to Custom (0x0003). author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) The BopPop record specifies that the chart group is a bar of pie chart group or a pie of pie chart group and specifies the chart group attributes. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) The BRAI record specifies a reference to data in a sheet (1) that is used by a part of a series, legend entry, trendline or error bars. A ChartParsedFormula structure that specifies the formula (section 2.2.2) that specifies the reference. Constructs a LinkedData record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) specifies the part of the series, trendline, or error bars the referenced data specifies. specifies the number format to use for the data. CATLAB - Category Labels (0x0856)
@author Patrick Cheng
specifies the properties of a category (3) axis, a date axis, or a series axis. Constructs a CategorySeriesAxis record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) specifies where the value axis crosses this axis, based on the following table. If fMaxCross is set to 1, the value this field MUST be ignored. Category (3) axis This field specifies the category (3) at which the value axis crosses. For example, if this field is 2, the value axis crosses this axis at the second category (3) on this axis. MUST be greater than or equal to 1 and less than or equal to 31999. Series axis MUST be 0. Date axis catCross MUST be equal to the value given by the following formula: catCross = catCrossDate – catMin + 1 Where catCrossDate is the catCrossDate field of the AxcExt record and catMin is the catMin field of the AxcExt record. specifies the interval between axis labels on this axis. MUST be greater than or equal to 1 and less than or equal to 31999. MUST be ignored for a date axis. specifies the interval at which major tick marks and minor tick marks are displayed on the axis. Major tick marks and minor tick marks that would have been visible are hidden unless they are located at a multiple of this field. specifies whether the value axis crosses this axis between major tick marks. MUST be a value from to following table: 0 The value axis crosses this axis on a major tick mark. 1 The value axis crosses this axis between major tick marks. specifies whether the value axis crosses this axis at the last category (3), the last series, or the maximum date. MUST be a value from the following table: 0 The value axis crosses this axis at the value specified by catCross. 1 The value axis crosses this axis at the last category (3), the last series, or the maximum date. specifies whether the axis is displayed in reverse order. MUST be a value from the following table: 0 The axis is displayed in order. 1 The axis is display in reverse order. the shape of the base of the data points in a bar or column chart group. MUST be a value from the following table 0x00 The base of the data point is a rectangle. 0x01 The base of the data point is an ellipse. how the data points in a bar or column chart group taper from base to tip. MUST be a value from the following 0x00 The data points of the bar or column chart group do not taper. The shape at the maximum value of the data point is the same as the shape at the base.: 0x01 The data points of the bar or column chart group taper to a point at the maximum value of each data point. 0x02 The data points of the bar or column chart group taper towards a projected point at the position of the maximum value of all of the data points in the chart group, but are clipped at the value of each data point. The Chart3d record specifies that the plot area of the chart group is rendered in a 3-D scene and also specifies the attributes of the 3-D plot area. The preceding chart group type MUST be of type bar, pie, line, area, or surface. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) A signed integer that specifies the clockwise rotation, in degrees, of the 3-D plot area around a vertical line through the center of the 3-D plot area. MUST be greater than or equal to 0 and MUST be less than or equal to 360. A signed integer that specifies the rotation, in degrees, of the 3-D plot area around a horizontal line through the center of the 3-D plot area.MUST be greater than or equal to -90 and MUST be less than or equal to 90. A signed integer that specifies the field of view angle for the 3-D plot area. MUST be greater than or equal to zero and less than 200. If fNotPieChart is 0, then this is an unsigned integer that specifies the thickness of the pie for a pie chart group. If fNotPieChart is 1, then this is a signed integer that specifies the height of the 3-D plot area as a percentage of its width. A signed integer that specifies the depth of the 3-D plot area as a percentage of its width. MUST be greater than or equal to 1 and less than or equal to 2000. An unsigned integer that specifies the width of the gap between the series and the front and back edges of the 3-D plot area as a percentage of the data point depth divided by 2. If fCluster is not 1 and chart group type is not a bar then pcGap also specifies distance between adjacent series as a percentage of the data point depth. MUST be less than or equal to 500. A bit that specifies whether the 3-D plot area is rendered with a vanishing point. If fNotPieChart is 0 the value MUST be 0. If fNotPieChart is 1 then the value MUST be a value from the following true Perspective vanishing point applied based on value of pcDist. false No vanishing point applied. specifies whether data points are clustered together in a bar chart group. If chart group type is not bar or pie, value MUST be ignored. If chart group type is pie, value MUST be 0. If chart group type is bar, then the value MUST be a value from the following true Data points are clustered. false Data points are not clustered. A bit that specifies whether the height of the 3-D plot area is automatically determined. If fNotPieChart is 0 then this MUST be 0. If fNotPieChart is 1 then the value MUST be a value from the following table: false The value of pcHeight is used to determine the height of the 3-D plot area true The height of the 3-D plot area is automatically determined A bit that specifies whether the chart group type is pie. MUST be a value from the following : false Chart group type MUST be pie. true Chart group type MUST not be pie. Whether the walls are rendered in 2-D. If fPerspective is 1 then this MUST be ignored. If the chart group type is not bar, area or pie this MUST be ignored. If the chart group is of type bar and fCluster is 0, then this MUST be ignored. If the chart group type is pie this MUST be 0 and MUST be ignored. If the chart group type is bar or area, then the value MUST be a value from the following false Chart walls and floor are rendered in 3D. true Chart walls are rendered in 2D and the chart floor is not rendered. ENDBLOCK - Chart Future Record Type End Block (0x0853)
@author Patrick Cheng
ENDOBJECT - Chart Future Record Type End Object (0x0855)
@author Patrick Cheng
The ChartFrtInfo record specifies the versions of the application that originally created and last saved the file. * The chart record is used to define the location and size of a chart. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a Chart record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the x field for the Chart record. Get the y field for the Chart record. Get the width field for the Chart record. Get the height field for the Chart record. STARTBLOCK - Chart Future Record Type Start Block (0x0852)
@author Patrick Cheng
STARTOBJECT - Chart Future Record Type Start Object (0x0854)
@author Patrick Cheng
Describes the formatting runs associated with a chart title. The CrtLayout12A record specifies layout information for a plot area. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) specifies the type of plot area for the layout target. false Outer plot area - The bounding rectangle that includes the axis labels, axis titles, data table (2) and plot area of the chart. true Inner plot area – The rectangle bounded by the chart axes. specifies the checksum specifies the horizontal offset of the plot area’s upper-left corner, relative to the upper-left corner of the chart area specifies the vertical offset of the plot area’s upper-left corner, relative to the upper-left corner of the chart area specifies the width of the plot area specifies the height of the plot area A CrtLayout12Mode structure that specifies the meaning of x. A CrtLayout12Mode structure that specifies the meaning of y. A CrtLayout12Mode structure that specifies the meaning of dx. A CrtLayout12Mode structure that specifies the meaning of dy. An Xnum (section 2.5.342) value that specifies a horizontal offset. The meaning is determined by wXMode. An Xnum value that specifies a vertical offset. The meaning is determined by wYMode. An Xnum value that specifies a width or an horizontal offset. The meaning is determined by wWidthMode. An Xnum value that specifies a height or an vertical offset. The meaning is determined by wHeightMode. The CrtLayout12Mode specifies a layout mode. Each layout mode specifies a different meaning of the x, y, dx, and dy fields of CrtLayout12 and CrtLayout12A. Position and dimension (2) are determined by the application. x, y, dx and dy MUST be ignored. x and y specify the offset of the top left corner, relative to its default position, as a fraction of the chart area. MUST be greater than or equal to -1.0 and MUST be less than or equal to 1.0. dx and dy specify the width and height, as a fraction of the chart area, MUST be greater than or equal to 0.0, and MUST be less than or equal to 1.0. x and y specify the offset of the upper-left corner; dx and dy specify the offset of the bottom-right corner. x, y, dx and dy are specified relative to the upper-left corner of the chart area as a fraction of the chart area. x, y, dx and dy MUST be greater than or equal to 0.0, and MUST be less than or equal to 1.0. The CrtLayout12 record specifies the layout information for attached label, when contained in the sequence of records that conforms to the ATTACHEDLABEL rule, or legend, when contained in the sequence of records that conforms to the LD rule. automatic layout type of the legend. MUST be ignored when this record is in the sequence of records that conforms to the ATTACHEDLABEL rule. MUST be a value from the following table: 0x0 Align to the bottom 0x1 Align to top right corner 0x2 Align to the top 0x3 Align to the right 0x4 Align to the left specifies the checksum of the values in the order as follows, A CrtLayout12Mode structure that specifies the meaning of x. A CrtLayout12Mode structure that specifies the meaning of y. A CrtLayout12Mode structure that specifies the meaning of dx. A CrtLayout12Mode structure that specifies the meaning of dy. An Xnum (section 2.5.342) value that specifies a horizontal offset. The meaning is determined by wXMode. An Xnum value that specifies a vertical offset. The meaning is determined by wYMode. An Xnum value that specifies a width or an horizontal offset. The meaning is determined by wWidthMode. An Xnum value that specifies a height or an vertical offset. The meaning is determined by wHeightMode. The CrtLine record specifies the presence of drop lines, high-low lines, series lines or leader lines on the chart group. This record is followed by a LineFormat record which specifies the format of the lines. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) The CrtLink record is written but unused. The CrtMlFrtContinue record specifies additional data for a CrtMlFrt record, as specified in the CrtMlFrt record. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) The CrtMlFrt record specifies additional properties for chart elements, as specified by the Chart Sheet Substream ABNF. These properties complement the record to which they correspond, and are stored as a structure chain defined in XmlTkChain. An application can ignore this record without loss of functionality, except for the additional properties. If this record is longer than 8224 bytes, it MUST be split into several records. The first section of the data appears in this record and subsequent sections appear in one or more CrtMlFrtContinue records that follow this record. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) * The data format record is used to index into a series. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a DataFormat record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the point number field for the DataFormat record. Get the series index field for the DataFormat record. Get the series number field for the DataFormat record. Get the format flags field for the DataFormat record. Set true to use excel 4 colors. @return the use excel 4 colors field value. DATALABEXT - Chart Data Label Extension (0x086A)
@author Patrick Cheng
The DataLabExtContents record specifies the contents of an extended data label. DATALABEXT - Chart Data Label Extension (0x086A)
@author Patrick Cheng
* The dat record is used to store options for the chart. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a Dat record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the options field for the Dat record. Sets the horizontal border field value. has a horizontal border has a horizontal border @return the horizontal border field value. Sets the vertical border field value. has vertical border has vertical border @return the vertical border field value. Sets the border field value. data table has a border data table has a border @return the border field value. Sets the show series key field value. shows the series key shows the series key @return the show series key field value. specifies the text elements that are formatted using the position and appearance information specified by the Text record immediately following this record. Format all Text records in the chart group where fShowPercent is equal to 0 or fShowValue is equal to 0. Format all Text records in the chart group where fShowPercent is equal to 1 or fShowValue is equal to 1. Format all Text records in the chart where the value of fScaled of the associated FontInfo structure is equal to 0. Format all Text records in the chart where the value of fScaled of the associated FontInfo structure is equal to 1. specifies the text elements that are formatted using the information specified by the Text record immediately following this record. Constructs a DefaultDataLabelTextProperties record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) specifies the text elements that are formatted using the position and appearance information specified by the Text record immediately following this record. The DropBar record specifies the attributes of the up bars or the down bars between multiple series of a line chart group and specifies the beginning of a collection of records as defined by the Chart Sheet Substream ABNF. The first of these collections in the line chart group specifies the attributes of the up bars. The second specifies the attributes of the down bars. If this record exists, then the chart group type MUST be line and the field cSer in the record SeriesList MUST be greater than 1. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) ENDBLOCK - Chart Future Record Type End Block (0x0853)
@author Patrick Cheng
The end record defines the end of a block of records for a (Graphing) data object. This record is matched with a corresponding BeginRecord. @see BeginRecord @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a EndRecord record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from The Fbi2 record specifies the font information at the time the scalable font is added to the chart. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) The Fbi record specifies the font information at the time the scalable font is added to the chart. Constructs a FontBasis record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the x Basis field for the FontBasis record. Get the y Basis field for the FontBasis record. Get the height basis field for the FontBasis record. Get the scale field for the FontBasis record. Get the index to font table field for the FontBasis record. * The font basis record stores various font metrics. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a FontBasis record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the x Basis field for the FontBasis record. Get the y Basis field for the FontBasis record. Get the height basis field for the FontBasis record. Get the scale field for the FontBasis record. Get the index to font table field for the FontBasis record. The FontX record specifies the font for a given text element. The Font record referenced by iFont can exist in this chart sheet substream or the workbook. Constructs a FontIndex record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) specifies the font to use for subsequent records. This font can either be the default font of the chart, part of the collection of Font records following the FrtFontList record, or part of the collection of Font records in the globals substream. If iFont is 0x0000, this record specifies the default font of the chart. If iFont is less than or equal to the number of Font records in the globals substream, iFont is a one-based index to a Font record in the globals substream. Otherwise iFont is a one-based index into the collection of Font records in this chart sheet substream where the index is equal to iFont – n, where n is the number of Font records in the globals substream. * The frame record indicates whether there is a border around the Displayed text of a chart. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a Frame record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the border type field for the Frame record. @return One of BORDER_TYPE_REGULAR BORDER_TYPE_SHADOW Get the options field for the Frame record. excel calculates the size automatically if true @return the auto size field value. excel calculates the position automatically @return the auto position field value. The FrtFontList record specifies font information used on the chart and specifies the beginning of a collection of Font records as defined by the Chart Sheet Substream ABNF. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) specifies the properties of a fill pattern for parts of a chart. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) The IFmtRecord record specifies the number format to use for the text on an axis. Constructs a NumberFormatIndex record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the format index field for the NumberFormatIndex record. The LegendException record specifies information about a legend entry which was changed from the default legend entry settings, and specifies the beginning of a collection of records as defined by the Chart Sheet Substream ABNF. The collection of records specifies legend entry formatting. On a chart where the legend contains legend entries for the series and trendlines, as defined in the legend overview, there MUST be zero instances or one instance of this record in the sequence of records that conform to the SERIESFORMAT rule. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) * Defines a legend for a chart. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache.org) Constructs a Legend record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the x axis upper left field for the Legend record. Get the y axis upper left field for the Legend record. Get the x size field for the Legend record. Get the y size field for the Legend record. Get the type field for the Legend record. @return One of TYPE_BOTTOM TYPE_CORNER TYPE_TOP TYPE_RIGHT TYPE_LEFT TYPE_UNDOCKED Get the spacing field for the Legend record. @return One of SPACING_CLOSE SPACING_MEDIUM SPACING_OPEN Get the options field for the Legend record. automatic positioning (1=docked) @return the auto position field value. excel 5 only (true) @return the auto series field value. position of legend on the x axis is automatic @return the auto x positioning field value. position of legend on the y axis is automatic @return the auto y positioning field value. vertical or horizontal legend (1 or 0 respectively). Always 0 if not automatic. @return the vertical field value. 1 if chart Contains data table @return the data table field value. * Describes a line format record. The line format record controls how a line on a chart appears. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a LineFormat record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the line color field for the LineFormat record. Get the line pattern field for the LineFormat record. @return One of LINE_PATTERN_SOLID LINE_PATTERN_DASH LINE_PATTERN_DOT LINE_PATTERN_DASH_DOT LINE_PATTERN_DASH_DOT_DOT LINE_PATTERN_NONE LINE_PATTERN_DARK_GRAY_PATTERN LINE_PATTERN_MEDIUM_GRAY_PATTERN LINE_PATTERN_LIGHT_GRAY_PATTERN Get the weight field for the LineFormat record. specifies the thickness of the line. @return One of WEIGHT_HAIRLINE WEIGHT_NARROW WEIGHT_MEDIUM WEIGHT_WIDE Get the format field for the LineFormat record. Get the colour palette index field for the LineFormat record. automatic format @return the auto field value. draw tick marks @return the draw ticks field value. book marks this as reserved = 0 but it seems to do something @return the Unknown field value. specifies the color, size, and shape of the associated data markers that appear on line, radar, and scatter chart groups. The associated data markers are specified by the preceding DataFormat record. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) the border color of the data marker. the interior color of the data marker. the type of data marker. whether the data marker is automatically generated. false The data marker is not automatically generated. true The data marker type, size, and color are automatically generated and the values are set accordingly in this record. whether to show the data marker interior. false The data marker interior is shown. true The data marker interior is not shown. whether to show the data marker border. false The data marker border is shown. true The data marker border is not shown. the border color of the data marker. the interior color of the data marker. specifies the size in twips of the data marker. * The number format index record indexes format table. This applies to an axis. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a NumberFormatIndex record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the format index field for the NumberFormatIndex record. * Links text to an object on the chart or identifies it as the title. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache.org) Constructs a ObjectLink record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the anchor id field for the ObjectLink record. @return One of ANCHOR_ID_CHART_TITLE ANCHOR_ID_Y_AXIS ANCHOR_ID_X_AXIS ANCHOR_ID_SERIES_OR_POINT ANCHOR_ID_Z_AXIS Get the link 1 field for the ObjectLink record. Get the link 2 field for the ObjectLink record. The PicF record specifies the layout of a picture that is attached to a picture-filled chart element. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) The PieFormat record specifies the distance of a data point or data points in a series from the center of one of the following: The plot area for a doughnut or pie chart group. The primary pie in a pie of pie or bar of pie chart group. The secondary bar/pie of a pie of pie chart group. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) A signed integer that specifies the distance of a data point or data points in a series from the center of one of the following: The plot area for a doughnut or pie chart group. The primary pie in a pie of pie or bar of pie chart group. The secondary bar/pie of a pie of pie chart group. The Pie record specifies that the chart group is a pie chart group or a doughnut chart group, and specifies the chart group attributes. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) An unsigned integer that specifies the starting angle of the first data point, clockwise from the top of the circle. MUST be less than or equal to 360. An unsigned integer that specifies the size of the center hole in a doughnut chart group as a percentage of the plot area size. MUST be a value from the following table: 0 Pie chart group. 10 to 90 Doughnut chart group. A bit that specifies whether one data point or more data points in the chart group have shadows. A bit that specifies whether the leader lines to the data labels are shown. * preceeds and identifies a frame as belonging to the plot area. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache.org) Constructs a PlotArea record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) * The plot growth record specifies the scaling factors used when a font is scaled. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a PlotGrowth record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the horizontalScale field for the PlotGrowth record. Get the verticalScale field for the PlotGrowth record. pecifies positioning mode for position information saved in a Pos record. Relative position to the chart, in points. Absolute width and height in points. It can only be applied to the mdBotRt field of Pos. Owner of Pos determines how to interpret the position data. Offset to default position, in 1/1000th of the plot area size. Relative position to the chart, in SPRC. specifies the size and position for a legend, an attached label, or the plot area, as specified by the primary axis group. specifies the positioning mode for the upper-left corner of a legend, an attached label, or the plot area. specifies the positioning mode for the lower-right corner of a legend, an attached label, or the plot area specifies a position. The meaning is specified in the earlier table showing the valid combinations mdTopLt and mdBotRt by type. specifies a width. The meaning is specified in the earlier table showing the valid combinations mdTopLt and mdBotRt by type. specifies a position. The meaning is specified in the earlier table showing the valid combinations mdTopLt and mdBotRt by type. specifies a height. The meaning is specified in the earlier table showing the valid combinations mdTopLt and mdBotRt by type. The RadarArea record specifies that the chart group is a filled radar chart group and specifies the chart group attributes. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) The Radar record specifies that the chart group is a radar chart group and specifies the chart group attributes. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) The RichTextStream record specifies additional text properties for the text in the entire chart, text in the current legend, text in the current legend entry, or text in the attached label. These text properties are a superset of the properties stored in the Text, Font, FontX, BRAI, and ObjectLink records based on the following table, as specified by the Chart Sheet Substream ABNF. In each case, the associated Font record is specified by the associated FontX record. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) The Scatter record specifies that the chart group is a scatter chart group or a bubble chart group, and specifies the chart group attributes. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) The SerAuxErrBar record specifies properties of an error bar. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) The SerAuxTrend record specifies a trendline. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) The SerFmt record specifies properties of the associated data points, data markers, or lines of the series. The associated data points, data markers, or lines of the series are specified by the preceding DataFormat record. If this record is not present in the sequence of records that conforms to the SS rule of the Chart Sheet Substream ABNF, then the properties of the associated data points, data markers, or lines of the series are specified by the default values of the fields of this record. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) * The series chart Group index record stores the index to the CHARTFORMAT record (0 based). * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a SeriesChartGroupIndex record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the chart Group index field for the SeriesChartGroupIndex record. * links a series to its position in the series list. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache.org) Constructs a SeriesIndex record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the index field for the SeriesIndex record. * The series label record defines the type of label associated with the data format record. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a SeriesLabels record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the format flags field for the SeriesLabels record. show actual value of the data point @return the show actual field value. show value as percentage of total (pie charts only) @return the show percent field value. show category label/value as percentage (pie charts only) @return the label as percentage field value. show smooth line @return the smoothed line field value. Display category label @return the show label field value. ?? @return the show bubble sizes field value. * The series list record defines the series Displayed as an overlay to the main chart record. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a SeriesList record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the series numbers field for the SeriesList record. * The series record describes the overall data for a series. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a Series record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the category data type field for the Series record. @return One of CATEGORY_DATA_TYPE_DATES CATEGORY_DATA_TYPE_NUMERIC CATEGORY_DATA_TYPE_SEQUENCE CATEGORY_DATA_TYPE_TEXT Get the values data type field for the Series record. @return One of VALUES_DATA_TYPE_DATES VALUES_DATA_TYPE_NUMERIC VALUES_DATA_TYPE_SEQUENCE VALUES_DATA_TYPE_TEXT Get the num categories field for the Series record. Get the num values field for the Series record. Get the bubble series type field for the Series record. @return One of BUBBLE_SERIES_TYPE_DATES BUBBLE_SERIES_TYPE_NUMERIC BUBBLE_SERIES_TYPE_SEQUENCE BUBBLE_SERIES_TYPE_TEXT Get the num bubble values field for the Series record. * Defines a series name * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache.org) the actual text cannot be longer than 255 characters Constructs a SeriesText record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the id field for the SeriesText record. Get the text field for the SeriesText record. * Indicates the chart-group index for a series. The order probably defines the mapping. So the 0th record probably means the 0th series. The only field in this of course defines which chart Group the 0th series (for instance) would map to. Confusing? Well thats because it Is. (p 522 BCG) * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache.org) Constructs a SeriesToChartGroup record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the chart Group index field for the SeriesToChartGroup record. The SerParent record specifies the series to which the current trendline or error bar corresponds. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) The SerToCrt record specifies the chart group for the current series. Constructs a SeriesChartGroupIndex record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the chart Group index field for the SeriesChartGroupIndex record. The ShapePropsStream record specifies the shape formatting properties for chart elements. These shape formatting properties are a superset of the properties stored in the LineFormat, AreaFormat, MarkerFormat, and GelFrame records. They are stored in the rgb field, which is an XML stream (section 2.1.7.22), as defined in [ECMA-376] Part 4, section 5.7.2.198. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) * Describes a chart sheet properties record. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) specifies properties of a chart as defined by the Chart Sheet Substream ABNF Constructs a SheetProperties record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the flags field for the SheetProperties record. Get the empty field for the SheetProperties record. @return One of EMPTY_NOT_PLOTTED EMPTY_ZERO EMPTY_INTERPOLATED specifies how the empty cells are plotted be a value from the following table: 0x00 Empty cells are not plotted. 0x01 Empty cells are plotted as zero. 0x02 Empty cells are plotted as interpolated. whether series are automatically allocated for the chart. whether to plot visible cells only. whether to size the chart with the window. If fAlwaysAutoPlotArea is 1, then this field MUST be 1. If fAlwaysAutoPlotArea is 0, then this field MUST be ignored. specifies whether the default plot area dimension (2) is used. 0 Use the default plot area dimension (2) regardless of the Pos record information. 1 Use the plot area dimension (2) of the Pos record; and fManPlotArea MUST be 1. STARTBLOCK - Chart Future Record Type Start Block (0x0852)
@author Patrick Cheng
The Surf record specifies that the chart group is a surface chart group and specifies the chart group attributes. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) The RichTextStream record specifies additional text properties for the text in the entire chart, text in the current legend, text in the current legend entry, or text in the attached label. These text properties are a superset of the properties stored in the Text, Font, FontX, BRAI, and ObjectLink records based on the following table, as specified by the Chart Sheet Substream ABNF. In each case, the associated Font record is specified by the associated FontX record. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) * The value range record defines the range of the value axis. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a ValueRange record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the minimum axis value field for the ValueRange record. Get the maximum axis value field for the ValueRange record. Get the major increment field for the ValueRange record. Get the minor increment field for the ValueRange record. Get the category axis cross field for the ValueRange record. Get the options field for the ValueRange record. automatic minimum value selected @return the automatic minimum field value. automatic maximum value selected @return the automatic maximum field value. automatic major Unit selected @return the automatic major field value. automatic minor Unit selected @return the automatic minor field value. category crossing point is automatically selected @return the automatic category crossing field value. use logarithmic scale @return the logarithmic scale field value. values are reverses in graph @return the values in reverse field value. category axis to cross at maximum value @return the cross category axis at maximum field value. reserved, must equal 1 (excel dev. guide says otherwise) @return the reserved field value. The YMult record specifies properties of the value multiplier for a value axis and that specifies the beginning of a collection of records as defined by the Chart Sheet substream ABNF. The collection of records specifies a display units label. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) Class ChartFormatRecord @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) @version %I%, %G% Constructs a ChartFormatRecord record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Section [2.4.324]. The Text record specifies the properties of an attached label and specifies the beginning of a collection of records as defined by the chart sheet substream ABNF. This collection of records specifies an attached label. Left-alignment if iReadingOrder specifies left-to-right reading order; otherwise, right-alignment Center-alignment Right-alignment if iReadingOrder specifies left-to-right reading order; otherwise, left-alignment Justify-alignment distributed alignment distributed alignment Transparent background Opaque background Constructs a Text record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the horizontal alignment field for the Text record. @return One of HORIZONTAL_ALIGNMENT_LEFT HORIZONTAL_ALIGNMENT_CENTER HORIZONTAL_ALIGNMENT_BOTTOM HORIZONTAL_ALIGNMENT_JUSTIFY Get the vertical alignment field for the Text record. @return One of VERTICAL_ALIGNMENT_TOP VERTICAL_ALIGNMENT_CENTER VERTICAL_ALIGNMENT_BOTTOM VERTICAL_ALIGNMENT_JUSTIFY Get the Display mode field for the Text record. @return One of DISPLAY_MODE_TRANSPARENT DISPLAY_MODE_OPAQUE Get the rgbColor field for the Text record. Get the x field for the Text record. Get the y field for the Text record. Set the width field for the Text record. Get the height field for the Text record. Get the options1 field for the Text record. Get the index of color value field for the Text record. Get the options2 field for the Text record. Get the text rotation field for the Text record. true = automaticly selected colour, false = user-selected @return the auto color field value. true = draw legend @return the show key field value. false = text is category label @return the show value field value. @return the auto generated text field value. @return the generated field value. @return the auto label deleted field value. @return the auto background field value. @return the show category label as percentage field value. @return the show value as percentage field value. @return the show bubble sizes field value. @return the show label field value. @return the data label placement field value. * The Tick record defines how tick marks and label positioning/formatting * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Andrew C. Oliver(acoliver at apache.org) Constructs a Tick record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the major tick type field for the Tick record. Get the minor tick type field for the Tick record. Get the label position field for the Tick record. Get the background field for the Tick record. Get the label color rgb field for the Tick record. Get the zero 1 field for the Tick record. Get the zero 2 field for the Tick record. Get the options field for the Tick record. Get the tick color field for the Tick record. Get the zero 3 field for the Tick record. use the quote Unquote automatic color for text @return the auto text color field value. use the quote Unquote automatic color for text background @return the auto text background field value. rotate text (0=none, 1=normal, 2=90 degrees counterclockwise, 3=90 degrees clockwise) @return the rotation field value. automatically rotate the text @return the autorotate field value. * The Units record describes Units. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a Units record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the Units field for the Units record. Title: Codepage Record

Description: the default characterset. for the workbook

REFERENCE: PG 293 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2)

Use {@link CodePageUtil} to turn these values into Java code pages to encode/decode strings.

@version 2.0-pre
Excel 97+ (Biff 8) should always store strings as UTF-16LE or compressed versions of that. As such, this should always be 0x4b0 = UTF_16, except for files coming from older versions. Constructs a CodepageRecord and Sets its fields appropriately @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the codepage for this workbook @see #CODEPAGE @return codepage - the codepage to Set Title: COLINFO Record

Description: Defines with width and formatting for a range of columns

REFERENCE: PG 293 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2)

@author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a ColumnInfo record and Sets its fields appropriately @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from @return true if the format, options and column width match Get the first column this record defines formatting info for @return the first column index (0-based) Get the last column this record defines formatting info for @return the last column index (0-based) Get the columns' width in 1/256 of a Char width @return column width Get the columns' default format info @return the extended format index @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.ExtendedFormatRecord Get the options bitfield - use the bitSetters instead @return the bitfield raw value Get whether or not these cells are hidden @return whether the cells are hidden. @see #SetOptions(short) Get the outline level for the cells @see #SetOptions(short) @return outline level for the cells Get whether the cells are collapsed @return wether the cells are collapsed @see #SetOptions(short) FeatFormulaErr2 (Formula Evaluation Shared Feature) common record part This record part specifies Formula Evaluation & Error Ignoring data for a sheet, stored as part of a Shared Feature. It can be found in records such as {@link FeatRecord}. For the full meanings of the flags, see pages 669 and 670 of the Excel binary file format documentation. What errors we should ignore Title: FeatProtection (Protection Shared Feature) common record part This record part specifies Protection data for a sheet, stored as part of a Shared Feature. It can be found in records such as {@link FeatRecord} 0 means no password. Otherwise indicates the password verifier algorithm (same kind as {@link PasswordRecord} and {@link PasswordRev4Record}) Title: FeatSmartTag (Smart Tag Shared Feature) common record part This record part specifies Smart Tag data for a sheet, stored as part of a Shared Feature. It can be found in records such as {@link FeatRecord}. It is made up of a hash, and a Set of Factoid Data that Makes up the smart tags. For more details, see page 669 of the Excel binary file format documentation. Title: FtrHeader (Future Record Header) common record part This record part specifies a header for a Ftr (Future) style record, which includes extra attributes above and beyond those of a traditional record. This MUST match the type on the Containing record This is a FrtFlags MUST be 8 bytes and all zero Common Interface for all Shared Features Title: Unicode String

Description: Unicode String - just standard fields that are in several records. It is considered more desirable then repeating it in all of them.

This is often called a XLUnicodeRichExtendedString in MS documentation.

REFERENCE: PG 264 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2)

REFERENCE: PG 951 Excel Binary File Format (.xls) Structure Specification v20091214 Returns our size, excluding our 4 byte header Our handling of Equals is inconsistent with CompareTo. The trouble is because we don't truely understand rich text fields yet it's difficult to make a sound comparison. @param o The object to Compare. @return true if the object is actually Equal. construct a unicode string record and fill its fields, ID is ignored @param in the RecordInputstream to read the record from get the number of characters in the string, as an un-wrapped int @return number of characters Get the option flags which among other things return if this is a 16-bit or 8 bit string @return optionflags bitmask @return the actual string this Contains as a java String object Adds a font run to the formatted string. If a font run exists at the current charcter location, then it is Replaced with the font run to be Added. Swaps all use in the string of one font index for use of a different font index. Normally only called when fonts have been Removed / re-ordered unlike the real records we return the same as "getString()" rather than debug info @see #getDebugInfo() @return String value of the record return a character representation of the fields of this record @return String of output for biffviewer etc. Serialises out the String. There are special rules about where we can and can't split onto Continue records.

The ContinueFrt12 record specifies a continuation of the data in a preceding Future Record Type record that has data longer than 8,224 bytes. Such records are split into several records. The first section of the data appears in the base record and subsequent sections appear in one or more ContinueFrt12 records that appear after the base record. The preceding base record MUST contain a FrtRefHeader or a FrtHeader field. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com)
Title: Continue Record - Helper class used primarily for SST Records Description: handles overflow for prior record in the input stream; content Is tailored to that prior record @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Csaba Nagy (ncsaba at yahoo dot com) @version 2.0-pre default constructor Main constructor -- kinda dummy because we don't validate or fill fields @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Writes the full encoding of a Continue record without making an instance @param initialDataByte (optional - often used for unicode flag). If supplied, this will be written before srcData @return the total number of bytes written Get the data for continuation @return byte array containing all of the continued data Debugging toString @return string representation Clone this record. Common superclass of all records that can produce {@link ContinueRecord}s while being Serialized. @author Josh Micich Serializes this record's content to the supplied data output.
The standard BIFF header (ushort sid, ushort size) has been handled by the superclass, so only BIFF data should be written by this method. Simple data types can be written with the standard {@link LittleEndianOutput} methods. Methods from {@link ContinuableRecordOutput} can be used to Serialize strings (with {@link ContinueRecord}s being written as required). If necessary, implementors can explicitly start {@link ContinueRecord}s (regardless of the amount of remaining space). @param out a data output stream
@return the total Length of the encoded record(s) (Note - if any {@link ContinueRecord} is required, this result includes the size of those too) A decorated {@link RecordInputStream} that can read primitive data types (short, int, long, etc.) spanned across a {@link ContinueRecord } boundary.

Most records construct themselves from {@link RecordInputStream}. This class assumes that a {@link ContinueRecord} record break always occurs at the type boundary, however, it is not always so.

Two attachments to Bugzilla 50779 demonstrate that a CONTINUE break can appear right in between two bytes of a unicode character or between two bytes of a short. The problematic portion of the data is in a Asian Phonetic Settings Block (ExtRst) of a UnicodeString.

{@link RecordInputStream} greedily requests the bytes to be read and stumbles on such files with a "Not enough data (1) to read requested (2) bytes" exception. The ContinuableRecordInput class circumvents this "type boundary" rule and Reads data byte-by-byte rolling over CONTINUE if necessary.

YK: For now (March 2011) this class is only used to read @link NPOI.HSSF.Record.Common.UnicodeString.ExtRst} blocks of a UnicodeString.

@author Yegor Kozlov
An augmented {@link LittleEndianOutput} used for serialization of {@link ContinuableRecord}s. This class keeps track of how much remaining space is available in the current BIFF record and can start new {@link ContinueRecord}s as required. @author Josh Micich @return total number of bytes written so far (including all BIFF headers) Terminates the last record (also updates its 'ushort size' field) @return number of remaining bytes of space in current record Terminates the current record and starts a new {@link ContinueRecord} (regardless of how much space is still available in the current record). Writes the 'optionFlags' byte and encoded character data of a unicode string. This includes:
  • byte optionFlags
  • encoded character data (in "ISO-8859-1" or "UTF-16LE" encoding)
Notes:
  • The value of the 'is16bitEncoded' flag is determined by the actual character data of text
  • The string options flag is never separated (by a {@link ContinueRecord}) from the first chunk of character data it refers to.
  • The 'ushort Length' field is assumed to have been explicitly written earlier. Hence, there may be an intervening {@link ContinueRecord}
Writes a unicode string complete with header and character data. This includes:
  • ushort Length
  • byte optionFlags
  • ushort numberOfRichTextRuns (optional)
  • ushort extendedDataSize (optional)
  • encoded character data (in "ISO-8859-1" or "UTF-16LE" encoding)
The following bits of the 'optionFlags' byte will be set as appropriate:
MaskDescription
0x01is16bitEncoded
0x04hasExtendedData
0x08isRichText
Notes:
  • The value of the 'is16bitEncoded' flag is determined by the actual character data of text
  • The string header fields are never separated (by a {@link ContinueRecord}) from the first chunk of character data (i.e. the first character is always encoded in the same record as the string header).
** Allows the writing of BIFF records when the 'ushort size' header field is not known in advance. When the client is finished writing data, it calls {@link #terminate()}, at which point this class updates the 'ushort size' with its value. @author Josh Micich for writing the 'ushort size' field once its value is known includes 4 byte header Finishes writing the current record and updates 'ushort size' field.
After this method is called, only {@link #getTotalSize()} may be called.
Title: Country Record (aka WIN.INI country) Description: used for localization. Currently HSSF always Sets this to 1 and it seems to work fine even in Germany. (es geht's auch fuer Deutschland) REFERENCE: PG 298 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a CountryRecord and Sets its fields appropriately @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Gets the default country @return country ID (1 = US) Gets the current country @return country ID (1 = US) XCT ?CRN Count REFERENCE: 5.114 @author Josh Micich return the non static version of the id for this record. Title: CRN Description: This record stores the contents of an external cell or cell range REFERENCE: 5.23 @author josh micich return the non static version of the id for this record. @author Josh Micich Reads an unsigned short value without decrypting Reads an unsigned short value without decrypting Create using the default password and a specified docId @param docId 16 bytes @return true if the keyDigest is compatible with the specified saltData and saltHash The {@link RC4} instance needs to be Changed every 1024 bytes. @param keyBlockNo used to seed the newly Created {@link RC4} Stores the BIFF8 encryption/decryption password for the current thread. This has been done using a {@link ThreadLocal} in order to avoid further overloading the various public APIs (e.g. {@link HSSFWorkbook}) that need this functionality. @return the BIFF8 encryption/decryption password for the current thread. null if it is currently unSet. Used for both encrypting and decrypting BIFF8 streams. The internal {@link RC4} instance is renewed (re-keyed) every 1024 bytes. @author Josh Micich This field is used to keep track of when to change the {@link RC4} instance. The change occurs every 1024 bytes. Every byte passed over is counted. TODO: Additionally, the lbPlyPos (position_of_BOF) field of the BoundSheet8 record MUST NOT be encrypted. @return true if record type specified by sid is never encrypted Used when BIFF header fields (sid, size) are being Read. The internal {@link RC4} instance must step even when unencrypted bytes are read Simple implementation of the alleged RC4 algorithm. Inspired by wikipedia's RC4 article @author Josh Micich @return The size of this field in bytes. This operation Is not valid Until after the call to FillField() Populates this fields data from the byte array passed in1. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Appends the string representation of this field to the supplied StringBuilder. @param str The string buffer to Append to. Converts this field to it's byte array form. @param offset The offset into the byte array to start writing to. @param data The data array to Write to. @return The number of bytes written. Title: Date Window 1904 Flag record Description: Flag specifying whether 1904 date windowing Is used. (tick toc tick toc...BOOM!) REFERENCE: PG 280 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a DateWindow1904 record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Gets whether or not to use 1904 date windowing (which means you'll be screwed in 2004) @return window flag - 0/1 (false,true) Title: DBCell Record Description: Used by Excel and other MS apps to quickly Find rows in the sheets. REFERENCE: PG 299/440 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height @version 2.0-pre Constructs a DBCellRecord and Sets its fields appropriately @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from offset from the start of this DBCellRecord to the start of the first cell in the next DBCell block. Gets offset from the start of this DBCellRecord to the start of the first cell in the next DBCell block. @return rowoffset to the start of the first cell in the next DBCell block return the cell offset in the array @param index of the cell offset to retrieve @return celloffset from the celloffset array Get the number of cell offsets in the celloffset array @return number of cell offsets @returns the size of the Group of DBCellRecords needed to encode the specified number of blocks and rows DConRef records specify a range in a workbook (internal or external) that serves as a data source for pivot tables or data consolidation. Represents a DConRef Structure [MS-XLS s. 2.4.86], and the contained DConFile structure [MS-XLS s. 2.5.69]. This in turn contains a XLUnicodeStringNoCch [MS-XLS s. 2.5.296].
                     _______________________________
                    |          DConRef              |
            (bytes) +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+...+-+-+-+-+
                    |    ref    |cch|  stFile   | un|
                    +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+...+-+-+-+-+
                                          |
                                 _________|_____________________
                                |DConFile / XLUnicodeStringNoCch|
                                +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+...+-+-+-+
                         (bits) |h|   reserved  |      rgb      |
                                +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+...+-+-+-+
             
Where
  • DConFile.h = 0x00 if the characters inrgb are single byte, and DConFile.h = 0x01 if they are double byte.
    If they are double byte, then
    • If it exists, the length of DConRef.un = 2. Otherwise it is 1.
    • The length of DConFile.rgb = (2 * DConRef.cch). Otherwise it is equal to DConRef.cch
    • .
  • DConRef.rgb starts with 0x01 if it is an external reference, and with 0x02 if it is a self-reference.
At the moment this class is read-only. @author Niklas Rehfeld
The id of the record type, sid = {@value} A RefU structure specifying the range of cells if this record is part of an SXTBL. [MS XLS s.2.5.211] A RefU structure specifying the range of cells if this record is part of an SXTBL. [MS XLS s.2.5.211] A RefU structure specifying the range of cells if this record is part of an SXTBL. [MS XLS s.2.5.211] A RefU structure specifying the range of cells if this record is part of an SXTBL. [MS XLS s.2.5.211] the number of chars in the link the type of characters (single or double byte) The link's path string. This is the rgb field of a XLUnicodeStringNoCch. Therefore it will contain at least one leading special character (0x01 or 0x02) and probably other ones.

@see DConFile [MS-XLS s. 2.5.77] and VirtualPath [MS-XLS s. 2.5.69]

unused bits at the end, must be set to 0. Read constructor. @param data byte array containing a DConRef Record, including the header. Read Constructor. @param inStream RecordInputStream containing a DConRefRecord structure. @return The first column of the range. @return The first row of the range. @return The last column of the range. @return The last row of the range. @return raw path byte array. @return the link's path, with the special characters stripped/replaced. May be null. See MS-XLS 2.5.277 (VirtualPath) Checks if the data source in this reference record is external to this sheet or internal. @return true iff this is an external reference. Title: Default Column Width Record Description: Specifies the default width for columns that have no specific width Set. REFERENCE: PG 302 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre The default column width is 8 characters Constructs a DefaultColumnWidth record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the default column width @return defaultwidth for columns Title: Default Row Height Record Description: Row height for rows with Undefined or not explicitly defined heights. REFERENCE: PG 301 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre The default row height for empty rows is 255 twips (255 / 20 == 12.75 points)

Constructs a DefaultRowHeight record and Sets its fields appropriately. the RecordInputstream to Read the record from
Get the default row height Title: Delta Record Description: controls the accuracy of the calculations REFERENCE: PG 303 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a Delta record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the maximum Change @return maxChange - maximum rounding error Title: Dimensions Record Description: provides the minumum and maximum bounds of a sheet. REFERENCE: PG 303 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a Dimensions record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the first row number for the sheet @return row - first row on the sheet Get the last row number for the sheet @return row - last row on the sheet Get the first column number for the sheet @return column - first column on the sheet Get the last col number for the sheet @return column - last column on the sheet Process the bytes into escher records. (Not done by default in case we break things, Unless you Set the "poi.deSerialize.escher" system property) Size of record (including 4 byte headers for all sections) DrawingRecord (0x00EC)

Cloning of drawing records must be executed through HSSFPatriarch, because all id's must be changed @return cloned drawing records This Is purely for the biff viewer. During normal operations we don't want to be seeing this.

specifies the header for an entry in a property table
specifies the identifier of the property in this entry. whether the value in the op field is a BLIP identifier. If this value equals 0x1, the value in the op field specifies the BLIP identifier in the OfficeArtBStoreContainer record, as defined in section 2.2.20. If fComplex equals 0x1, this bit MUST be ignored. specifies whether this property is a complex property. If this value equals 0x1, the op field specifies the size of the data for this property, rather than the property data itself. specifies the common record header for all the OfficeArt records. author: Antony liu (antony.apollo at gmail.com) specifies the version if the record is an atom. If the record is a container, this field MUST contain 0xF. An unsigned integer that differentiates an atom from the other atoms that are contained in the record. specifies the type of the record. This value MUST be from 0xF000 through 0xFFFF, inclusive. that specifies the length, in bytes, of the record. If the record is an atom, this value specifies the length of the atom, excluding the header. If the record is a container, this value specifies the sum of the lengths of the atoms that the record contains, plus the length of the record header for each atom. Title: double Stream Flag Record Description: tells if this Is a double stream file. (always no for HSSF generated files) double Stream files contain both BIFF8 and BIFF7 workbooks. REFERENCE: PG 305 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a DBCellRecord and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Title: DATAVALIDATIONS Record Description: used in data validation ; This record Is the list header of all data validation records (0x01BE) in the current sheet. @author Dragos Buleandra (dragos.buleandra@trade2b.ro) Options of the DVAL Horizontal position of the dialog Vertical position of the dialog Object ID of the drop down arrow object for list boxes ; in our case this will be always FFFF , Until MSODrawingGroup and MSODrawing records are implemented Number of following DV Records Constructs a DVAL record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from @return the field_1_options @return the Horizontal position of the dialog @return the the Vertical position of the dialog Get Object ID of the drop down arrow object for list boxes Get number of following DV records Title: DATAVALIDATION Record (0x01BE)

Description: This record stores data validation Settings and a list of cell ranges which contain these Settings. The data validation Settings of a sheet are stored in a sequential list of DV records. This list Is followed by DVAL record(s) @author Dragos Buleandra (dragos.buleandra@trade2b.ro) @version 2.0-pre Option flags Title of the prompt box Title of the error box Text of the prompt box Text of the error box Not used - Excel seems to always write 0x3FE0 Formula data for first condition (RPN token array without size field) Not used - Excel seems to always write 0x0000 Formula data for second condition (RPN token array without size field) Cell range address list with all affected ranges Option flags field @see org.apache.poi.hssf.util.HSSFDataValidation utility class Constructs a DV record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from When entered via the UI, Excel translates empty string into "\0" While it is possible to encode the title/text as empty string (Excel doesn't exactly crash), the resulting tool-tip text / message box looks wrong. It is best to do the same as the Excel UI and encode 'not present' as "\0". Get the condition data type @return the condition data type @see org.apache.poi.hssf.util.HSSFDataValidation utility class Get the condition error style @return the condition error style @see org.apache.poi.hssf.util.HSSFDataValidation utility class return true if in list validations the string list Is explicitly given in the formula, false otherwise @return true if in list validations the string list Is explicitly given in the formula, false otherwise @see org.apache.poi.hssf.util.HSSFDataValidation utility class return true if empty values are allowed in cells, false otherwise @return if empty values are allowed in cells, false otherwise @see org.apache.poi.hssf.util.HSSFDataValidation utility class @return true if drop down arrow should be suppressed when list validation is used, false otherwise return true if a prompt window should appear when cell Is selected, false otherwise @return if a prompt window should appear when cell Is selected, false otherwise @see org.apache.poi.hssf.util.HSSFDataValidation utility class return true if an error window should appear when an invalid value Is entered in the cell, false otherwise @return if an error window should appear when an invalid value Is entered in the cell, false otherwise @see org.apache.poi.hssf.util.HSSFDataValidation utility class Get the condition operator @return the condition operator @see org.apache.poi.hssf.util.HSSFDataValidation utility class Gets the option flags field. @return options - the option flags field Clones the object. Uses serialisation, as the contents are somewhat complex End Of File record. Description: Marks the end of records belonging to a particular object in the HSSF File REFERENCE: PG 307 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a EOFRecord record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from This class Is used to aggregate the MSODRAWING and OBJ record combinations. This Is necessary due to the bizare way in which these records are Serialized. What happens Is that you Get a combination of MSODRAWING -> OBJ -> MSODRAWING -> OBJ records but the escher records are Serialized _across_ the MSODRAWING records. It Gets even worse when you start looking at TXO records. So what we do with this class Is aggregate lazily. That Is we don't aggregate the MSODRAWING -> OBJ records Unless we need to modify them. At first document contains 4 types of records which belong to drawing layer. There are can be such sequence of record:

DrawingRecord ContinueRecord ... ContinueRecord ObjRecord | TextObjectRecord ..... ContinueRecord ... ContinueRecord ObjRecord | TextObjectRecord NoteRecord ... NoteRecord

To work with shapes we have to read data from Drawing and Continue records into single array of bytes and build escher(office art) records tree from this array. Each shape in drawing layer matches corresponding ObjRecord Each textbox matches corresponding TextObjectRecord

ObjRecord contains information about shape. Thus each ObjRecord corresponds EscherContainerRecord(SPGR)

EscherAggrefate contains also NoteRecords NoteRecords must be serial @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Maps shape container objects to their OBJ records list of "tail" records that need to be Serialized after all drawing Group records @return Returns the current sid. Calculates the string representation of this record. This Is simply a dump of all the records. Calculates the xml representation of this record. This is simply a dump of all the records. @param tab - string which must be added before each line (used by default '\t') @return xml representation of the all aggregated records @param sid - record sid we want to check if it belongs to drawing layer @return true if record is instance of DrawingRecord or ContinueRecord or ObjRecord or TextObjRecord Collapses the drawing records into an aggregate. read Drawing, Obj, TxtObj, Note and Continue records into single byte array, create Escher tree from byte array, create map <EscherRecord, Record> @param records - list of all records inside sheet @param locFirstDrawingRecord - location of the first DrawingRecord inside sheet @return new EscherAggregate create from all aggregated records which belong to drawing layer Serializes this aggregate to a byte array. Since this Is an aggregate record it will effectively Serialize the aggregated records. @param offset The offset into the start of the array. @param data The byte array to Serialize to. @return The number of bytes Serialized. @param drawingData - escher records saved into single byte array @param writtenEscherBytes - count of bytes already saved into drawing records (we should know it to decide create drawing or continue record) @param pos current position of data array @param data - array of bytes where drawing records must be serialized @param i - number of shape, saved into data array @return offset of data array after serialization How many bytes do the raw escher records contain. @param records List of escher records @return the number of bytes @param records list of records to look into @param loc - location of the record which sid must be returned @return sid of the record with selected location @return record size, including header size of obj, text, note, drawing, continue records create base tree with such structure: EscherDgContainer -EscherSpgrContainer --EscherSpContainer ---EscherSpRecord ---EscherSpgrRecord ---EscherSpRecord -EscherDgRecord id of DgRecord and SpRecord are empty and must be set later by HSSFPatriarch Unused since this Is an aggregate record. Use CreateAggregate(). @see #CreateAggregate Converts the Records into UserModel objects on the bound HSSFPatriarch

Associates an escher record to an OBJ record or a TXO record. ClientData or Textbox record Obj or TextObj record
Remove echerRecord and associated to it Obj or TextObj record clientData or textbox record to be removed @return unmodifiable copy of tail records. We need to access them when building shapes. Every HSSFComment shape has a link to a NoteRecord from the tailRec collection. @param obj - ObjRecord with id == NoteRecord.id @return null if note record is not found else returns note record with id == obj.id Title: Extended Format Record Description: Probably one of the more complex records. There are two breeds: Style and Cell. It should be noted that fields in the extended format record are somewhat arbitrary. Almost all of the fields are bit-level, but we name them as best as possible by functional Group. In some places this Is better than others. REFERENCE: PG 426 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre Constructor ExtendedFormatRecord Constructs an ExtendedFormat record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Clones all the style information from another ExtendedFormatRecord, onto this one. This will then hold all the same style options. If The source ExtendedFormatRecord comes from a different Workbook, you will need to sort out the font and format indicies yourself! Get the index to the FONT record (which font to use 0 based) Get the index to the Format record (which FORMAT to use 0-based) Gets the options bitmask - you can also use corresponding option bit Getters (see other methods that reference this one) Get whether the cell Is locked or not Get whether the cell Is hidden or not Get whether the cell Is a cell or style XFRecord Get some old holdover from lotus 123. Who cares, its all over for Lotus. RIP Lotus. for cell XF types this Is the parent style (usually 0/normal). For style this should be NULL. Get the alignment options bitmask. See corresponding bitGetter methods that reference this one. Get the horizontal alignment of the cell. Get whether to wrap the text in the cell Get the vertical alignment of text in the cell Docs just say this Is for far east versions.. (I'm guessing it justifies for right-to-left Read languages) Get the degree of rotation. (I've not actually seen this used anywhere) Get the indent options bitmask (see corresponding bit Getters that reference this field) Get indention (not sure of the Units, think its spaces) Get whether to shrink the text to fit Get whether to merge cells Get the Reading order for far east versions (0 - Context, 1 - Left to right, 2 - right to left) - We could use some help with support for the far east. Get whether or not to use the format in this XF instead of the parent XF. Get whether or not to use the font in this XF instead of the parent XF. Get whether or not to use the alignment in this XF instead of the parent XF. Get whether or not to use the border in this XF instead of the parent XF. Get whether or not to use the pattern in this XF instead of the parent XF. (foregrount/background) Get whether or not to use the locking/hidden in this XF instead of the parent XF. Get the border options bitmask (see the corresponding bit Getter methods that reference back to this one) Get the borderline style for the left border Get the borderline style for the right border Get the borderline style for the top border Get the borderline style for the bottom border Get the palette options bitmask (see the individual bit Getter methods that reference this one) Get the palette index for the left border color Get the palette index for the right border color Get the Additional palette options bitmask (see individual bit Getter methods that reference this method) Get the palette index for the top border Get the palette index for the bottom border Get for diagonal borders Get the diagonal border line style Not sure what this Is for (maybe Fill lines?) 1 = down, 2 = up, 3 = both, 0 for none.. Get the Additional Fill pattern Get the Fill palette options bitmask (see indivdual bit Getters that reference this method) Get the foreground palette color index Get the background palette color index Will consider two different records with the same contents as Equals, as the various indexes that matter are embedded in the records EXTERNALNAME

@author Josh Micich 'rgoper' / 'Last received results of the DDE link' (seems to be only applicable to DDE links)
Logically this is a 2-D array, which has been flattened into 1-D array here.
(logical) number of columns in the {@link #_ddeValues} array (logical) number of rows in the {@link #_ddeValues} array Convenience Function to determine if the name Is a built-in name For OLE and DDE, links can be either 'automatic' or 'manual' only for OLE and DDE DDE links only. If true, this denotes the 'StdDocumentName' @return the standard String representation of this name index to External Book Block (which starts with a EXTERNALBOOK record) a Constructor for making new sub record @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from called by the class that is responsible for writing this sucker. Subclasses should implement this so that their data is passed back in a byte array. @param offset to begin writing at @param data byte array containing instance data @return number of bytes written Title: Extern Sheet Description: A List of Inndexes to SupBook REFERENCE: @author Libin Roman (Vista Portal LDT. Developer) @version 1.0-pre Constructs a Extern Sheet record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Add a zero-based reference to a {@link org.apache.poi.hssf.record.SupBookRecord}.

If the type of the SupBook record is same-sheet referencing, Add-In referencing, DDE data source referencing, or OLE data source referencing, then no scope is specified and this value MUST be -2. Otherwise, the scope must be set as follows:

  1. -2 Workbook-level reference that applies to the entire workbook.
  2. -1 Sheet-level reference.
  3. >=0 Sheet-level reference. This specifies the first sheet in the reference.

    If the SupBook type is unused or external workbook referencing, then this value specifies the zero-based index of an external sheet name, see {@link org.apache.poi.hssf.record.SupBookRecord#getSheetNames()}. This referenced string specifies the name of the first sheet within the external workbook that is in scope. This sheet MUST be a worksheet or macro sheet.

    If the supporting link type is self-referencing, then this value specifies the zero-based index of a {@link org.apache.poi.hssf.record.BoundSheetRecord} record in the workbook stream that specifies the first sheet within the scope of this reference. This sheet MUST be a worksheet or a macro sheet.

@param firstSheetIndex the scope, must be -2 for add-in references @param lastSheetIndex the scope, must be -2 for add-in references @return index of newly added ref
returns the number of REF Records, which is in model @return number of REF records @return number of REF structures Adds REF struct (ExternSheetSubRecord) @param rec REF struct Returns the index of the SupBookRecord for this index @return -1 if not found Returns the first sheet that the reference applies to, or -1 if the referenced sheet can't be found, or -2 if the reference is workbook scoped. Returns the last sheet that the reference applies to, or -1 if the referenced sheet can't be found, or -2 if the reference is workbook scoped. For a single sheet reference, the first and last should be the same. called by the class that Is responsible for writing this sucker. Subclasses should implement this so that their data Is passed back in a byte array. @param offset to begin writing at @param data byte array containing instance data @return number of bytes written return the non static version of the id for this record. Title: A sub Record for Extern Sheet Description: Defines a named range within a workbook. REFERENCE: @author Libin Roman (Vista Portal LDT. Developer) @version 1.0-pre a Constractor for making new sub record Constructs a Extern Sheet Sub Record record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Sets the Index to the sup book @param index sup book index Gets the index to sup book @return sup book index Sets the index to first sheet in supbook @param index index to first sheet Gets the index to first sheet from supbook @return index to first supbook Sets the index to last sheet in supbook @param index index to last sheet Gets the index to last sheet in supbook @return index to last supbook called by the class that Is responsible for writing this sucker. Subclasses should implement this so that their data Is passed back in a byte array. @param offset to begin writing at @param data byte array containing instance data @return number of bytes written returns the record size return the non static version of the id for this record. Extended SST table info subrecord Contains the elements of "info" in the SST's array field @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.ExtSSTRecord Creates new ExtSSTInfoSubRecord Title: Extended Static String Table Description: This record Is used for a quick Lookup into the SST record. This record breaks the SST table into a Set of buckets. The offsets to these buckets within the SST record are kept as well as the position relative to the start of the SST record. REFERENCE: PG 313 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.ExtSSTInfoSubRecord Constructs a EOFRecord record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Returns the size of this record Given a number of strings (in the sst), returns the size of the extsst record Title: FeatHdr (Feature Header) Record This record specifies common information for Shared Features, and specifies the beginning of a collection of records to define them. The collection of data (Globals Substream ABNF, macro sheet substream ABNF or worksheet substream ABNF) specifies Shared Feature data. Specifies the enhanced protection type. Used to protect a shared workbook by restricting access to some areas of it Specifies that formula errors should be ignored Specifies the smart tag type. Recognises certain types of entries (proper names, dates/times etc) and flags them for action Specifies the shared list type. Used for a table within a sheet 0x00000000 = rgbHdrData not present 0xffffffff = rgbHdrData present We need a BOFRecord to make sense of this... Title: Feat (Feature) Record This record specifies Shared Features data. It is normally paired up with a {@link FeatHdrRecord}. See SHAREDFEATURES_* on {@link FeatHdrRecord} Only matters if type is ISFFEC2 Contents depends on isf_sharedFeatureType : ISFPROTECTION -> FeatProtection ISFFEC2 -> FeatFormulaErr2 ISFFACTOID -> FeatSmartTag Title: File Pass Record Description: Indicates that the record after this record are encrypted. HSSF does not support encrypted excel workbooks and the presence of this record will cause Processing to be aborted. REFERENCE: PG 420 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 3.0-pre Title: FILESHARING Description: stores the encrypted Readonly for a workbook (Write protect) This functionality Is accessed from the options dialog box available when performing 'Save As'.

REFERENCE: PG 314 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2)

@author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) Constructs a FileSharing record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the Readonly @return short representing if this Is Read only (1 = true) @returns password hashed with hashPassword() (very lame) @returns username of the user that Created the file Clone this record. Title: Function Group Count Record Description: Number of built in function Groups in the current version of the SpReadsheet (probably only used on Windoze) REFERENCE: PG 315 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre suggested default (14 dec) Constructs a FnGroupCount record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the number of built-in functions @return number of built-in functions Title: Font Record - descrbes a font in the workbook (index = 0-3,5-infinity - skip 4) Description: An element in the Font Table REFERENCE: PG 315 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a Font record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Clones all the font style information from another FontRecord, onto this one. This will then hold all the same font style options. Set the font to be italics or not @param italics - whether the font Is italics or not @see #SetAttributes(short) Set the font to be stricken out or not @param strike - whether the font Is stricken out or not @see #SetAttributes(short) whether to use the mac outline font style thing (mac only) - Some mac person should comment this instead of me doing it (since I have no idea) @param mac - whether to do that mac font outline thing or not @see #SetAttributes(short) whether to use the mac shado font style thing (mac only) - Some mac person should comment this instead of me doing it (since I have no idea) @param mac - whether to do that mac font shadow thing or not @see #SetAttributes(short) Set the type of Underlining for the font Set the font family (TODO) @param f family Set the Char Set @param charSet - CharSet Set the name of the font @param fn - name of the font (i.e. "Arial") Gets the height of the font in 1/20th point Units @return fontheight (in points/20) Get the font attributes (see individual bit Getters that reference this method) @return attribute - the bitmask Get the font's color palette index @return cpi - font color index Get the bold weight for this font (100-1000dec or 0x64-0x3e8). Default Is 0x190 for normal and 0x2bc for bold @return bw - a number between 100-1000 for the fonts "boldness" Get the type of base or subscript for the font @return base or subscript option Does this FontRecord have all the same font properties as the supplied FontRecord? Note that {@link #equals(Object)} will check for exact objects, while this will check for exact contents, because normally the font record's position makes a big difference too. Only returns two for the same exact object - creating a second FontRecord with the same properties won't be considered equal, as the record's position in the record stream matters. Title: Footer Record Description: Specifies the footer for a sheet REFERENCE: PG 317 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Shawn Laubach (slaubach at apache dot org) Modified 3/14/02 @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre

Initializes a new instance of the class. the RecordInputstream to Read the record from
Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . return the non static version of the id for this record. Title: Format Record Description: describes a number format -- those goofy strings like $(#,###) REFERENCE: PG 317 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Shawn M. Laubach (slaubach at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a Format record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the format index code (for built in formats) @return the format index code @see org.apache.poi.hssf.model.Workbook Get the format string @return the format string Manages the cached formula result values of other types besides numeric. Excel encodes the same 8 bytes that would be field_4_value with various NaN values that are decoded/encoded by this class. deliberately chosen by Excel in order to encode other values within Double NaNs @return null if the double value encoded by valueLongBits is a normal (non NaN) double value. Formula Record. REFERENCE: PG 317/444 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre Since the NaN support seems sketchy (different constants) we'll store and spit it out directly Creates new FormulaRecord Constructs a Formula record and Sets its fields appropriately. Note - id must be 0x06 (NOT 0x406 see MSKB #Q184647 for an "explanation of this bug in the documentation) or an exception will be throw upon validation @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from @return true if this {@link FormulaRecord} is followed by a {@link StringRecord} representing the cached text result of the formula evaluation. Get the calculated value of the formula @return calculated value Get the option flags @return bitmask Get the stack as a list @return list of tokens (casts stack to a list and returns it!) this method can return null Is we are Unable to Create Ptgs from existing excel file callers should Check for null! Construct a new FtCblsSubRecord and fill its data with the default values Convert this record to string. Used by BiffViewer and other utilities. Serialize the record data into the supplied array of bytes @param out the stream to serialize into @return id of this record. The FtCf structure specifies the clipboard format of the picture-type Obj record Containing this FtCf. Specifies the format of the picture is an enhanced metafile. Specifies the format of the picture is a bitmap. Specifies the picture is in an unspecified format that is neither and enhanced metafile nor a bitmap. Construct a new FtPioGrbitSubRecord and fill its data with the default values Convert this record to string. Used by BiffViewer and other utilities. Serialize the record data into the supplied array of bytes @param out the stream to serialize into @return id of this record. This structure appears as part of an Obj record that represents image display properties. A bit that specifies whether the picture's aspect ratio is preserved when rendered in different views (Normal view, Page Break Preview view, Page Layout view and printing). A bit that specifies whether the pictFmla field of the Obj record that Contains this FtPioGrbit specifies a DDE reference. A bit that specifies whether this object is expected to be updated on print to reflect the values in the cell associated with the object. A bit that specifies whether the picture is displayed as an icon. A bit that specifies whether this object is an ActiveX control. It MUST NOT be the case that both fCtl and fDde are equal to 1. A bit that specifies whether the object data are stored in an embedding storage (= 0) or in the controls stream (ctls) (= 1). A bit that specifies whether this is a camera picture. A bit that specifies whether this picture's size has been explicitly Set. 0 = picture size has been explicitly Set, 1 = has not been Set A bit that specifies whether the OLE server for the object is called to load the object's data automatically when the parent workbook is opened. Construct a new FtPioGrbitSubRecord and fill its data with the default values Use one of the bitmasks MANUAL_ADVANCE_BIT ... CURSOR_VISIBLE_BIT @param bitmask @param enabled Convert this record to string. Used by BiffViewer and other utilities. Serialize the record data into the supplied array of bytes @param out the stream to serialize into @return id of this record. Title: GridSet Record. Description: flag denoting whether the user specified that gridlines are used when printing. REFERENCE: PG 320 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a GridSet record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get whether the gridlines are shown during printing. @return gridSet - true if gridlines are NOT printed, false if they are. Title: Guts Record Description: Row/column gutter sizes REFERENCE: PG 320 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a Guts record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the size of the gutter that appears at the left of the rows @return gutter size in screen Units Get the size of the gutter that appears at the above the columns @return gutter size in screen Units Get the maximum outline level for the row gutter. @return maximum outline level Get the maximum outline level for the col gutter. @return maximum outline level Title: HCenter record Description: whether to center between horizontal margins REFERENCE: PG 320 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre Constructs an HCenter record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get whether or not to horizonatally center this sheet. @return center - t/f Common header/footer base class @author Josh Micich get the length of the footer string @return length of the footer string The HEADERFOOTER record stores information Added in Office Excel 2007 for headers/footers. @author Yegor Kozlov construct a HeaderFooterRecord record. No fields are interpreted and the record will be Serialized in its original form more or less @param in the RecordInputstream to read the record from spit the record out AS IS. no interpretation or identification If this header belongs to a specific sheet view , the sheet view?s GUID will be saved here. If it is zero, it means the current sheet. Otherwise, this field MUST match the guid field of the preceding {@link UserSViewBegin} record. @return the sheet view's GUID @return whether this record belongs to the current sheet Title: Header Record Description: Specifies a header for a sheet REFERENCE: PG 321 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Shawn Laubach (slaubach at apache dot org) Modified 3/14/02 @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre Constructs an Header record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Title: Hide Object Record Description: flag defines whether to hide placeholders and object REFERENCE: PG 321 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre Constructs an HideObj record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Set hide object options @param hide options @see #HIDE_ALL @see #SHOW_PLACEHOLDERS @see #SHOW_ALL Get hide object options @return hide options @see #HIDE_ALL @see #SHOW_PLACEHOLDERS @see #SHOW_ALL HorizontalPageBreak record that stores page breaks at rows This class Is just used so that SID Compares work properly in the RecordFactory @see PageBreakRecord @author Danny Mui (dmui at apache dot org) @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from The HyperlinkRecord wraps an HLINK-record from the Excel-97 format. Supports only external links for now (eg http://) @author Mark Hissink Muller mark@hissinkmuller.nl @author Yegor Kozlov (yegor at apache dot org) Link flags Tail of a URL link Tail of a file link cell range of this hyperlink 16-byte GUID Some sort of options for file links. Link options. Can include any of HLINK_* flags. Test label Moniker. Makes sense only for URL and file links in 8:3 DOS format No Unicode string header, always 8-bit characters, zero-terminated Link Text describing a place in document. In Excel UI, this is appended to the address, (after a '#' delimiter).
This field is optional. If present, the {@link #HLINK_PLACE} must be set.
Remaining bytes Create a new hyperlink Read hyperlink from input stream @param in the stream to Read from Return the column of the first cell that Contains the hyperlink @return the 0-based column of the first cell that Contains the hyperlink Set the column of the last cell that Contains the hyperlink @return the 0-based column of the last cell that Contains the hyperlink Return the row of the first cell that Contains the hyperlink @return the 0-based row of the first cell that Contains the hyperlink Return the row of the last cell that Contains the hyperlink @return the 0-based row of the last cell that Contains the hyperlink Returns a 16-byte guid identifier. Seems to always equal {@link STD_MONIKER} @return 16-byte guid identifier Returns a 16-byte moniker. @return 16-byte moniker Return text label for this hyperlink @return text to Display Hypelink Address. Depending on the hyperlink type it can be URL, e-mail, patrh to a file, etc. @return the Address of this hyperlink Link options. Must be a combination of HLINK_* constants. Label options Options for a file link Initialize a new url link Initialize a new file link Initialize a new document link Title: Index Record Description: Occurs right after BOF, tells you where the DBCELL records are for a sheet Important for locating cells NOT USED IN THIS RELEASE REFERENCE: PG 323 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre Constructs an Index record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Returns the size of an INdexRecord when it needs to index the specified number of blocks Title: Interface End Record Description: Shows where the Interface Records end (MMS) (has no fields) REFERENCE: PG 324 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre Constructs an InterfaceEnd record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from for test TestInterfaceEndRecord.TestCreate() Title: Interface Header Record Description: Defines the beginning of Interface records (MMS) REFERENCE: PG 324 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre suggested (and probably correct) default Constructs an Codepage record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Title: Iteration Record Description: Tells whether to iterate over forumla calculations or not (if a formula Is dependant upon another formula's result) (odd feature for something that can only have 32 elements in a formula!) REFERENCE: PG 325 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre Constructs an Iteration record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get whether or not to iterate for calculations @return whether iterative calculations are turned off or on Label Record - Read only support for strings stored directly in the cell.. Don't use this (except to Read), use LabelSST instead REFERENCE: PG 325 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.LabelSSTRecord Creates new LabelRecord Constructs an Label record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the number of Chars this string Contains @return number of Chars Is this Uncompressed Unicode (16bit)? Or just 8-bit compressed? @return IsUnicode - True for 16bit- false for 8bit Get the value @return the text string @see #GetStringLength THROWS A RUNTIME EXCEPTION.. USE LABELSSTRecords. YOU HAVE NO REASON to use LABELRecord!! Title: Label SST Record Description: Refers to a string in the shared string table and Is a column value. REFERENCE: PG 325 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre Constructs an LabelSST record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the index to the string in the SSTRecord @return index of string in the SST Table @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.SSTRecord Record for the left margin. NOTE: This source was automatically generated. @author Shawn Laubach (slaubach at apache dot org) Constructs a LeftMargin record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the margin field for the LeftMargin record. Not implemented yet. May commit it anyway just so people can see where I'm heading. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) The margin interface Is a parent used to define left, right, top and bottom margins. This allows much of the code to be generic when it comes to handling margins. NOTE: This source wass automatically generated. @author Shawn Laubach (slaubach at apache dot org) Get the margin field for the Margin. Title: Merged Cells Record Description: Optional record defining a square area of cells to "merged" into one cell. REFERENCE: NONE (UNDOCUMENTED PRESENTLY) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre sometimes the regions array is shared with other MergedCellsRecords Constructs a MergedCellsRecord and Sets its fields appropriately @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the number of merged areas. If this drops down to 0 you should just go ahead and delete the record. @return number of areas @return MergedRegion at the given index representing the area that is Merged (r1,c1 - r2,c2) Title: MMS Record Description: defines how many Add menu and del menu options are stored in the file. Should always be Set to 0 for HSSF workbooks REFERENCE: PG 328 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a MMS record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Set number of Add menu options (Set to 0) @param am number of Add menu options Set number of del menu options (Set to 0) @param dm number of del menu options Title: Mulitple Blank cell record Description: Represents a Set of columns in a row with no value but with styling. In this release we have Read-only support for this record type. The RecordFactory Converts this to a Set of BlankRecord objects. REFERENCE: PG 329 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) @version 2.0-pre @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.BlankRecord Creates new MulBlankRecord Constructs a MulBlank record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the row number of the cells this represents @return row number starting column (first cell this holds in the row) @return first column number ending column (last cell this holds in the row) @return first column number Get the number of columns this Contains (last-first +1) @return number of columns (last - first +1) returns the xf index for column (coffset = column - field_2_first_col) @param coffset the column (coffset = column - field_2_first_col) @return the XF index for the column Used to store multiple RK numbers on a row. 1 MulRk = Multiple Cell values. HSSF just Converts this into multiple NUMBER records. Read-ONLY SUPPORT! REFERENCE: PG 330 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre Creates new MulRKRecord Constructs a MulRK record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from starting column (first cell this holds in the row) @return first column number ending column (last cell this holds in the row) @return first column number Get the number of columns this Contains (last-first +1) @return number of columns (last - first +1) returns the xf index for column (coffset = column - field_2_first_col) @return the XF index for the column returns the rk number for column (coffset = column - field_2_first_col) @return the value (decoded into a double) Title: NAMECMT Record (0x0894) Description: Defines a comment associated with a specified name. REFERENCE: @author Andrew Shirley (aks at corefiling.co.uk) @param ris the RecordInputstream to read the record from return the non static version of the id for this record. @return the name of the NameRecord to which this comment applies. @return the text of the comment. Title: Name Record (aka Named Range) Description: Defines a named range within a workbook. REFERENCE: @author Libin Roman (Vista Portal LDT. Developer) @author Sergei Kozello (sergeikozello at mail.ru) @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) @version 1.0-pre Included for completeness sake, not implemented Included for completeness sake, not implemented Included for completeness sake, not implemented Included for completeness sake, not implemented Included for completeness sake, not implemented Included for completeness sake, not implemented Included for completeness sake, not implemented Included for completeness sake, not implemented Included for completeness sake, not implemented Included for completeness sake, not implemented One-based extern index of sheet (resolved via LinkTable). Zero if this is a global name the one based sheet number. Creates new NameRecord Constructs a Name record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Constructor to Create a built-in named region @param builtin Built-in byte representation for the name record, use the public constants @param index @return function Group @see FnGroupCountRecord Gets the option flag @return option flag returns the keyboard shortcut @return keyboard shortcut ** Indicates that the defined name refers to a user-defined function. This attribute is used when there is an add-in or other code project associated with the file. @param function true indicates the name refers to a function. @return true if name has a formula (named range or defined value) @return true if name Is hidden @return true if name Is a function @return true if name Is a command @return true if function macro or command macro @return true if array formula or user defined Convenience Function to determine if the name Is a built-in name Gets the name @return name Gets the Built In Name @return the built in Name Gets the definition, reference (Formula) @return definition -- can be null if we cant Parse ptgs Get the custom menu text @return custom menu text Gets the description text @return description text Get the help topic text @return gelp topic text Gets the status bar text @return status bar text For named ranges, and built-in names @return the 1-based sheet number. called by the class that Is responsible for writing this sucker. Subclasses should implement this so that their data Is passed back in a @param offset to begin writing at @param data byte array containing instance data @return number of bytes written Gets the extern sheet number @return extern sheet index return the non static version of the id for this record. @see Object#ToString() Creates a human Readable name for built in types @return Unknown if the built-in name cannot be translated NOTE: Comment Associated with a Cell (1Ch) @author Yegor Kozlov Flag indicating that the comment Is hidden (default) Flag indicating that the comment Is visible Saves padding byte value to reduce delta during round-trip serialization.
The documentation is not clear about how padding should work. In any case Excel(2007) does something different.
Construct a new NoteRecord and Fill its data with the default values Constructs a NoteRecord and Fills its fields from the supplied RecordInputStream. @param in the stream to Read from @return id of this record. Serialize the record data into the supplied array of bytes @param offset offset in the data @param data the data to Serialize into @return size of the record Size of record Convert this record to string. Used by BiffViewer and other utulities. Return the row that Contains the comment @return the row that Contains the comment Return the column that Contains the comment @return the column that Contains the comment Options flags. @return the options flag @see #NOTE_VISIBLE @see #NOTE_HIDDEN Object id for OBJ record that Contains the comment Name of the original comment author @return the name of the original author of the comment For unit testing only! Contains a numeric cell value. REFERENCE: PG 334 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre Creates new NumberRecord Constructs a Number record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the value for the cell @return double representing the value Title: Object Protect Record Description: Protect embedded object with the lamest "security" ever invented. This record tells "I want to protect my objects" with lame security. It appears in conjunction with the PASSWORD and PROTECT records as well as its scenario protect cousin. REFERENCE: PG 368 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) Constructs a Protect record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get whether the sheet Is protected or not @return whether to protect the sheet or not The obj record is used to hold various graphic objects and controls. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) used when POI has no idea what is going on Excel seems to tolerate padding to quad or double byte length Constructs a OBJ record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Some XLS files have ObjRecords with nearly 8Kb of excessive padding. These were probably written by a version of POI (around 3.1) which incorrectly interpreted the second short of the ftLbs subrecord (0x1FEE) as a length, and read that many bytes as padding (other bugs helped allow this to occur). Excel reads files with this excessive padding OK, truncating the over-sized ObjRecord back to the its proper size. POI does the same. Size of record (excluding 4 byte header) Base class for all old (Biff 2 - Biff 4) cell value records (implementors of {@link CellValueRecordInterface}). Subclasses are expected to manage the cell data values (of various types). Get the index to the ExtendedFormat, for non-Biff2 @see NPOI.HSSF.Record.ExtendedFormatRecord @return index to the XF record Is this a Biff2 record, or newer? Append specific debug info (used by {@link #ToString()} for the value Contained in this record. Trailing new-line should not be Appended (superclass does that). Gets the debug info BIFF record type name (used by {@link #ToString()}. Formula Record (0x0006 / 0x0206 / 0x0406) - holds a formula in encoded form, along with the value if a number Get the calculated value of the formula @return calculated value Get the option flags @return bitmask @return the formula tokens. never null Biff2 - Biff 4 Label Record (0x0004 / 0x0204) - read only support for strings stored directly in the cell, from the older file formats that didn't use {@link LabelSSTRecord} @param in the RecordInputstream to read the record from Get the number of characters this string Contains @return number of characters Get the String of the cell Not supported Title: Bound Sheet Record (aka BundleSheet) (0x0085) for BIFF 5
Description: Defines a sheet within a workbook. Basically stores the sheet name and tells where the Beginning of file record is within the HSSF file.
Get the offset in bytes of the Beginning of File Marker within the HSSF Stream part of the POIFS file @return offset in bytes Get the sheetname for this sheet. (this appears in the tabs at the bottom) @return sheetname the name of the sheet Biff2 - Biff 4 Label Record (0x0007 / 0x0207) - read only support for formula string results. @param in the RecordInputstream to read the record from @return The string represented by this record. Record that Contains the functionality page _breaks (horizontal and vertical) The other two classes just specifically Set the SIDS for record creation. REFERENCE: Microsoft Excel SDK page 322 and 420 @see HorizontalPageBreakRecord @see VerticalPageBreakRecord @author Danny Mui (dmui at apache dot org) Since both records store 2byte integers (short), no point in differentiating it in the records. The subs (rows or columns, don't seem to be able to Set but excel Sets them automatically) Adds the page break at the specified parameters @param main Depending on sid, will determine row or column to put page break (zero-based) @param subFrom No user-interface to Set (defaults to minumum, 0) @param subTo No user-interface to Set Removes the break indicated by the parameter @param main (zero-based) Retrieves the region at the row/column indicated @param main FIXME: Document this! @return The Break or null if no break exists at the row/col specified. PaletteRecord - Supports custom palettes. @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Brian Sanders (bsanders at risklabs dot com) - custom palette editing @version 2.0-pre The standard size of an XLS palette The byte index of the first color Constructs a PaletteRecord record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Dangerous! Only call this if you intend to replace the colors! Returns the color value at a given index @return the RGB triplet for the color, or null if the specified index does not exist Sets the color value at a given index If the given index Is greater than the current last color index, then black Is Inserted at every index required to make the palette continuous. @param byteIndex the index to Set; if this index Is less than 0x8 or greater than 0x40, then no modification Is made Creates the default palette as PaletteRecord binary data @see org.apache.poi.hssf.model.Workbook#createPalette PColor - element in the list of colors - consider it a "struct" * Describes the frozen and Unfozen panes. * NOTE: This source Is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a Pane record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the x field for the Pane record. Get the y field for the Pane record. Get the top row field for the Pane record. Get the left column field for the Pane record. Get the active pane field for the Pane record. @return One of ACTIVE_PANE_LOWER_RIGHT ACTIVE_PANE_UPPER_RIGHT ACTIVE_PANE_LOWER_LEFT ACTIVE_PANE_UPPER_LEFT Title: Password Record Description: stores the encrypted password for a sheet or workbook (HSSF doesn't support encryption) REFERENCE: PG 371 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a Password record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the password @return short representing the password Clone this record. Title: Protection Revision 4 password Record Description: Stores the (2 byte??!!) encrypted password for a shared workbook REFERENCE: PG 374 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a PasswordRev4 (PROT4REVPASS) record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from set the password @param pw representing the password SXDI - Data Item (0x00C5)
@author Patrick Cheng
SXVDEX - Extended PivotTable View Fields (0x0100)
@author Patrick Cheng
the value of the cchSubName field when the subName is not present SXPI - Page Item (0x00B6)
@author Patrick Cheng
Index to the View Item SXVI(0x00B2) record Index to the {@link ViewFieldsRecord} SXVD(0x00B1) record Object ID for the drop-down arrow SXIDSTM - Stream ID (0x00D5)
@author Patrick Cheng
SXVIEW - View Definition (0x00B0)
@author Patrick Cheng
SXVD - View Fields (0x00B1)
@author Patrick Cheng
values for the {@link ViewFieldsRecord#sxaxis} field the value of the cchName field when the name is not present 5 shorts SXVS - View Source (0x00E3)
@author Patrick Cheng
Title: Precision Record Description: defines whether to store with full precision or what's Displayed by the gui (meaning have really screwed up and skewed figures or only think you do!) REFERENCE: PG 372 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a Precision record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get whether to use full precision or just skew all you figures all to hell. @return fullprecision - or not Title: Print Gridlines Record Description: whether to print the gridlines when you enjoy you spReadsheet on paper. REFERENCE: PG 373 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a PrintGridlines record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get whether or not to print the gridlines (and make your spReadsheet ugly) @return make spReadsheet ugly - Y/N Title: Print Headers Record Description: Whether or not to print the row/column headers when you enjoy your spReadsheet in the physical form. REFERENCE: PG 373 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a PrintHeaders record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get whether to print the headers - y/n true if [print headers]; otherwise, false. Title: Print Setup Record Description: Stores print Setup options -- bogus for HSSF (and marked as such) REFERENCE: PG 385 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a PrintSetup (SetUP) record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Title: Protection Revision 4 Record Description: describes whether this is a protected shared/tracked workbook ( HSSF does not support encryption because we don't feel like going to jail ) REFERENCE: PG 373 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a ProtectionRev4 record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get whether the this is protected shared/tracked workbook or not @return whether to protect the workbook or not Title: Protect Record Description: defines whether a sheet or workbook is protected (HSSF DOES NOT SUPPORT ENCRYPTION) (kindly ask the US government to stop having arcane stupid encryption laws and we'll support it) (after all terrorists will all use US-legal encrypton right??) HSSF now supports the simple "protected" sheets (where they are not encrypted and open office et al ignore the password record entirely). REFERENCE: PG 373 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) Constructs a Protect record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get whether the sheet is protected or not @return whether to protect the sheet or not Title: Recalc Id Record Description: This record Contains an ID that marks when a worksheet was last recalculated. It's an optimization Excel uses to determine if it needs to recalculate the spReadsheet when it's opened. So far, only the two values 0xC1 0x01 0x00 0x00 0x80 0x38 0x01 0x00 (do not recalculate) and 0xC1 0x01 0x00 0x00 0x60 0x69 0x01 0x00 have been seen. If the field isNeeded Is Set to false (default), then this record Is swallowed during the serialization Process REFERENCE: http://chicago.sourceforge.net/devel/docs/excel/biff8.html @author Luc Girardin (luc dot girardin at macrofocus dot com) @version 2.0-pre @see org.apache.poi.hssf.model.Workbook An unsigned integer that specifies the recalculation engine identifier of the recalculation engine that performed the last recalculation. If the value is less than the recalculation engine identifier associated with the application, the application will recalculate the results of all formulas on this workbook immediately after loading the file Constructs a RECALCID record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Title: Record Description: All HSSF Records inherit from this class. It populates the fields common to all records (id, size and data). Subclasses should be sure to validate the id, Company: @author Andrew C. Oliver @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre instantiates a blank record strictly for ID matching called by the class that is responsible for writing this sucker. Subclasses should implement this so that their data is passed back in a byte array. @return byte array containing instance data return the non static version of the id for this record. Common base class of {@link Record} and {@link RecordAggregate} @author Josh Micich called by the class that is responsible for writing this sucker. Subclasses should implement this so that their data is passed back in a byte array. @param offset to begin writing at @param data byte array containing instance data @return number of bytes written gives the current serialized size of the record. Should include the sid and reclength (4 bytes). Title: Record Factory Description: Takes a stream and outputs an array of Record objects. @deprecated use {@link org.apache.poi.hssf.eventmodel.EventRecordFactory} instead @see org.apache.poi.hssf.eventmodel.EventRecordFactory @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) @author Csaba Nagy (ncsaba at yahoo dot com) A "create" method is used instead of the usual constructor if the created record might be of a different class to the declaring class. cache of the recordsToMap(); Debug / diagnosis method
Gets the POI implementation class for a given sid. Only a subset of the any BIFF records are actually interpreted by POI. A few others are known but not interpreted (see {@link UnknownRecord#getBiffName(int)}). @return the POI implementation class for the specified record sid. null if the specified record is not interpreted by POI.
Changes the default capacity (10000) to handle larger files Create an array of records from an input stream @param in the InputStream from which the records will be obtained @return an array of Records Created from the InputStream @exception RecordFormatException on error Processing the InputStream Converts a {@link MulBlankRecord} into an equivalent array of {@link BlankRecord}s RK record is a slightly smaller alternative to NumberRecord POI likes NumberRecord better The rk. Converts a MulRKRecord into an equivalent array of NumberRecords The MRK. A stream based way to get at complete records, with as low a memory footprint as possible. This handles Reading from a RecordInputStream, turning the data into full records, processing continue records etc. Most users should use {@link HSSFEventFactory} / {@link HSSFListener} and have new records pushed to them, but this does allow for a "pull" style of coding. Keeps track of the sizes of the Initial records up to and including {@link FilePassRecord} Needed for protected files because each byte is encrypted with respect to its absolute position from the start of the stream. @return last record scanned while looking for encryption info. This will typically be the first or second record Read. Possibly null if stream was empty false in some test cases Temporarily stores a group of {@link Record}s, for future return by {@link #nextRecord()}. This is used at the start of the workbook stream, and also when the most recently read underlying record is a {@link MulRKRecord} used to help iterating over the unread records The most recent record that we gave to the user The most recent DrawingRecord seen @param shouldIncludeContinueRecords caller can pass false if loose {@link ContinueRecord}s should be skipped (this is sometimes useful in event based processing). Returns the next (complete) record from the stream, or null if there are no more. @return the next {@link Record} from the multiple record group as expanded from a recently read {@link MulRKRecord}. null if not present. @return the next available record, or null if this pass didn't return a record that's suitable for returning (eg was a continue record). Title: Record Input Stream Description: Wraps a stream and provides helper methods for the construction of records. @author Jason Height (jheight @ apache dot org) Maximum size of a single record (minus the 4 byte header) without a continue Header {@link LittleEndianInput} facet of the wrapped {@link InputStream} Data {@link LittleEndianInput} facet of the wrapped {@link InputStream} the record identifier of the BIFF record currently being read This method will Read a byte from the current record @return the sid of the next record or {@link #INVALID_SID_VALUE} if at end of stream Moves to the next record in the stream. Note: The auto continue flag is Reset to true Reads an 8 bit, signed value Reads a 16 bit, signed value Reads an 8 bit, Unsigned value Reads a 16 bit,un- signed value. @return given a byte array of 16-bit Unicode Chars, compress to 8-bit and return a string { 0x16, 0x00 } -0x16 @param Length the Length of the string @return the Converted string @exception ArgumentException if len is too large (i.e., there is not enough data in string to Create a String of that Length) Returns the remaining bytes for the current record. @return The remaining bytes of the current record. Reads all byte data for the current record, including any that overlaps into any following continue records. @deprecated Best to write a input stream that wraps this one where there Is special sub record that may overlap continue records. The remaining number of bytes in the current record. @return The number of bytes remaining in the current record Returns true iif a Continue record is next in the excel stream _currentDataOffset @return True when a ContinueRecord is next. @return sid of next record. Can be called after hasNextRecord() Title: RefMode Record Description: Describes which reference mode to use REFERENCE: PG 376 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a RefMode record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the reference mode to use (HSSF uses/assumes A1) @return mode to use @see #USE_A1_MODE @see #USE_R1C1_MODE Title: Refresh All Record Description: Flag whether to refresh all external data when loading a sheet. (which hssf doesn't support anyhow so who really cares?) REFERENCE: PG 376 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a RefreshAll record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get whether to refresh all external data when loading a sheet @return refreshall or not Record for the right margin. * NOTE: This source was automatically generated. * @author Shawn Laubach (slaubach at apache dot org) Constructs a RightMargin record and Sets its fields appropriately. * * @param id id must be 0x27 or an exception * will be throw upon validation * @param size size the size of the data area of the record * @param data data of the record (should not contain sid/len) Get the margin field for the RightMargin record. Title: RK Record Description: An internal 32 bit number with the two most significant bits storing the type. This is part of a bizarre scheme to save disk space and memory (gee look at all the other whole records that are in the file just "cause"..,far better to waste Processor cycles on this then leave on of those "valuable" records out). We support this in Read-ONLY mode. HSSF Converts these to NUMBER records REFERENCE: PG 376 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.NumberRecord Constructs a RK record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the type of the number @return one of these values:
  1. RK_IEEE_NUMBER
  2. RK_IEEE_NUMBER_TIMES_100
  3. RK_INTEGER
  4. RK_INTEGER_TIMES_100
Extract the value of the number The mechanism for determining the value is dependent on the two low order bits of the raw number. If bit 1 is Set, the number is an integer and can be cast directly as a double, otherwise, it's apparently the exponent and mantissa of a double (and the remaining low-order bits of the double's mantissa are 0's). If bit 0 is Set, the result of the conversion to a double Is divided by 100; otherwise, the value is left alone. [Insert picture of Screwy Squirrel in full Napoleonic regalia] @return the value as a proper double (hey, it could happen) this record only used for record that has name and not implemented. Title: Row Record Description: stores the row information for the sheet. REFERENCE: PG 379 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre The maximum row number that excel can handle (zero based) ie 65536 rows Is max number of rows. 16 bit options flags Constructs a Row record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the logical row number for this row (0 based index) @return row - the row number Get the logical col number for the first cell this row (0 based index) @return col - the col number Get the logical col number for the last cell this row plus one (0 based index) @return col - the last col number + 1 Get the height of the row @return height of the row Get whether to optimize or not (Set to 0) @return optimize (Set to 0) Gets the option bitmask. (use the individual bit Setters that refer to this method) @return options - the bitmask Get the outline level of this row @return ol - the outline level @see #GetOptionFlags() Get whether or not to colapse this row @return c - colapse or not @see #GetOptionFlags() Get whether or not to Display this row with 0 height @return - z height is zero or not. @see #GetOptionFlags() Get whether the font and row height are not compatible @return - f -true if they aren't compatible (damn not logic) @see #GetOptionFlags() Get whether the row has been formatted (even if its got all blank cells) @return formatted or not @see #GetOptionFlags() if the row is formatted then this is the index to the extended format record @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.ExtendedFormatRecord @return index to the XF record or bogus value (undefined) if Isn't formatted bit that specifies whether any cell in the row has a thick top border, or any cell in the row directly above the current row has a thick bottom border. @param f has thick top border A bit that specifies whether any cell in the row has a medium or thick bottom border, or any cell in the row directly below the current row has a medium or thick top border. @param f has thick bottom border A bit that specifies whether the phonetic guide feature is enabled for any cell in this row. @param f use phoenetic guide Title: Save Recalc Record Description: defines whether to recalculate before saving (Set to true) REFERENCE: PG 381 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre Constructs an SaveRecalc record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get whether to recalculate formulas/etc before saving or not @return recalc - whether to recalculate or not Title: Scenario Protect Record Description: I have no idea what a Scenario is or why on would want to protect it with the lamest "security" ever invented. However this record tells excel "I want to protect my scenarios" (0xAF) with lame security. It appears in conjunction with the PASSWORD and PROTECT records as well as its object protect cousin. REFERENCE: PG 383 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) Constructs a Protect record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get whether the sheet is protected or not @return whether to protect the sheet or not * Specifies the window's zoom magnification. If this record Isn't present then the windows zoom is 100%. see p384 Excel Dev Kit * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache.org) Constructs a SCL record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the numerator field for the SCL record. Get the denominator field for the SCL record. Title: Selection Record Description: shows the user's selection on the sheet for Write Set num refs to 0 TODO : Fully implement reference subrecords. REFERENCE: PG 291 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a Selection record and Sets its fields appropriately. the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Gets or sets the pane this is for. The pane. Gets or sets the active cell row. row number of active cell Gets or sets the active cell's col number of active cell Gets or sets the active cell's reference number ref number of active cell Title: SharedFormulaRecord Description: Primarily used as an excel optimization so that multiple similar formulas are not written out too many times. We should recognize this record and Serialize as Is since this Is used when Reading templates. Note: the documentation says that the SID Is BC where biffviewer reports 4BC. The hex dump shows that the two byte sid representation to be 'BC 04' that Is consistent with the other high byte record types. @author Danny Mui at apache dot org @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from print a sort of string representation ([SHARED FORMULA RECORD] id = x [/SHARED FORMULA RECORD]) @return the equivalent {@link Ptg} array that the formula would have, were it not shared. Common base class for {@link SharedFormulaRecord}, {@link ArrayRecord} and {@link TableRecord} which are have similarities. @author Josh Micich reads only the range (1 {@link CellRangeAddress8Bit}) from the stream @return true if (rowIx, colIx) is within the range ({@link #Range}) of this shared value object. @return true if (rowIx, colIx) describes the first cell in this shared value object's range ({@link #Range}) Handles the task of deserializing a SST string. The two main entry points are @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) @author Jason Height (jheight at apache.org) This Is the starting point where strings are constructed. Note that strings may span across multiple continuations. Read the SST record carefully before beginning to hack. Title: Static String Table Record Description: This holds all the strings for LabelSSTRecords. REFERENCE: PG 389 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.LabelSSTRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.ContinueRecord how big can an SST record be? As big as any record can be: 8228 bytes standard record overhead: two shorts (record id plus data space size) SST overhead: the standard record overhead, plus the number of strings and the number of Unique strings -- two ints how much data can we stuff into an SST record? That would be _max minus the standard SST record overhead Union of strings in the SST and EXTSST according to docs ONLY SST Offsets from the beginning of the SST record (even across continuations) Offsets relative the start of the current SST or continue record default constructor Constructs an SST record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Add a string. @param string string to be Added @return the index of that string in the table @return number of strings @return number of Unique strings Get a particular string by its index @param id index into the array of strings @return the desired string Return a debugging string representation @return string representation @return sid @return hashcode @return an iterator of the strings we hold. All instances are UnicodeStrings @return count of the strings we hold. called by the class that Is responsible for writing this sucker. Subclasses should implement this so that their data Is passed back in a byte array. @return size Creates an extended string record based on the current contents of the current SST record. The offset within the stream to the SST record Is required because the extended string record points directly to the strings in the SST record. NOTE: THIS FUNCTION MUST ONLY BE CALLED AFTER THE SST RECORD HAS BEEN SERIALIZED. @param sstOffset The offset in the stream to the start of the SST record. @return The new SST record. Calculates the size in bytes of the EXTSST record as it would be if the record was Serialized. @return The size of the ExtSST record in bytes. This class handles serialization of SST records. It utilizes the record processor class write individual records. This has been refactored from the SSTRecord class. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) OffSets from the beginning of the SST record (even across continuations) OffSets relative the start of the current SST or continue record Subclasses of this class (the majority of BIFF records) are non-continuable. This allows for some simplification of serialization logic @author Josh Micich Write the data content of this BIFF record including the sid and record length. The subclass must write the exact number of bytes as reported by Record#getRecordSize() offset data Write the data content of this BIFF record. The 'ushort sid' and 'ushort size' header fields have already been written by the superclass.
The number of bytes written must equal the record size reported by {@link Record#getDataSize()} minus four ( record header consiting of a 'ushort sid' and 'ushort reclength' has already been written by thye superclass).
Supports the STRING record structure. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a String record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from called by the class that Is responsible for writing this sucker. Subclasses should implement this so that their data Is passed back in a byte array. @param offset to begin writing at @param data byte array containing instance data @return number of bytes written return the non static version of the id for this record. @return The string represented by this record. Title: Style Record Description: Describes a builtin to the gui or user defined style REFERENCE: PG 390 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author aviks : string fixes for UserDefined Style @version 2.0-pre Constructs a Style record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from if this is a builtin style set the number of the built in style @param builtinStyleId style number (0-7) Get the actual index of the style extended format record @see #Index @return index of the xf record Get the style's name @return name of the style @see #NameLength Get the row or column level of the style (if builtin 1||2) * The common object data record is used to store all common preferences for an excel object. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a CommonObjectData record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) Get the object type field for the CommonObjectData record. Get the object id field for the CommonObjectData record. Get the option field for the CommonObjectData record. Get the reserved1 field for the CommonObjectData record. Get the reserved2 field for the CommonObjectData record. Get the reserved3 field for the CommonObjectData record. true if object is locked when sheet has been protected @return the locked field value. object appears when printed @return the printable field value. whether object uses an automatic Fill style @return the autoFill field value. whether object uses an automatic line style @return the autoline field value. A sub-record within the OBJ record which stores a reference to an object stored in a Separate entry within the OLE2 compound file. @author Daniel Noll either an area or a cell ref Formulas often have a single non-zero trailing byte. This is in a similar position to he pre-streamId padding It is unknown if the value is important (it seems to mirror a value a few bytes earlier) Constructs an EmbeddedObjectRef record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the record input stream. Gets the stream ID containing the actual data. The data itself can be found under a top-level directory entry in the OLE2 filesystem under the name "MBDxxxxxxxx" where xxxxxxxx is this ID converted into hex (in big endian order, funnily enough.) @return the data stream ID. Possibly null * The end data record is used to denote the end of the subrecords. * NOTE: This source is automatically generated please do not modify this file. Either subclass or * Remove the record in src/records/definitions. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a End record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) * The Group marker record is used as a position holder for Groups. * @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Constructs a Group marker record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Size of record (exluding 4 byte header) From [MS-XLS].pdf 2.5.147 FtLbsData: An unsigned integer that indirectly specifies whether some of the data in this structure appear in a subsequent Continue record. If _cbFContinued is 0x00, all of the fields in this structure except sid and _cbFContinued MUST NOT exist. If this entire structure is Contained within the same record, then _cbFContinued MUST be greater than or equal to the size, in bytes, of this structure, not including the four bytes for the ft and _cbFContinued fields a formula that specifies the range of cell values that are the items in this list. An unsigned integer that specifies the number of items in the list. An unsigned integer that specifies the one-based index of the first selected item in this list. A value of 0x00 specifies there is no currently selected item. flags that tell what data follows An ObjId that specifies the edit box associated with this list. A value of 0x00 specifies that there is no edit box associated with this list. An optional LbsDropData that specifies properties for this dropdown control. This field MUST exist if and only if the Containing Obj?s cmo.ot is equal to 0x14. An optional array of strings where each string specifies an item in the list. The number of elements in this array, if it exists, MUST be {@link #_cLines} An optional array of bools that specifies which items in the list are part of a multiple selection @param in the stream to read data from @param cbFContinued the seconf short in the record header @param cmoOt the Containing Obj's {@link CommonObjectDataSubRecord#field_1_objectType} @return the formula that specifies the range of cell values that are the items in this list. @return the number of items in the list @return a new instance of LbsDataSubRecord to construct auto-filters @see org.apache.poi.hssf.model.ComboboxShape#createObjRecord(org.apache.poi.hssf.usermodel.HSSFSimpleShape, int) This structure specifies properties of the dropdown list control Combo dropdown control Combo Edit dropdown control Simple dropdown control (just the dropdown button) An unsigned integer that specifies the style of this dropdown. An unsigned integer that specifies the number of lines to be displayed in the dropdown. An unsigned integer that specifies the smallest width in pixels allowed for the dropdown window a string that specifies the current string value in the dropdown Optional, undefined and MUST be ignored. This field MUST exist if and only if the size of str in bytes is an odd number Represents a NoteStructure (0xD) sub record. The docs say nothing about it. The Length of this record is always 26 bytes. @author Yegor Kozlov Construct a new NoteStructureSubRecord and Fill its data with the default values Constructs a NoteStructureSubRecord and Sets its fields appropriately. Convert this record to string. Used by BiffViewer and other utulities. Serialize the record data into the supplied array of bytes @param offset offset in the data @param data the data to Serialize into @return size of the record Size of record @return id of this record. FtSbs structure Subrecords are part of the OBJ class. Wether this record terminates the sub-record stream. There are two cases when this method must be overridden and return true - EndSubRecord (sid = 0x00) - LbsDataSubRecord (sid = 0x12) @return whether this record is the last in the sub-record stream Title: Sup Book (EXTERNALBOOK) Description: A External Workbook Description (Suplemental Book) Its only a dummy record for making new ExternSheet Record REFERENCE: 5.38 @author Libin Roman (Vista Portal LDT. Developer) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver@apache.org) Constructs a Extern Sheet record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param id id must be 0x16 or an exception will be throw upon validation @param size the size of the data area of the record @param data data of the record (should not contain sid/len) Title: Sheet Tab Index Array Record Description: Contains an array of sheet id's. Sheets always keep their ID regardless of what their name Is. REFERENCE: PG 412 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a TabID record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Set the tab array. (0,1,2). @param array of tab id's {0,1,2} Get the tab array. (0,1,2). @return array of tab id's {0,1,2} DATATABLE (0x0236)

TableRecord - The record specifies a data table. This record Is preceded by a single Formula record that defines the first cell in the data table, which should only contain a single Ptg, {@link TblPtg}. See p536 of the June 08 binary docs TABLESTYLES (0x088E)
@author Patrick Cheng
expect tRef, tRef3D, tArea, tArea3D or tName Not clear if needed . Excel seems to be OK if this byte is not present. Value is often the same as the earlier firstColumn byte. Get the text orientation field for the TextObjectBase record. @return a TextOrientation @return the Horizontal text alignment field value. @return the Vertical text alignment field value. Text has been locked @return the text locked field value. Record for the top margin. NOTE: This source was automatically generated. @author Shawn Laubach (slaubach at apache dot org) Constructs a TopMargin record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the margin field for the TopMargin record. Title: Uncalced Record If this record occurs in the Worksheet Substream, it indicates that the formulas have not been recalculated before the document was saved. @author Olivier Leprince Default constructor Read constructor Title: Unknown Record (for debugging) Description: Unknown record just tells you the sid so you can figure out what records you are missing. Also helps us Read/modify sheets we don't know all the records to. (HSSF leaves these alone!) Company: SuperLink Software, Inc. @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) @param id id of the record -not Validated, just stored for serialization @param data the data construct an Unknown record. No fields are interperated and the record will be Serialized in its original form more or less @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from spit the record out AS IS. no interpretation or identification print a sort of string representation ([UNKNOWN RECORD] id = x [/UNKNOWN RECORD]) These BIFF record types are known but still uninterpreted by POI @return the documented name of this BIFF record type, null if unknown to POI @return true if the unknown record id has been observed in POI unit tests Unlike the other Record.Clone methods this Is a shallow Clone The UserSViewBegin record specifies Settings for a custom view associated with the sheet. This record also marks the start of custom view records, which save custom view Settings. Records between {@link UserSViewBegin} and {@link UserSViewEnd} contain Settings for the custom view, not Settings for the sheet itself. @author Yegor Kozlov construct an UserSViewBegin record. No fields are interpreted and the record will be Serialized in its original form more or less @param in the RecordInputstream to read the record from spit the record out AS IS. no interpretation or identification @return Globally unique identifier for the custom view The UserSViewEnd record marks the end of the Settings for a custom view associated with the sheet @author Yegor Kozlov construct an UserSViewEnd record. No fields are interpreted and the record will be Serialized in its original form more or less @param in the RecordInputstream to read the record from spit the record out AS IS. no interpretation or identification Title: Use Natural Language Formulas Flag Description: Tells the GUI if this was written by something that can use "natural language" formulas. HSSF can't. REFERENCE: PG 420 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a UseSelFS record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Title: VCenter record Description: tells whether to center the sheet between vertical margins REFERENCE: PG 420 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a VCENTER record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get whether to center vertically or not @return vcenter or not VerticalPageBreak record that stores page breaks at columns This class Is just used so that SID Compares work properly in the RecordFactory @see PageBreakRecord @author Danny Mui (dmui at apache dot org) @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Title: Window1 Record Description: Stores the attributes of the workbook window. This Is basically so the gui knows how big to make the window holding the spReadsheet document. REFERENCE: PG 421 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a WindowOne record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the horizontal position of the window (in 1/20ths of a point) @return h - horizontal location Get the vertical position of the window (in 1/20ths of a point) @return v - vertical location Get the width of the window @return width Get the height of the window @return height Get the options bitmask (see bit Setters) @return o - the bitmask Get whether the window Is hidden or not @return Ishidden or not Get whether the window has been iconized or not @return iconize or not Get whether to Display the horizontal scrollbar or not @return Display or not Get whether to Display the vertical scrollbar or not @return Display or not Get whether to Display the tabs or not @return Display or not @return the index of the currently Displayed sheet deprecated May 2008 @deprecated - Misleading name - use GetActiveSheetIndex() @return the first visible sheet in the worksheet tab-bar. I.E. the scroll position of the tab-bar. deprecated May 2008 @deprecated - Misleading name - use GetFirstVisibleTab() Get the number of selected tabs @return number of tabs ratio of the width of the tabs to the horizontal scrollbar @return ratio Title: Window Protect Record Description: flags whether workbook windows are protected REFERENCE: PG 424 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a WindowProtect record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Is this window protected or not @return protected or not Title: Window Two Record Description: sheet window Settings REFERENCE: PG 422 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a WindowTwo record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the options bitmask or just use the bit Setters. @return options Get whether the window should Display formulas @return formulas or not Get whether the window should Display gridlines @return gridlines or not Get whether the window should Display row and column headings @return headings or not Get whether the window should freeze panes @return freeze panes or not Get whether the window should Display zero values @return zeros or not Get whether the window should Display a default header @return header or not Is this arabic? @return arabic or not Get whether the outline symbols are displaed @return symbols or not freeze Unsplit panes or not @return freeze or not sheet tab Is selected @return selected or not Is the sheet currently Displayed in the window @return Displayed or not deprecated May 2008 @deprecated use IsActive() was the sheet saved in page break view @return pagebreaksaved or not Get the top row visible in the window @return toprow Get the leftmost column Displayed in the window @return leftmost Get the palette index for the header color @return color zoom magification in page break view @return zoom Get the zoom magnification in normal view @return zoom Get the reserved bits - why would you do this? @return reserved stuff -probably garbage Title: Write Access Record Description: Stores the username of that who owns the spReadsheet generator (on Unix the user's login, on Windoze its the name you typed when you installed the thing) REFERENCE: PG 424 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @version 2.0-pre this record is always padded to a constant length Constructs a WriteAccess record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get the username for the user that Created the report. HSSF uses the logged in user. On natively Created M$ Excel sheet this would be the name you typed in when you installed it in most cases. @return username of the user who Is logged in (probably "tomcat" or "apache") Title: Write Protect Record Description: Indicated that the sheet/workbook Is Write protected. REFERENCE: PG 425 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @version 3.0-pre Constructs a WriteAccess record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Title: WSBool Record. Description: stores workbook Settings (aka its a big "everything we didn't put somewhere else") REFERENCE: PG 425 Microsoft Excel 97 Developer's Kit (ISBN: 1-57231-498-2) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Glen Stampoultzis (gstamp@iprimus.com.au) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 2.0-pre Constructs a WSBool record and Sets its fields appropriately. @param in the RecordInputstream to Read the record from Get first byte (see bit Getters)

Whether to show automatic page breaks or not
Whether sheet is a dialog sheet or not Get if row summaries appear below detail in the outline Get if col summaries appear right of the detail in the outline Get the second byte (see bit Getters) fit to page option is on Whether to display the guts or not whether alternate expression evaluation is on whether alternative formula entry is on The xtHeader.drType field MUST be equal to 0x07. The xtHeader.drType field MUST be equal to 0x02. The xtHeader.drType field MUST be equal to 0x03. The xtHeader.drType field MUST be equal to 0x04. The xtHeader.drType field MUST be equal to 0x01. The xtHeader.drType field MUST be equal to 0x05. An array of Unicode characters. The size of the array, in characters, is specified by the cchValue field. The size of the field, in bytes, MUST equal the result of the following formula:cchValue * 2. The chartStyle.xtHeader.xmlTkTag MUST be equal to 0x0003. The nInterval.xtHeader.xmlTkTag field MUST be equal to 0x0052. @author Josh Micich Creates a list constraint Creates a number based data validation constraint. The text values entered for expr1 and expr2 can be either standard Excel formulas or formatted number values. If the expression starts with '=' it is Parsed as a formula, otherwise it is Parsed as a formatted number. @param validationType one of {@link NPOI.SS.UserModel.DataValidationConstraint.ValidationType#ANY}, {@link NPOI.SS.UserModel.DataValidationConstraint.ValidationType#DECIMAL}, {@link NPOI.SS.UserModel.DataValidationConstraint.ValidationType#INTEGER}, {@link NPOI.SS.UserModel.DataValidationConstraint.ValidationType#TEXT_LENGTH} @param comparisonOperator any constant from {@link NPOI.SS.UserModel.DataValidationConstraint.OperatorType} enum @param expr1 date formula (when first char is '=') or formatted number value @param expr2 date formula (when first char is '=') or formatted number value Creates a time based data validation constraint. The text values entered for expr1 and expr2 can be either standard Excel formulas or formatted time values. If the expression starts with '=' it is Parsed as a formula, otherwise it is Parsed as a formatted time. To parse formatted times, two formats are supported: "HH:MM" or "HH:MM:SS". This is contrary to Excel which uses the default time format from the OS. @param comparisonOperator constant from {@link NPOI.SS.UserModel.DataValidationConstraint.OperatorType} enum @param expr1 date formula (when first char is '=') or formatted time value @param expr2 date formula (when first char is '=') or formatted time value Creates a date based data validation constraint. The text values entered for expr1 and expr2 can be either standard Excel formulas or formatted date values. If the expression starts with '=' it is Parsed as a formula, otherwise it is Parsed as a formatted date (Excel uses the same convention). To parse formatted dates, a date format needs to be specified. This is contrary to Excel which uses the default short date format from the OS. @param comparisonOperator constant from {@link NPOI.SS.UserModel.DataValidationConstraint.OperatorType} enum @param expr1 date formula (when first char is '=') or formatted date value @param expr2 date formula (when first char is '=') or formatted date value @param dateFormat ignored if both expr1 and expr2 are formulas. Default value is "YYYY/MM/DD" otherwise any other valid argument for SimpleDateFormat can be used @see SimpleDateFormat Distinguishes formula expressions from simple value expressions. This logic is only required by a few factory methods in this class that create data validation constraints from more or less the same parameters that would have been entered in the Excel UI. The data validation dialog box uses the convention that formulas begin with '='. Other methods in this class follow the POI convention (formulas and values are distinct), so the '=' convention is not used there. @param textExpr a formula or value expression @return all text After '=' if textExpr begins with '='. Otherwise null if textExpr does not begin with '=' @return null if numberStr is null @return null if timeStr is null @param dateFormat pass null for default YYYYMMDD @return null if timeStr is null Convenience method @return true if this constraint is a 'list' validation Convenience method @return true if this constraint is a 'list' validation with explicit values @return the numeric value for expression 1. May be null @return the numeric value for expression 2. May be null @return both Parsed formulas (for expression 1 and 2). @return The Parsed token array representing the formula or value specified. Empty array if both formula and value are null Translates Graphics calls into escher calls. The translation Is lossy so many features are not supported and some just aren't implemented yet. If in doubt test the specific calls you wish to make. Graphics calls are always performed into an EscherGroup so one will need to be Created. Important:
One important concept worth considering Is that of font size. One of the difficulties in Converting Graphics calls into escher Drawing calls Is that Excel does not have the concept of absolute pixel positions. It measures it's cell widths in 'Chars' and the cell heights in points. Unfortunately it's not defined exactly what a type of Char it's measuring. Presumably this Is due to the fact that the Excel will be using different fonts on different platforms or even within the same platform. Because of this constraint we've had to calculate the verticalPointsPerPixel. This the amount the font should be scaled by when you Issue commands such as DrawString(). A good way to calculate this Is to use the follow formula:
                  multipler = GroupHeightInPoints / heightOfGroup
             
The height of the Group Is calculated fairly simply by calculating the difference between the y coordinates of the bounding box of the shape. The height of the Group can be calculated by using a convenience called HSSFClientAnchor.GetAnchorHeightInPoints().
@author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org)
Construct an escher graphics object. @param escherGroup The escher Group to Write the graphics calls into. @param workbook The workbook we are using. @param forecolor The foreground color to use as default. @param verticalPointsPerPixel The font multiplier. (See class description for information on how this works.). Constructs an escher graphics object. @param escherGroup The escher Group to Write the graphics calls into. @param workbook The workbook we are using. @param foreground The foreground color to use as default. @param verticalPointsPerPixel The font multiplier. (See class description for information on how this works.). @param font The font to use. Fills a (closed) polygon, as defined by a pair of arrays, which hold the x and y coordinates. This Draws the polygon, with nPoint line segments. The first nPoint - 1 line segments are Drawn between sequential points (xPoints[i],yPoints[i],xPoints[i+1],yPoints[i+1]). The line segment Is a closing one, from the last point to the first (assuming they are different). The area inside of the polygon Is defined by using an even-odd Fill rule (also known as the alternating rule), and the area inside of it Is Filled. @param xPoints array of the x coordinates. @param yPoints array of the y coordinates. @param nPoints the total number of points in the polygon. @see java.awt.Graphics#DrawPolygon(int[], int[], int) Instances of this class keep track of multiple dependent cell evaluations due to recursive calls to HSSFFormulaEvaluator.internalEvaluate(). The main purpose of this class Is to detect an attempt to evaluate a cell that Is alReady being evaluated. In other words, it detects circular references in spReadsheet formulas. @author Josh Micich Stores the parameters that identify the evaluation of one cell.
@return human Readable string for debug purposes Notifies this evaluation tracker that evaluation of the specified cell Is about to start.
In the case of a true return code, the caller should continue evaluation of the specified cell, and also be sure to call endEvaluate() when complete.
In the case of a false return code, the caller should return an evaluation result of ErrorEval.CIRCULAR_REF_ERROR, and not call endEvaluate().
@return true if the specified cell has not been visited yet in the current evaluation. false if the specified cell Is alReady being evaluated.
Notifies this evaluation tracker that the evaluation of the specified cell Is complete.

Every successful call to startEvaluate must be followed by a call to endEvaluate (recommended in a finally block) to enable proper tracking of which cells are being evaluated at any point in time.

Assuming a well behaved client, parameters to this method would not be required. However, they have been included to assert correct behaviour, and form more meaningful error messages. This class makes an EvaluationCycleDetector instance available to each thRead via a ThReadLocal in order to avoid Adding a parameter to a few protected methods within HSSFFormulaEvaluator. @author Josh Micich @return

Stores width and height details about a font. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org)
Construct the font details with the given name and height. The font name. The height of the font. Gets the name of the font. Gets the height. Adds the char. The c. The width. Retrieves the width of the specified Char. If the metrics for a particular Char are not available it defaults to returning the width for the 'W' Char. The character. Adds the chars. The chars. The widths. Builds the font height property. Name of the font. Builds the font widths property. Name of the font. Builds the font chars property. Name of the font. Create an instance of FontDetails by loading them from the provided property object. the font name. the property object holding the details of this particular font. a new FontDetails instance. Gets the width of all Chars in a string. The string to measure. The width of the string for a 10 point font. Split the given string into an array of strings using the given delimiter. The text. The separator. The max. Common class for HSSFHeader and HSSFFooter @return the internal text representation (combining center, left and right parts). Possibly empty string if no header or footer is set. Never null. Creates the complete footer string based on the left, center, and middle strings. The parts. Sets the header footer text. the new header footer text (contains mark-up tags). Possibly empty string never Get the left side of the header or footer. The string representing the left side. Get the center of the header or footer. The string representing the center. Get the right side of the header or footer. The string representing the right side.. Returns the string that represents the change in font size. the new font size. The special string to represent a new font size Returns the string that represents the change in font. the new font. the fonts style, one of regular, italic, bold, italic bold or bold italic. The special string to represent a new font size Returns the string representing the current page number The special string for page number. Returns the string representing the number of pages. The special string for the number of pages. Returns the string representing the current date The special string for the date Gets the time. The time. Returns the string representing the current time @return The special string for the time Returns the string representing the current file name The special string for the file name. Returns the string representing the current tab (sheet) name The special string for tab name. Returns the string representing the start bold The special string for start bold Returns the string representing the end bold The special string for end bold. Returns the string representing the start underline The special string for start underline. Returns the string representing the end underline The special string for end underline. Returns the string representing the start double underline The special string for start double underline. Returns the string representing the end double underline The special string for end double underline. Removes any fields (eg macros, page markers etc) from the string. Normally used to make some text suitable for showing to humans, and the resultant text should not normally be saved back into the document! The text. Are fields currently being Stripped from the text that this {@link HeaderStories} returns? Default is false, but can be changed true if [are fields stripped]; otherwise, false. Represents a special field in a header or footer, eg the page number The character sequence that marks this field A special field that normally comes in a pair, eg turn on underline / turn off underline Instance to this class. Explicit static constructor to tell C# compiler not to mark type as beforefieldinit. Initialize AllFields. Accessing the initialized instance. An anchor Is what specifics the position of a shape within a client object or within another containing shape. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Initializes a new instance of the class. The DX1. The dy1. The DX2. The dy2. Gets or sets the DX1. The DX1. Gets or sets the dy1. The dy1. Gets or sets the dy2. The dy2. Gets or sets the DX2. The DX2. Gets a value indicating whether this instance is horizontally flipped. true if this instance is horizontally flipped; otherwise, false. Gets a value indicating whether this instance is vertically flipped. true if this instance is vertically flipped; otherwise, false. High level representation for Border Formatting component of Conditional Formatting Settings @author Dmitriy Kumshayev High level representation of a cell in a row of a spReadsheet. Cells can be numeric, formula-based or string-based (text). The cell type specifies this. String cells cannot conatin numbers and numeric cells cannot contain strings (at least according to our model). Client apps should do the conversions themselves. Formula cells have the formula string, as well as the formula result, which can be numeric or string. Cells should have their number (0 based) before being Added to a row. Only cells that have values should be Added. @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Dan Sherman (dsherman at Isisph.com) @author Brian Sanders (kestrel at burdell dot org) Active Cell support @author Yegor Kozlov cell comments support Creates new Cell - Should only be called by HSSFRow. This Creates a cell from scratch. When the cell is initially Created it is Set to CellType.Blank. Cell types can be Changed/overwritten by calling SetCellValue with the appropriate type as a parameter although conversions from one type to another may be prohibited. Workbook record of the workbook containing this cell Sheet record of the sheet containing this cell the row of this cell the column for this cell Creates new Cell - Should only be called by HSSFRow. This Creates a cell from scratch. Workbook record of the workbook containing this cell Sheet record of the sheet containing this cell the row of this cell the column for this cell CellType.Numeric, CellType.String, CellType.Formula, CellType.Blank, CellType.Boolean, CellType.Error Creates an Cell from a CellValueRecordInterface. HSSFSheet uses this when reading in cells from an existing sheet. Workbook record of the workbook containing this cell Sheet record of the sheet containing this cell the Cell Value Record we wish to represent private constructor to prevent blank construction used internally -- given a cell value record, figure out its type the Workbook that this Cell is bound to the HSSFRow this cell belongs to Set the cells type (numeric, formula or string) Type of the cell. Sets the cell type. The SetValue flag indicates whether to bother about trying to preserve the current value in the new record if one is Created. The SetCellValue method will call this method with false in SetValue since it will overWrite the cell value later Type of the cell. if set to true [set value]. The row. The col. Index of the style. Get the cells type (numeric, formula or string) The type of the cell. Set a numeric value for the cell the numeric value to Set this cell to. For formulas we'll Set the precalculated value, for numerics we'll Set its value. For other types we will Change the cell to a numeric cell and Set its value. Set a date value for the cell. Excel treats dates as numeric so you will need to format the cell as a date. the date value to Set this cell to. For formulas we'll Set the precalculated value, for numerics we'll Set its value. For other types we will Change the cell to a numeric cell and Set its value. Set a string value for the cell. Please note that if you are using full 16 bit Unicode you should call SetEncoding() first. value to Set the cell to. For formulas we'll Set the formula string, for String cells we'll Set its value. For other types we will Change the cell to a string cell and Set its value. If value is null then we will Change the cell to a Blank cell. set a error value for the cell @param errorCode the error value to set this cell to. For formulas we'll set the precalculated value , for errors we'll set its value. For other types we will change the cell to an error cell and set its value. Set a string value for the cell. Please note that if you are using full 16 bit Unicode you should call SetEncoding() first. value to Set the cell to. For formulas we'll Set the formula string, for String cells we'll Set its value. For other types we will Change the cell to a string cell and Set its value. If value is null then we will Change the cell to a Blank cell. Should be called any time that a formula could potentially be deleted. Does nothing if this cell currently does not hold a formula Gets or sets the cell formula. The cell formula. Get the value of the cell as a number. For strings we throw an exception. For blank cells we return a 0. The numeric cell value. Used to help format error messages The cell type code. Types the mismatch. The expected type code. The actual type code. if set to true [is formula cell]. Checks the type of the formula cached value. The expected type code. The fr. Get the value of the cell as a date. For strings we throw an exception. For blank cells we return a null. The date cell value. Get the value of the cell as a string - for numeric cells we throw an exception. For blank cells we return an empty string. For formulaCells that are not string Formulas, we return empty String The string cell value. Get the value of the cell as a string - for numeric cells we throw an exception. For blank cells we return an empty string. For formulaCells that are not string Formulas, we return empty String The rich string cell value. Set a bool value for the cell the bool value to Set this cell to. For formulas we'll Set the precalculated value, for bools we'll Set its value. For other types we will Change the cell to a bool cell and Set its value. Chooses a new bool value for the cell when its type is changing. Usually the caller is calling SetCellType() with the intention of calling SetCellValue(bool) straight afterwards. This method only exists to give the cell a somewhat reasonable value until the SetCellValue() call (if at all). TODO - perhaps a method like SetCellTypeAndValue(int, Object) should be introduced to avoid this Get the value of the cell as a bool. For strings, numbers, and errors, we throw an exception. For blank cells we return a false. true if [boolean cell value]; otherwise, false. Get the value of the cell as an error code. For strings, numbers, and bools, we throw an exception. For blank cells we return a 0. The error cell value. Get the style for the cell. This is a reference to a cell style contained in the workbook object. The cell style. Applying a user-defined style (UDS) is special. Excel does not directly reference user-defined styles, but instead create a 'proxy' ExtendedFormatRecord referencing the UDS as parent. The proceudre to apply a UDS is as follows: 1. search for a ExtendedFormatRecord with parentIndex == style.getIndex() and xfType == ExtendedFormatRecord.XF_CELL. 2. if not found then create a new ExtendedFormatRecord and copy all attributes from the user-defined style and set the parentIndex to be style.getIndex() 3. return the index of the ExtendedFormatRecord, this will be assigned to the parent cell record @param style the user style to apply @return the index of a ExtendedFormatRecord record that will be referenced by the cell Should only be used by HSSFSheet and friends. Returns the low level CellValueRecordInterface record the cell via the low level api. Checks the bounds. The cell num. if the bounds are exceeded. Sets this cell as the active cell for the worksheet Returns a string representation of the cell This method returns a simple representation, anthing more complex should be in user code, with knowledge of the semantics of the sheet being Processed. Formula cells return the formula string, rather than the formula result. Dates are Displayed in dd-MMM-yyyy format Errors are Displayed as #ERR<errIdx> Returns comment associated with this cell The cell comment associated with this cell. Removes the comment for this cell, if there is one. WARNING - some versions of excel will loose all comments after performing this action! Gets the index of the column. The index of the column. Updates the cell record's idea of what column it belongs in (0 based) @param num the new cell number Gets the (zero based) index of the row containing this cell The index of the row. Get or set hyperlink associated with this cell If the supplied hyperlink is null on setting, the hyperlink for this cell will be removed. The hyperlink associated with this cell or null if not found Removes the hyperlink for this cell, if there is one. Only valid for formula cells one of (CellType.Numeric,CellType.String, CellType.Boolean, CellType.Error) depending on the cached value of the formula The purpose of this method is to validate the cell state prior to modification Called when this cell is modified. The purpose of this method is to validate the cell state prior to modification. High level representation of the style of a cell in a sheet of a workbook. @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) Initializes a new instance of the class. The index. The record. The workbook. Initializes a new instance of the class. The index. The record. The workbook. Get the index within the HSSFWorkbook (sequence within the collection of ExtnededFormat objects) Unique index number of the Underlying record this style represents (probably you don't care Unless you're comparing which one is which) Gets the parent style. the parent style for this cell style. In most cases this will be null, but in a few cases there'll be a fully defined parent. Get the index of the format The data format. Get the contents of the format string, by looking up the DataFormat against the bound workbook Get the contents of the format string, by looking up the DataFormat against the supplied workbook The workbook the format string or "General" if not found Get the contents of the format string, by looking up the DataFormat against the supplied workbook The internal workbook. Set the font for this style a font object Created or retreived from the HSSFWorkbook object Gets the index of the font for this style. The index of the font. Gets the font for this style The parent workbook that this style belongs to. Get whether the cell's using this style are to be hidden whether the cell using this style should be hidden Get whether the cell's using this style are to be locked whether the cell using this style should be locked Get the type of horizontal alignment for the cell the type of alignment Gets or sets a value indicating whether the text should be wrapped true if [wrap text]; otherwise, false. Gets or sets the vertical alignment for the cell. the type of alignment Gets or sets the degree of rotation for the text in the cell The rotation degrees (between -90 and 90 degrees). Verifies that this style belongs to the supplied Workbook. Will throw an exception if it belongs to a different one. This is normally called when trying to assign a style to a cell, to ensure the cell and the style are from the same workbook (if they're not, it won't work) The workbook. Gets or sets the number of spaces to indent the text in the cell number of spaces Gets or sets the type of border to use for the left border of the cell The border type. Gets or sets the type of border to use for the right border of the cell The border type. Gets or sets the type of border to use for the top border of the cell The border type. Gets or sets the type of border to use for the bottom border of the cell The border type. Gets or sets the color to use for the left border The index of the color definition Gets or sets the color to use for the left border. The index of the color definition Gets or sets the color to use for the top border The index of the color definition. Gets or sets the color to use for the left border The index of the color definition. Gets or sets the color to use for the diagional border The index of the color definition. Gets or sets the line type to use for the diagional border The line type. Gets or sets the type of diagional border . The border diagional type. Gets or sets whether the cell is shrink-to-fit Get or set the reading order, for RTL/LTR ordering of the text.

0 means Context (Default), 1 means Left To Right, and 2 means Right to Left

@return order - the reading order (0,1,2)
Gets or sets the fill pattern. - Set to 1 to Fill with foreground color The fill pattern. Checks if the background and foreground Fills are Set correctly when one or the other is Set to the default color. Works like the logic table below: BACKGROUND FOREGROUND NONE AUTOMATIC 0x41 0x40 NONE RED/ANYTHING 0x40 0xSOMETHING Clones all the style information from another HSSFCellStyle, onto this one. This HSSFCellStyle will then have all the same properties as the source, but the two may be edited independently. Any stylings on this HSSFCellStyle will be lost! The source HSSFCellStyle could be from another HSSFWorkbook if you like. This allows you to copy styles from one HSSFWorkbook to another. Clones all the style information from another HSSFCellStyle, onto this one. This HSSFCellStyle will then have all the same properties as the source, but the two may be edited independently. Any stylings on this HSSFCellStyle will be lost! The source HSSFCellStyle could be from another HSSFWorkbook if you like. This allows you to copy styles from one HSSFWorkbook to another. The source. Gets or sets the color of the fill background. The color of the fill background. Set the background Fill color. cs.SetFillPattern(HSSFCellStyle.FINE_DOTS ); cs.SetFillBackgroundColor(new HSSFColor.RED().Index); optionally a Foreground and background Fill can be applied: Note: Ensure Foreground color is Set prior to background cs.SetFillPattern(HSSFCellStyle.FINE_DOTS ); cs.SetFillForegroundColor(new HSSFColor.BLUE().Index); cs.SetFillBackgroundColor(new HSSFColor.RED().Index); or, for the special case of SOLID_Fill: cs.SetFillPattern(HSSFCellStyle.SOLID_FOREGROUND ); cs.SetFillForegroundColor(new HSSFColor.RED().Index); It is necessary to Set the Fill style in order for the color to be shown in the cell. Gets or sets the foreground Fill color Fill color. @see org.apache.poi.hssf.usermodel.HSSFPalette#GetColor(short) Gets the name of the user defined style. Returns null for built in styles, and styles where no name has been defined Serves as a hash function for a particular type. A hash code for the current . Determines whether the specified is equal to the current . The to compare with the current . true if the specified is equal to the current ; otherwise, false. The parameter is null. Has methods for construction of a chart object. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Creates a bar chart. API needs some work. :) NOTE: Does not yet work... checking it in just so others can take a look. Returns all the charts for the given sheet. NOTE: You won't be able to do very much with these charts yet, as this is very limited support Get the X offset of the chart Get the Y offset of the chart Get the width of the chart. {@link ChartRecord} Get the height of the chart. {@link ChartRecord} Returns the series of the chart Returns the chart's title, if there is one, or null if not Set value range (basic Axis Options) @param axisIndex 0 - primary axis, 1 - secondary axis @param minimum minimum value; Double.NaN - automatic; null - no change @param maximum maximum value; Double.NaN - automatic; null - no change @param majorUnit major unit value; Double.NaN - automatic; null - no change @param minorUnit minor unit value; Double.NaN - automatic; null - no change A series in a chart See {@link SeriesRecord} Returns the series' title, if there is one, or null if not @return record with data names @return record with data values @return record with data category labels @return record with data secondary category labels @return record with series create anchor from existing file @param escherChildAnchorRecord create anchor from scratch @param dx1 x coordinate of the left up corner @param dy1 y coordinate of the left up corner @param dx2 x coordinate of the right down corner @param dy2 y coordinate of the right down corner @param dx1 x coordinate of the left up corner @param dy1 y coordinate of the left up corner @param dx2 x coordinate of the right down corner @param dy2 y coordinate of the right down corner A client anchor Is attached to an excel worksheet. It anchors against a top-left and buttom-right cell. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Creates a new client anchor and defaults all the anchor positions to 0. Creates a new client anchor and Sets the top-left and bottom-right coordinates of the anchor. Note: Microsoft Excel seems to sometimes disallow higher y1 than y2 or higher x1 than x2 in the anchor, you might need to reverse them and draw shapes vertically or horizontally flipped! the x coordinate within the first cell. the y coordinate within the first cell. the x coordinate within the second cell. the y coordinate within the second cell. the column (0 based) of the first cell. the row (0 based) of the first cell. the column (0 based) of the second cell. the row (0 based) of the second cell. Calculates the height of a client anchor in points. the sheet the anchor will be attached to the shape height. Gets the row height in points. The sheet. The row num. Gets or sets the col1. The col1. Gets or sets the col2. The col2. Gets or sets the row1. The row1. Gets or sets the row2. The row2. Sets the top-left and bottom-right coordinates of the anchor Note: Microsoft Excel seems to sometimes disallow higher y1 than y2 or higher x1 than x2 in the anchor, you might need to reverse them and draw shapes vertically or horizontally flipped! the column (0 based) of the first cell. the row (0 based) of the first cell. the x coordinate within the first cell. the y coordinate within the first cell. the column (0 based) of the second cell. the row (0 based) of the second cell. the x coordinate within the second cell. the y coordinate within the second cell. Gets a value indicating whether this instance is horizontally flipped. true if the anchor goes from right to left; otherwise, false. Gets a value indicating whether this instance is vertically flipped. true if the anchor goes from bottom to top.; otherwise, false. Gets the anchor type 0 = Move and size with Cells, 2 = Move but don't size with cells, 3 = Don't move or size with cells. The type of the anchor. Checks the range. The value. The min range. The max range. Name of the variable. Represents a cell comment - a sticky note associated with a cell. @author Yegor Kozlov Construct a new comment with the given parent and anchor. defines position of this anchor in the sheet Initializes a new instance of the class. The note. The txo. Gets or sets a value indicating whether this is visible. true if visible; otherwise, false. Sets whether this comment Is visible. @return true if the comment Is visible, false otherwise Gets or sets the row of the cell that Contains the comment the 0-based row of the cell that Contains the comment Gets or sets the column of the cell that Contains the comment the 0-based column of the cell that Contains the comment Gets or sets the name of the original comment author the name of the original author of the comment Gets the note record. the underlying Note record. Do we know which cell this comment belongs to? HSSFConditionalFormatting class encapsulates all Settings of Conditional Formatting. The class can be used to make a copy HSSFConditionalFormatting Settings HSSFConditionalFormatting cf = sheet.GetConditionalFormattingAt(index); newSheet.AddConditionalFormatting(cf); or to modify existing Conditional Formatting Settings (formatting regions and/or rules). Use {@link HSSFSheet#GetConditionalFormattingAt(int)} to Get access to an instance of this class. To Create a new Conditional Formatting Set use the following approach: // Define a Conditional Formatting rule, which triggers formatting // when cell's value Is greater or equal than 100.0 and // applies patternFormatting defined below. HSSFConditionalFormattingRule rule = sheet.CreateConditionalFormattingRule( ComparisonOperator.GE, "100.0", // 1st formula null // 2nd formula Is not used for comparison operator GE ); // Create pattern with red background HSSFPatternFormatting patternFmt = rule.cretePatternFormatting(); patternFormatting.SetFillBackgroundColor(HSSFColor.RED.index); // Define a region containing first column Region [] regions = { new Region(1,(short)1,-1,(short)1) }; // Apply Conditional Formatting rule defined above to the regions sheet.AddConditionalFormatting(regions, rule); @author Dmitriy Kumshayev Initializes a new instance of the class. The workbook. The cf aggregate. Gets the CF records aggregate. Gets the array of Regions Gets array of CellRangeAddresses Replaces an existing Conditional Formatting rule at position idx. Excel allows to Create up to 3 Conditional Formatting rules. This method can be useful to modify existing Conditional Formatting rules. position of the rule. Should be between 0 and 2. Conditional Formatting rule Add a Conditional Formatting rule. Excel allows to Create up to 3 Conditional Formatting rules. Conditional Formatting rule Gets the Conditional Formatting rule at position idx The index. Gets the number of Conditional Formatting rules. The number of rules. Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . High level representation of Conditional Formatting Rule. It allows to specify formula based conditions for the Conditional Formatting and the formatting Settings such as font, border and pattern. @author Dmitriy Kumshayev @return - font formatting object if defined, null otherwise Create a new font formatting structure if it does not exist, otherwise just return existing object. @return - font formatting object, never returns null. @return - border formatting object if defined, null otherwise Create a new border formatting structure if it does not exist, otherwise just return existing object. @return - border formatting object, never returns null. @return - pattern formatting object if defined, null otherwise Create a new pattern formatting structure if it does not exist, otherwise just return existing object. @return - pattern formatting object, never returns null. @return - the conditiontype for the cfrule @return - the comparisionoperatation for the cfrule Creates a HSSFFormulaEvaluator, the object that Evaluates formula cells. @return a HSSFFormulaEvaluator instance Creates a HSSFClientAnchor. Use this object to position drawing object in a sheet @return a HSSFClientAnchor instance @see NPOI.SS.usermodel.Drawing The first user-defined format starts at 164. Construncts a new data formatter. It takes a workbook to have access to the workbooks format records. the workbook the formats are tied to. Get the format index that matches the given format string Automatically Converts "text" to excel's format string to represent text. The format string matching a built in format. index of format or -1 if Undefined. Get the format index that matches the given format string, creating a new format entry if required. Aliases text to the proper format as required. The format string matching a built in format. index of format. Get the format string that matches the given format index The index of a format. string represented at index of format or null if there Is not a format at that index Get the format string that matches the given format index The index of a built in format. string represented at index of format or null if there Is not a builtin format at that index Get the number of builtin and reserved builtinFormats number of builtin and reserved builtinFormats Ensures that the formats list can hold entries up to and including the entry with this index HSSFDataFormatter contains methods for formatting the value stored in an HSSFCell. This can be useful for reports and GUI presentations when you need to display data exactly as it appears in Excel. Supported formats include currency, SSN, percentages, decimals, dates, phone numbers, zip codes, etc. Internally, formats will be implemented using subclasses of such as and . Therefore the formats used by this class must obey the same pattern rules as these Format subclasses. This means that only legal number pattern characters ("0", "#", ".", "," etc.) may appear in number formats. Other characters can be inserted before or after the number pattern to form a prefix or suffix. For example the Excel pattern "$#,##0.00 "USD"_);($#,##0.00 "USD")" will be correctly formatted as "$1,000.00 USD" or "($1,000.00 USD)". However the pattern "00-00-00" is incorrectly formatted by DecimalFormat as "000000--". For Excel formats that are not compatible with DecimalFormat, you can provide your own custom {@link Format} implementation via HSSFDataFormatter.AddFormat(String,Format). The following custom formats are already provided by this class:
             
  • SSN "000-00-0000"
  • Phone Number "(###) ###-####"
  • Zip plus 4 "00000-0000"
If the Excel format pattern cannot be parsed successfully, then a default format will be used. The default number format will mimic the Excel General format: "#" for whole numbers and "#.##########" for decimal numbers. You can override the default format pattern with HSSFDataFormatter.DefaultNumberFormat=(Format). Note: the default format will only be used when a Format cannot be created from the cell's data format string. @author James May (james dot may at fmr dot com)
Creates a formatter using the given locale. Creates a formatter using the {@link Locale#getDefault() default locale}. Utility class for creating data validation cells @author Dragos Buleandra (dragos.buleandra@trade2b.ro) Constructor which Initializes the cell range on which this object will be applied @param constraint @author Radhakrishnan J Contains methods for dealing with Excel dates. @author Michael Harhen @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) @author Dan Sherman (dsherman at isisph.com) @author Hack Kampbjorn (hak at 2mba.dk) @author Alex Jacoby (ajacoby at gmail.com) @author Pavel Krupets (pkrupets at palmtreebusiness dot com) Contains raw Excel error codes (as defined in OOO's excelfileformat.pdf (2.5.6) @author Michael Harhen #NULL! - Intersection of two cell ranges is empty #DIV/0! - Division by zero #VALUE! - Wrong type of operand #REF! - Illegal or deleted cell reference #NAME? - Wrong function or range name #NUM! - Value range overflow #N/A - Argument or function not available Gets standard Excel error literal for the specified error code. @throws ArgumentException if the specified error code is not one of the 7 standard error codes The error code. Determines whether [is valid code] [the specified error code]. The error code. true if the specified error code is a standard Excel error code.; otherwise, false. HSSF wrapper for a cell under evaluation @author Josh Micich HSSF wrapper for a sheet under evaluation @author Josh Micich Internal POI use only @author Josh Micich Represents a Font used in a workbook. @version 1.0-pre @author Andrew C. Oliver Initializes a new instance of the class. The index. The record. Get the name for the font (i.e. Arial) the name of the font to use Get the index within the HSSFWorkbook (sequence within the collection of Font objects) Unique index number of the Underlying record this Font represents (probably you don't care Unless you're comparing which one is which) Get or sets the font height in Unit's of 1/20th of a point. Maybe you might want to use the GetFontHeightInPoints which matches to the familiar 10, 12, 14 etc.. height in 1/20ths of a point. Gets or sets the font height in points. height in the familiar Unit of measure - points. Gets or sets whether to use italics or not true if this instance is italic; otherwise, false. Get whether to use a strikeout horizontal line through the text or not strikeout or not Gets or sets the color for the font. The color to use. get the color value for the font HSSFWorkbook Gets or sets the boldness to use The boldweight. get or set if the font bold style Gets or sets normal,base or subscript. offset type to use (none,base,sub) Gets or sets the type of text Underlining to use The Underlining type. Gets or sets the char set to use. The char set. Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Serves as a hash function for a particular type. A hash code for the current . Determines whether the specified is equal to the current . The to compare with the current . true if the specified is equal to the current ; otherwise, false. The parameter is null. High level representation for Font Formatting component of Conditional Formatting Settings @author Dmitriy Kumshayev Get the type of base or subscript for the font @return base or subscript option @return font color index Gets the height of the font in 1/20th point Units @return fontheight (in points/20); or -1 if not modified Get the font weight for this font (100-1000dec or 0x64-0x3e8). Default Is 0x190 for normal and 0x2bc for bold @return bw - a number between 100-1000 for the fonts "boldness" @return @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.cf.FontFormatting#GetRawRecord() Get the type of Underlining for the font @return font Underlining type @see #U_NONE @see #U_SINGLE @see #U_DOUBLE @see #U_SINGLE_ACCOUNTING @see #U_DOUBLE_ACCOUNTING Get whether the font weight Is Set to bold or not @return bold - whether the font Is bold or not @return true if escapement type was modified from default @return true if font cancellation was modified from default @return true if font outline type was modified from default @return true if font shadow type was modified from default @return true if font style was modified from default @return true if font style was Set to italic @return true if font outline Is on @return true if font shadow Is on @return true if font strikeout Is on @return true if font Underline type was modified from default @return true if font weight was modified from default Set font style options. @param italic - if true, Set posture style to italic, otherwise to normal @param bold- if true, Set font weight to bold, otherwise to normal Set font style options to default values (non-italic, non-bold) Class to Read and manipulate the footer. The footer works by having a left, center, and right side. The total cannot be more that 255 bytes long. One uses this class by Getting the HSSFFooter from HSSFSheet and then Getting or Setting the left, center, and right side. For special things (such as page numbers and date), one can use a the methods that return the Chars used to represent these. One can also Change the fonts by using similar methods. @author Shawn Laubach (slaubach at apache dot org) Initializes a new instance of the class. Footer record to create the footer with Gets the raw footer. The raw footer. @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @param stabilityClassifier used to optimise caching performance. Pass null for the (conservative) assumption that any cell may have its definition changed after evaluation begins. @param udfFinder pass null for default (AnalysisToolPak only) @param stabilityClassifier used to optimise caching performance. Pass null for the (conservative) assumption that any cell may have its definition changed after evaluation begins. @param udfFinder pass null for default (AnalysisToolPak only) Coordinates several formula evaluators together so that formulas that involve external references can be evaluated. @param workbookNames the simple file names used to identify the workbooks in formulas with external links (for example "MyData.xls" as used in a formula "[MyData.xls]Sheet1!A1") @param evaluators all evaluators for the full set of workbooks required by the formulas. If cell Contains a formula, the formula is Evaluated and returned, else the CellValue simply copies the appropriate cell value from the cell and also its cell type. This method should be preferred over EvaluateInCell() when the call should not modify the contents of the original cell. @param cell If cell contains a formula, the formula is evaluated and returned, else the CellValue simply copies the appropriate cell value from the cell and also its cell type. This method should be preferred over evaluateInCell() when the call should not modify the contents of the original cell. @param cell may be null signifying that the cell is not present (or blank) @return null if the supplied cell is null or blank Should be called whenever there are major changes (e.g. moving sheets) to input cells in the evaluated workbook. If performance is not critical, a single call to this method may be used instead of many specific calls to the notify~ methods. Failure to call this method after changing cell values will cause incorrect behaviour of the evaluate~ methods of this class Should be called to tell the cell value cache that the specified (value or formula) cell has changed. Failure to call this method after changing cell values will cause incorrect behaviour of the evaluate~ methods of this class Should be called to tell the cell value cache that the specified cell has just been deleted. Failure to call this method after changing cell values will cause incorrect behaviour of the evaluate~ methods of this class Should be called to tell the cell value cache that the specified (value or formula) cell has changed. Failure to call this method after changing cell values will cause incorrect behaviour of the evaluate~ methods of this class If cell Contains formula, it Evaluates the formula, and saves the result of the formula. The cell remains as a formula cell. Else if cell does not contain formula, this method leaves the cell UnChanged. Note that the type of the formula result is returned, so you know what kind of value is also stored with the formula.
            int EvaluatedCellType = evaluator.EvaluateFormulaCell(cell);
            
Be aware that your cell will hold both the formula, and the result. If you want the cell Replaced with the result of the formula, use {@link #EvaluateInCell(HSSFCell)} @param cell The cell to Evaluate @return The type of the formula result (the cell's type remains as CellType.Formula however)
Returns a CellValue wrapper around the supplied ValueEval instance. @param cell If cell Contains formula, it Evaluates the formula, and puts the formula result back into the cell, in place of the old formula. Else if cell does not contain formula, this method leaves the cell UnChanged. Note that the same instance of Cell is returned to allow chained calls like:
            int EvaluatedCellType = evaluator.EvaluateInCell(cell).CellType;
            
Be aware that your cell value will be Changed to hold the result of the formula. If you simply want the formula value computed for you, use {@link #EvaluateFormulaCell(HSSFCell)} @param cell
Loops over all cells in all sheets of the supplied workbook. For cells that contain formulas, their formulas are Evaluated, and the results are saved. These cells remain as formula cells. For cells that do not contain formulas, no Changes are made. This is a helpful wrapper around looping over all cells, and calling EvaluateFormulaCell on each one. Loops over all cells in all sheets of the supplied workbook. For cells that contain formulas, their formulas are evaluated, and the results are saved. These cells remain as formula cells. For cells that do not contain formulas, no changes are made. This is a helpful wrapper around looping over all cells, and calling evaluateFormulaCell on each one. Whether to ignore missing references to external workbooks and use cached formula results in the main workbook instead.

In some cases exetrnal workbooks referenced by formulas in the main workbook are not avaiable. With this method you can control how POI handles such missing references:

  • by default ignoreMissingWorkbooks=false and POI throws {@link org.apache.poi.ss.formula.CollaboratingWorkbooksEnvironment.WorkbookNotFoundException} if an external reference cannot be resolved
  • if ignoreMissingWorkbooks=true then POI uses cached formula result that already exists in the main workbook

@param ignore whether to ignore missing references to external workbooks
{@inheritDoc} Class to Read and manipulate the header. The header works by having a left, center, and right side. The total cannot be more that 255 bytes long. One uses this class by Getting the HSSFHeader from HSSFSheet and then Getting or Setting the left, center, and right side. For special things (such as page numbers and date), one can use a the methods that return the Chars used to represent these. One can also Change the fonts by using similar methods. @author Shawn Laubach (slaubach at apache dot org) Initializes a new instance of the class. Footer record to Create the footer with Gets the raw footer. The raw footer. Represents an Excel hyperlink. @author Yegor Kozlov (yegor at apache dot org) Low-level record object that stores the actual hyperlink data If we Create a new hypelrink remember its type Initializes a new instance of the class. The type of hyperlink to Create. Initializes a new instance of the class. The record. Gets or sets the row of the first cell that Contains the hyperlink the 0-based row of the cell that Contains the hyperlink. Gets or sets the row of the last cell that Contains the hyperlink the 0-based row of the last cell that Contains the hyperlink Gets or sets the column of the first cell that Contains the hyperlink the 0-based column of the first cell that Contains the hyperlink Gets or sets the column of the last cell that Contains the hyperlink the 0-based column of the last cell that Contains the hyperlink Gets or sets Hypelink Address. Depending on the hyperlink type it can be URL, e-mail, patrh to a file, etc. the Address of this hyperlink Gets or sets the text mark. The text mark. Gets or sets the short filename. The short filename. Gets or sets the text label for this hyperlink text to Display Gets the type of this hyperlink the type of this hyperlink High Level Represantion of Named Range @author Libin Roman (Vista Portal LDT. Developer) Creates new HSSFName - called by HSSFWorkbook to Create a sheet from scratch. lowlevel Workbook object associated with the sheet. the Name Record Gets or sets the sheets name which this named range is referenced to sheet name, which this named range refered to Gets or sets the name of the named range named range name Returns the sheet index this name applies to. @return the sheet index this name applies to, -1 if this name applies to the entire workbook Sets the NameParsedFormula structure that specifies the formula for the defined name. the sequence of {@link Ptg}s for the formula. Tests if this name points to a cell that no longer exists true if the name refers to a deleted cell; otherwise, false. Gets a value indicating whether this instance is function name. true if this instance is function name; otherwise, false. Indicates that the defined name refers to a user-defined function. This attribute is used when there is an add-in or other code project associated with the file. @param value true indicates the name refers to a function. Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Represents binary object (i.e. OLE) data stored in the file. Eg. A GIF, JPEG etc... @author Daniel Noll Reference to the filesystem root, required for retrieving the object data. Returns the OLE2 Class Name of the object Gets the object data. Only call for ones that have data though. See {@link #hasDirectoryEntry()} @return the object data as an OLE2 directory. @ if there was an error Reading the data. Returns the data portion, for an ObjectData that doesn't have an associated POIFS Directory Entry Does this ObjectData have an associated POIFS Directory Entry? (Not all do, those that don't have a data portion) Finds the EmbeddedObjectRefSubRecord, or throws an Exception if there wasn't one Excel can Get cranky if you give it files containing too many (especially duplicate) objects, and this class can help to avoid those. In general, it's much better to make sure you don't duplicate the objects in your code, as this is likely to be much faster than creating lots and lots of excel objects+records, only to optimise them down to many fewer at a later stage. However, sometimes this is too hard / tricky to do, which is where the use of this class comes in. Goes through the Workbook, optimising the fonts by removing duplicate ones. For now, only works on fonts used in HSSFCellStyle and HSSFRichTextString. Any other font uses (eg charts, pictures) may well end up broken! This can be a slow operation, especially if you have lots of cells, cell styles or rich text strings The workbook in which to optimise the fonts Goes through the Wokrbook, optimising the cell styles by removing duplicate ones and ones that aren't used. For best results, optimise the fonts via a call to OptimiseFonts(HSSFWorkbook) first The workbook in which to optimise the cell styles Represents a workbook color palette. Internally, the XLS format refers to colors using an offset into the palette record. Thus, the first color in the palette has the index 0x8, the second has the index 0x9, etc. through 0x40 @author Brian Sanders (bsanders at risklabs dot com) Retrieves the color at a given index the palette index, between 0x8 to 0x40 inclusive. the color, or null if the index Is not populated Finds the first occurance of a given color the RGB red component, between 0 and 255 inclusive the RGB green component, between 0 and 255 inclusive the RGB blue component, between 0 and 255 inclusive the color, or null if the color does not exist in this palette Finds the closest matching color in the custom palette. The method for Finding the distance between the colors Is fairly primative. The red component of the color to match. The green component of the color to match. The blue component of the color to match. The closest color or null if there are no custom colors currently defined. Sets the color at the given offset the palette index, between 0x8 to 0x40 inclusive the RGB red component, between 0 and 255 inclusive the RGB green component, between 0 and 255 inclusive the RGB blue component, between 0 and 255 inclusive Adds a new color into an empty color slot. The red component The green component The blue component The new custom color. user custom color Initializes a new instance of the class. The byte offset. The colors. Initializes a new instance of the class. The byte offset. The red. The green. The blue. Gets index to the standard palette Gets triplet representation like that in Excel Gets a hex string exactly like a gnumeric triplet Gets the gnumeric part. The color. The patriarch is the toplevel container for shapes in a sheet. It does little other than act as a container for other shapes and Groups. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) The EscherAggregate we have been bound to. (This will handle writing us out into records, and building up our shapes from the records) Creates the patriarch. the sheet this patriarch is stored in. The bound aggregate. check if any shapes contain wrong data At now(13.08.2010) check if patriarch contains 2 or more comments with same coordinates @param shape to be removed @return true of shape is removed Creates a new Group record stored Under this patriarch. the client anchor describes how this Group is attached to the sheet. the newly created Group. Creates a simple shape. This includes such shapes as lines, rectangles, and ovals. Note: Microsoft Excel seems to sometimes disallow higher y1 than y2 or higher x1 than x2 in the anchor, you might need to reverse them and draw shapes vertically or horizontally flipped! the client anchor describes how this Group is attached to the sheet. the newly created shape. Creates a picture. the client anchor describes how this Group is attached to the sheet. Index of the picture. the newly created shape. CreatePicture the client anchor describes how this picture is attached to the sheet. the index of the picture in the workbook collection of pictures. return newly created shape Adds a new OLE Package Shape @param anchor the client anchor describes how this picture is attached to the sheet. @param storageId the storageId returned by {@Link HSSFWorkbook.AddOlePackage} @param pictureIndex the index of the picture (used as preview image) in the workbook collection of pictures. @return newly Created shape Creates a polygon the client anchor describes how this Group is attached to the sheet. the newly Created shape. Constructs a textbox Under the patriarch. the client anchor describes how this Group is attached to the sheet. the newly Created textbox. Constructs a cell comment. @param anchor the client anchor describes how this comment is attached to the sheet. @return the newly created comment. YK: used to create autofilters @see org.apache.poi.hssf.usermodel.HSSFSheet#setAutoFilter(int, int, int, int) Constructs a cell comment. the client anchor describes how this comment is attached to the sheet. the newly created comment. Returns a list of all shapes contained by the patriarch. The children. add a shape to this drawing Total count of all children and their children's children. The count of all children. Sets the coordinate space of this Group. All children are contrained to these coordinates. The x1. The y1. The x2. The y2. Does this HSSFPatriarch contain a chart? (Technically a reference to a chart, since they Get stored in a different block of records) FIXME - detect chart in all cases (only seems to work on some charts so far) true if this instance contains chart; otherwise, false. The top left x coordinate of this Group. The x1. The top left y coordinate of this Group. The y1. The bottom right x coordinate of this Group. The x2. The bottom right y coordinate of this Group. The y2. Returns the aggregate escher record we're bound to Creates a new client anchor and sets the top-left and bottom-right coordinates of the anchor. @param dx1 the x coordinate in EMU within the first cell. @param dy1 the y coordinate in EMU within the first cell. @param dx2 the x coordinate in EMU within the second cell. @param dy2 the y coordinate in EMU within the second cell. @param col1 the column (0 based) of the first cell. @param row1 the row (0 based) of the first cell. @param col2 the column (0 based) of the second cell. @param row2 the row (0 based) of the second cell. @return the newly created client anchor create shape tree from existing escher records tree High level representation for Conditional Formatting Settings @author Dmitriy Kumshayev Initializes a new instance of the class. The cf rule record. Gets the pattern formatting block. The pattern formatting block. Gets or sets the color of the fill background. The color of the fill background. Gets or sets the color of the fill foreground. The color of the fill foreground. Gets or sets the fill pattern. The fill pattern. Represents a escher picture. Eg. A GIF, JPEG etc... @author Glen Stampoultzis @author Yegor Kozlov (yegor at apache.org) Constructs a picture object. The parent. The anchor. Reset the image to the dimension of the embedded image Please note, that this method works correctly only for workbooks with default font size (Arial 10pt for .xls). If the default font is changed the resized image can be streched vertically or horizontally. Resize the image proportionally. scale Resize the image

Please note, that this method works correctly only for workbooks with default font size (Arial 10pt for .xls). If the default font is changed the resized image can be streched vertically or horizontally.

resize(1.0,1.0) keeps the original size,
resize(0.5,0.5) resize to 50% of the original,
resize(2.0,2.0) resizes to 200% of the original.
resize({@link Double#MAX_VALUE},{@link Double#MAX_VALUE}) resizes to the dimension of the embedded image.

@param scaleX the amount by which the image width is multiplied relative to the original width. @param scaleY the amount by which the image height is multiplied relative to the original height.
Gets or sets the index of the picture. The index of the picture. Calculate the preferred size for this picture. @param scale the amount by which image dimensions are multiplied relative to the original size. @return HSSFClientAnchor with the preferred size for this image @since POI 3.0.2 Calculate the preferred size for this picture. the amount by which image width is multiplied relative to the original width. the amount by which image height is multiplied relative to the original height. HSSFClientAnchor with the preferred size for this image Calculate the preferred size for this picture. HSSFClientAnchor with the preferred size for this image The metadata of PNG and JPEG can contain the width of a pixel in millimeters. Return the the "effective" dpi calculated as 25.4/HorizontalPixelSize and 25.4/VerticalPixelSize . Where 25.4 is the number of mm in inch. The image. the resolution Return the dimension of the embedded image in pixel image dimension Return picture data for this shape @return picture data for this shape The color applied to the lines of this shape. @return the anchor that is used by this picture. @return the sheet which contains the picture shape Represents binary data stored in the file. Eg. A GIF, JPEG etc... @author Daniel Noll Underlying escher blip record containing the bitmap data. Constructs a picture object. the underlying blip record containing the bitmap data. Gets the picture data. the picture data. gets format of the picture. The format. Suggests a file extension for this image. the file extension. Returns the mime type for the image @return the POI internal image type, -1 if not unknown image type @see Workbook#PICTURE_TYPE_DIB @see Workbook#PICTURE_TYPE_EMF @see Workbook#PICTURE_TYPE_JPEG @see Workbook#PICTURE_TYPE_PICT @see Workbook#PICTURE_TYPE_PNG @see Workbook#PICTURE_TYPE_WMF @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at baselinksoftware.com) Generates the shape records for this shape. Creates the low level OBJ record for this shape. @return array of x coordinates @return array of y coordinates @param xPoints - array of x coordinates @param yPoints - array of y coordinates Defines the width and height of the points in the polygon @param width @param height @return shape width @return shape height Used to modify the print Setup. @author Shawn Laubach (slaubach at apache dot org) Initializes a new instance of the class. Takes the low level print Setup record. Gets or sets the size of the paper. The size of the paper. Gets or sets the scale. The scale. Gets or sets the page start. The page start. Gets or sets the number of pages wide to fit sheet in. the number of pages wide to fit sheet in Gets or sets number of pages high to fit the sheet in number of pages high to fit the sheet in. Gets or sets the bit flags for the options. the bit flags for the options. Gets or sets the left to right print order. the left to right print order. Gets or sets the landscape mode. the landscape mode. Gets or sets the valid Settings. the valid Settings. Gets or sets the black and white Setting. black and white Setting Gets or sets the draft mode. the draft mode. Gets or sets the print notes. the print notes. Gets or sets a value indicating whether [no orientation]. true if [no orientation]; otherwise, false. Gets or sets the use page numbers. use page numbers. Gets or sets the horizontal resolution. the horizontal resolution. Gets or sets the vertical resolution. the vertical resolution. Gets or sets the header margin. The header margin. Gets or sets the footer margin. The footer margin. Gets or sets the number of copies. the number of copies. Rich text Unicode string. These strings can have fonts applied to arbitary parts of the string. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) @author Jason Height (jheight at apache.org) Place holder for indicating that NO_FONT has been applied here Initializes a new instance of the class. Initializes a new instance of the class. The string. Initializes a new instance of the class. The workbook. The record. This must be called to Setup the internal work book references whenever a RichTextString Is Added to a cell The workbook. The record. Called whenever the Unicode string Is modified. When it Is modified we need to Create a new SST index, so that other LabelSSTRecords will not be affected by Changes tat we make to this string. Adds to SST if required. Applies a font to the specified Chars of a string. The start index to apply the font to (inclusive). The end index to apply the font to (exclusive). The font to use. Applies a font to the specified Chars of a string. The start index to apply the font to (inclusive). The end index to apply to font to (exclusive). The index of the font to use. Sets the font of the entire string. The font to use. Removes any formatting that may have been applied to the string. Returns the plain string representation. The string. Returns the raw, probably shared Unicode String. Used when tweaking the styles, eg updating font positions. Changes to this string may well effect other RichTextStrings too! The raw unicode string. Gets or sets the unicode string. The unicode string. Gets the number of Chars in the font.. The length. Returns the font in use at a particular index. The index. The font that's currently being applied at that index or null if no font Is being applied or the index Is out of range. Gets the number of formatting runs used. There will always be at least one of font NO_FONT. The num formatting runs. The index within the string to which the specified formatting run applies. the index of the formatting run the index within the string. Gets the font used in a particular formatting run. the index of the formatting run. the font number used. Compares one rich text string to another. The other rich text string. Equalses the specified o. The o. Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Applies the specified font to the entire string. Index of the font to apply. High level representation of a row of a spReadsheet. Only rows that have cells should be Added to a Sheet. @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) used for collections reference to low level representation reference to containing low level Workbook reference to containing Sheet Creates new HSSFRow from scratch. Only HSSFSheet should do this. low-level Workbook object containing the sheet that Contains this row low-level Sheet object that Contains this Row the row number of this row (0 based) Creates an HSSFRow from a low level RowRecord object. Only HSSFSheet should do this. HSSFSheet uses this when an existing file is Read in. low-level Workbook object containing the sheet that Contains this row low-level Sheet object that Contains this Row the low level api object this row should represent Use this to create new cells within the row and return it. The cell that is returned is a CELL_TYPE_BLANK (/). The type can be changed either through calling SetCellValue or SetCellType. the column number this cell represents a high level representation of the created cell. Use this to create new cells within the row and return it. The cell that is returned is a CELL_TYPE_BLANK. The type can be changed either through calling setCellValue or setCellType. the column number this cell represents a high level representation of the created cell. Remove the Cell from this row. The cell to Remove. Removes the cell. The cell. if set to true [also remove records]. used internally to refresh the "last cell plus one" when the last cell is removed. @return 0 when row contains no cells used internally to refresh the "first cell" when the first cell is removed. @return 0 when row contains no cells (also when first cell is occupied) Create a high level Cell object from an existing low level record. Should only be called from HSSFSheet or HSSFRow itself. The low level cell to Create the high level representation from the low level record passed in true, when the row is invisible. This is the case when the height is zero. Removes all the cells from the row, and their records too. Get row number this row represents the row number (0 based) Returns the rows outline level. Increased as you put it into more Groups (outlines), reduced as you take it out of them. The outline level. Moves the supplied cell to a new column, which must not already have a cell there! The cell to move The new column number (0 based) Returns the HSSFSheet this row belongs to @return the HSSFSheet that owns this row used internally to Add a cell. The cell. Get the hssfcell representing a given column (logical cell) 0-based. If you ask for a cell that is not defined, then you Get a null. This is the basic call, with no policies applied 0 based column number Cell representing that column or null if Undefined. Get the hssfcell representing a given column (logical cell) 0-based. If you ask for a cell that is not defined then you get a null, unless you have set a different MissingCellPolicy on the base workbook. Short method signature provided to retain binary compatibility. 0 based column number Cell representing that column or null if undefined. Get the hssfcell representing a given column (logical cell) 0-based. If you ask for a cell that is not defined then you get a null, unless you have set a different MissingCellPolicy on the base workbook. 0 based column number Cell representing that column or null if undefined. Get the hssfcell representing a given column (logical cell) 0-based. If you ask for a cell that is not defined, then your supplied policy says what to do 0 based column number Policy on blank / missing cells that column or null if Undefined + policy allows. Get the number of the first cell contained in this row. the first logical cell in the row, or -1 if the row does not contain any cells. Gets the index of the last cell contained in this row PLUS ONE . The result also happens to be the 1-based column number of the last cell. This value can be used as a standard upper bound when iterating over cells: short representing the last logical cell in the row PLUS ONE, or -1 if the row does not contain any cells. short minColIx = row.GetFirstCellNum(); short maxColIx = row.GetLastCellNum(); for(short colIx=minColIx; colIx<maxColIx; colIx++) { Cell cell = row.GetCell(colIx); if(cell == null) { continue; } //... do something with cell } Gets the number of defined cells (NOT number of cells in the actual row!). That is to say if only columns 0,4,5 have values then there would be 3. the number of defined cells in the row. Gets or sets whether or not to Display this row with 0 height height is zero or not. Get or sets the row's height or ff (-1) for undefined/default-height in twips (1/20th of a point) rowheight or 0xff for Undefined (use sheet default) is this row formatted? Most aren't, but some rows do have whole-row styles. For those that do, you can get the formatting from {@link #getRowStyle()} true if this instance is formatted; otherwise, false. Returns the whole-row cell styles. Most rows won't have one of these, so will return null. Call IsFormmated to check first The row style. Get the row's height or ff (-1) for Undefined/default-height in points (20*Height) row height or 0xff for Undefined (use sheet default). Get the lowlevel RowRecord represented by this object - should only be called by other parts of the high level API RowRecord this row represents used internally to refresh the "first cell" when the first cell is Removed. The first cell index. Get cells in the row (existing cells only, no blanks) Gets the cell enumerator of the physically defined cells. Note that the 4th element might well not be cell 4, as the iterator will not return Un-defined (null) cells. Call CellNum on the returned cells to know which cell they are. Compares the current instance with another object of the same type and returns an integer that indicates whether the current instance precedes, follows, or occurs in the same position in the sort order as the other object. An object to compare with this instance. A 32-bit signed integer that indicates the relative order of the objects being compared. The return value has these meanings: Value Meaning Less than zero This instance is less than . Zero This instance is equal to . Greater than zero This instance is greater than . is not the same type as this instance. Determines whether the specified is equal to the current . The to compare with the current . true if the specified is equal to the current ; otherwise, false. The parameter is null. Returns a hash code. In this case it is the number of the row. An abstract shape. Note: Microsoft Excel seems to sometimes disallow higher y1 than y2 or higher x1 than x2 in the anchor, you might need to reverse them and draw shapes vertically or horizontally flipped! creates shapes from existing file @param spContainer @param objRecord Create a new shape with the specified parent and anchor. The parent. The anchor. Gets the parent shape. The parent. Gets or sets the anchor that is used by this shape. The anchor. The color applied to the lines of this shape. The color of the line style. Sets the color applied to the lines of this shape The red. The green. The blue. Gets or sets the color used to fill this shape. The color of the fill. Sets the color used to fill this shape. The red. The green. The blue. Gets or sets with width of the line in EMUs. 12700 = 1 pt. The width of the line. Gets or sets One of the constants in LINESTYLE_* The line style. Gets or sets a value indicating whether this instance is no fill. true if this shape Is not filled with a color; otherwise, false. whether this shape is vertically flipped. whether this shape is horizontally flipped. get or set the rotation, in degrees, that is applied to a shape. Negative values specify rotation in the counterclockwise direction. Rotation occurs around the center of the shape. The default value for this property is 0x00000000 Count of all children and their childrens children. The count of all children. An interface that indicates whether a class can contain children. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Gets Any children contained by this shape. The children. dd shape to the list of child records shape set coordinates of this group relative to the parent x1 y1 x2 y2 Get the top left x coordinate of this group. Get the top left y coordinate of this group. Get the bottom right x coordinate of this group. Get the bottom right y coordinate of this group. remove first level shapes @param shape to be removed @return true if shape is removed else return false @author Evgeniy Berlog date: 05.06.12 build shape tree from escher container @param container root escher container from which escher records must be taken @param agg - EscherAggregate @param out - shape container to which shapes must be added @param root - node to create HSSFObjectData shapes A shape Group may contain other shapes. It was no actual form on the sheet. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Create another Group Under this Group. the position of the new Group. the Group Create a new simple shape Under this Group. the position of the shape. the shape Create a new textbox Under this Group. the position of the shape. the textbox Creates a polygon the client anchor describes how this Group Is attached to the sheet. the newly Created shape. Creates a picture. the client anchor describes how this Group Is attached to the sheet. Index of the picture. the newly Created shape. Return all children contained by this shape. Sets the coordinate space of this Group. All children are constrained to these coordinates. The x1. The y1. The x2. The y2. Gets The top left x coordinate of this Group. The x1. Gets The top left y coordinate of this Group. The y1. Gets The bottom right x coordinate of this Group. The x2. Gets the bottom right y coordinate of this Group. The y2. Count of all children and their childrens children. High level representation of a worksheet. @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) @author Libin Roman (romal at vistaportal.com) @author Shawn Laubach (slaubach at apache dot org) (Just a little) @author Jean-Pierre Paris (jean-pierre.paris at m4x dot org) (Just a little, too) @author Yegor Kozlov (yegor at apache.org) (Autosizing columns) width of 1px in columns with default width in units of 1/256 of a character width width of 1px in columns with overridden width in units of 1/256 of a character width Used for compile-time optimization. This is the initial size for the collection of rows. It is currently Set to 20. If you generate larger sheets you may benefit by Setting this to a higher number and recompiling a custom edition of HSSFSheet. reference to the low level Sheet object Creates new HSSFSheet - called by HSSFWorkbook to create a _sheet from scratch. You should not be calling this from application code (its protected anyhow). The HSSF Workbook object associated with the _sheet. Creates an HSSFSheet representing the given Sheet object. Should only be called by HSSFWorkbook when reading in an exisiting file. The HSSF Workbook object associated with the _sheet. lowlevel Sheet object this _sheet will represent Clones the _sheet. The _workbook. the cloned sheet Copy one row to the target row index of the source row index of the target row used internally to Set the properties given a Sheet object The _sheet. Gets the flag indicating whether the window should show 0 (zero) in cells containing zero value. When false, cells with zero value appear blank instead of showing the number zero. In Excel 2003 this option can be changed in the Options dialog on the View tab. @return whether all zero values on the worksheet are displayed Create a new row within the _sheet and return the high level representation The row number. @see org.apache.poi.hssf.usermodel.HSSFRow @see #RemoveRow(HSSFRow) Used internally to Create a high level Row object from a low level row object. USed when Reading an existing file low level record to represent as a high level Row and Add to _sheet. HSSFRow high level representation Remove a row from this _sheet. All cells contained in the row are Removed as well the row to Remove. used internally to refresh the "last row" when the last row is Removed. The last row. used internally to refresh the "first row" when the first row is Removed. The first row. Add a row to the _sheet @param AddLow whether to Add the row to the low level model - false if its already there Returns the HSSFCellStyle that applies to the given (0 based) column, or null if no style has been set for that column The column. Returns the logical row (not physical) 0-based. If you ask for a row that is not defined you get a null. This is to say row 4 represents the fifth row on a _sheet. Index of the row to get. the row number or null if its not defined on the _sheet Returns the number of phsyically defined rows (NOT the number of rows in the _sheet) The physical number of rows. Gets the first row on the _sheet the number of the first logical row on the _sheet Gets the last row on the _sheet last row contained n this _sheet. Creates a data validation object The data validation object settings Get the visibility state for a given column.F:\Gloria\�о�\�ļ���ʽ\NPOI\src\NPOI\HSSF\Util\HSSFDataValidation.cs the column to Get (0-based). the visiblity state of the column. Get the hidden state for a given column. the column to Set (0-based) the visiblity state of the column; Set the width (in Units of 1/256th of a Char width) the column to Set (0-based) the width in Units of 1/256th of a Char width Get the width (in Units of 1/256th of a Char width ) the column to Set (0-based) the width in Units of 1/256th of a Char width Gets or sets the default width of the column. The default width of the column. Get the default row height for the _sheet (if the rows do not define their own height) in twips (1/20 of a point) The default height of the row. Get the default row height for the _sheet (if the rows do not define their own height) in points. The default row height in points. Get whether gridlines are printed. true if printed; otherwise, false. Adds a merged region of cells (hence those cells form one) The region (rowfrom/colfrom-rowto/colto) to merge. index of this region adds a merged region of cells (hence those cells form one) region (rowfrom/colfrom-rowto/colto) to merge index of this region Whether a record must be Inserted or not at generation to indicate that formula must be recalculated when _workbook is opened. true if [force formula recalculation]; otherwise, false. @return true if an Uncalced record must be Inserted or not at generation Determine whether printed output for this _sheet will be vertically centered. true if [vertically center]; otherwise, false. Determine whether printed output for this _sheet will be horizontally centered. true if [horizontally center]; otherwise, false. Removes a merged region of cells (hence letting them free) index of the region to Unmerge returns the number of merged regions The number of merged regions Gets the row enumerator. an iterator of the PHYSICAL rows. Meaning the 3rd element may not be the third row if say for instance the second row is undefined. Call on each row if you care which one it is. Alias for GetRowEnumerator() to allow foreach loops. an iterator of the PHYSICAL rows. Meaning the 3rd element may not be the third row if say for instance the second row is undefined. Call on each row if you care which one it is. used internally in the API to Get the low level Sheet record represented by this Object. low level representation of this HSSFSheet. Sets the active cell. The row. The column. Sets the active cell range. The first row. The last row. The first column. The last column. Sets the active cell range. The cellranges. The index of the active range. The active row in the active range The active column in the active range Gets or sets whether alternate expression evaluation is on true if [alternative expression]; otherwise, false. whether alternative formula entry is on true alternative formulas or not; otherwise, false. show automatic page breaks or not whether to show auto page breaks Gets or sets a value indicating whether _sheet is a dialog _sheet true if is dialog; otherwise, false. Gets or sets a value indicating whether to Display the guts or not. true if guts or no guts (or glory); otherwise, false. Gets or sets a value indicating whether fit to page option is on true if [fit to page]; otherwise, false. Get if row summaries appear below detail in the outline true if below or not; otherwise, false. Get if col summaries appear right of the detail in the outline true right or not; otherwise, false. Gets or sets whether gridlines are printed. true Gridlines are printed; otherwise, false. Gets the print setup object. The user model for the print setup object. Gets the user model for the document header. The Document header. Gets the user model for the document footer. The Document footer. Gets or sets whether the worksheet is displayed from right to left instead of from left to right. true for right to left, false otherwise poi bug 47970 Note - this is not the same as whether the _sheet is focused (isActive) true if this _sheet is currently selected; otherwise, false. Gets or sets a value indicating if this _sheet is currently focused. true if this _sheet is currently focused; otherwise, false. Sets whether sheet is selected. Whether to select the sheet or deselect the sheet. Answer whether protection is enabled or disabled true if protection enabled; otherwise, false. Gets the hashed password The password. Answer whether object protection is enabled or disabled true if protection enabled; otherwise, false. Answer whether scenario protection is enabled or disabled true if protection enabled; otherwise, false. Sets the protection enabled as well as the password password to set for protection, pass null to remove protection Sets the zoom magnication for the _sheet. The zoom is expressed as a fraction. For example to express a zoom of 75% use 3 for the numerator and 4 for the denominator. The numerator for the zoom magnification. The denominator for the zoom magnification. Sets the enclosed border of region. The region. Type of the border. The color. Sets the right border of region. The region. Type of the border. The color. Sets the left border of region. The region. Type of the border. The color. Sets the top border of region. The region. Type of the border. The color. Sets the bottom border of region. The region. Type of the border. The color. The top row in the visible view when the _sheet is first viewed after opening it in a viewer the rownum (0 based) of the top row The left col in the visible view when the _sheet Is first viewed after opening it in a viewer the rownum (0 based) of the top row Sets desktop window pane display area, when the file is first opened in a viewer. @param toprow the top row to show in desktop window pane @param leftcol the left column to show in desktop window pane Sets desktop window pane display area, when the file is first opened in a viewer. the top row to show in desktop window pane the left column to show in desktop window pane Shifts the merged regions left or right depending on mode TODO: MODE , this is only row specific The start row. The end row. The n. if set to true [is row]. Shifts rows between startRow and endRow n number of rows. If you use a negative number, it will Shift rows up. Code Ensures that rows don't wrap around. Calls ShiftRows(startRow, endRow, n, false, false); Additionally Shifts merged regions that are completely defined in these rows (ie. merged 2 cells on a row to be Shifted). the row to start Shifting the row to end Shifting the number of rows to Shift Shifts rows between startRow and endRow n number of rows. If you use a negative number, it will shift rows up. Code ensures that rows don't wrap around Additionally shifts merged regions that are completely defined in these rows (ie. merged 2 cells on a row to be shifted). TODO Might want to add bounds checking here the row to start shifting the row to end shifting the number of rows to shift whether to copy the row height during the shift whether to set the original row's height to the default Shifts rows between startRow and endRow n number of rows. If you use a negative number, it will Shift rows up. Code Ensures that rows don't wrap around Additionally Shifts merged regions that are completely defined in these rows (ie. merged 2 cells on a row to be Shifted). TODO Might want to Add bounds Checking here the row to start Shifting the row to end Shifting the number of rows to Shift whether to copy the row height during the Shift whether to Set the original row's height to the default if set to true [move comments]. Inserts the chart records. The records. Creates a split (freezepane). Any existing freezepane or split pane is overwritten. Horizonatal position of split. Vertical position of split. Top row visible in bottom pane Left column visible in right pane. Creates a split (freezepane). Any existing freezepane or split pane is overwritten. Horizonatal position of split. Vertical position of split. Creates a split pane. Any existing freezepane or split pane is overwritten. Horizonatal position of split (in 1/20th of a point). Vertical position of split (in 1/20th of a point). Left column visible in right pane. Top row visible in bottom pane. Active pane. One of: PANE_LOWER_RIGHT,PANE_UPPER_RIGHT, PANE_LOWER_LEFT, PANE_UPPER_LEFT Returns the information regarding the currently configured pane (split or freeze). null if no pane configured, or the pane information. Gets or sets if gridlines are Displayed. whether gridlines are Displayed Gets or sets a value indicating whether formulas are displayed. whether formulas are Displayed Gets or sets a value indicating whether RowColHeadings are displayed. whether RowColHeadings are displayed Gets the size of the margin in inches. which margin to get. the size of the margin Sets the size of the margin in inches. which margin to get. the size of the margin Sets a page break at the indicated row The row. Determines if there is a page break at the indicated row The row. true if [is row broken] [the specified row]; otherwise, false. Removes the page break at the indicated row The row. Retrieves all the horizontal page breaks all the horizontal page breaks, or null if there are no row page breaks Retrieves all the vertical page breaks all the vertical page breaks, or null if there are no column page breaks Sets a page break at the indicated column The column. Determines if there is a page break at the indicated column The column. true if [is column broken] [the specified column]; otherwise, false. Removes a page break at the indicated column The column. Runs a bounds Check for row numbers The row. Runs a bounds Check for column numbers The column. Aggregates the drawing records and dumps the escher record hierarchy to the standard output. if set to true [fat]. Returns the agregate escher records for this _sheet, it there is one. WARNING - calling this will trigger a parsing of the associated escher records. Any that aren't supported (such as charts and complex drawing types) will almost certainly be lost or corrupted when written out. The drawing escher aggregate. This will hold any graphics or charts for the sheet. @return the top-level drawing patriarch, if there is one, else returns null Creates the top-level drawing patriarch. This will have the effect of removing any existing drawings on this sheet. This may then be used to add graphics or charts @return The new patriarch. Gets or sets the tab color of the _sheet Gets or sets whether the tab color of _sheet is automatic Expands or collapses a column Group. One of the columns in the Group. true = collapse Group, false = expand Group. Create an outline for the provided column range. beginning of the column range. end of the column range. Ungroups the column. From column. To column. Groups the row. From row. To row. Remove a Array Formula from this sheet. All cells contained in the Array Formula range are removed as well any cell within Array Formula range the of cells affected by this change Also creates cells if they don't exist. Sets array formula to specified region for result. text representation of the formula Region of array formula for result the of cells affected by this change Ungroups the row. From row. To row. Sets the row group collapsed. The row. if set to true [collapse]. Sets the default column style for a given column. POI will only apply this style to new cells Added to the _sheet. the column index the style to set Adjusts the column width to fit the contents. This Process can be relatively slow on large sheets, so this should normally only be called once per column, at the end of your Processing. the column index. Adjusts the column width to fit the contents. This Process can be relatively slow on large sheets, so this should normally only be called once per column, at the end of your Processing. You can specify whether the content of merged cells should be considered or ignored. Default is to ignore merged cells. the column index whether to use the contents of merged cells when calculating the width of the column Checks if the provided region is part of the merged regions. Region searched in the merged regions true, when the region is contained in at least one of the merged regions Gets the merged region at the specified index The index. Convert HSSFFont to Font. The font. Returns cell comment for the specified row and column The row. The column. cell comment or null if not found Gets the sheet conditional formatting. The sheet conditional formatting. Get the DVRecords objects that are associated to this _sheet a list of DVRecord instances Provide a reference to the parent workbook. Returns the name of this _sheet Create an instance of a DataValidationHelper. Instance of a DataValidationHelper Enable filtering for a range of cells the range of cells to filter Returns the column outline level. Increased as you put it into more groups (outlines), reduced as you take it out of them. The Conditional Formatting facet of HSSFSheet @author Dmitriy Kumshayev A factory method allowing to Create a conditional formatting rule with a cell comparison operator TODO - formulas containing cell references are currently not Parsed properly a constant value from HSSFConditionalFormattingRule.ComparisonOperator formula for the valued, Compared with the cell second formula (only used with HSSFConditionalFormattingRule#COMPARISON_OPERATOR_BETWEEN and HSSFConditionalFormattingRule#COMPARISON_OPERATOR_NOT_BETWEEN operations) A factory method allowing to Create a conditional formatting rule with a formula. The formatting rules are applied by Excel when the value of the formula not equal to 0. TODO - formulas containing cell references are currently not Parsed properly formula for the valued, Compared with the cell Adds a copy of HSSFConditionalFormatting object to the sheet This method could be used to copy HSSFConditionalFormatting object from one sheet to another. HSSFConditionalFormatting object index of the new Conditional Formatting object HSSFConditionalFormatting cf = sheet.GetConditionalFormattingAt(index); newSheet.AddConditionalFormatting(cf); Allows to Add a new Conditional Formatting Set to the sheet. list of rectangular regions to apply conditional formatting rules Set of up to three conditional formatting rules index of the newly Created Conditional Formatting object Adds the conditional formatting. The regions. The rule1. Adds the conditional formatting. The regions. The rule1. The rule2. Gets Conditional Formatting object at a particular index @param index of the Conditional Formatting object to fetch Conditional Formatting object the number of Conditional Formatting objects of the sheet The num conditional formattings. Removes a Conditional Formatting object by index index of a Conditional Formatting object to Remove Represents a simple shape such as a line, rectangle or oval. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Initializes a new instance of the class. The parent. The anchor. Gets the shape type. One of the OBJECT_TYPE_* constants. @see #OBJECT_TYPE_LINE @see #OBJECT_TYPE_OVAL @see #OBJECT_TYPE_RECTANGLE @see #OBJECT_TYPE_PICTURE @see #OBJECT_TYPE_COMMENT Get or set the rich text string used by this object. A textbox Is a shape that may hold a rich text string. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Construct a new textbox with the given parent and anchor. The parent. One of HSSFClientAnchor or HSSFChildAnchor Gets or sets the left margin within the textbox. The margin left. Gets or sets the right margin within the textbox. The margin right. Gets or sets the top margin within the textbox The top margin. Gets or sets the bottom margin within the textbox. The margin bottom. Gets or sets the horizontal alignment. The horizontal alignment. Gets or sets the vertical alignment. The vertical alignment. High level representation of a workbook. This is the first object most users will construct whether they are reading or writing a workbook. It is also the top level object for creating new sheets/etc. @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) @author Shawn Laubach (slaubach at apache dot org) The maximum number of cell styles in a .xls workbook. The 'official' limit is 4,000, but POI allows a slightly larger number. This extra delta takes into account built-in styles that are automatically created for new workbooks See http://office.microsoft.com/en-us/excel-help/excel-specifications-and-limits-HP005199291.aspx used for compile-time performance/memory optimization. This determines the initial capacity for the sheet collection. Its currently Set to 3. Changing it in this release will decrease performance since you're never allowed to have more or less than three sheets! this Is the reference to the low level Workbook object this holds the HSSFSheet objects attached to this workbook this holds the HSSFName objects attached to this workbook holds whether or not to preserve other nodes in the POIFS. Used for macros and embedded objects. Used to keep track of the data formatter so that all CreateDataFormatter calls return the same one for a given book. This Ensures that updates from one places Is visible someplace else. this holds the HSSFFont objects attached to this workbook. We only create these from the low level records as required. Totals the sizes of all sheet records and eventually serializes them Creates new HSSFWorkbook from scratch (start here!) Companion to HSSFWorkbook(POIFSFileSystem), this constructs the POI filesystem around your inputstream, including all nodes. This calls {@link #HSSFWorkbook(InputStream, boolean)} with preserve nodes set to true. @see #HSSFWorkbook(InputStream, boolean) @see #HSSFWorkbook(POIFSFileSystem) @see org.apache.poi.poifs.filesystem.POIFSFileSystem @exception IOException if the stream cannot be read given a POI POIFSFileSystem object, Read in its Workbook and populate the high and low level models. If you're Reading in a workbook...start here. the POI filesystem that Contains the Workbook stream. whether to preseve other nodes, such as macros. This takes more memory, so only say yes if you need to. If Set, will store all of the POIFSFileSystem in memory Normally, the Workbook will be in a POIFS Stream called "Workbook". However, some weird XLS generators use "WORKBOOK" given a POI POIFSFileSystem object, and a specific directory within it, Read in its Workbook and populate the high and low level models. If you're Reading in a workbook...start here. the POI filesystem directory to Process from the POI filesystem that Contains the Workbook stream. whether to preseve other nodes, such as macros. This takes more memory, so only say yes if you need to. If Set, will store all of the POIFSFileSystem in memory given a POI POIFSFileSystem object, and a specific directory within it, read in its Workbook and populate the high and low level models. If you're reading in a workbook...start here. @param directory the POI filesystem directory to process from @param preserveNodes whether to preseve other nodes, such as macros. This takes more memory, so only say yes if you need to. If set, will store all of the POIFSFileSystem in memory @see org.apache.poi.poifs.filesystem.POIFSFileSystem @exception IOException if the stream cannot be read Companion to HSSFWorkbook(POIFSFileSystem), this constructs the POI filesystem around your inputstream. @param s the POI filesystem that Contains the Workbook stream. @param preserveNodes whether to preseve other nodes, such as macros. This takes more memory, so only say yes if you need to. @see org.apache.poi.poifs.filesystem.POIFSFileSystem @see #HSSFWorkbook(POIFSFileSystem) @exception IOException if the stream cannot be Read used internally to Set the workbook properties. This is basically a kludge to deal with the now obsolete Label records. If you have to read in a sheet that contains Label records, be aware that the rest of the API doesn't deal with them, the low level structure only provides Read-only semi-immutable structures (the Sets are there for interface conformance with NO impelmentation). In short, you need to call this function passing it a reference to the Workbook object. All labels will be converted to LabelSST records and their contained strings will be written to the Shared String tabel (SSTRecord) within the Workbook. The records. The offset. Retrieves the current policy on what to do when getting missing or blank cells from a row. The default is to return blank and null cells. The missing cell policy. Sets the order of appearance for a given sheet. the name of the sheet to reorder the position that we want to Insert the sheet into (0 based) Validates the index of the sheet. The index. Test only. Do not use Selects a single sheet. This may be different to the 'active' sheet (which Is the sheet with focus). The index. Sets the selected tabs. The indexes. Gets the tab whose data is actually seen when the sheet is opened. This may be different from the "selected sheet" since excel seems to allow you to show the data of one sheet when another Is seen "selected" in the tabs (at the bottom). Sets the tab whose data is actually seen when the sheet is opened. This may be different from the "selected sheet" since excel seems to allow you to show the data of one sheet when another Is seen "selected" in the tabs (at the bottom). The sheet number(0 based). Gets or sets the first tab that is displayed in the list of tabs in excel. @deprecated POI will now properly handle Unicode strings without forceing an encoding @deprecated POI will now properly handle Unicode strings without forceing an encoding Set the sheet name. The sheet number(0 based). The name. Get the sheet name The sheet index. Sheet name Check whether a sheet is hidden The sheet index. true if sheet is hidden; otherwise, false. Check whether a sheet is very hidden. This is different from the normal hidden status The sheet index. true if sheet is very hidden; otherwise, false. Hide or Unhide a sheet The sheet index True to mark the sheet as hidden, false otherwise Hide or unhide a sheet. The sheet number 0 for not hidden, 1 for hidden, 2 for very hidden Returns the index of the sheet by his name the sheet name index of the sheet (0 based) Returns the index of the given sheet the sheet to look up index of the sheet (0 based).-1 if not found Returns the external sheet index of the sheet with the given internal index, creating one if needed. Used by some of the more obscure formula and named range things. Index of the internal sheet. Create an HSSFSheet for this HSSFWorkbook, Adds it to the sheets and returns the high level representation. Use this to Create new sheets. HSSFSheet representing the new sheet. Create an HSSFSheet from an existing sheet in the HSSFWorkbook. the sheet index HSSFSheet representing the Cloned sheet. Gets the name of the unique sheet. Name of the SRC. Create an HSSFSheet for this HSSFWorkbook, Adds it to the sheets and returns the high level representation. Use this to Create new sheets. sheetname to set for the sheet. HSSFSheet representing the new sheet. Get the number of spreadsheets in the workbook (this will be three after serialization) The number of sheets. Gets the sheets. Get the HSSFSheet object at the given index. index of the sheet number (0-based) HSSFSheet at the provided index Get sheet with the given name (case insensitive match) name of the sheet HSSFSheet with the name provided or null if it does not exist Removes sheet at the given index. index of the sheet (0-based) Care must be taken if the Removed sheet Is the currently active or only selected sheet in the workbook. There are a few situations when Excel must have a selection and/or active sheet. (For example when printing - see Bug 40414). This method makes sure that if the Removed sheet was active, another sheet will become active in its place. Furthermore, if the Removed sheet was the only selected sheet, another sheet will become selected. The newly active/selected sheet will have the same index, or one less if the Removed sheet was the last in the workbook. determine whether the Excel GUI will backup the workbook when saving. the current Setting for backups. Sets the repeating rows and columns for a sheet (as found in File->PageSetup->Sheet). This Is function Is included in the workbook because it Creates/modifies name records which are stored at the workbook level. 0 based index to sheet. 0 based start of repeating columns. 0 based end of repeating columns. 0 based start of repeating rows. 0 based end of repeating rows. To set just repeating columns: workbook.SetRepeatingRowsAndColumns(0,0,1,-1-1); To set just repeating rows: workbook.SetRepeatingRowsAndColumns(0,-1,-1,0,4); To remove all repeating rows and columns for a sheet. workbook.SetRepeatingRowsAndColumns(0,-1,-1,-1,-1); Create a new Font and Add it to the workbook's font table new font object Finds a font that matches the one with the supplied attributes The bold weight. The color. Height of the font. The name. if set to true [italic]. if set to true [strikeout]. The type offset. The underline. Get the number of fonts in the font table The number of fonts. Get the font at the given index number The index number HSSFFont at the index Reset the fonts cache, causing all new calls to getFontAt() to create new objects. Should only be called after deleting fonts, and that's not something you should normally do Create a new Cell style and Add it to the workbook's style table the new Cell Style object Get the number of styles the workbook Contains count of cell styles Get the cell style object at the given index index within the Set of styles HSSFCellStyle object at the index Closes the underlying {@link NPOIFSFileSystem} from which the Workbook was read, if any. Has no effect on Workbooks opened from an InputStream, or newly created ones. Write out this workbook to an Outputstream. Constructs a new POI POIFSFileSystem, passes in the workbook binary representation and Writes it out. the java OutputStream you wish to Write the XLS to Get the bytes of just the HSSF portions of the XLS file. Use this to construct a POI POIFSFileSystem yourself. byte[] array containing the binary representation of this workbook and all contained sheets, rows, cells, etc. The locator of user-defined functions. By default includes functions from the Excel Analysis Toolpack Register a new toolpack in this workbook. @param toopack the toolpack to register Gets the workbook. The workbook. Gets the total number of named ranges in the workboko The number of named ranges Gets the Named range position of the named range named range high level Gets the named range name the named range index (0 based) named range name TODO - make this less cryptic / move elsewhere Index to REF entry in EXTERNSHEET record in the Link Table zero-based to DEFINEDNAME or EXTERNALNAME record the string representation of the defined or external name Sets the printarea for the sheet provided i.e. Reference = $A$1:$B$2 Zero-based sheet index (0 Represents the first sheet to keep consistent with java) Valid name Reference for the Print Area Sets the print area. Zero-based sheet index (0 = First Sheet) Column to begin printarea Column to end the printarea Row to begin the printarea Row to end the printarea Retrieves the reference for the printarea of the specified sheet, the sheet name Is Appended to the reference even if it was not specified. Zero-based sheet index (0 Represents the first sheet to keep consistent with java) String Null if no print area has been defined Delete the printarea for the sheet specified Zero-based sheet index (0 = First Sheet) Creates a new named range and Add it to the model named range high level Gets the named range index by his name Note: Excel named ranges are case-insensitive and this method performs a case-insensitive search. named range name named range index As GetNameIndex(String) is not necessarily unique (name + sheet index is unique), this method is more accurate. the name whose index in the list of names of this workbook should be looked up. an index value >= 0 if the name was found; -1, if the name was not found Remove the named range by his index The named range index (0 based) Creates the instance of HSSFDataFormat for this workbook. the HSSFDataFormat object Remove the named range by his name named range name As #removeName(String) is not necessarily unique (name + sheet index is unique), this method is more accurate. the name to remove. Spits out a list of all the drawing records in the workbook. if set to true [fat]. Adds a picture to the workbook. The bytes of the picture The format of the picture. One of PictureType. the index to this picture (1 based). Gets all pictures from the Workbook. the list of pictures (a list of HSSFPictureData objects.) Performs a recursive search for pictures in the given list of escher records. the escher records. the list to populate with the pictures. Adds the LinkTable records required to allow formulas referencing the specified external workbook to be added to this one. Allows formulas such as "[MyOtherWorkbook]Sheet3!$A$5" to be added to the file, for workbooks not already referenced. The name the workbook will be referenced as in formulas The open workbook to fetch the link required information from Is the workbook protected with a password (not encrypted)? true if this instance is write protected; otherwise, false. protect a workbook with a password (not encypted, just Sets Writeprotect flags and the password. password to set The username. Removes the Write protect flag Gets all embedded OLE2 objects from the Workbook. the list of embedded objects (a list of HSSFObjectData objects.) Gets all embedded OLE2 objects from the Workbook. the list of records to search. the list of embedded objects to populate. Recursively iterates a shape container to get all embedded objects. the parent. the list of embedded objects to populate. Gets the new UID. The new UID. Support foreach ISheet, e.g. HSSFWorkbook workbook = new HSSFWorkbook(); foreach(ISheet sheet in workbook) ... Enumeration of all the sheets of this workbook Whether the application shall perform a full recalculation when the workbook is opened. Typically you want to force formula recalculation when you modify cell formulas or values of a workbook previously created by Excel. When set to true, this flag will tell Excel that it needs to recalculate all formulas in the workbook the next time the file is opened. Note, that recalculation updates cached formula results and, thus, modifies the workbook. Depending on the version, Excel may prompt you with "Do you want to save the changes in filename?" on close. Value is true if the application will perform a full recalculation of workbook values when the workbook is opened. since 3.8 Changes an external referenced file to another file. A formular in Excel which refers a cell in another file is saved in two parts: The referenced file is stored in an reference table. the row/cell information is saved separate. This method invokation will only change the reference in the lookup-table itself. @param oldUrl The old URL to search for and which is to be replaced @param newUrl The URL replacement @return true if the oldUrl was found and replaced with newUrl. Otherwise false This class Creates OperationEval instances to help evaluate OperationPtg formula tokens. @author Josh Micich returns the OperationEval concrete impl instance corresponding to the supplied operationPtg Allows the user to lookup the font metrics for a particular font without actually having the font on the system. The font details are Loaded as a resource from the POI jar file (or classpath) and should be contained in path "/font_metrics.properties". The font widths are for a 10 point version of the font. Use a multiplier for other sizes. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) The font metrics property file we're using Our cache of font details we've alReady looked up Retrieves the fake font details for a given font. @param font the font to lookup. @return the fake font. 4 bytes - little endian 2 bytes - little endian 2 bytes - little endian 8 bytes - serialized as big endian, stored with inverted endianness here Read a GUID in standard text form e.g.
13579BDF-0246-8ACE-0123-456789ABCDEF
->
0x13579BDF, 0x0246, 0x8ACE 0x0123456789ABCDEF

Title: HSSFCellRangeAddress

Description: Implementation of the cell range Address lists,like Is described in OpenOffice.org's Excel Documentation . In BIFF8 there Is a common way to store absolute cell range Address lists in several records (not formulas). A cell range Address list consists of a field with the number of ranges and the list of the range Addresses. Each cell range Address (called an AddR structure) Contains 4 16-bit-values.

Copyright: Copyright (c) 2004

Company:

@author Dragos Buleandra (dragos.buleandra@trade2b.ro) @version 2.0-pre
Number of following AddR structures List of AddR structures. Each structure represents a cell range Construct a new HSSFCellRangeAddress object and Sets its fields appropriately . Even this Isn't an Excel record , I kept the same behavior for reading/writing the object's data as for a regular record . @param in the RecordInputstream to read the record from Get the number of following AddR structures. The number of this structures Is automatically Set when reading an Excel file and/or increased when you manually Add a new AddR structure . This Is the reason there Isn't a Set method for this field . @return number of AddR structures Add an AddR structure . @param first_row - the upper left hand corner's row @param first_col - the upper left hand corner's col @param last_row - the lower right hand corner's row @param last_col - the lower right hand corner's col @return the index of this AddR structure Remove the AddR structure stored at the passed in index @param index The AddR structure's index return the AddR structure at the given index. @return AddrStructure representing Get the upper left hand corner column number @return column number for the upper left hand corner Get the upper left hand corner row number @return row number for the upper left hand corner Get the lower right hand corner column number @return column number for the lower right hand corner Get the lower right hand corner row number @return row number for the lower right hand corner Various utility functions that make working with a cells and rows easier. The various methods that deal with style's allow you to Create your HSSFCellStyles as you need them. When you apply a style change to a cell, the code will attempt to see if a style already exists that meets your needs. If not, then it will Create a new style. This is to prevent creating too many styles. there is an upper limit in Excel on the number of styles that can be supported. @author Eric Pugh epugh@upstate.com Get a row from the spreadsheet, and Create it if it doesn't exist. The 0 based row number The sheet that the row is part of. The row indicated by the rowCounter Get a specific cell from a row. If the cell doesn't exist, The row that the cell is part of The column index that the cell is in. The cell indicated by the column. Creates a cell, gives it a value, and applies a style if provided the row to Create the cell in the column index to Create the cell in The value of the cell If the style is not null, then Set A new HSSFCell Create a cell, and give it a value. the row to Create the cell in the column index to Create the cell in The value of the cell A new HSSFCell. Translate color palette entries from the source to the destination sheet Take a cell, and align it. the cell to Set the alignment for The workbook that is being worked with. the column alignment to use. Take a cell, and apply a font to it the cell to Set the alignment for The workbook that is being worked with. The HSSFFont that you want to Set... This method attempt to find an already existing HSSFCellStyle that matches what you want the style to be. If it does not find the style, then it Creates a new one. If it does Create a new one, then it applies the propertyName and propertyValue to the style. This is necessary because Excel has an upper limit on the number of Styles that it supports. @param workbook The workbook that is being worked with. @param propertyName The name of the property that is to be changed. @param propertyValue The value of the property that is to be changed. @param cell The cell that needs it's style changes @exception NestableException Thrown if an error happens. Returns a map containing the format properties of the given cell style. cell style map of format properties (String -> Object) Sets the format properties of the given style based on the given map. The cell style The parent workbook. The map of format properties (String -> Object). Utility method that returns the named short value form the given map. Returns zero if the property does not exist, or is not a {@link Short}. The map of named properties (String -> Object) The property name. property value, or zero Utility method that returns the named boolean value form the given map. Returns false if the property does not exist, or is not a {@link Boolean}. map of properties (String -> Object) The property name. property value, or false Utility method that Puts the named short value to the given map. The map of properties (String -> Object). The property name. The property value. Utility method that Puts the named boolean value to the given map. map of properties (String -> Object) property name property value Looks for text in the cell that should be unicode, like alpha; and provides the unicode version of it. The cell to check for unicode values transalted to unicode Intends to provide support for the very evil index to triplet Issue and will likely replace the color constants interface for HSSF 2.0. This class Contains static inner class members for representing colors. Each color has an index (for the standard palette in Excel (tm) ), native (RGB) triplet and string triplet. The string triplet Is as the color would be represented by Gnumeric. Having (string) this here Is a bit of a collusion of function between HSSF and the HSSFSerializer but I think its a reasonable one in this case. @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Brian Sanders (bsanders at risklabs dot com) - full default color palette Creates a new instance of HSSFColor this function returns all colors in a hastable. Its not implemented as a static member/staticly initialized because that would be dirty in a server environment as it Is intended. This means you'll eat the time it takes to Create it once per request but you will not hold onto it if you have none of those requests. @return a hashtable containing all colors keyed by int excel-style palette indexes This function returns all the Colours, stored in a Hashtable that can be edited. No caching is performed. If you don't need to edit the table, then call {@link #getIndexHash()} which returns a statically cached imuatable map of colours. this function returns all colors in a hastable. Its not implemented as a static member/staticly initialized because that would be dirty in a server environment as it Is intended. This means you'll eat the time it takes to Create it once per request but you will not hold onto it if you have none of those requests. a hashtable containing all colors keyed by String gnumeric-like triplets @return index to the standard palette @return triplet representation like that in Excel @return a hex string exactly like a gnumeric triplet Class BLACK Class BROWN Class OLIVE_GREEN Class DARK_GREEN Class DARK_TEAL Class DARK_BLUE Class INDIGO Class GREY_80_PERCENT Class DARK_RED Class ORANGE Class DARK_YELLOW Class GREEN Class TEAL Class BLUE Class BLUE_GREY Class GREY_50_PERCENT Class RED Class LIGHT_ORANGE Class LIME Class SEA_GREEN Class AQUA Class GREY_40_PERCENT Class TURQUOISE Class SKY_BLUE Class PLUM Class GREY_25_PERCENT Class ROSE Class TAN Class LIGHT_YELLOW Class LIGHT_GREEN Class LIGHT_TURQUOISE Class PALE_BLUE Class LAVENDER Class WHITE Class CORNFLOWER_BLUE Class LEMON_CHIFFON Class MAROON Class ORCHID Class CORAL Class ROYAL_BLUE Class LIGHT_CORNFLOWER_BLUE Special Default/Normal/Automatic color. Note: This class Is NOT in the default HashTables returned by HSSFColor. The index Is a special case which Is interpreted in the various SetXXXColor calls. @author Jason Various utility functions that make working with a region of cells easier. @author Eric Pugh epugh@upstate.com For setting the same property on many cells to the same value Sets the left border for a region of cells by manipulating the cell style of the individual cells on the left The new border The region that should have the border The sheet that the region is on. The workbook that the region is on. Sets the leftBorderColor attribute of the HSSFRegionUtil object The color of the border The region that should have the border The sheet that the region is on. The workbook that the region is on. Sets the borderRight attribute of the HSSFRegionUtil object The new border The region that should have the border The sheet that the region is on. The workbook that the region is on. Sets the rightBorderColor attribute of the HSSFRegionUtil object The color of the border The region that should have the border The workbook that the region is on. The sheet that the region is on. Sets the borderBottom attribute of the HSSFRegionUtil object The new border The region that should have the border The sheet that the region is on. The workbook that the region is on. Sets the bottomBorderColor attribute of the HSSFRegionUtil object The color of the border The region that should have the border The sheet that the region is on. The workbook that the region is on. Sets the borderBottom attribute of the HSSFRegionUtil object The new border The region that should have the border The sheet that the region is on. The workbook that the region is on. Sets the topBorderColor attribute of the HSSFRegionUtil object The color of the border The region that should have the border The sheet that the region is on. The workbook that the region is on. Utility for delaying the concatenation of multiple byte arrays. Doing this up-front causes significantly more copying, which for a large number of byte arrays can cost a large amount of time. Clears the array (sets the concatenated length back to zero. Concatenates an array onto the end of our array. This is a relatively fast operation. @param array the array to concatenate. @throws ArgumentException if {@code array} is {@code null}. Gets the concatenated contents as a single byte array. This is a slower operation, but the concatenated array is stored off as a single array again so that subsequent calls will not perform Additional copying. @return the byte array. Returns {@code null} if no data has been placed into it. * Title: Range Address * Description: provides connectivity utilities for ranges * * * REFERENCE: * @author IgOr KaTz & EuGeNe BuMaGiN (Tal Moshaiov) (VistaPortal LDT.) @version 1.0 Accepts an external reference from excel. i.e. Sheet1!$A$4:$B$9 @param _url @return String note: All absolute references are Removed Utility class for helping convert RK numbers. @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) @author Rolf-J黵gen Moll @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.MulRKRecord @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.RKRecord Do the dirty work of decoding; made a private static method to facilitate testing the algorithm This holds the common functionality for all POI Document classes. Currently, this relates to Document Information Properties @author Nick Burch Holds metadata on our document Holds further metadata on our document The directory that our document lives in For our own logging use Initializes a new instance of the class. The dir. The fs. Initializes a new instance of the class. The fs. Will create whichever of SummaryInformation and DocumentSummaryInformation (HPSF) properties are not already part of your document. This is normally useful when creating a new document from scratch. If the information properties are already there, then nothing will happen. Fetch the Document Summary Information of the document The document summary information. Fetch the Summary Information of the document The summary information. Find, and Create objects for, the standard Documment Information Properties (HPSF). If a given property Set is missing or corrupt, it will remain null; For a given named property entry, either return it or null if if it wasn't found Name of the set. Writes out the standard Documment Information Properties (HPSF) the POIFSFileSystem to Write the properties into Writes out the standard Documment Information Properties (HPSF) the POIFSFileSystem to Write the properties into. a list of POIFS entries to Add the property names too. Writes out a given ProperySet the (POIFS Level) name of the property to Write. the PropertySet to Write out. the POIFSFileSystem to Write the property into. Writes the document out to the specified output stream The out1. Copies nodes from one POIFS to the other minus the excepts the source POIFS to copy from. the target POIFS to copy to a list of Strings specifying what nodes NOT to copy Copies nodes from one POIFS to the other minus the excepts the source POIFS to copy from. the target POIFS to copy to a list of Strings specifying what nodes NOT to copy Checks to see if the String is in the list, used when copying nodes between one POIFS and another The entry. The list. true if [is in list] [the specified entry]; otherwise, false. Copies an Entry into a target POIFS directory, recursively The entry. The target.

A class describing attributes of the Big Block Size

Returns the value that Gets written into the header. Is the power of two that corresponds to the size of the block, eg 512 => 9 A repository for constants shared by POI classes. @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Most files use 512 bytes as their big block size Some use 4096 bytes Most files use 512 bytes as their big block size Most files use 512 bytes as their big block size How big a block in the small block stream is. Fixed size How big a single property is The minimum size of a document before it's stored using Big Blocks (normal streams). Smaller documents go in the Mini Stream (SBAT / Small Blocks) The highest sector number you're allowed, 0xFFFFFFFA Indicates the sector holds a FAT block (0xFFFFFFFD) Indicates the sector holds a DIFAT block (0xFFFFFFFC) Indicates the sector is the end of a chain (0xFFFFFFFE) Indicates the sector is not used (0xFFFFFFFF) The first 4 bytes of an OOXML file, used in detection Return a stream with decrypted data. Use {@link #getLength()} to get the size of that data that can be safely read from the stream. Just reading to the end of the input stream is not sufficient because there are normally padding bytes that must be discarded the node to read from decrypted stream Returns the length of the encytpted data that can be safely read with {@link #getDataStream(org.apache.poi.poifs.filesystem.DirectoryNode)}. Just reading to the end of the input stream is not sufficient because there are normally padding bytes that must be discarded The length variable is initialized in {@link #getDataStream(org.apache.poi.poifs.filesystem.DirectoryNode)}, an attempt to call getLength() prior to getDataStream() will result in IllegalStateException. return length of the encrypted data Interface for a drill-down viewable object. Such an object has content that may or may not be displayed, at the discretion of the viewer. The content is returned to the viewer as an array or as an Iterator, and the object provides a clue as to which technique the viewer should use to get its content. A POIFSViewable object is also expected to provide a short description of itself, that can be used by a viewer when the viewable object is collapsed. @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Provides a short description of the object to be used when a POIFSViewable object has not provided its contents. true if [prefer array]; otherwise, false. Gets the short description. The short description. Get an array of objects, some of which may implement POIFSViewable The viewable array. Give viewers a hint as to whether to call ViewableArray or ViewableIterator The viewable iterator. This class contains methods used to inspect POIFSViewable objects @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Inspect an object that may be viewable, and drill down if told to the object to be viewed if true and the object implements POIFSViewable, inspect the objects' contents how far in to indent each string string to use for indenting a List of Strings holding the content Indents the specified indent level. how far in to indent each string string to use for indenting The data. An event-driven Reader for POIFS file systems. Users of this class first Create an instance of it, then use the RegisterListener methods to Register POIFSReaderListener instances for specific documents. Once all the listeners have been Registered, the Read() method is called, which results in the listeners being notified as their documents are Read. @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Initializes a new instance of the class. Read from an InputStream and Process the documents we Get the InputStream from which to Read the data POIFSDocument list Register a POIFSReaderListener for all documents @param listener the listener to be registered @exception NullPointerException if listener is null @exception IllegalStateException if read() has already been called Register a POIFSReaderListener for a document in the root directory @param listener the listener to be registered @param name the document name @exception NullPointerException if listener is null or name is null or empty @exception IllegalStateException if read() has already been called Register a POIFSReaderListener for a document in the specified directory @param listener the listener to be registered @param path the document path; if null, the root directory is assumed @param name the document name @exception NullPointerException if listener is null or name is null or empty @exception IllegalStateException if read() has already been called Processes the properties. The small_blocks. The big_blocks. The properties. The path. Class POIFSReaderEvent @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) @version %I%, %G% package scoped constructor @param stream the DocumentInputStream, freshly opened @param path the path of the document @param documentName the name of the document @return the DocumentInputStream, freshly opened @return the document's path @return the document's name EventArgs for POIFSReader author: Tony Qu Interface POIFSReaderListener @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) @version %I%, %G% Process a POIFSReaderEvent that this listener had Registered for @param event the POIFSReaderEvent A registry for POIFSReaderListeners and the DocumentDescriptors of the documents those listeners are interested in @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) @version %I%, %G% Construct the registry Register a POIFSReaderListener for a particular document @param listener the listener @param path the path of the document of interest @param documentName the name of the document of interest Register for all documents @param listener the listener who wants to Get all documents Get am iterator of listeners for a particular document @param path the document path @param name the name of the document @return an Iterator POIFSReaderListeners; may be empty Class POIFSWriterEvent @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) @version %I%, %G% namespace scoped constructor @param stream the DocumentOutputStream, freshly opened @param path the path of the document @param documentName the name of the document @param limit the limit, in bytes, that can be written to the stream @return the DocumentOutputStream, freshly opened @return the document's path @return the document's name @return the limit on writing, in bytes EventArgs for POIFSWriter author: Tony Qu Initializes a new instance of the class. the POIFSDocumentWriter, freshly opened the path of the document the name of the document the limit, in bytes, that can be written to the stream Gets the limit on writing, in bytes The limit. Gets the document's name The name. Gets the document's path The path. the POIFSDocumentWriter, freshly opened The stream. Interface POIFSWriterListener @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) @version %I%, %G% Process a POIFSWriterEvent that this listener had registered for @param event the POIFSWriterEvent This interface defines behaviors for objects managed by the Block Allocation Table (BAT). @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Gets the number of BigBlock's this instance uses count of BigBlock instances Sets the start block for this instance index into the array of BigBlock instances making up the the filesystem This abstract class describes a way to read, store, chain and free a series of blocks (be they Big or Small ones) Returns the size of the blocks managed through the block store. Load the block at the given offset. Extends the file if required to hold blocks up to the specified offset, and return the block from there. Returns the BATBlock that handles the specified offset, and the relative index within it Works out what block follows the specified one. Changes the record of what block follows the specified one. Finds a free block, and returns its offset. This method will extend the file/stream if needed, and if doing so, allocate new FAT blocks to address the extra space. Creates a Detector for loops in the chain Used to detect if a chain has a loop in it, so we can bail out with an error rather than spinning away for ever... This interface defines methods specific to Directory objects managed by a Filesystem instance. @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) get an iterator of the Entry instances contained directly in this instance (in other words, children only; no grandchildren etc.) The entries.never null, but hasNext() may return false immediately (i.e., this DirectoryEntry is empty). All objects retrieved by next() are guaranteed to be implementations of Entry. get the names of all the Entries contained directly in this instance (in other words, names of children only; no grandchildren etc). the names of all the entries that may be retrieved with getEntry(String), which may be empty (if this DirectoryEntry is empty is this DirectoryEntry empty? true if this instance contains no Entry instances; otherwise, false. find out how many Entry instances are contained directly within this DirectoryEntry number of immediately (no grandchildren etc.) contained Entry instances get a specified Entry by name the name of the Entry to obtain. the specified Entry, if it is directly contained in this DirectoryEntry Create a new DocumentEntry the name of the new DocumentEntry the Stream from which to Create the new DocumentEntry the new DocumentEntry Create a new DocumentEntry; the data will be provided later the name of the new DocumentEntry the size of the new DocumentEntry BeforeWriting event handler the new DocumentEntry Create a new DirectoryEntry the name of the new DirectoryEntry the name of the new DirectoryEntry Gets or sets the storage ClassID. The storage ClassID. Checks if entry with specified name present entry name true if have Simple implementation of DirectoryEntry @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Create a DirectoryNode. This method Is not public by design; it Is intended strictly for the internal use of this package the DirectoryProperty for this DirectoryEntry the POIFSFileSystem we belong to the parent of this entry open a document in the directory's entry's list of entries the name of the document to be opened a newly opened DocumentStream Create a new DocumentEntry; the data will be provided later the name of the new documentEntry the new DocumentEntry Change a contained Entry's name the original name the new name true if the operation succeeded, else false Deletes the entry. the EntryNode to be Deleted true if the entry was Deleted, else false Gets the path. this directory's path representation get an iterator of the Entry instances contained directly in this instance (in other words, children only; no grandchildren etc.) The entries.never null, but hasNext() may return false immediately (i.e., this DirectoryEntry is empty). All objects retrieved by next() are guaranteed to be implementations of Entry. get the names of all the Entries contained directly in this instance (in other words, names of children only; no grandchildren etc). @return the names of all the entries that may be retrieved with getEntry(String), which may be empty (if this DirectoryEntry is empty) is this DirectoryEntry empty? true if this instance contains no Entry instances; otherwise, false. find out how many Entry instances are contained directly within this DirectoryEntry number of immediately (no grandchildren etc.) contained Entry instances get a specified Entry by name the name of the Entry to obtain. the specified Entry, if it is directly contained in this DirectoryEntry Create a new DirectoryEntry the name of the new DirectoryEntry the name of the new DirectoryEntry Gets or Sets the storage clsid for the directory entry The storage ClassID. Is this a DirectoryEntry? true if the Entry Is a DirectoryEntry, else false extensions use this method to verify internal rules regarding deletion of the underlying store. true if it's ok to Delete the underlying store, else false Get an array of objects, some of which may implement POIFSViewable an array of Object; may not be null, but may be empty Get an Iterator of objects, some of which may implement POIFSViewable an Iterator; may not be null, but may have an empty back end store Give viewers a hint as to whether to call GetViewableArray or GetViewableIterator true if a viewer should call GetViewableArray; otherwise, falseif a viewer should call GetViewableIterator Provides a short description of the object, to be used when a POIFSViewable object has not provided its contents. The short description. Class DocumentDescriptor @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Initializes a new instance of the class. the Document path the Document name Gets the path. The path. Gets the name. The name. equality. Two DocumentDescriptor instances are equal if they have equal paths and names the object we're checking equality for true if the object is equal to this object Serves as a hash function for a particular type. hashcode Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . This interface defines methods specific to Document objects managed by a Filesystem instance. @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) get the size of the document, in bytes size in bytes This class provides methods to read a DocumentEntry managed by a {@link POIFSFileSystem} or {@link NPOIFSFileSystem} instance. It Creates the appropriate one, and delegates, allowing us to work transparently with the two. returned by read operations if we're at end of document For use by downstream implementations Create an InputStream from the specified DocumentEntry @param document the DocumentEntry to be read @exception IOException if the DocumentEntry cannot be opened (like, maybe it has been deleted?) Create an InputStream from the specified Document @param document the Document to be read Create an InputStream from the specified Document @param document the Document to be read Tests if this input stream supports the mark and reset methods. @return true always Repositions this stream to the position at the time the mark() method was last called on this input stream. If mark() has not been called this method repositions the stream to its beginning. Simple implementation of DocumentEntry @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) create a DocumentNode. This method Is not public by design; it Is intended strictly for the internal use of this package @param property the DocumentProperty for this DocumentEntry @param parent the parent of this entry get the POIFSDocument @return the internal POIFSDocument get the zize of the document, in bytes @return size in bytes Is this a DocumentEntry? @return true if the Entry Is a DocumentEntry, else false extensions use this method to verify internal rules regarding deletion of the underlying store. @return true if it's ok to delete the underlying store, else false Get an array of objects, some of which may implement POIFSViewable @return an array of Object; may not be null, but may be empty Get an Iterator of objects, some of which may implement POIFSViewable @return an Iterator; may not be null, but may have an empty back end store Give viewers a hint as to whether to call getViewableArray or getViewableIterator @return true if a viewer should call getViewableArray, false if a viewer should call getViewableIterator Provides a short description of the object, to be used when a POIFSViewable object has not provided its contents. @return short description This class provides a wrapper over an OutputStream so that Document Writers can't accidently go over their size limits @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Create a DocumentOutputStream @param stream the OutputStream to which the data is actually read @param limit the maximum number of bytes that can be written Writes the specified byte to this output stream. The general contract for write is that one byte is written to the output stream. The byte to be written is the eight low-order bits of the argument b. The 24 high-order bits of b are ignored. @param b the byte. @exception IOException if an I/O error occurs. In particular, an IOException may be thrown if the output stream has been closed, or if the Writer tries to write too much data. Writes b.Length bytes from the specified byte array to this output stream. @param b the data. @exception IOException if an I/O error occurs. Writes len bytes from the specified byte array starting at offset off to this output stream. The general contract for Write(b, off, len) is that some of the bytes in the array b are written to the output stream in order; element b[off] is the first byte written and b[off+len-1] is the last byte written by this operation. the data. the start offset in the data. the number of bytes to Write. Flushes this output stream and forces any buffered output bytes to be written out Closes this output stream and releases any system resources associated with this stream. The general contract of close is that it closes the output stream. A closed stream cannot perform output operations and cannot be reopened. @exception IOException if an I/O error occurs. write the rest of the document's data (fill in at the end) @param totalLimit the actual number of bytes the corresponding document must fill @param fill the byte to fill remaining space with @exception IOException on I/O error This interface provides access to an object managed by a Filesystem instance. Entry objects are further divided into DocumentEntry and DirectoryEntry instances. @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Get the name of the Entry The name. Is this a DirectoryEntry? true if the Entry Is a DirectoryEntry; otherwise, false. Is this a DocumentEntry? true if the Entry Is a DocumentEntry; otherwise, false. Get this Entry's parent (the DirectoryEntry that owns this Entry). All Entry objects, except the root Entry, has a parent. this Entry's parent; null iff this Is the root Entry This property is moved to EntryNode Delete this Entry. ThIs operation should succeed, but there are special circumstances when it will not: If this Entry Is the root of the Entry tree, it cannot be deleted, as there Is no way to Create another one. If this Entry Is a directory, it cannot be deleted unless it Is empty. true if the Entry was successfully deleted, else false Rename this Entry. ThIs operation will fail if: There Is a sibling Entry (i.e., an Entry whose parent Is the same as this Entry's parent) with the same name. ThIs Entry Is the root of the Entry tree. Its name Is dictated by the Filesystem and many not be Changed. the new name for this Entry true if the operation succeeded, else false Abstract implementation of Entry Extending classes should override isDocument() or isDirectory(), as appropriate Extending classes must override isDeleteOK() @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Create a DocumentNode. ThIs method Is not public by design; it Is intended strictly for the internal use of extending classes the Property for this Entry the parent of this entry grant access to the property the property backing this entry Is this the root of the tree? true if this instance is root; otherwise, false. extensions use this method to verify internal rules regarding deletion of the underlying store. true if it's ok to Delete the underlying store; otherwise, false. Get the name of the Entry The name. Get the name of the Entry @return name Is this a DirectoryEntry? true if the Entry Is a DirectoryEntry; otherwise, false. Is this a DocumentEntry? true if the Entry Is a DocumentEntry; otherwise, false. Get this Entry's parent (the DocumentEntry that owns this Entry). All Entry objects, except the root Entry, has a parent. this Entry's parent; null iff this Is the root Entry Delete this Entry. ThIs operation should succeed, but there are special circumstances when it will not: If this Entry Is the root of the Entry tree, it cannot be deleted, as there Is no way to Create another one. If this Entry Is a directory, it cannot be deleted unless it Is empty. true if the Entry was successfully deleted, else false Rename this Entry. ThIs operation will fail if: There Is a sibling Entry (i.e., an Entry whose parent Is the same as this Entry's parent) with the same name. ThIs Entry Is the root of the Entry tree. Its name Is dictated by the Filesystem and many not be Changed. the new name for this Entry true if the operation succeeded, else false Copies an Entry into a target POIFS directory, recursively Copies all the nodes from one POIFS Directory to another @param sourceRoot is the source Directory to copy from @param targetRoot is the target Directory to copy to Copies nodes from one Directory to the other minus the excepts @param filteredSource The filtering source Directory to copy from @param filteredTarget The filtering target Directory to copy to Copies nodes from one Directory to the other minus the excepts @param sourceRoot is the source Directory to copy from @param targetRoot is the target Directory to copy to @param excepts is a list of Strings specifying what nodes NOT to copy @deprecated use {@link FilteringDirectoryNode} instead Copies all nodes from one POIFS to the other @param source is the source POIFS to copy from @param target is the target POIFS to copy to Copies nodes from one POIFS to the other, minus the excepts. This delegates the filtering work to {@link FilteringDirectoryNode}, so excepts can be of the form "NodeToExclude" or "FilteringDirectory/ExcludedChildNode" @param source is the source POIFS to copy from @param target is the target POIFS to copy to @param excepts is a list of Entry Names to be excluded from the copy Checks to see if the two Directories hold the same contents. For this to be true, they must have entries with the same names, no entries in one but not the other, and the size+contents of each entry must match, and they must share names. To exclude certain parts of the Directory from being checked, use a {@link FilteringDirectoryNode} Checks to see if two Documents have the same name and the same contents. (Their parent directories are not checked) A DirectoryEntry filter, which exposes another DirectoryEntry less certain parts. This is typically used when copying or comparing Filesystems. Creates a filter round the specified directory, which will exclude entries such as "MyNode" and "MyDir/IgnoreNode". The excludes can stretch into children, if they contain a /. The Directory to filter The Entries to exclude This class provides methods to read a DocumentEntry managed by a {@link NPOIFSFileSystem} instance. current offset into the Document current block count current marked offset into the Document (used by mark and Reset) and the block count for it the Document's size have we been closed? the actual Document Create an InputStream from the specified DocumentEntry @param document the DocumentEntry to be read @exception IOException if the DocumentEntry cannot be opened (like, maybe it has been deleted?) Create an InputStream from the specified Document @param document the Document to be read Repositions this stream to the position at the time the mark() method was last called on this input stream. If mark() has not been called this method repositions the stream to its beginning. This class provides methods to write a DocumentEntry managed by a {@link NPOIFSFileSystem} instance. the Document's size have we been closed? the actual Document and its Property our buffer, when null we're into normal blocks our main block stream, when we're into normal blocks Create an OutputStream from the specified DocumentEntry. The specified entry will be emptied. @param document the DocumentEntry to be written Create an OutputStream to create the specified new Entry @param parent Where to create the Entry @param name Name of the new entry This exception is thrown when we try to open a file that doesn't seem to actually be an OLE2 file After all This class manages a document in the NIO POIFS filesystem. This is the {@link NPOIFSFileSystem} version. Constructor for an existing Document Constructor for an existing Document Constructor for a new Document @param name the name of the POIFSDocument @param stream the InputStream we read data from Frees the underlying stream and property @return size of the document @return the instance's DocumentProperty Get an array of objects, some of which may implement POIFSViewable @return an array of Object; may not be null, but may be empty Get an Iterator of objects, some of which may implement POIFSViewable @return an Iterator; may not be null, but may have an empty back end store Provides a short description of the object, to be used when a POIFSViewable object has not provided its contents. @return short description This is the main class of the POIFS system; it manages the entire life cycle of the filesystem. This is the new NIO version Convenience method for clients that want to avoid the auto-close behaviour of the constructor. What big block size the file uses. Most files use 512 bytes, but a few use 4096 Constructor, intended for writing

Creates a POIFSFileSystem from a File. This uses less memory than creating from an InputStream.

Note that with this constructor, you will need to call {@link #close()} when you're done to have the underlying file closed, as the file is kept open during normal operation to read the data out.

@param file the File from which to read or read/write the data @param readOnly whether the POIFileSystem will only be used in read-only mode @exception IOException on errors reading, or on invalid data
*

Creates a POIFSFileSystem from an open FileChannel. This uses * less memory than creating from an InputStream. The stream will * be used in read-only mode.

* *

Note that with this constructor, you will need to call {@link #close()} * when you're done to have the underlying Channel closed, as the channel is * kept open during normal operation to read the data out.

* * @param channel the FileChannel from which to read the data * * @exception IOException on errors reading, or on invalid data

Creates a POIFSFileSystem from an open FileChannel. This uses less memory than creating from an InputStream.

Note that with this constructor, you will need to call {@link #close()} when you're done to have the underlying Channel closed, as the channel is kept open during normal operation to read the data out.

@param channel the FileChannel from which to read or read/write the data @param readOnly whether the POIFileSystem will only be used in read-only mode @exception IOException on errors reading, or on invalid data
Create a POIFSFileSystem from an InputStream. Normally the stream is read until EOF. The stream is always closed.

Some streams are usable After reaching EOF (typically those that return true for markSupported()). In the unlikely case that the caller has such a stream and needs to use it After this constructor completes, a work around is to wrap the stream in order to trap the close() call. A convenience method ( CreateNonClosingInputStream()) has been provided for this purpose:

             InputStream wrappedStream = POIFSFileSystem.CreateNonClosingInputStream(is);
             HSSFWorkbook wb = new HSSFWorkbook(wrappedStream);
             is.Reset();
             doSomethingElse(is);
             
Note also the special case of MemoryStream for which the close() method does nothing.
             MemoryStream bais = ...
             HSSFWorkbook wb = new HSSFWorkbook(bais); // calls bais.Close() !
             bais.Reset(); // no problem
             doSomethingElse(bais);
             
@param stream the InputStream from which to read the data @exception IOException on errors Reading, or on invalid data
@param stream the stream to be closed @param success false if an exception is currently being thrown in the calling method Checks that the supplied InputStream (which MUST support mark and reset, or be a PushbackInputStream) has a POIFS (OLE2) header at the start of it. If your InputStream does not support mark / reset, then wrap it in a PushBackInputStream, then be sure to always use that, and not the original! @param inp An InputStream which supports either mark/reset, or is a PushbackInputStream Checks if the supplied first 8 bytes of a stream / file has a POIFS (OLE2) header. Read and process the PropertiesTable and the FAT / XFAT blocks, so that we're Ready to work with the file Load the block at the given offset. Load the block at the given offset, extending the file if needed Returns the BATBlock that handles the specified offset, and the relative index within it Works out what block follows the specified one. Changes the record of what block follows the specified one. Finds a free block, and returns its offset. This method will extend the file if needed, and if doing so, allocate new FAT blocks to Address the extra space. For unit Testing only! Returns the underlying properties table Returns the MiniStore, which performs a similar low level function to this, except for the small blocks. add a new POIFSDocument to the FileSytem @param document the POIFSDocument being Added add a new DirectoryProperty to the FileSystem @param directory the DirectoryProperty being Added Create a new document to be Added to the root directory @param stream the InputStream from which the document's data will be obtained @param name the name of the new POIFSDocument @return the new DocumentEntry @exception IOException on error creating the new POIFSDocument create a new DocumentEntry in the root entry; the data will be provided later @param name the name of the new DocumentEntry @param size the size of the new DocumentEntry @param Writer the Writer of the new DocumentEntry @return the new DocumentEntry @exception IOException create a new DirectoryEntry in the root directory @param name the name of the new DirectoryEntry @return the new DirectoryEntry @exception IOException on name duplication Write the filesystem out to the open file. Will thrown an {@link ArgumentException} if opened from an {@link InputStream}. @exception IOException thrown on errors writing to the stream Write the filesystem out @param stream the OutputStream to which the filesystem will be written @exception IOException thrown on errors writing to the stream Has our in-memory objects write their state to their backing blocks Closes the FileSystem, freeing any underlying files, streams and buffers. After this, you will be unable to read or write from the FileSystem. Get the root entry @return the root entry open a document in the root entry's list of entries @param documentName the name of the document to be opened @return a newly opened DocumentInputStream @exception IOException if the document does not exist or the name is that of a DirectoryEntry remove an entry @param entry to be Removed Get an array of objects, some of which may implement POIFSViewable @return an array of Object; may not be null, but may be empty Get an Iterator of objects, some of which may implement POIFSViewable @return an Iterator; may not be null, but may have an empty back end store Provides a short description of the object, to be used when a POIFSViewable object has not provided its contents. @return short description @return The Big Block size, normally 512 bytes, sometimes 4096 bytes @return The Big Block size, normally 512 bytes, sometimes 4096 bytes This class handles the MiniStream (small block store) in the NIO case for {@link NPOIFSFileSystem} Load the block at the given offset. Load the block, extending the underlying stream if needed Returns the BATBlock that handles the specified offset, and the relative index within it Works out what block follows the specified one. Changes the record of what block follows the specified one. Finds a free block, and returns its offset. This method will extend the file if needed, and if doing so, allocate new FAT blocks to Address the extra space. Writes the SBATs to their backing blocks This handles Reading and writing a stream within a {@link NPOIFSFileSystem}. It can supply an iterator to read blocks, and way to write out to existing and new blocks. Most users will want a higher level version of this, which deals with properties to track which stream this is. This only works on big block streams, it doesn't handle small block ones. This uses the new NIO code TODO Implement a streaming write method, and append Constructor for an existing stream. It's up to you to know how to Get the start block (eg from a {@link HeaderBlock} or a {@link Property}) Constructor for a new stream. A start block won't be allocated until you begin writing to it. What block does this stream start at? Will be {@link POIFSConstants#END_OF_CHAIN} for a new stream that hasn't been written to yet. Returns an iterator that'll supply one {@link ByteBuffer} per block in the stream. Updates the contents of the stream to the new Set of bytes. Note - if this is property based, you'll still need to update the size in the property yourself Frees all blocks in the stream This class provides methods to read a DocumentEntry managed by a {@link POIFSFileSystem} instance. @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) current offset into the Document current marked offset into the Document (used by mark and Reset) the Document's size have we been closed? the actual Document the data block Containing the current stream pointer Create an InputStream from the specified DocumentEntry @param document the DocumentEntry to be read @exception IOException if the DocumentEntry cannot be opened (like, maybe it has been deleted?) Create an InputStream from the specified Document @param document the Document to be read Repositions this stream to the position at the time the mark() method was last called on this input stream. If mark() has not been called this method repositions the stream to its beginning. This exception is thrown when we try to open a file that's actually an Office 2007+ XML file, rather than an OLE2 file (which is what POIFS works with) Represents an Ole10Native record which is wrapped around certain binary files being embedded in OLE2 documents. @author Rainer Schwarze the field encoding mode - merely a try-and-error guess ... the data is stored in parsed format - including label, command, etc. the data is stored raw after the length field the data is stored raw after the length field and the flags1 field Creates an instance of this class from an embedded OLE Object. The OLE Object is expected to include a stream "{01}Ole10Native" which Contains the actual data relevant for this class. poifs POI Filesystem object Returns an instance of this class Creates an instance of this class from an embedded OLE Object. The OLE Object is expected to include a stream "{01}Ole10Native" which contains the actual data relevant for this class. directory POI Filesystem object Returns an instance of this class Creates an instance and fills the fields based on ... the fields Creates an instance and Fills the fields based on the data in the given buffer. @param data The buffer Containing the Ole10Native record @param offset The start offset of the record in the buffer @param plain as of POI 3.11 this parameter is ignored @throws Ole10NativeException on invalid or unexcepted data format Creates an instance and Fills the fields based on the data in the given buffer. @param data The buffer Containing the Ole10Native record @param offset The start offset of the record in the buffer @throws Ole10NativeException on invalid or unexcepted data format Returns the value of the totalSize field - the total length of the structure is totalSize + 4 (value of this field + size of this field). @return the totalSize Returns flags1 - currently unknown - usually 0x0002. @return the flags1 Returns the label field - usually the name of the file (without directory) but probably may be any name specified during packaging/embedding the data. @return the label Returns the fileName field - usually the name of the file being embedded including the full path. @return the fileName Returns flags2 - currently unknown - mostly 0x0000. @return the flags2 Returns unknown1 field - currently unknown. @return the unknown1 Returns the command field - usually the name of the file being embedded including the full path, may be a command specified during embedding the file. @return the command Returns the size of the embedded file. If the size is 0 (zero), no data has been embedded. To be sure, that no data has been embedded, check whether {@link #getDataBuffer()} returns null. @return the dataSize Returns the buffer Containing the embedded file's data, or null if no data was embedded. Note that an embedding may provide information about the data, but the actual data is not included. (So label, filename etc. are available, but this method returns null.) @return the dataBuffer Returns the flags3 - currently unknown. @return the flags3 Have the contents printer out into an OutputStream, used when writing a file back out to disk (Normally, atom classes will keep their bytes around, but non atom classes will just request the bytes from their children, then chuck on their header and return) This class manages a document in the POIFS filesystem. @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Initializes a new instance of the class. the name of the POIFSDocument the InputStream we read data from Constructor from small blocks the name of the POIFSDocument the small blocks making up the POIFSDocument the actual length of the POIFSDocument read data from the internal stores the buffer to write to the offset into our storage to read from Writes the blocks. The stream. Gets the number of BigBlock's this instance uses count of BigBlock instances Gets the document property. The document property. Provides a short description of the object to be used when a POIFSViewable object has not provided its contents. true if [prefer array]; otherwise, false. Gets the short description. The short description. Gets the size. The size. Gets the small blocks. The small blocks. Sets the start block for this instance index into the array of BigBlock instances making up the the filesystem Get an array of objects, some of which may implement POIFSViewable The viewable array. Give viewers a hint as to whether to call ViewableArray or ViewableIterator The viewable iterator. Class POIFSDocumentPath @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) simple constructor for the path of a document that is in the root of the POIFSFileSystem. The constructor that takes an array of Strings can also be used to create such a POIFSDocumentPath by passing it a null or empty String array constructor for the path of a document that is not in the root of the POIFSFileSystem the Strings making up the path to a document. The Strings must be ordered as they appear in the directory hierarchy of the the document -- the first string must be the name of a directory in the root of the POIFSFileSystem, and every Nth (for N > 1) string thereafter must be the name of a directory in the directory identified by the (N-1)th string. If the components parameter is null or has zero length, the POIFSDocumentPath is appropriate for a document that is in the root of a POIFSFileSystem constructor that adds additional subdirectories to an existing path the existing path the additional subdirectory names to be added equality. Two POIFSDocumentPath instances are equal if they have the same number of component Strings, and if each component String is equal to its coresponding component String the object we're checking equality for true if the object is equal to this object get the specified component which component (0 ... length() - 1) the nth component; Serves as a hash function for a particular type. A hash code for the current . Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Gets the length. the number of components Returns the path's parent or null if this path is the root path. path of parent, or null if this path is the root path This class provides methods to read a DocumentEntry managed by a Filesystem instance. @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Create an InputStream from the specified DocumentEntry the DocumentEntry to be read Create an InputStream from the specified Document the Document to be read at the end Of document. Returns the number of bytes that can be read (or skipped over) from this input stream without blocking by the next caller of a method for this input stream. The next caller might be the same thread or or another thread. the number of bytes that can be read from this input stream without blocking. Closes the current stream and releases any resources (such as sockets and file handles) associated with the current stream. Reads some number of bytes from the input stream and stores them into the buffer array b. The number of bytes actually read is returned as an integer. The definition of this method in java.io.InputStream allows this method to block, but it won't. If b is null, a NullPointerException is thrown. If the length of b is zero, then no bytes are read and 0 is returned; otherwise, there is an attempt to read at least one byte. If no byte is available because the stream is at end of file, the value -1 is returned; otherwise, at least one byte is read and stored into b. The first byte read is stored into element b[0], the next one into b[1], and so on. The number of bytes read is, at most, equal to the length of b. Let k be the number of bytes actually read; these bytes will be stored in elements b[0] through b[k-1], leaving elements b[k] through b[b.length-1] unaffected. If the first byte cannot be read for any reason other than end of file, then an IOException is thrown. In particular, an IOException is thrown if the input stream has been closed. The read(b) method for class InputStream has the same effect as: the buffer into which the data is read. the total number of bytes read into the buffer, or -1 if there is no more data because the end of the stream has been reached. Reads up to len bytes of data from the input stream into an array of bytes. An attempt is made to read as many as len bytes, but a smaller number may be read, possibly zero. The number of bytes actually read is returned as an integer. The definition of this method in java.io.InputStream allows it to block, but it won't. If b is null, a NullPointerException is thrown. If off is negative, or len is negative, or off+len is greater than the length of the array b, then an IndexOutOfBoundsException is thrown. If len is zero, then no bytes are read and 0 is returned; otherwise, there is an attempt to read at least one byte. If no byte is available because the stream is at end of file, the value -1 is returned; otherwise, at least one byte is read and stored into b. The first byte read is stored into element b[off], the next one into b[off+1], and so on. The number of bytes read is, at most, equal to len. Let k be the number of bytes actually read; these bytes will be stored in elements b[off] through b[off+k-1], leaving elements b[off+k] through b[off+len-1] unaffected. In every case, elements b[0] through b[off] and elements b[off+len] through b[b.length-1] are unaffected. If the first byte cannot be read for any reason other than end of file, then an IOException is thrown. In particular, an IOException is thrown if the input stream has been closed. the buffer into which the data is read. the start offset in array b at which the data is written. the maximum number of bytes to read. the total number of bytes read into the buffer, or -1 if there is no more data because the end of the stream has been reached. Reads the next byte of data from the input stream. The value byte is returned as an int in the range 0 to 255. If no byte is available because the end of the stream has been reached, the value -1 is returned. The definition of this method in java.io.InputStream allows this method to block, but it won't. the next byte of data, or -1 if the end of the stream is reached. When overridden in a derived class, sets the position within the current stream. A byte offset relative to the parameter. A value of type indicating the reference point used to obtain the new position. The new position within the current stream. An I/O error occurs. The stream does not support seeking, such as if the stream is constructed from a pipe or console output. Methods were called after the stream was closed. Skips the specified n. The n. When overridden in a derived class, writes a sequence of bytes to the current stream and advances the current position within this stream by the number of bytes written. An array of bytes. This method copies bytes from to the current stream. The zero-based byte offset in at which to begin copying bytes to the current stream. The number of bytes to be written to the current stream. The sum of and is greater than the buffer length. is null. or is negative. An I/O error occurs. The stream does not support writing. Methods were called after the stream was closed. When overridden in a derived class, gets a value indicating whether the current stream supports reading. true if the stream supports reading; otherwise, false. When overridden in a derived class, gets a value indicating whether the current stream supports seeking. true if the stream supports seeking; otherwise, false. When overridden in a derived class, gets a value indicating whether the current stream supports writing. true if the stream supports writing; otherwise, false. When overridden in a derived class, gets the length in bytes of the stream. A long value representing the length of the stream in bytes. A class derived from Stream does not support seeking. Methods were called after the stream was closed. When overridden in a derived class, gets or sets the position within the current stream. The current position within the stream. An I/O error occurs. The stream does not support seeking. Methods were called after the stream was closed. This class provides a wrapper over an OutputStream so that Document writers can't accidently go over their size limits @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Create a POIFSDocumentWriter the OutputStream to which the data is actually the maximum number of bytes that can be written Closes this output stream and releases any system resources associated with this stream. The general contract of close is that it closes the output stream. A closed stream cannot perform output operations and cannot be reopened. Flushes this output stream and forces any buffered output bytes to be written out. Writes b.length bytes from the specified byte array to this output stream. the data. Writes len bytes from the specified byte array starting at offset off to this output stream. The general contract for write(b, off, len) is that some of the bytes in the array b are written to the output stream in order; element b[off] is the first byte written and b[off+len-1] is the last byte written by this operation. If b is null, a NullPointerException is thrown. If off is negative, or len is negative, or off+len is greater than the length of the array b, then an IndexOutOfBoundsException is thrown. the data. the start offset in the data. the number of bytes to write. Writes the specified byte to this output stream. The general contract for write is that one byte is written to the output stream. The byte to be written is the eight low-order bits of the argument b. The 24 high-order bits of b are ignored. the byte. write the rest of the document's data (fill in at the end) the actual number of bytes the corresponding document must fill the byte to fill remaining space with When overridden in a derived class, gets a value indicating whether the current stream supports reading. true if the stream supports reading; otherwise, false. When overridden in a derived class, gets a value indicating whether the current stream supports seeking. true if the stream supports seeking; otherwise, false. When overridden in a derived class, gets a value indicating whether the current stream supports writing. true if the stream supports writing; otherwise, false. When overridden in a derived class, gets the length in bytes of the stream. A long value representing the length of the stream in bytes. A class derived from Stream does not support seeking. Methods were called after the stream was closed. When overridden in a derived class, gets or sets the position within the current stream. The current position within the stream. An I/O error occurs. The stream does not support seeking. Methods were called after the stream was closed. This is the main class of the POIFS system; it manages the entire life cycle of the filesystem. @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Convenience method for clients that want to avoid the auto-Close behaviour of the constructor. The stream. A convenience method ( CreateNonClosingInputStream()) has been provided for this purpose: StreamwrappedStream = POIFSFileSystem.CreateNonClosingInputStream(is); HSSFWorkbook wb = new HSSFWorkbook(wrappedStream); is.reset(); doSomethingElse(is); What big block size the file uses. Most files use 512 bytes, but a few use 4096 Initializes a new instance of the class. intended for writing Create a POIFSFileSystem from an Stream. Normally the stream is Read until EOF. The stream is always Closed. In the unlikely case that the caller has such a stream and needs to use it after this constructor completes, a work around is to wrap the stream in order to trap the Close() call. the Streamfrom which to Read the data @param stream the stream to be Closed @param success false if an exception is currently being thrown in the calling method Checks that the supplied Stream(which MUST support mark and reset, or be a PushbackInputStream) has a POIFS (OLE2) header at the start of it. If your Streamdoes not support mark / reset, then wrap it in a PushBackInputStream, then be sure to always use that, and not the original! An Streamwhich supports either mark/reset, or is a PushbackStream true if [has POIFS header] [the specified inp]; otherwise, false. Create a new document to be Added to the root directory the Streamfrom which the document's data will be obtained the name of the new POIFSDocument the new DocumentEntry Create a new DocumentEntry in the root entry; the data will be provided later the name of the new DocumentEntry the size of the new DocumentEntry the Writer of the new DocumentEntry the new DocumentEntry Create a new DirectoryEntry in the root directory the name of the new DirectoryEntry the new DirectoryEntry open a document in the root entry's list of entries @param documentName the name of the document to be opened @return a newly opened DocumentInputStream @exception IOException if the document does not exist or the name is that of a DirectoryEntry Writes the file system. the OutputStream to which the filesystem will be written Get the root entry The root. Add a new POIFSDocument the POIFSDocument being Added Add a new DirectoryProperty The directory. Removes the specified entry. The entry. Get an array of objects, some of which may implement POIFSViewable an array of Object; may not be null, but may be empty Get an Iterator of objects, some of which may implement POIFSViewable an Iterator; may not be null, but may have an empty back end store Give viewers a hint as to whether to call GetViewableArray or GetViewableIterator true if a viewer should call GetViewableArray, false if a viewer should call GetViewableIterator Provides a short description of the object, to be used when a POIFSViewable object has not provided its contents. The short description. Gets The Big Block size, normally 512 bytes, sometimes 4096 bytes The size of the big block. A POIFS backed by a byte array. Common definition of how we read and write bytes Close the underlying stream Copies the contents to the specified Stream A POIFS DataSource backed by a File TODO - Return the ByteBuffers in such a way that in RW mode, changes to the buffer end up on the disk (will fix the HPSF TestWrite currently failing unit test when done) Reads a sequence of bytes from this FileStream starting at the given file position. The file position at which the transfer is to begin; Writes a sequence of bytes to this FileStream from the given Stream, starting at the given file position. The Stream from which bytes are to be transferred The file position at which the transfer is to begin; must be non-negative This interface defines methods for finding and setting sibling Property instances @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Gets or sets the previous child. The previous child. Gets or sets the next child. The next child. Trivial extension of Property for POIFSDocuments @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Initializes a new instance of the class. the name of the directory Initializes a new instance of the class. index number byte data offset into byte data Change a Property's name the Property whose name Is being Changed. the new name for the Property true if the name Change could be made, else false Delete a Property the Property being Deleted true if the Property could be Deleted, else false Directory Property Comparer Object equality, implemented as object identity Object we're being Compared to true if identical, else false Compare method. Assumes both parameters are non-null instances of Property. One property is less than another if its name is shorter than the other property's name. If the names are the same length, the property whose name comes before the other property's name, alphabetically, is less than the other property. first object to compare, better be a Property second object to compare, better be a Property negative value if o1 smaller than o2, zero if o1 equals o2, positive value if o1 bigger than o2. Gets a value indicating whether this instance is directory. true if a directory type Property; otherwise, false. Perform whatever activities need to be performed prior to writing Get an iterator over the children of this Parent; all elements are instances of Property. Iterator of children; may refer to an empty collection Add a new child to the collection of children the new child to be added; must not be null Trivial extension of Property for POIFSDocuments @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Initializes a new instance of the class. POIFSDocument name POIFSDocument size Initializes a new instance of the class. index number byte data offset into byte data Gets or sets the document. the associated POIFSDocument Determines whether this instance is directory. true if this instance is directory; otherwise, false. Perform whatever activities need to be performed prior to writing Update the size of the property's data Prepare to be written Behavior for parent (directory) properties @author Marc Johnson27591@hotmail.com Get an iterator over the children of this Parent all elements are instances of Property. Add a new child to the collection of children the new child to be added; must not be null Sets the previous child. Sets the next child. This abstract base class is the ancestor of all classes implementing POIFS Property behavior. @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Initializes a new instance of the class. Constructor from byte data index number byte data offset into byte data Write the raw data to an OutputStream. the OutputStream to which the data Should be written. Gets or sets the start block for the document referred to by this Property. the start block index Based on the currently defined size, Should this property use small blocks? true if the size Is less than _big_block_minimum_bytes does the length indicate a small document? length in bytes true if the length Is less than _big_block_minimum_bytes; otherwise, false. Gets or sets the name of this property property name Gets a value indicating whether this instance is directory. true if a directory type Property; otherwise, false. Gets or sets the storage class ID for this property stream. ThIs Is the Class ID of the COM object which can read and write this property stream Storage Class ID Set the property type. Makes no attempt to validate the value. the property type (root, file, directory) Sets the color of the node. the node color (red or black) Sets the child property. the child property's index in the Property Table Get the child property (its index in the Property Table) The index of the child. Gets or sets the size of the document associated with this Property the size of the document, in bytes Gets or sets the index. The index. Get the index for this Property @return the index of this Property within its Property Table Perform whatever activities need to be performed prior to writing Gets the index of the next child. The index of the next child. Gets the index of the previous child. The index of the previous child. Determines whether the specified index Is valid value to be checked true if the index Is valid; otherwise, false. Gets or sets the previous child. the new 'previous' child; may be null, which has the effect of saying there Is no 'previous' child Gets or sets the next Child the new 'next' child; may be null, which has the effect of saying there Is no 'next' child Get an array of objects, some of which may implement POIFSViewable an array of Object; may not be null, but may be empty Get an Iterator of objects, some of which may implement POIFSViewable may not be null, but may have an empty back end store Give viewers a hint as to whether to call GetViewableArray or GetViewableIterator true if a viewer Should call GetViewableArray; otherwise, false if a viewer Should call GetViewableIterator Provides a short description of the object, to be used when a POIFSViewable object has not provided its contents. The short description. Constants used by Properties namespace Convert raw data blocks to an array of Property's The blocks to be converted the converted List of Property objects. May contain nulls, but will not be null Default constructor reading constructor (used when we've read in a file and we want to extract the property table from it). Populates the properties thoroughly @param startBlock the first block of the property table @param blockList the list of blocks @exception IOException if anything goes wrong (which should be a result of the input being NFG) Prepare to be written Leon Return the number of BigBlock's this instance uses @return count of BigBlock instances Write the storage to an Stream @param stream the Stream to which the stored data should be written @exception IOException on problems writing to the specified stream Initializes a new instance of the class. index number byte data offset into byte data Gets or sets the size of the document associated with this Property the size of the document, in bytes A block of block allocation table entries. BATBlocks are created only through a static factory method: createBATBlocks. @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) For a regular fat block, these are 128 / 1024 next sector values. For a XFat (DIFat) block, these are 127 / 1023 next sector values, then a chaining value. Does this BATBlock have any free sectors in it? Where in the file are we? Create a single instance initialized with default values Create a single instance initialized (perhaps partially) with entries @param entries the array of block allocation table entries @param start_index the index of the first entry to be written to the block @param end_index the index, plus one, of the last entry to be written to the block (writing is for all index k, start_index <= k < end_index) Create a single BATBlock from the byte buffer, which must hold at least one big block of data to be read. ** Create an array of BATBlocks from an array of int block allocation table entries the poifs bigBlockSize the array of int entries the newly created array of BATBlocks Create an array of XBATBlocks from an array of int block allocation table entries the array of int entries the start block of the array of XBAT blocks the newly created array of BATBlocks Calculate how many BATBlocks are needed to hold a specified number of BAT entries. the number of entries the number of BATBlocks needed Calculate how many XBATBlocks are needed to hold a specified number of BAT entries. the number of entries the number of XBATBlocks needed Calculates the maximum size of a file which is addressable given the number of FAT (BAT) sectors specified. (We don't care if those BAT blocks come from the 109 in the header, or from header + XBATS, it won't affect the calculation) The actual file size will be between [size of fatCount-1 blocks] and [size of fatCount blocks]. For 512 byte block sizes, this means we may over-estimate by up to 65kb. For 4096 byte block sizes, this means we may over-estimate by up to 4mb Gets the entries per block. The number of entries per block Gets the entries per XBAT block. number of entries per XBAT block Gets the XBAT chain offset. offset of chain index of XBAT block Does this BATBlock have any free sectors in it, or is it full? Retrieve where in the file we live Create a single instance initialized (perhaps partially) with entries the array of block allocation table entries the index of the first entry to be written to the block the index, plus one, of the last entry to be written to the block (writing is for all index k, start_index less than k less than end_index) Write the block's data to an Stream the Stream to which the stored data should be written Abstract base class of all POIFS block storage classes. All extensions of BigBlock should write 512 bytes of data when requested to write their data. This class has package scope, as there is no reason at this time to make the class public. @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Default implementation of write for extending classes that contain their data in a simple array of bytes. the OutputStream to which the data should be written. the byte array of to be written. Write the block's data to an OutputStream the OutputStream to which the stored data should be written Write the storage to an OutputStream the OutputStream to which the stored data should be written This class manages and creates the Block Allocation Table, which is basically a set of linked lists of block indices. Each block of the filesystem has an index. The first block, the header, is skipped; the first block after the header is index 0, the next is index 1, and so on. A block's index is also its index into the Block Allocation Table. The entry that it finds in the Block Allocation Table is the index of the next block in the linked list of blocks making up a file, or it is set to -2: end of list. @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) create a BlockAllocationTableReader for an existing filesystem. Side effect: when this method finishes, the BAT blocks will have been Removed from the raw block list, and any blocks labeled as 'unused' in the block allocation table will also have been Removed from the raw block list. the poifs bigBlockSize the number of BAT blocks making up the block allocation table the array of BAT block indices from the filesystem's header the number of XBAT blocks the index of the first XBAT block the list of RawDataBlocks create a BlockAllocationTableReader from an array of raw data blocks the raw data the list holding the managed blocks Initializes a new instance of the class. walk the entries from a specified point and return the associated blocks. The associated blocks are Removed from the block list the first block in the chain the raw data block list array of ListManagedBlocks, in their correct order determine whether the block specified by index is used or not determine whether the block specified by index is used or not true if the specified block is used; otherwise, false. return the next block index The index of the current block index of the next block (may be POIFSConstants.END_OF_CHAIN, indicating end of chain (duh)) Convert an array of blocks into a Set of integer indices the array of blocks containing the indices the list of blocks being managed. Unused blocks will be eliminated from the list This class manages and creates the Block Allocation Table, which is basically a set of linked lists of block indices. Each block of the filesystem has an index. The first block, the header, is skipped; the first block after the header is index 0, the next is index 1, and so on. A block's index is also its index into the Block Allocation Table. The entry that it finds in the Block Allocation Table is the index of the next block in the linked list of blocks making up a file, or it is set to -2: end of list. * @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Initializes a new instance of the class. Create the BATBlocks we need start block index of BAT blocks Allocate space for a block of indices the number of blocks to allocate space for the starting index of the blocks Sets the start block for this instance index into the array of BigBlock instances making up the the filesystem create the BATBlocks Write the storage to an OutputStream the OutputStream to which the stored data should be written Gets the number of BigBlock's this instance uses count of BigBlock instances Interface for lists of blocks that are mapped by block allocation tables @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) remove the specified block from the list the index of the specified block; if the index is out of range, that's ok Remove and return the specified block from the list the index of the specified block the specified block get the blocks making up a particular stream in the list. The blocks are removed from the list. the index of the first block in the stream the stream as an array of correctly ordered blocks set the associated BlockAllocationTable the associated BlockAllocationTable Initializes a new instance of the class. provide blocks to manage blocks to be managed remove the specified block from the list the index of the specified block; if the index is out of range, that's ok Remove and return the specified block from the list the index of the specified block the specified block get the blocks making up a particular stream in the list. The blocks are removed from the list. the index of the first block in the stream the stream as an array of correctly ordered blocks set the associated BlockAllocationTable the associated BlockAllocationTable An interface for persisting block storage of POIFS components. @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Writes the blocks. The stream. Wraps a byte array and provides simple data input access. Internally, this class maintains a buffer read index, so that for the most part, primitive data can be read in a data-input-stream-like manner.

Note - the calling class should call the {@link #available()} method to detect end-of-buffer and Move to the next data block when the current is exhausted. For optimisation reasons, no error handling is performed in this class. Thus, mistakes in calling code ran may raise ugly exceptions here, like {@link ArrayIndexOutOfBoundsException}, etc .

The multi-byte primitive input methods ({@link #readUshortLE()}, {@link #readIntLE()} and {@link #readLongLE()}) have corresponding 'spanning Read' methods which (when required) perform a read across the block boundary. These spanning read methods take the previous {@link DataInputBlock} as a parameter. Reads of larger amounts of data (into byte array buffers) must be managed by the caller since these could conceivably involve more than two blocks. @author Josh Micich Possibly any size (usually 512K or 64K). Assumed to be at least 8 bytes for all blocks before the end of the stream. The last block in the stream can be any size except zero. Reads a short which was encoded in little endian format. Reads a short which spans the end of prevBlock and the start of this block. Reads an int which was encoded in little endian format. Reads an int which spans the end of prevBlock and the start of this block. Reads a long which was encoded in little endian format. Reads a long which spans the end of prevBlock and the start of this block. Reads a small amount of data from across the boundary between two blocks. The {@link #_readIndex} of this (the second) block is updated accordingly. Note- this method (and other code) assumes that the second {@link DataInputBlock} always is big enough to complete the read without being exhausted. Reads len bytes from this block into the supplied buffer.

create a document block from a raw data block The block.
Create a single instance initialized with data. the InputStream delivering the data. the poifs bigBlockSize Get the number of bytes Read for this block. bytes Read into the block Was this a partially Read block? true if the block was only partially filled with data Gets the fill byte used The fill byte. convert a single long array into an array of DocumentBlock instances the poifs bigBlockSize the byte array to be converted the intended size of the array (which may be smaller) an array of DocumentBlock instances, filled from the input array Read data from an array of DocumentBlocks the blocks to Read from the buffer to Write the data into the offset into the array of blocks to Read from Write the storage to an OutputStream the OutputStream to which the stored data should be written The block containing the archive header @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) What big block Size the file uses. Most files use 512 bytes, but a few use 4096 Number of small block allocation table blocks (int) (Number of MiniFAT Sectors in Microsoft parlance) create a new HeaderBlockReader from an Stream the source Stream Alerts the short read. The read. The expected size. Get start of Property Table the index of the first block of the Property Table Gets start of small block allocation table The SBAT start. Gets number of BAT blocks The BAT count. Gets the BAT array. The BAT array. Gets the XBAT count. The XBAT count. @return XBAT count Gets the index of the XBAT. The index of the XBAT. Gets The Big Block Size, normally 512 bytes, sometimes 4096 bytes The size of the big block. @return Constants used in reading/writing the Header block @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) The block containing the archive header @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) What big block Size the file uses. Most files use 512 bytes, but a few use 4096 Number of small block allocation table blocks (int) (Number of MiniFAT Sectors in Microsoft parlance) create a new HeaderBlockReader from an Stream the source Stream Alerts the short read. The read. expected size to read Get start of Property Table the index of the first block of the Property Table Gets start of small block allocation table The SBAT start. Gets number of BAT blocks The BAT count. Gets the BAT array. The BAT array. Gets the XBAT count. The XBAT count. @return XBAT count Gets the index of the XBAT. The index of the XBAT. Gets The Big Block Size, normally 512 bytes, sometimes 4096 bytes The size of the big block. @return The block containing the archive header @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Set BAT block parameters. Assumes that all BAT blocks are contiguous. Will construct XBAT blocks if necessary and return the array of newly constructed XBAT blocks. count of BAT blocks index of first BAT block array of XBAT blocks; may be zero Length, will not be null Set start of Property Table the index of the first block of the Property Table Set start of small block allocation table the index of the first big block of the small block allocation table Set count of SBAT blocks the number of SBAT blocks For a given number of BAT blocks, calculate how many XBAT blocks will be needed number of BAT blocks number of XBAT blocks needed Write the block's data to an Stream the Stream to which the stored data should be written An interface for blocks managed by a list that works with a BlockAllocationTable to keep block sequences straight @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org Get the data from the block the block's data as a byte array A block of Property instances @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Create a single instance initialized with default values the properties to be inserted the offset into the properties array Create an array of PropertyBlocks from an array of Property instances, creating empty Property instances to make up any shortfall the Property instances to be converted into PropertyBlocks, in a java List the array of newly created PropertyBlock instances Write the block's data to an OutputStream the OutputStream to which the stored data should be written A big block created from an InputStream, holding the raw data @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org Constructor RawDataBlock the Stream from which the data will be read Initializes a new instance of the class. the Stream from which the data will be read the size of the POIFS blocks, normally 512 bytes {@link POIFSConstants#BIG_BLOCK_SIZE} When we read the data, did we hit end of file? true if the EoF was hit during this block, or; otherwise, falseif not. If you have a dodgy short last block, then it's possible to both have data, and also hit EoF... Did we actually find any data to read? It's possible, in the event of a short last block, to both have hit the EoF, but also to have data true if this instance has data; otherwise, false. Get the data from the block the block's data as a byte array A list of RawDataBlocks instances, and methods to manage the list @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org Initializes a new instance of the class. the InputStream from which the data will be read The big block size, either 512 bytes or 4096 bytes This class implements reading the small document block list from an existing file @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) fetch the small document block list from an existing file the poifs bigBlockSize the raw data from which the small block table will be extracted the root property (which contains the start block and small block table size) the start block of the SBAT the small document block list This class implements reading the small document block list from an existing file @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Initializes a new instance of the class. the poifs bigBlockSize a IList of POIFSDocument instances the Filesystem's root property Get the number of SBAT blocks number of SBAT big blocks Gets the SBAT. the Small Block Allocation Table Return the number of BigBlock's this instance uses count of BigBlock instances Sets the start block. The start block. Write the storage to an OutputStream the OutputStream to which the stored data should be written Storage for documents that are too small to use regular DocumentBlocks for their data @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) convert a single long array into an array of SmallDocumentBlock instances the poifs bigBlockSize the byte array to be converted the intended size of the array (which may be smaller) an array of SmallDocumentBlock instances, filled from the array fill out a List of SmallDocumentBlocks so that it fully occupies a Set of big blocks the List to be filled out. number of big blocks the list encompasses Factory for creating SmallDocumentBlocks from DocumentBlocks the original DocumentBlocks the total document size an array of new SmallDocumentBlocks instances create a list of SmallDocumentBlock's from raw data the raw data containing the SmallDocumentBlock a List of SmallDocumentBlock's extracted from the input Read data from an array of SmallDocumentBlocks the blocks to Read from. the buffer to Write the data into. the offset into the array of blocks to Read from Calculate the storage size of a Set of SmallDocumentBlocks number of SmallDocumentBlocks total size Makes the empty small document block. Converts to block count. The size. Write the storage to an OutputStream the OutputStream to which the stored data should be written Get the data from the block the block's data as a byte array A list of SmallDocumentBlocks instances, and methods to manage the list @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) Initializes a new instance of the class. a list of SmallDocumentBlock instances Common Parent for OLE2 based Text Extractors of POI Documents, such as .doc, .xls You will typically find the implementation of a given format's text extractor under NPOI.Format.Extractor @see org.apache.poi.hssf.extractor.ExcelExtractor @see org.apache.poi.hslf.extractor.PowerPointExtractor @see org.apache.poi.hdgf.extractor.VisioTextExtractor @see org.apache.poi.hwpf.extractor.WordExtractor Creates a new text extractor for the given document Returns the document information metadata for the document The doc summary information. Returns the summary information metadata for the document The summary information. Returns an HPSF powered text extractor for the document properties metadata, such as title and author. Common Parent for Text Extractors of POI Documents. You will typically find the implementation of a given format's text extractor under org.apache.poi.[format].extractor . @see org.apache.poi.hssf.extractor.ExcelExtractor @see org.apache.poi.hslf.extractor.PowerPointExtractor @see org.apache.poi.hdgf.extractor.VisioTextExtractor @see org.apache.poi.hwpf.extractor.WordExtractor The POIDocument that's open Creates a new text extractor for the given document The document. Creates a new text extractor, using the same document as another text extractor. Normally only used by properties extractors. The other extractor. Retrieves all the text from the document. How cells, paragraphs etc are separated in the text is implementation specific - see the javadocs for a specific project for details. All the text from the document. Returns another text extractor, which is able to output the textual content of the document metadata / properties, such as author and title. The metadata text extractor. Copies an Entry into a target POIFS directory, recursively Copies nodes from one POIFS to the other minus the excepts @param source is the source POIFS to copy from @param target is the target POIFS to copy to @param excepts is a list of Strings specifying what nodes NOT to copy Copies nodes from one POIFS to the other minus the excepts @param source is the source POIFS to copy from @param target is the target POIFS to copy to @param excepts is a list of Strings specifying what nodes NOT to copy Fills the specified array. The array. The default value. Assigns the specified byte value to each element of the specified range of the specified array of bytes. The range to be filled extends from index fromIndex, inclusive, to index toIndex, exclusive. (If fromIndex==toIndex, the range to be filled is empty.) the array to be filled the index of the first element (inclusive) to be filled with the specified value the index of the last element (exclusive) to be filled with the specified value the value to be stored in all elements of the array if fromIndex > toIndex if fromIndex < 0 or toIndex > a.length Checks that {@code fromIndex} and {@code toIndex} are in the range and throws an appropriate exception, if they aren't. Convert Array to ArrayList source array Fills the specified array. The array. The default value. Equals the specified a1. The a1. The b1. Returns true if the two specified arrays of Objects are equal to one another. The two arrays are considered equal if both arrays contain the same number of elements, and all corresponding pairs of elements in the two arrays are equal. Two objects e1 and e2 are considered equal if (e1==null ? e2==null : e1.equals(e2)). In other words, the two arrays are equal if they contain the same elements in the same order. Also, two array references are considered equal if both are null. @param a one array to be tested for equality @param a2 the other array to be tested for equality @return true if the two arrays are equal Moves a number of entries in an array to another point in the array, shifting those inbetween as required. The array to alter The (0 based) index of the first entry to move The (0 based) index of the positition to move to The number of entries to move Copies the specified array, truncating or padding with zeros (if necessary) so the copy has the specified length. This method is temporary replace for Arrays.copyOf() until we start to require JDK 1.6. the array to be copied the length of the copy to be returned a copy of the original array, truncated or padded with zeros to obtain the specified length Returns a hash code based on the contents of the specified array. For any two long arrays a and b such that Arrays.Equals(a, b), it is also the case that Arrays.HashCode(a) == Arrays.HashCode(b). The value returned by this method is the same value that would be obtained by invoking the {@link List#hashCode() hashCode} method on a {@link List} Containing a sequence of {@link Long} instances representing the elements of a in the same order. If a is null, this method returns 0. @param a the array whose hash value to compute @return a content-based hash code for a @since 1.5 Returns a hash code based on the contents of the specified array. For any two non-null int arrays a and b such that Arrays.Equals(a, b), it is also the case that Arrays.HashCode(a) == Arrays.HashCode(b). The value returned by this method is the same value that would be obtained by invoking the {@link List#hashCode() hashCode} method on a {@link List} Containing a sequence of {@link int} instances representing the elements of a in the same order. If a is null, this method returns 0. @param a the array whose hash value to compute @return a content-based hash code for a @since 1.5 Returns a hash code based on the contents of the specified array. For any two short arrays a and b such that Arrays.Equals(a, b), it is also the case that Arrays.HashCode(a) == Arrays.HashCode(b). The value returned by this method is the same value that would be obtained by invoking the {@link List#hashCode() hashCode} method on a {@link List} Containing a sequence of {@link short} instances representing the elements of a in the same order. If a is null, this method returns 0. @param a the array whose hash value to compute @return a content-based hash code for a @since 1.5 Returns a hash code based on the contents of the specified array. For any two char arrays a and b such that Arrays.Equals(a, b), it is also the case that Arrays.HashCode(a) == Arrays.HashCode(b). The value returned by this method is the same value that would be obtained by invoking the {@link List#hashCode() hashCode} method on a {@link List} Containing a sequence of {@link Character} instances representing the elements of a in the same order. If a is null, this method returns 0. @param a the array whose hash value to compute @return a content-based hash code for a @since 1.5 Returns a hash code based on the contents of the specified array. For any two byte arrays a and b such that Arrays.Equals(a, b), it is also the case that Arrays.HashCode(a) == Arrays.HashCode(b). The value returned by this method is the same value that would be obtained by invoking the {@link List#hashCode() hashCode} method on a {@link List} Containing a sequence of {@link Byte} instances representing the elements of a in the same order. If a is null, this method returns 0. @param a the array whose hash value to compute @return a content-based hash code for a @since 1.5 Returns a hash code based on the contents of the specified array. For any two bool arrays a and b such that Arrays.Equals(a, b), it is also the case that Arrays.HashCode(a) == Arrays.HashCode(b). The value returned by this method is the same value that would be obtained by invoking the {@link List#hashCode() hashCode} method on a {@link List} Containing a sequence of {@link Boolean} instances representing the elements of a in the same order. If a is null, this method returns 0. @param a the array whose hash value to compute @return a content-based hash code for a @since 1.5 Returns a hash code based on the contents of the specified array. For any two float arrays a and b such that Arrays.Equals(a, b), it is also the case that Arrays.HashCode(a) == Arrays.HashCode(b). The value returned by this method is the same value that would be obtained by invoking the {@link List#hashCode() hashCode} method on a {@link List} Containing a sequence of {@link Float} instances representing the elements of a in the same order. If a is null, this method returns 0. @param a the array whose hash value to compute @return a content-based hash code for a @since 1.5 Returns a hash code based on the contents of the specified array. For any two double arrays a and b such that Arrays.Equals(a, b), it is also the case that Arrays.HashCode(a) == Arrays.HashCode(b). The value returned by this method is the same value that would be obtained by invoking the {@link List#hashCode() hashCode} method on a {@link List} Containing a sequence of {@link Double} instances representing the elements of a in the same order. If a is null, this method returns 0. @param a the array whose hash value to compute @return a content-based hash code for a @since 1.5 Returns a hash code based on the contents of the specified array. If the array Contains other arrays as elements, the hash code is based on their identities rather than their contents. It is therefore acceptable to invoke this method on an array that Contains itself as an element, either directly or indirectly through one or more levels of arrays. For any two arrays a and b such that Arrays.Equals(a, b), it is also the case that Arrays.HashCode(a) == Arrays.HashCode(b). The value returned by this method is equal to the value that would be returned by Arrays.AsList(a).HashCode(), unless a is null, in which case 0 is returned. @param a the array whose content-based hash code to compute @return a content-based hash code for a @see #deepHashCode(Object[]) @since 1.5 Returns a hash code based on the "deep contents" of the specified array. If the array Contains other arrays as elements, the hash code is based on their contents and so on, ad infInitum. It is therefore unacceptable to invoke this method on an array that Contains itself as an element, either directly or indirectly through one or more levels of arrays. The behavior of such an invocation is undefined. For any two arrays a and b such that Arrays.DeepEquals(a, b), it is also the case that Arrays.DeepHashCode(a) == Arrays.DeepHashCode(b). The computation of the value returned by this method is similar to that of the value returned by {@link List#hashCode()} on a list Containing the same elements as a in the same order, with one difference: If an element e of a is itself an array, its hash code is computed not by calling e.HashCode(), but as by calling the appropriate overloading of Arrays.HashCode(e) if e is an array of a primitive type, or as by calling Arrays.DeepHashCode(e) recursively if e is an array of a reference type. If a is null, this method returns 0. @param a the array whose deep-content-based hash code to compute @return a deep-content-based hash code for a @see #hashCode(Object[]) @since 1.5 Returns true if the two specified arrays are deeply Equal to one another. Unlike the {@link #Equals(Object[],Object[])} method, this method is appropriate for use with nested arrays of arbitrary depth. Two array references are considered deeply equal if both are null, or if they refer to arrays that contain the same number of elements and all corresponding pairs of elements in the two arrays are deeply Equal. Two possibly null elements e1 and e2 are deeply equal if any of the following conditions hold:
  • e1 and e2 are both arrays of object reference types, and Arrays.DeepEquals(e1, e2) would return true
  • e1 and e2 are arrays of the same primitive type, and the appropriate overloading of Arrays.Equals(e1, e2) would return true.
  • e1 == e2
  • e1.Equals(e2) would return true.
Note that this defInition permits null elements at any depth. If either of the specified arrays contain themselves as elements either directly or indirectly through one or more levels of arrays, the behavior of this method is undefined. @param a1 one array to be tested for Equality @param a2 the other array to be tested for Equality @return true if the two arrays are equal @see #Equals(Object[],Object[]) @see Objects#deepEquals(Object, Object) @since 1.5
Returns a string representation of the contents of the specified array. The string representation consists of a list of the array's elements, enclosed in square brackets ("[]"). Adjacent elements are Separated by the characters ", " (a comma followed by a space). Elements are Converted to strings as by String.ValueOf(long). Returns "null" if a is null. @param a the array whose string representation to return @return a string representation of a @since 1.5 Returns a string representation of the contents of the specified array. The string representation consists of a list of the array's elements, enclosed in square brackets ("[]"). Adjacent elements are Separated by the characters ", " (a comma followed by a space). Elements are Converted to strings as by String.ValueOf(int). Returns "null" if a is null. @param a the array whose string representation to return @return a string representation of a @since 1.5 Returns a string representation of the contents of the specified array. The string representation consists of a list of the array's elements, enclosed in square brackets ("[]"). Adjacent elements are Separated by the characters ", " (a comma followed by a space). Elements are Converted to strings as by String.ValueOf(short). Returns "null" if a is null. @param a the array whose string representation to return @return a string representation of a @since 1.5 Returns a string representation of the contents of the specified array. The string representation consists of a list of the array's elements, enclosed in square brackets ("[]"). Adjacent elements are Separated by the characters ", " (a comma followed by a space). Elements are Converted to strings as by String.ValueOf(char). Returns "null" if a is null. @param a the array whose string representation to return @return a string representation of a @since 1.5 Returns a string representation of the contents of the specified array. The string representation consists of a list of the array's elements, enclosed in square brackets ("[]"). Adjacent elements are Separated by the characters ", " (a comma followed by a space). Elements are Converted to strings as by String.ValueOf(byte). Returns "null" if a is null. @param a the array whose string representation to return @return a string representation of a @since 1.5 Returns a string representation of the contents of the specified array. The string representation consists of a list of the array's elements, enclosed in square brackets ("[]"). Adjacent elements are Separated by the characters ", " (a comma followed by a space). Elements are Converted to strings as by String.ValueOf(bool). Returns "null" if a is null. @param a the array whose string representation to return @return a string representation of a @since 1.5 Returns a string representation of the contents of the specified array. The string representation consists of a list of the array's elements, enclosed in square brackets ("[]"). Adjacent elements are Separated by the characters ", " (a comma followed by a space). Elements are Converted to strings as by String.ValueOf(float). Returns "null" if a is null. @param a the array whose string representation to return @return a string representation of a @since 1.5 Returns a string representation of the contents of the specified array. The string representation consists of a list of the array's elements, enclosed in square brackets ("[]"). Adjacent elements are Separated by the characters ", " (a comma followed by a space). Elements are Converted to strings as by String.ValueOf(double). Returns "null" if a is null. @param a the array whose string representation to return @return a string representation of a @since 1.5 Returns a string representation of the "deep contents" of the specified array. If the array Contains other arrays as elements, the string representation Contains their contents and so on. This method is designed for Converting multidimensional arrays to strings. The string representation consists of a list of the array's elements, enclosed in square brackets ("[]"). Adjacent elements are Separated by the characters ", " (a comma followed by a space). Elements are Converted to strings as by String.ValueOf(Object), unless they are themselves arrays. If an element e is an array of a primitive type, it is Converted to a string as by invoking the appropriate overloading of Arrays.ToString(e). If an element e is an array of a reference type, it is Converted to a string as by invoking this method recursively. To avoid infInite recursion, if the specified array Contains itself as an element, or Contains an indirect reference to itself through one or more levels of arrays, the self-reference is Converted to the string "[...]". For example, an array Containing only a reference to itself would be rendered as "[[...]]". This method returns "null" if the specified array is null. @param a the array whose string representation to return @return a string representation of a @see #ToString(Object[]) @since 1.5 Returns a string representation of the contents of the specified array. If the array contains other arrays as elements, they are converted to strings by the {@link Object#toString} method inherited from Object, which describes their identities rather than their contents.

The value returned by this method is equal to the value that would be returned by Arrays.asList(a).toString(), unless a is null, in which case "null" is returned.

@param a the array whose string representation to return @return a string representation of a @see #deepToString(Object[]) @since 1.5
The signum of this BigInteger: -1 for negative, 0 for zero, or 1 for positive. Note that the BigInteger zero must have a signum of 0. This is necessary to ensures that there is exactly one representation for each BigInteger value. @serial The magnitude of this BigInteger, in big-endian order: the zeroth element of this array is the most-significant int of the magnitude. The magnitude must be "minimal" in that the most-significant int ({@code mag[0]}) must be non-zero. This is necessary to ensure that there is exactly one representation for each BigInteger value. Note that this implies that the BigInteger zero has a zero-length mag array. One plus the bitCount of this BigInteger. Zeros means unitialized. @serial @see #bitCount @deprecated Deprecated since logical value is offset from stored value and correction factor is applied in accessor method. One plus the bitLength of this BigInteger. Zeros means unitialized. (either value is acceptable). @serial @see #bitLength() @deprecated Deprecated since logical value is offset from stored value and correction factor is applied in accessor method. Two plus the index of the lowest-order int in the magnitude of this BigInteger that contains a nonzero int, or -2 (either value is acceptable). The least significant int has int-number 0, the next int in order of increasing significance has int-number 1, and so forth. @deprecated Deprecated since logical value is offset from stored value and correction factor is applied in accessor method. This mask is used to obtain the value of an int as if it were unsigned. This internal constructor differs from its public cousin with the arguments reversed in two ways: it assumes that its arguments are correct, and it doesn't copy the magnitude array. Translates a byte array containing the two's-complement binary representation of a BigInteger into a BigInteger. The input array is assumed to be in big-endian byte-order: the most significant byte is in the zeroth element. @param val big-endian two's-complement binary representation of BigInteger. @throws NumberFormatException {@code val} is zero bytes long. This private constructor translates an int array containing the two's-complement binary representation of a BigInteger into a BigInteger. The input array is assumed to be in big-endian int-order: the most significant int is in the zeroth element. Constructs a BigInteger with the specified value, which may not be zero. Returns the input array stripped of any leading zero bytes. Since the source is trusted the copying may be skipped. Returns the String representation of this BigInteger in the given radix. If the radix is outside the range from {@link Character#Min_RADIX} to {@link Character#Max_RADIX} inclusive, it will default to 10 (as is the case for {@code Integer.toString}). The digit-to-character mapping provided by {@code Character.forDigit} is used, and a minus sign is prepended if appropriate. (This representation is compatible with the {@link #BigInteger(String, int) (String, int)} constructor.) @param radix radix of the String representation. @return String representation of this BigInteger in the given radix. @see Integer#toString @see Character#forDigit @see #BigInteger(java.lang.String, int) The BigInteger constant zero. @since 1.2 The BigInteger constant one. @since 1.2 The BigInteger constant two. (Not exported.) The BigInteger constant ten. @since 1.5 Returns a BigInteger whose value is equal to that of the specified {@code long}. This "static factory method" is provided in preference to a ({@code long}) constructor because it allows for reuse of frequently used BigIntegers. @param val value of the BigInteger to return. @return a BigInteger with the specified value. Returns a BigInteger with the given two's complement representation. Assumes that the input array will not be modified (the returned BigInteger will reference the input array if feasible). Package private method to return bit length for an integer. Returns the number of bits in the two's complement representation of this BigInteger that differ from its sign bit. This method is useful when implementing bit-vector style sets atop BigIntegers. @return number of bits in the two's complement representation of this BigInteger that differ from its sign bit. Returns a BigInteger whose value is the absolute value of this BigInteger. @return {@code abs(this)} Returns a BigInteger whose value is {@code (-this)}. @return {@code -this} Returns a BigInteger whose value is (thisexponent). Note that {@code exponent} is an integer rather than a BigInteger. @param exponent exponent to which this BigInteger is to be raised. @return thisexponent @throws ArithmeticException {@code exponent} is negative. (This would cause the operation to yield a non-integer value.) Multiplies int arrays x and y to the specified lengths and places the result into z. There will be no leading zeros in the resultant array. Multiply an array by one word k and add to result, return the carry Squares the contents of the int array x. The result is placed into the int array z. The contents of x are not changed. Add one word to the number a mlen words into a. Return the resulting carry. Returns the signum function of this BigInteger. @return -1, 0 or 1 as the value of this BigInteger is negative, zero or positive. Returns a byte array containing the two's-complement representation of this BigInteger. The byte array will be in big-endian byte-order: the most significant byte is in the zeroth element. The array will contain the minimum number of bytes required to represent this BigInteger, including at least one sign bit, which is {@code (ceil((this.bitLength() + 1)/8))}. (This representation is compatible with the {@link #BigInteger(byte[]) (byte[])} constructor.) @return a byte array containing the two's-complement representation of this BigInteger. @see #BigInteger(byte[]) Returns the length of the two's complement representation in ints, including space for at least one sign bit. Returns the specified int of the little-endian two's complement representation (int 0 is the least significant). The int number can be arbitrarily high (values are logically preceded by infinitely many sign ints). Returns the index of the int that contains the first nonzero int in the little-endian binary representation of the magnitude (int 0 is the least significant). If the magnitude is zero, return value is undefined. Returns a copy of the input array stripped of any leading zero bytes. Takes an array a representing a negative 2's-complement number and returns the minimal (no leading zero bytes) unsigned whose value is -a. Takes an array a representing a negative 2's-complement number and returns the minimal (no leading zero ints) unsigned whose value is -a. Returns the number of zero bits preceding the highest-order ("leftmost") one-bit in the two's complement binary representation of the specified {@code int} value. Returns 32 if the specified value has no one-bits in its two's complement representation, in other words if it is equal to zero. Note that this method is closely related to the logarithm base 2. For all positive {@code int} values x:
  • floor(log2(x)) = {@code 31 - numberOfLeadingZeros(x)}
  • ceil(log2(x)) = {@code 32 - numberOfLeadingZeros(x - 1)}
@return the number of zero bits preceding the highest-order ("leftmost") one-bit in the two's complement binary representation of the specified {@code int} value, or 32 if the value is equal to zero. @since 1.5
Returns the number of zero bits following the lowest-order ("rightmost") one-bit in the two's complement binary representation of the specified {@code int} value. Returns 32 if the specified value has no one-bits in its two's complement representation, in other words if it is equal to zero. @return the number of zero bits following the lowest-order ("rightmost") one-bit in the two's complement binary representation of the specified {@code int} value, or 32 if the value is equal to zero. @since 1.5 Returns the number of one-bits in the two's complement binary representation of the specified {@code int} value. This function is sometimes referred to as the population count. @return the number of one-bits in the two's complement binary representation of the specified {@code int} value. @since 1.5 Compares the magnitude array of this BigInteger with the specified BigInteger's. This is the version of compareTo ignoring sign. @param val BigInteger whose magnitude array to be compared. @return -1, 0 or 1 as this magnitude array is less than, equal to or greater than the magnitude aray for the specified BigInteger's. Compares this BigInteger with the specified Object for equality. @param x Object to which this BigInteger is to be compared. @return {@code true} if and only if the specified Object is a BigInteger whose value is numerically equal to this BigInteger. Returns the minimum of this BigInteger and {@code val}. @param val value with which the minimum is to be computed. @return the BigInteger whose value is the lesser of this BigInteger and {@code val}. If they are equal, either may be returned. Returns the maximum of this BigInteger and {@code val}. @param val value with which the maximum is to be computed. @return the BigInteger whose value is the greater of this and {@code val}. If they are equal, either may be returned. Returns the hash code for this BigInteger. @return hash code for this BigInteger. Converts this BigInteger to an {@code int}. This conversion is analogous to a narrowing primitive conversion from {@code long} to {@code int} as defined in section 5.1.3 of The Java(TM) Language Specification: if this BigInteger is too big to fit in an {@code int}, only the low-order 32 bits are returned. Note that this conversion can lose information about the overall magnitude of the BigInteger value as well as return a result with the opposite sign. @return this BigInteger converted to an {@code int}. Converts this BigInteger to a {@code long}. This conversion is analogous to a narrowing primitive conversion from {@code long} to {@code int} as defined in section 5.1.3 of The Java(TM) Language Specification: if this BigInteger is too big to fit in a {@code long}, only the low-order 64 bits are returned. Note that this conversion can lose information about the overall magnitude of the BigInteger value as well as return a result with the opposite sign. @return this BigInteger converted to a {@code long}. Returns a BigInteger whose value is {@code (this >> n)}. Sign extension is performed. The shift distance, {@code n}, may be negative, in which case this method performs a left shift. (Computes floor(this / 2n).) @param n shift distance, in bits. @return {@code this >> n} @throws ArithmeticException if the shift distance is {@code Integer.Min_VALUE}. @see #shiftLeft Returns a BigInteger whose value is {@code (~this)}. (This method returns a negative value if and only if this BigInteger is non-negative.) @return {@code ~this} Returns a BigInteger whose value is {@code (this | val)}. (This method returns a negative BigInteger if and only if either this or val is negative.) @param val value to be OR'ed with this BigInteger. @return {@code this | val} Package private methods used by BigDecimal code to multiply a BigInteger with a long. Assumes v is not equal to INFLATED. Returns a BigInteger whose value is {@code (this * val)}. @param val value to be multiplied by this BigInteger. @return {@code this * val} Returns a BigInteger whose value is {@code (this + val)}. @param val value to be added to this BigInteger. @return {@code this + val} Adds the contents of the int arrays x and y. This method allocates a new int array to hold the answer and returns a reference to that array. Returns a BigInteger whose value is {@code (this - val)}. @param val value to be subtracted from this BigInteger. @return {@code this - val} Subtracts the contents of the second int arrays (little) from the first (big). The first int array (big) must represent a larger number than the second. This method allocates the space necessary to hold the answer. Returns a BigInteger whose value is {@code (this / val)}. @param val value by which this BigInteger is to be divided. @return {@code this / val} @throws ArithmeticException if {@code val} is zero. Holds the magnitude of this MutableBigInteger in big endian order. The magnitude may start at an offset into the value array, and it may end before the length of the value array. The number of ints of the value array that are currently used to hold the magnitude of this MutableBigInteger. The magnitude starts at an offset and offset + intLen may be less than value.Length. The offset into the value array where the magnitude of this MutableBigInteger begins. MutableBigInteger with one element value array with the value 1. Used by BigDecimal divideAndRound to increment the quotient. Use this constant only when the method is not going to modify this object. The default constructor. An empty MutableBigInteger is created with a one word capacity. Construct a new MutableBigInteger with a magnitude specified by the int val. Construct a new MutableBigInteger with the specified value array up to the length of the array supplied. Construct a new MutableBigInteger with a magnitude equal to the specified BigInteger. Construct a new MutableBigInteger with a magnitude equal to the specified MutableBigInteger. Internal helper method to return the magnitude array. The caller is not supposed to modify the returned array. Convert this MutableBigInteger to a long value. The caller has to make sure this MutableBigInteger can be fit into long. Convert this MutableBigInteger to a BigInteger object. Clear out a MutableBigInteger for reuse. Set a MutableBigInteger to zero, removing its offset. Compare the magnitude of two MutableBigIntegers. Returns -1, 0 or 1 as this MutableBigInteger is numerically less than, equal to, or greater than b. Compare this against half of a MutableBigInteger object (Needed for remainder tests). Assumes no leading unnecessary zeros, which holds for results from divide(). Return the index of the lowest set bit in this MutableBigInteger. If the magnitude of this MutableBigInteger is zero, -1 is returned. Return the int in use in this MutableBigInteger at the specified index. This method is not used because it is not inlined on all platforms. Return a long which is equal to the unsigned value of the int in use in this MutableBigInteger at the specified index. This method is not used because it is not inlined on all platforms. Ensure that the MutableBigInteger is in normal form, specifically making sure that there are no leading zeros, and that if the magnitude is zero, then intLen is zero. If this MutableBigInteger cannot hold len words, increase the size of the value array to len words. Convert this MutableBigInteger into an int array with no leading zeros, of a length that is equal to this MutableBigInteger's intLen. Sets the int at index+offset in this MutableBigInteger to val. This does not get inlined on all platforms so it is not used as often as originally intended. Sets this MutableBigInteger's value array to the specified array. The intLen is set to the specified length. Sets this MutableBigInteger's value array to a copy of the specified array. The intLen is set to the length of the new array. Sets this MutableBigInteger's value array to a copy of the specified array. The intLen is set to the length of the specified array. Returns true iff this MutableBigInteger has a value of one. Returns true iff this MutableBigInteger has a value of zero. Returns true iff this MutableBigInteger is even. Returns true iff this MutableBigInteger is odd. Returns true iff this MutableBigInteger is in normal form. A MutableBigInteger is in normal form if it has no leading zeros after the offset, and intLen + offset <= value.Length. Returns a String representation of this MutableBigInteger in radix 10. Right shift this MutableBigInteger n bits. The MutableBigInteger is left in normal form. Left shift this MutableBigInteger n bits. A primitive used for division. This method adds in one multiple of the divisor a back to the dividend result at a specified offset. It is used when qhat was estimated too large, and must be adjusted. This method is used for division. It multiplies an n word input a by one word input x, and subtracts the n word product from q. This is needed when subtracting qhat*divisor from dividend. Right shift this MutableBigInteger n bits, where n is less than 32. Assumes that intLen > 0, n > 0 for speed Left shift this MutableBigInteger n bits, where n is less than 32. Assumes that intLen > 0, n > 0 for speed Adds the contents of two MutableBigInteger objects.The result is placed within this MutableBigInteger. The contents of the addend are not changed. Subtracts the smaller of this and b from the larger and places the result into this MutableBigInteger. Subtracts the smaller of a and b from the larger and places the result into the larger. Returns 1 if the answer is in a, -1 if in b, 0 if no operation was performed. Multiply the contents of two MutableBigInteger objects. The result is placed into MutableBigInteger z. The contents of y are not changed. Multiply the contents of this MutableBigInteger by the word y. The result is placed into z. This method is used for division of an n word dividend by a one word divisor. The quotient is placed into quotient. The one word divisor is specified by divisor. @return the remainder of the division is returned. Calculates the quotient of this div b and places the quotient in the provided MutableBigInteger objects and the remainder object is returned. Uses Algorithm D in Knuth section 4.3.1. Many optimizations to that algorithm have been adapted from the Colin Plumb C library. It special cases one word divisors for speed. The content of b is not changed. Internally used to calculate the quotient of this div v and places the quotient in the provided MutableBigInteger object and the remainder is returned. @return the remainder of the division will be returned. Divide this MutableBigInteger by the divisor represented by its magnitude array. The quotient will be placed into the provided quotient object & the remainder object is returned. Compare two longs as if they were unsigned. Returns true iff one is bigger than two. This method divides a long quantity by an int to estimate qhat for two multi precision numbers. It is used when the signed value of n is less than zero. Calculate GCD of this and b. This and b are changed by the computation. Calculate GCD of this and v. Assumes that this and v are not zero. Calculate GCD of a and b interpreted as unsigned integers. Returns the modInverse of this mod p. This and p are not affected by the operation. Calculate the multiplicative inverse of this mod mod, where mod is odd. This and mod are not changed by the calculation. This method implements an algorithm due to Richard Schroeppel, that uses the same intermediate representation as Montgomery Reduction ("Montgomery Form"). The algorithm is described in an unpublished manuscript entitled "Fast Modular Reciprocals." Uses the extended Euclidean algorithm to compute the modInverse of base mod a modulus that is a power of 2. The modulus is 2^k. Manage operations dealing with bit-mapped fields. @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) Create a instance the mask specifying which bits apply to this BitField. Bits that are set in this mask are the bits that this BitField operates on Create a instance the mask specifying which bits apply to this BitField. Bits that are set in this mask are the bits that this BitField operates on Clear the bits. the int data containing the bits we're interested in the value of holder with the specified bits cleared (set to 0) Clear the bits. the short data containing the bits we're interested in the value of holder with the specified bits cleared (set to 0) Obtain the value for the specified BitField, appropriately shifted right. Many users of a BitField will want to treat the specified bits as an int value, and will not want to be aware that the value is stored as a BitField (and so shifted left so many bits) the int data containing the bits we're interested in the selected bits, shifted right appropriately Obtain the value for the specified BitField, unshifted the short data containing the bits we're interested in the selected bits Obtain the value for the specified BitField, appropriately shifted right, as a short. Many users of a BitField will want to treat the specified bits as an int value, and will not want to be aware that the value is stored as a BitField (and so shifted left so many bits) the short data containing the bits we're interested in the selected bits, shifted right appropriately Obtain the value for the specified BitField, appropriately shifted right. Many users of a BitField will want to treat the specified bits as an int value, and will not want to be aware that the value is stored as a BitField (and so shifted left so many bits) the int data containing the bits we're interested in the selected bits, shifted right appropriately Are all of the bits set or not? This is a stricter test than isSet, in that all of the bits in a multi-bit set must be set for this method to return true the int data containing the bits we're interested in true if all of the bits are set otherwise, false. is the field set or not? This is most commonly used for a single-bit field, which is often used to represent a boolean value; the results of using it for a multi-bit field is to determine whether *any* of its bits are set the int data containing the bits we're interested in true if any of the bits are set; otherwise, false. Set the bits. the int data containing the bits we're interested in the value of holder with the specified bits set to 1 Set a boolean BitField the int data containing the bits we're interested in indicating whether to set or clear the bits the value of holder with the specified bits set or cleared Set the bits. the short data containing the bits we're interested in the value of holder with the specified bits set to 1 Set a boolean BitField the short data containing the bits we're interested in indicating whether to set or clear the bits the value of holder with the specified bits set or cleared Obtain the value for the specified BitField, appropriately shifted right, as a short. Many users of a BitField will want to treat the specified bits as an int value, and will not want to be aware that the value is stored as a BitField (and so shifted left so many bits) the short data containing the bits we're interested in the new value for the specified bits the selected bits, shifted right appropriately Sets the value. the byte data containing the bits we're interested in The value. Set a boolean BitField the byte data containing the bits we're interested in indicating whether to set or clear the bits the value of holder with the specified bits set or cleared Clears the bits. the byte data containing the bits we're interested in the value of holder with the specified bits cleared Set the bits. the byte data containing the bits we're interested in the value of holder with the specified bits set to 1 Returns immutable Btfield instances. @author Jason Height (jheight at apache dot org) Gets the instance. The mask. Implementation of a BlockingInputStream to provide data to RawDataBlock that expects data in 512 byte chunks. Useful to read data from slow (ie, non FileInputStream) sources, for example when Reading an OLE2 Document over a network. Possible extentions: add a timeout. Curently a call to Read(byte[]) on this class is blocking, so use at your own peril if your underlying stream blocks. @author Jens Gerhard @author aviks - documentation cleanups. We had to revert to byte per byte Reading to keep with slow network connections on one hand, without missing the end-of-file. This is the only method that does its own thing in this class everything else is delegated to aggregated stream. THIS IS A BLOCKING BLOCK READ!!! Returns the number of elements between the current position and the limit. The number of elements remaining in this buffer Tells whether there are any elements between the current position and the limit. true if, and only if, there is at least one element remaining in this buffer representation of a byte (8-bit) field at a fixed location within a byte array @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org Initializes a new instance of the class. The offset. Initializes a new instance of the class. The offset. The value. Initializes a new instance of the class. The offset. The data. Initializes a new instance of the class. The offset. The _value. The data. Gets or sets the value. The value. set the value from its offset into an array of bytes the byte array from which the value is to be read set the value from an Stream the Stream from which the value is to be read set the ByteField's current value and write it to a byte array value to be set the byte array to write the value to Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . write the value out to an array of bytes at the appropriate offset the array of bytes to which the value is to be written Represents a class ID (16 bytes). Unlike other little-endian type the {@link ClassID} is not just 16 bytes stored in the wrong order. Instead, it is a double word (4 bytes) followed by two words (2 bytes each) followed by 8 bytes. @author Rainer Klute klute@rainer-klute.de @version $Id: ClassID.java 489730 2006-12-22 19:18:16Z bayard $ @since 2002-02-09 The bytes making out the class ID in correct order, i.e. big-endian. Creates a and Reads its value from a byte array. The byte array to Read from. The offset of the first byte to Read. Creates a and initializes its value with 0x00 bytes.

Creates a {@link ClassID} from a human-readable representation of the Class ID in standard format "{xxxxxxxx-xxxx-xxxx-xxxx-xxxxxxxxxxxx}".

@param externalForm representation of the Class ID represented by this object.
The number of bytes occupied by this object in the byte stream. Gets the length. The number of bytes occupied by this object in the byte stream. Gets or sets the bytes making out the class ID. They are returned in correct order, i.e. big-endian. the bytes making out the class ID.. Reads the class ID's value from a byte array by turning little-endian into big-endian. The byte array to Read from The offset within the A byte array containing the class ID. Writes the class ID to a byte array in the little-endian format. The byte array to Write to. The offset within the Checks whether this ClassID is equal to another object. the object to compare this PropertySet with true if the objects are equal, else false Serves as a hash function for a particular type. A hash code for the current . Returns a human-Readable representation of the Class ID in standard format "{xxxxxxxx-xxxx-xxxx-xxxx-xxxxxxxxxxxx}". A String representation of the Class ID represented by this object.. Utilities for working with Microsoft CodePages.

Provides constants for understanding numeric codepages, along with utilities to translate these into Java Character Sets.

Codepage 037, a special case

Codepage for SJIS

Codepage for GBK, aka MS936

Codepage for MS949

Codepage for UTF-16

Codepage for UTF-16 big-endian

Codepage for Windows 1250

Codepage for Windows 1251

Codepage for Windows 1252

Codepage for Windows 1253

Codepage for Windows 1254

Codepage for Windows 1255

Codepage for Windows 1256

Codepage for Windows 1257

Codepage for Windows 1258

Codepage for Johab

Codepage for Macintosh Roman (Java: MacRoman)

Codepage for Macintosh Japan (Java: unknown - use SJIS, cp942 or cp943)

Codepage for Macintosh Chinese Traditional (Java: unknown - use Big5, MS950, or cp937)

Codepage for Macintosh Korean (Java: unknown - use EUC_KR or cp949)

Codepage for Macintosh Arabic (Java: MacArabic)

Codepage for Macintosh Hebrew (Java: MacHebrew)

Codepage for Macintosh Greek (Java: MacGreek)

Codepage for Macintosh Cyrillic (Java: MacCyrillic)

Codepage for Macintosh Chinese Simplified (Java: unknown - use EUC_CN, ISO2022_CN_GB, MS936 or cp935)

Codepage for Macintosh Romanian (Java: MacRomania)

Codepage for Macintosh Ukrainian (Java: MacUkraine)

Codepage for Macintosh Thai (Java: MacThai)

Codepage for Macintosh Central Europe (Latin-2) (Java: MacCentralEurope)

Codepage for Macintosh Iceland (Java: MacIceland)

Codepage for Macintosh Turkish (Java: MacTurkish)

Codepage for Macintosh Croatian (Java: MacCroatian)

Codepage for US-ASCII

Codepage for KOI8-R

Codepage for ISO-8859-1

Codepage for ISO-8859-2

Codepage for ISO-8859-3

Codepage for ISO-8859-4

Codepage for ISO-8859-5

Codepage for ISO-8859-6

Codepage for ISO-8859-7

Codepage for ISO-8859-8

Codepage for ISO-8859-9

Codepage for ISO-2022-JP

Another codepage for ISO-2022-JP

Yet another codepage for ISO-2022-JP

Codepage for ISO-2022-KR

Codepage for EUC-JP

Codepage for EUC-KR

Codepage for GB2312

Codepage for GB18030

Another codepage for US-ASCII

Codepage for UTF-8

Codepage for Unicode

Converts a string into bytes, in the equivalent character encoding to the supplied codepage number. @param string The string to convert @param codepage The codepage number Converts the bytes into a String, based on the equivalent character encoding to the supplied codepage number. @param string The byte of the string to convert @param codepage The codepage number Converts the bytes into a String, based on the equivalent character encoding to the supplied codepage number. @param string The byte of the string to convert @param codepage The codepage number

Turns a codepage number into the equivalent character encoding's name.

@param codepage The codepage number @return The character encoding's name. If the codepage number is 65001, the encoding name is "UTF-8". All other positive numbers are mapped to "cp" followed by the number, e.g. if the codepage number is 1252 the returned character encoding name will be "cp1252". @exception UnsupportedEncodingException if the specified codepage is less than zero.
This class comes from Java Initializes a new instance of the class. Adds the specified o. The o. Determines whether [contains] [the specified o]. The o. true if [contains] [the specified o]; otherwise, false. Copies the elements of the to an , starting at a particular index. The one-dimensional that is the destination of the elements copied from . The must have zero-based indexing. The zero-based index in at which copying begins. is null. is less than zero. is multidimensional. -or- is equal to or greater than the length of . -or- The number of elements in the source is greater than the available space from to the end of the destination . The type of the source cannot be cast automatically to the type of the destination . Gets the number of elements contained in the . The number of elements contained in the . Returns an enumerator that iterates through a collection. An object that can be used to iterate through the collection. Removes the specified o. The o. Removes all of the elements from this set. The set will be empty after this call returns. This class comes from Java Initializes a new instance of the class. Removes the specified key. The key. Gets the enumerator. Determines whether the specified key contains key. The key. true if the specified key contains key; otherwise, false. Adds the specified key. The key. The value. Gets the count. The count. Gets or sets the with the specified key. Gets the keys. The keys. Clears this instance. Loads the specified in stream. The in stream. Loads the convert. The string. Converts encoded \uxxxx to unicode chars and changes special saved chars to their original forms Continues the line. The line. CRC Verification Initializes a new instance of the class. CRC Bytes. The buffer. String CRC the string File CRC the input file Stream CRC the input stream Implementors of this interface allow client code to 'delay' writing to a certain section of a data output stream.
A typical application is for writing BIFF records when the size is not known until well after the header has been written. The client code can call to reserve two bytes of the output for the 'ushort size' header field. The delayed output can be written at any stage.
@author Josh Micich
Creates an output stream intended for outputting a sequence of size bytes. behavior of a field at a fixed location within a byte array @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org set the value from its offset into an array of bytes the byte array from which the value is to be read set the value from an Stream the Stream from which the value is to be read return the value as a String write the value out to an array of bytes at the appropriate offset the array of bytes to which the value is to be written dump data in hexadecimal format; derived from a HexDump utility I wrote in June 2001. @author Marc Johnson @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Dumps bytesToDump bytes to an output stream. @param in The stream to read from @param out The output stream @param start The index to use as the starting position for the left hand side label @param bytesToDump The number of bytes to output. Use -1 to read until the end of file. Shorts to hex. The value. char array of 2 (zero padded) uppercase hex chars and prefixed with '0x' Bytes to hex. The value. char array of 1 (zero padded) uppercase hex chars and prefixed with '0x' Ints to hex. The value. char array of 4 (zero padded) uppercase hex chars and prefixed with '0x' char array of 4 (zero padded) uppercase hex chars and prefixed with '0x' The value. char array of 4 (zero padded) uppercase hex chars and prefixed with '0x' Toes the hex chars. The p value. The n bytes. char array of uppercase hex chars, zero padded and prefixed with '0x' This method reads hex data from a filename and returns a byte array. The file may contain line comments that are preceeded with a # symbol. The filename to read The bytes read from the file. If there was a problem while reading the file. Same as ReadData(String) except that this method allows you to specify sections within a file. Sections are referenced using section headers in the form: The stream. The section. Reads the data. The filename. The section. Reads the data. The stream. The EOF char. Reads from string. The data. Reads to EOL. The stream. construct the with its offset into its containing byte array class. offset of the field within its byte array. construct the with its offset into its containing byte array and initialize its value offset of the field within its byte array the initial value Construct the with its offset into its containing byte array and initialize its value from its byte array offset of the field within its byte array the byte array to Read the value from construct the with its offset into its containing byte array, initialize its value, and write the value to a byte offset of the field within its byte array the initial value the byte array to write the value to get or Set the IntegerField's current value The value. Set the IntegerField's current value and write it to a byte array value to be Set the byte array to write the value to Set the value from its offset into an array of bytes The data. Set the value from an Stream the Stream from which the value is to be Read write the value out to an array of bytes at the appropriate offset the array of bytes to which the value is to be written Same as using the constructor with the same parameter list. Avoid creation of an useless object. offset of the field within its byte array the initial value the byte array to write the value to Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . A List of int's; as full an implementation of the java.Util.List interface as possible, with an eye toward minimal creation of objects the mimicry of List is as follows:
  • if possible, operations designated 'optional' in the List interface are attempted
  • wherever the List interface refers to an Object, substitute int
  • wherever the List interface refers to a Collection or List, substitute IntList
the mimicry is not perfect, however:
  • operations involving Iterators or ListIterators are not supported
  • Remove(Object) becomes RemoveValue to distinguish it from Remove(int index)
  • subList is not supported
@author Marc Johnson
create an IntList of default size create a copy of an existing IntList the existing IntList create an IntList with a predefined Initial size the size for the internal array add the specfied value at the specified index the index where the new value is to be Added the new value Appends the specified element to the end of this list element to be Appended to this list. return true (as per the general contract of the Collection.add method Appends all of the elements in the specified collection to the end of this list, in the order that they are returned by the specified collection's iterator. The behavior of this operation is unspecified if the specified collection is modified while the operation is in progress. (Note that this will occur if the specified collection is this list, and it's nonempty.) collection whose elements are to be Added to this list. return true if this list Changed as a result of the call. Inserts all of the elements in the specified collection into this list at the specified position. Shifts the element currently at that position (if any) and any subsequent elements to the right (increases their indices). The new elements will appear in this list in the order that they are returned by the specified collection's iterator. The behavior of this operation is unspecified if the specified collection is modified while the operation is in progress. (Note that this will occur if the specified collection is this list, and it's nonempty.) index at which to insert first element from the specified collection. elements to be inserted into this list. return true if this list Changed as a result of the call. Removes all of the elements from this list. This list will be empty After this call returns (unless it throws an exception). Returns true if this list Contains the specified element. More formally, returns true if and only if this list Contains at least one element e such that o == e element whose presence in this list is to be Tested. return true if this list Contains the specified element. Returns true if this list Contains all of the elements of the specified collection. collection to be Checked for Containment in this list. return true if this list Contains all of the elements of the specified collection. Compares the specified object with this list for Equality. Returns true if and only if the specified object is also a list, both lists have the same size, and all corresponding pairs of elements in the two lists are Equal. (Two elements e1 and e2 are equal if e1 == e2.) In other words, two lists are defined to be equal if they contain the same elements in the same order. This defInition ensures that the Equals method works properly across different implementations of the List interface. the object to be Compared for Equality with this list. return true if the specified object is equal to this list. Returns the element at the specified position in this list. index of element to return. return the element at the specified position in this list. Returns the hash code value for this list. The hash code of a list is defined to be the result of the following calculation: hashCode = 1; Iterator i = list.Iterator(); while (i.HasNext()) { Object obj = i.Next(); hashCode = 31*hashCode + (obj==null ? 0 : obj.HashCode()); } This ensures that list1.Equals(list2) implies that list1.HashCode()==list2.HashCode() for any two lists, list1 and list2, as required by the general contract of Object.HashCode. return the hash code value for this list. Returns the index in this list of the first occurrence of the specified element, or -1 if this list does not contain this element. More formally, returns the lowest index i such that (o == Get(i)), or -1 if there is no such index. element to search for. return the index in this list of the first occurrence of the specified element, or -1 if this list does not contain this element. Returns true if this list Contains no elements. return true if this list Contains no elements. Returns the index in this list of the last occurrence of the specified element, or -1 if this list does not contain this element. More formally, returns the highest index i such that (o == Get(i)), or -1 if there is no such index. element to search for. the index in this list of the last occurrence of the specified element, or -1 if this list does not contain this element. Removes the element at the specified position in this list. Shifts any subsequent elements to the left (subtracts one from their indices). Returns the element that was Removed from the list. the index of the element to Removed. return the element previously at the specified position. Removes the first occurrence in this list of the specified element (optional operation). If this list does not contain the element, it is unChanged. More formally, Removes the element with the lowest index i such that (o.Equals(get(i))) (if such an element exists). element to be Removed from this list, if present. return true if this list Contained the specified element. Removes from this list all the elements that are Contained in the specified collection collection that defines which elements will be Removed from the list. return true if this list Changed as a result of the call. Retains only the elements in this list that are Contained in the specified collection. In other words, Removes from this list all the elements that are not Contained in the specified collection. collection that defines which elements this Set will retain. return true if this list Changed as a result of the call. Replaces the element at the specified position in this list with the specified element index of element to Replace. element to be stored at the specified position. the element previously at the specified position. Returns the number of elements in this list. If this list Contains more than Int32.MaxValue elements, returns Int32.MaxValue. the number of elements in this IntList the number of elements in this IntList Returns an array Containing all of the elements in this list in proper sequence. Obeys the general contract of the Collection.ToArray method. an array Containing all of the elements in this list in proper sequence. Returns an array Containing all of the elements in this list in proper sequence. Obeys the general contract of the Collection.ToArray(Object[]) method. the array into which the elements of this list are to be stored, if it is big enough; otherwise, a new array is allocated for this purpose. return an array Containing the elements of this list. A List of objects that are indexed AND keyed by an int; also allows for Getting the index of a value in the list

I am happy is someone wants to re-implement this without using the internal list and hashmap. If so could you please make sure that you can add elements half way into the list and have the value-key mappings update

@author Jason Height
create an IntMapper of default size Appends the specified element to the end of this list element to be Appended to this list. return true (as per the general contract of the Collection.add method) Gets the size. Gets the T object at the specified index. Gets the index of T object. The o. Gets the enumerator. Reads all the data from the input stream, and returns the bytes Read. The stream. Tony Qu changed the code Reads the fully. The stream. The b. Same as the normal in.Read(b, off, len) , but tries to ensure that the entire len number of bytes is Read. If the end of file is reached before any bytes are Read, returns -1. If the end of the file is reached after some bytes are Read, returns the number of bytes Read. If the end of the file isn't reached before len bytes have been Read, will return len bytes. The stream. The b. The off. The len. Copies all the data from the given InputStream to the OutputStream. It leaves both streams open, so you will still need to close them once done. a utility class for handling little-endian numbers, which the 80x86 world is replete with. The methods are all static, and input/output is from/to byte arrays, or from InputStreams. @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) @author Andrew Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) Initializes a new instance of the class. get a short value from a byte array the byte array a starting offset into the byte array the short (16-bit) value get an unsigned short value from a byte array the byte array a starting offset into the byte array the unsigned short (16-bit) value in an integer get a short value from a byte array a starting offset into the byte array the short (16-bit) value get a short value from a byte array the unsigned short (16-bit) value in an integer get an int value from a byte array the byte array a starting offset into the byte array the int (32-bit) value get an int value from the beginning of a byte array the byte array the int (32-bit) value Gets the U int. the byte array a starting offset into the byte array the unsigned int (32-bit) value in a long Gets the U int. the byte array the unsigned int (32-bit) value in a long get a long value from a byte array the byte array a starting offset into the byte array the long (64-bit) value get a double value from a byte array, reads it in little endian format then converts the resulting revolting IEEE 754 (curse them) floating point number to a c# double the byte array a starting offset into the byte array the double (64-bit) value Puts the short. the byte array a starting offset into the byte array The value. Added for consistency with other put~() methods the byte array a starting offset into the byte array The value. Puts the U short. the byte array a starting offset into the byte array The value. put a short value into beginning of a byte array the byte array the short (16-bit) value Put signed short into output stream @param value the short (16-bit) value @param outputStream output stream @throws IOException if an I/O error occurs put an int value into a byte array the byte array a starting offset into the byte array the int (32-bit) value put an int value into beginning of a byte array the byte array the int (32-bit) value Put int into output stream the int (32-bit) value output stream put a long value into a byte array the byte array a starting offset into the byte array the long (64-bit) value put a double value into a byte array the byte array a starting offset into the byte array the double (64-bit) value Reads the short. The stream. get an int value from an Stream the Stream from which the int is to be read the int (32-bit) value will be propagated back to the caller if the stream cannot provide enough bytes get a long value from a Stream the Stream from which the long is to be read the long (64-bit) value will be propagated back to the caller if the stream cannot provide enough bytes Us the byte to int. The b. get the unsigned value of a byte. the byte array. a starting offset into the byte array. the unsigned value of the byte as a 32 bit integer Copy a portion of a byte array the original byte array Where to start copying from. Number of bytes to copy. The byteArray value if copying would cause access ofdata outside array bounds. Gets the unsigned byte. the byte array Gets the unsigned byte. the byte array a starting offset into the byte array Puts the double. the byte array The value. put a double value into a byte array @param value the double (64-bit) value @param outputStream output stream @throws IOException if an I/O error occurs Puts the uint. the byte array The value. Put unsigned int into output stream @param value the int (32-bit) value @param outputStream output stream @throws IOException if an I/O error occurs Puts the uint. the byte array a starting offset into the byte array The value. Puts the long. the byte array The value. Put long into output stream @param value the long (64-bit) value @param outputStream output stream @throws IOException if an I/O error occurs Puts the long. the byte array The value. Puts the ulong. the byte array a starting offset into the byte array The value. Puts the number. the byte array a starting offset into the byte array The value. The size. Puts the number. the byte array a starting offset into the byte array The value. The size. Puts the short array. the byte array a starting offset into the byte array The value. Puts the U short. the byte array The value. Put unsigned short into output stream @param value the unsigned short (16-bit) value @param outputStream output stream @throws IOException if an I/O error occurs Reads from stream. The stream. The size. Reads the long. The stream. Adapts a plain byte array to @author Josh Micich Adapts a plain byte array to @author Josh Micich @author Josh Micich Wraps an providing

This class does not buffer any input, so the stream Read position maintained by this class is consistent with that of the inner stream.

@author Josh Micich
@author Josh Micich Wraps an providing @author Josh Micich construct the with its offset into its containing byte array The offset. construct the LongField with its offset into its containing byte array and initialize its value offset of the field within its byte array the initial value Construct the class with its offset into its containing byte array and initialize its value from its byte array The offset of the field within its byte array the byte array to read the value from construct the class with its offset into its containing byte array, initialize its value, and write the value to a byte array offset of the field within its byte array the initial value the byte array to write the value to Getg or sets the LongField's current value The current value set the LongField's current value and write it to a byte array value to be set the byte array to write the value to set the value from its offset into an array of bytes the byte array from which the value is to be read set the value from an Stream the Stream from which the value is to be write the value out to an array of bytes at the appropriate offset the array of bytes to which the value is to be written Same as using the constructor with the same parameter list. Avoid creation of an useless object. offset of the field within its byte array the initial value the byte array to write the value to Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . This class provides common functionality for the various LZW implementations in the different file formats. It's currently used by HDGF and HMEF. Two good resources on LZW are: http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/LZW http://marknelson.us/1989/10/01/lzw-data-compression/ Does the mask bit mean it's compressed or uncompressed? How much to append to the code length in the stream to Get the real code length? Normally 2 or 3 Does the 12 bits of the position Get stored in Little Endian or Big Endian form? This controls whether a pos+length of 0x12 0x34 becomes a position of 0x123 or 0x312 Populates the dictionary, and returns where in it to begin writing new codes. Generally, if the dictionary is pre-populated, then new codes should be placed at the end of that block. Equally, if the dictionary is left with all zeros, then usually the new codes can go in at the start. Adjusts the position offset if needed when looking something up in the dictionary. Decompresses the given input stream, returning the array of bytes of the decompressed input. Perform a streaming decompression of the input. Works by: 1) Reading a flag byte, the 8 bits of which tell you if the following 8 codes are compressed our un-compressed 2) Consider the 8 bits in turn 3) If the bit is Set, the next code is un-compressed, so add it to the dictionary and output it 4) If the bit isn't Set, then read in the length and start position in the dictionary, and output the bytes there 5) Loop until we've done all 8 bits, then read in the next flag byte Given an integer, turn it into a java byte, handling the wrapping. This is a convenience method Given a java byte, turn it into an integer between 0 and 255 (i.e. handle the unwrapping). This is a convenience method A Logger class that strives to make it as easy as possible for developers to write Log calls, while simultaneously making those calls as cheap as possible by performing lazy evaluation of the Log message. @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) @author Nicola Ken Barozzi (nicolaken at apache.org) Log a message @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 The object to Log. Check if a Logger is enabled to Log at the specified level @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first object to place in the message @param obj2 second object to place in the message Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third Object to place in the message Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third Object to place in the message @param obj4 fourth Object to place in the message Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third Object to place in the message @param obj4 fourth Object to place in the message @param obj5 fifth Object to place in the message Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third Object to place in the message @param obj4 fourth Object to place in the message @param obj5 fifth Object to place in the message @param obj6 sixth Object to place in the message Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third Object to place in the message @param obj4 fourth Object to place in the message @param obj5 fifth Object to place in the message @param obj6 sixth Object to place in the message @param obj7 seventh Object to place in the message Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third Object to place in the message @param obj4 fourth Object to place in the message @param obj5 fifth Object to place in the message @param obj6 sixth Object to place in the message @param obj7 seventh Object to place in the message @param obj8 eighth Object to place in the message Log a message @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 The object to Log. This is converted to a string. @param exception An exception to be Logged Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param exception An exception to be Logged Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third object to place in the message @param exception An error message to be Logged Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third object to place in the message @param obj4 fourth object to place in the message @param exception An exception to be Logged Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third object to place in the message @param obj4 fourth object to place in the message @param obj5 fifth object to place in the message @param exception An exception to be Logged Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third object to place in the message @param obj4 fourth object to place in the message @param obj5 fifth object to place in the message @param obj6 sixth object to place in the message @param exception An exception to be Logged Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third object to place in the message @param obj4 fourth object to place in the message @param obj5 fifth object to place in the message @param obj6 sixth object to place in the message @param obj7 seventh object to place in the message @param exception An exception to be Logged Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third object to place in the message @param obj4 fourth object to place in the message @param obj5 fifth object to place in the message @param obj6 sixth object to place in the message @param obj7 seventh object to place in the message @param obj8 eighth object to place in the message @param exception An exception to be Logged Logs a formated message. The message itself may contain % characters as place holders. This routine will attempt to match the placeholder by looking at the type of parameter passed to obj1. If the parameter is an array, it traverses the array first and matches parameters sequentially against the array items. Otherwise the parameters after message are matched in order. If the place holder matches against a number it is printed as a whole number. This can be overridden by specifying a precision in the form %n.m where n is the padding for the whole part and m is the number of decimal places to display. n can be excluded if desired. n and m may not be more than 9. If the last parameter (after flattening) is a Exception it is Logged specially. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param message The message to Log. @param obj1 The first object to match against. Logs a formated message. The message itself may contain % characters as place holders. This routine will attempt to match the placeholder by looking at the type of parameter passed to obj1. If the parameter is an array, it traverses the array first and matches parameters sequentially against the array items. Otherwise the parameters after message are matched in order. If the place holder matches against a number it is printed as a whole number. This can be overridden by specifying a precision in the form %n.m where n is the padding for the whole part and m is the number of decimal places to display. n can be excluded if desired. n and m may not be more than 9. If the last parameter (after flattening) is a Exception it is Logged specially. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param message The message to Log. @param obj1 The first object to match against. @param obj2 The second object to match against. Logs a formated message. The message itself may contain % characters as place holders. This routine will attempt to match the placeholder by looking at the type of parameter passed to obj1. If the parameter is an array, it traverses the array first and matches parameters sequentially against the array items. Otherwise the parameters after message are matched in order. If the place holder matches against a number it is printed as a whole number. This can be overridden by specifying a precision in the form %n.m where n is the padding for the whole part and m is the number of decimal places to display. n can be excluded if desired. n and m may not be more than 9. If the last parameter (after flattening) is a Exception it is Logged specially. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param message The message to Log. @param obj1 The first object to match against. @param obj2 The second object to match against. @param obj3 The third object to match against. Logs a formated message. The message itself may contain % characters as place holders. This routine will attempt to match the placeholder by looking at the type of parameter passed to obj1. If the parameter is an array, it traverses the array first and matches parameters sequentially against the array items. Otherwise the parameters after message are matched in order. If the place holder matches against a number it is printed as a whole number. This can be overridden by specifying a precision in the form %n.m where n is the padding for the whole part and m is the number of decimal places to display. n can be excluded if desired. n and m may not be more than 9. If the last parameter (after flattening) is a Exception it is Logged specially. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param message The message to Log. @param obj1 The first object to match against. @param obj2 The second object to match against. @param obj3 The third object to match against. @param obj4 The forth object to match against. File header for PNG format. Checks if the offset matches the PNG header. @param data the data to check. @param offset the offset to check at. @return {@code true} if the offset matches. Map of POILogger instances, with classes as keys A common instance of NullLogger, as it does nothing we only need the one The name of the class to use. Initialised the first time we need it Initializes a new instance of the class. Get a logger, based on a class name the class whose name defines the log a POILogger for the specified class Get a logger, based on a String the String that defines the log a POILogger for the specified class package scope so it cannot be instantiated outside of the util package. You need a POILogger? Go to the POILogFactory for one Log a message @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 The object to Log. This is converted to a string. Log a message @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 The object to Log. This is converted to a string. @param exception An exception to be Logged Check if a Logger is enabled to Log at the specified level @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first object to place in the message @param obj2 second object to place in the message Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third Object to place in the message Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third Object to place in the message @param obj4 fourth Object to place in the message Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third Object to place in the message @param obj4 fourth Object to place in the message @param obj5 fifth Object to place in the message Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third Object to place in the message @param obj4 fourth Object to place in the message @param obj5 fifth Object to place in the message @param obj6 sixth Object to place in the message Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third Object to place in the message @param obj4 fourth Object to place in the message @param obj5 fifth Object to place in the message @param obj6 sixth Object to place in the message @param obj7 seventh Object to place in the message Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third Object to place in the message @param obj4 fourth Object to place in the message @param obj5 fifth Object to place in the message @param obj6 sixth Object to place in the message @param obj7 seventh Object to place in the message @param obj8 eighth Object to place in the message Log an exception, without a message @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param exception An exception to be Logged Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param exception An exception to be Logged Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third object to place in the message @param exception An error message to be Logged Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third object to place in the message @param obj4 fourth object to place in the message @param exception An exception to be Logged Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third object to place in the message @param obj4 fourth object to place in the message @param obj5 fifth object to place in the message @param exception An exception to be Logged Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third object to place in the message @param obj4 fourth object to place in the message @param obj5 fifth object to place in the message @param obj6 sixth object to place in the message @param exception An exception to be Logged Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third object to place in the message @param obj4 fourth object to place in the message @param obj5 fifth object to place in the message @param obj6 sixth object to place in the message @param obj7 seventh object to place in the message @param exception An exception to be Logged Log a message. Lazily appends Object parameters together. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param obj1 first Object to place in the message @param obj2 second Object to place in the message @param obj3 third object to place in the message @param obj4 fourth object to place in the message @param obj5 fifth object to place in the message @param obj6 sixth object to place in the message @param obj7 seventh object to place in the message @param obj8 eighth object to place in the message @param exception An exception to be Logged Logs a formated message. The message itself may contain % characters as place holders. This routine will attempt to match the placeholder by looking at the type of parameter passed to obj1. If the parameter is an array, it traverses the array first and matches parameters sequentially against the array items. Otherwise the parameters after message are matched in order. If the place holder matches against a number it is printed as a whole number. This can be overridden by specifying a precision in the form %n.m where n is the padding for the whole part and m is the number of decimal places to display. n can be excluded if desired. n and m may not be more than 9. If the last parameter (after flattening) is a Exception it is Logged specially. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param message The message to Log. @param obj1 The first object to match against. Logs a formated message. The message itself may contain % characters as place holders. This routine will attempt to match the placeholder by looking at the type of parameter passed to obj1. If the parameter is an array, it traverses the array first and matches parameters sequentially against the array items. Otherwise the parameters after message are matched in order. If the place holder matches against a number it is printed as a whole number. This can be overridden by specifying a precision in the form %n.m where n is the padding for the whole part and m is the number of decimal places to display. n can be excluded if desired. n and m may not be more than 9. If the last parameter (after flattening) is a Exception it is Logged specially. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param message The message to Log. @param obj1 The first object to match against. @param obj2 The second object to match against. Logs a formated message. The message itself may contain % characters as place holders. This routine will attempt to match the placeholder by looking at the type of parameter passed to obj1. If the parameter is an array, it traverses the array first and matches parameters sequentially against the array items. Otherwise the parameters after message are matched in order. If the place holder matches against a number it is printed as a whole number. This can be overridden by specifying a precision in the form %n.m where n is the padding for the whole part and m is the number of decimal places to display. n can be excluded if desired. n and m may not be more than 9. If the last parameter (after flattening) is a Exception it is Logged specially. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param message The message to Log. @param obj1 The first object to match against. @param obj2 The second object to match against. @param obj3 The third object to match against. Logs a formated message. The message itself may contain % characters as place holders. This routine will attempt to match the placeholder by looking at the type of parameter passed to obj1. If the parameter is an array, it traverses the array first and matches parameters sequentially against the array items. Otherwise the parameters after message are matched in order. If the place holder matches against a number it is printed as a whole number. This can be overridden by specifying a precision in the form %n.m where n is the padding for the whole part and m is the number of decimal places to display. n can be excluded if desired. n and m may not be more than 9. If the last parameter (after flattening) is a Exception it is Logged specially. @param level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL @param message The message to Log. @param obj1 The first object to match against. @param obj2 The second object to match against. @param obj3 The third object to match against. @param obj4 The forth object to match against. Flattens any contained objects. Only tranverses one level deep. Reads a byte from the stream and advances the position within the stream by one byte, or returns -1 if at the end of the stream. The unsigned byte cast to an Int32, or -1 if at the end of the stream. The stream does not support reading. Methods were called after the stream was closed. When overridden in a derived class, reads a sequence of bytes from the current stream and advances the position within the stream by the number of bytes read. An array of bytes. When this method returns, the buffer contains the specified byte array with the values between and ( + - 1) replaced by the bytes read from the current source. The zero-based byte offset in at which to begin storing the data read from the current stream. The maximum number of bytes to be read from the current stream. The total number of bytes read into the buffer. This can be less than the number of bytes requested if that many bytes are not currently available, or zero (0) if the end of the stream has been reached. The sum of and is larger than the buffer length. is null. or is negative. An I/O error occurs. The stream does not support reading. Methods were called after the stream was closed. Unreads the specified b. The b. When overridden in a derived class, gets a value indicating whether the current stream supports reading. true if the stream supports reading; otherwise, false. When overridden in a derived class, gets a value indicating whether the current stream supports seeking. true if the stream supports seeking; otherwise, false. When overridden in a derived class, gets a value indicating whether the current stream supports writing. true if the stream supports writing; otherwise, false. When overridden in a derived class, gets the length in bytes of the stream. A long value representing the length of the stream in bytes. A class derived from Stream does not support seeking. Methods were called after the stream was closed. When overridden in a derived class, gets or sets the position within the current stream. The current position within the stream. An I/O error occurs. The stream does not support seeking. Methods were called after the stream was closed. Closes the current stream and releases any resources (such as sockets and file handles) associated with the current stream. When overridden in a derived class, clears all buffers for this stream and causes any buffered data to be written to the underlying device. An I/O error occurs. When overridden in a derived class, sets the position within the current stream. A byte offset relative to the parameter. A value of type indicating the reference point used to obtain the new position. The new position within the current stream. An I/O error occurs. The stream does not support seeking, such as if the stream is constructed from a pipe or console output. Methods were called after the stream was closed. When overridden in a derived class, sets the length of the current stream. The desired length of the current stream in bytes. An I/O error occurs. The stream does not support both writing and seeking, such as if the stream is constructed from a pipe or console output. Methods were called after the stream was closed. When overridden in a derived class, writes a sequence of bytes to the current stream and advances the current position within this stream by the number of bytes written. An array of bytes. This method copies bytes from to the current stream. The zero-based byte offset in at which to begin copying bytes to the current stream. The number of bytes to be written to the current stream. The sum of and is greater than the buffer length. is null. or is negative. An I/O error occurs. The stream does not support writing. Methods were called after the stream was closed. Writes a byte to the current position in the stream and advances the position within the stream by one byte. The byte to write to the stream. An I/O error occurs. The stream does not support writing, or the stream is already closed. Methods were called after the stream was closed. A common exception thrown by our binary format Parsers (especially HSSF and DDF), when they hit invalid format or data when Processing a record. construct the ShortField with its offset into its containing byte array offset of the field within its byte array if offset is negative construct the ShortField with its offset into its containing byte array and initialize its value offset of the field within its byte array the initial value if offset is negative Construct the ShortField with its offset into its containing byte array and initialize its value from its byte array offset of the field within its byte array the byte array to read the value from if the offset is not within the range of 0..(data.length - 1) construct the ShortField with its offset into its containing byte array, initialize its value, and write its value to its byte array offset of the field within its byte array the initial value the byte array to write the value to if offset is negative Gets or sets the value. The value. set the ShortField's current value and write it to a byte array value to be set the byte array to write the value to if the offset is out of range set the value from its offset into an array of bytes the byte array from which the value is to be read if the offset is out of range set the value from an Stream the Stream from which the value is to be read if an IOException is thrown from reading the Stream if there is not enough data available from the Stream write the value out to an array of bytes at the appropriate offset the array of bytes to which the value is to be written if the offset is out of range Same as using the constructor with the same parameter list. Avoid creation of an useless object. offset of the field within its byte array the initial value the byte array to write the value to Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . A List of short's; as full an implementation of the java.Util.List interface as possible, with an eye toward minimal creation of objects the mimicry of List is as follows:
  • if possible, operations designated 'optional' in the List interface are attempted
  • wherever the List interface refers to an Object, substitute short
  • wherever the List interface refers to a Collection or List, substitute shortList
the mimicry is not perfect, however:
  • operations involving Iterators or ListIterators are not supported
  • Remove(Object) becomes RemoveValue to distinguish it from Remove(short index)
  • subList is not supported
create an shortList of default size create a copy of an existing shortList the existing shortList create an shortList with a predefined Initial size the size for the internal array add the specfied value at the specified index the index where the new value is to be Added the new value Appends the specified element to the end of this list element to be Appended to this list. return true (as per the general contract of the Collection.add method). Appends all of the elements in the specified collection to the end of this list, in the order that they are returned by the specified collection's iterator. The behavior of this operation is unspecified if the specified collection is modified while the operation is in progress. (Note that this will occur if the specified collection is this list, and it's nonempty.) collection whose elements are to be Added to this list. return true if this list Changed as a result of the call. Inserts all of the elements in the specified collection into this list at the specified position. Shifts the element currently at that position (if any) and any subsequent elements to the right (increases their indices). The new elements will appear in this list in the order that they are returned by the specified collection's iterator. The behavior of this operation is unspecified if the specified collection is modified while the operation is in progress. (Note that this will occur if the specified collection is this list, and it's nonempty.) index at which to insert first element from the specified collection. elements to be inserted into this list. return true if this list Changed as a result of the call. if the index is out of range (index < 0 || index > size()) Removes all of the elements from this list. This list will be empty After this call returns (unless it throws an exception). Returns true if this list Contains the specified element. More formally, returns true if and only if this list Contains at least one element e such that o == e element whose presence in this list is to be Tested. return true if this list Contains the specified element. Returns true if this list Contains all of the elements of the specified collection. collection to be Checked for Containment in this list. return true if this list Contains all of the elements of the specified collection. Compares the specified object with this list for Equality. Returns true if and only if the specified object is also a list, both lists have the same size, and all corresponding pairs of elements in the two lists are Equal. (Two elements e1 and e2 are equal if e1 == e2.) In other words, two lists are defined to be equal if they contain the same elements in the same order. This defInition ensures that the Equals method works properly across different implementations of the List interface. the object to be Compared for Equality with this list. return true if the specified object is equal to this list. Returns the element at the specified position in this list. index of element to return. return the element at the specified position in this list. Returns the hash code value for this list. The hash code of a list is defined to be the result of the following calculation: hashCode = 1; Iterator i = list.Iterator(); while (i.HasNext()) { Object obj = i.Next(); hashCode = 31*hashCode + (obj==null ? 0 : obj.HashCode()); } This ensures that list1.Equals(list2) implies that list1.HashCode()==list2.HashCode() for any two lists, list1 and list2, as required by the general contract of Object.HashCode. return the hash code value for this list. Returns the index in this list of the first occurrence of the specified element, or -1 if this list does not contain this element. More formally, returns the lowest index i such that (o == Get(i)), or -1 if there is no such index. element to search for. the index in this list of the first occurrence of the specified element, or -1 if this list does not contain this element. Returns true if this list Contains no elements. return true if this list Contains no elements. Returns the index in this list of the last occurrence of the specified element, or -1 if this list does not contain this element. More formally, returns the highest index i such that (o == Get(i)), or -1 if there is no such index. element to search for. return the index in this list of the last occurrence of the specified element, or -1 if this list does not contain this element. Removes the element at the specified position in this list. Shifts any subsequent elements to the left (subtracts one from their indices). Returns the element that was Removed from the list. the index of the element to Removed. return the element previously at the specified position. Removes the first occurrence in this list of the specified element (optional operation). If this list does not contain the element, it is unChanged. More formally, Removes the element with the lowest index i such that (o.Equals(get(i))) (if such an element exists). element to be Removed from this list, if present. return true if this list Contained the specified element. Removes from this list all the elements that are Contained in the specified collection collection that defines which elements will be removed from this list. return true if this list Changed as a result of the call. Retains only the elements in this list that are Contained in the specified collection. In other words, Removes from this list all the elements that are not Contained in the specified collection. collection that defines which elements this Set will retain. return true if this list Changed as a result of the call. Replaces the element at the specified position in this list with the specified element index of element to Replace. element to be stored at the specified position. return the element previously at the specified position. Returns the number of elements in this list. If this list Contains more than Int32.MaxValue elements, returns Int32.MaxValue. return the number of elements in this shortList the number of elements in this shortList Returns an array Containing all of the elements in this list in proper sequence. Obeys the general contract of the Collection.ToArray method. an array Containing all of the elements in this list in proper sequence. Returns an array Containing all of the elements in this list in proper sequence. Obeys the general contract of the Collection.ToArray(Object[]) method. the array into which the elements of this list are to be stored, if it is big enough; otherwise, a new array is allocated for this purpose. return an array Containing the elements of this list. Title: String Utility Description: Collection of string handling utilities @author Andrew C. Oliver @author Sergei Kozello (sergeikozello at mail.ru) @author Toshiaki Kamoshida (kamoshida.toshiaki at future dot co dot jp) @since May 10, 2002 @version 1.0 Constructor for the StringUtil object Given a byte array of 16-bit unicode characters in Little Endian Format (most important byte last), return a Java String representation of it. { 0x16, 0x00 } -0x16 the byte array to be converted the initial offset into the byte array. it is assumed that string[ offset ] and string[ offset + 1 ] contain the first 16-bit unicode character the Length of the string the converted string Given a byte array of 16-bit unicode characters in little endian Format (most important byte last), return a Java String representation of it. { 0x16, 0x00 } -0x16 the byte array to be converted the converted string Convert String to 16-bit unicode characters in little endian format @param string the string @return the byte array of 16-bit unicode characters Given a byte array of 16-bit unicode characters in big endian Format (most important byte first), return a Java String representation of it. { 0x00, 0x16 } -0x16 the byte array to be converted the initial offset into the byte array. it is assumed that string[ offset ] and string[ offset + 1 ] contain the first 16-bit unicode character the Length of the string the converted string Given a byte array of 16-bit unicode characters in big endian Format (most important byte first), return a Java String representation of it. { 0x00, 0x16 } -0x16 the byte array to be converted the converted string Read 8 bit data (in IsO-8859-1 codepage) into a (unicode) Java String and return. (In Excel terms, read compressed 8 bit unicode as a string) byte array to read offset to read byte array Length to read byte array generated String instance by reading byte array Takes a unicode (java) string, and returns it as 8 bit data (in IsO-8859-1 codepage). (In Excel terms, write compressed 8 bit unicode) the String containing the data to be written the byte array to which the data Is to be written an offset into the byte arrat at which the data Is start when written Takes a unicode string, and returns it as little endian (most important byte last) bytes in the supplied byte array. (In Excel terms, write uncompressed unicode) the String containing the unicode data to be written the byte array to hold the uncompressed unicode, should be twice the Length of the String the offset to start writing into the byte array Takes a unicode string, and returns it as big endian (most important byte first) bytes in the supplied byte array. (In Excel terms, write uncompressed unicode) the String containing the unicode data to be written the byte array to hold the uncompressed unicode, should be twice the Length of the String. the offset to start writing into the byte array Gets the preferred encoding. the encoding we want to use, currently hardcoded to IsO-8859-1 check the parameter Has multibyte character string to check true if Has at least one multibyte character; otherwise, false. InputStream in is expected to contain:
  1. ushort nChars
  2. byte is16BitFlag
  3. byte[]/char[] characterData
For this encoding, the is16BitFlag is always present even if nChars==0.
InputStream in is expected to contain:
  1. byte is16BitFlag
  2. byte[]/char[] characterData
For this encoding, the is16BitFlag is always present even if nChars==0.
This method should be used when the nChars field is not stored as a ushort immediately before the is16BitFlag. Otherwise, {@link #readUnicodeString(LittleEndianInput)} can be used.
OutputStream out will get:
  1. ushort nChars
  2. byte is16BitFlag
  3. byte[]/char[] characterData
For this encoding, the is16BitFlag is always present even if nChars==0.
OutputStream out will get:
  1. byte is16BitFlag
  2. byte[]/char[] characterData
For this encoding, the is16BitFlag is always present even if nChars==0.
This method should be used when the nChars field is not stored as a ushort immediately before the is16BitFlag. Otherwise, {@link #writeUnicodeString(LittleEndianOutput, String)} can be used.
Gets the number of bytes that would be written by WriteUnicodeString(LittleEndianOutput, String) The value. Checks to see if a given String needs to be represented as Unicode The value. true if string needs Unicode to be represented.; otherwise, false. Tony Qu change the logic Encodes non-US-ASCII characters in a string, good for encoding file names for download http://www.acriticsreview.com/List.aspx?listid=42 Encodes a non-US-ASCII character. Encodes a non-US-ASCII character. Encodes a non-US-ASCII character. Encodes a non-US-ASCII character. Determines if the character needs to be encoded. http://www.acriticsreview.com/List.aspx?listid=42 Some strings may contain encoded characters of the unicode private use area. Currently the characters of the symbol fonts are mapped to the corresponding characters in the normal unicode range. @param string the original string @return the string with mapped characters @see Private Use Area (symbol) @see Symbol font - Unicode alternatives for Greek and special characters in HTML The minimum value of a Unicode high-surrogate code unit in the UTF-16 encoding, constant {@code '\u005CuD800'}. A high-surrogate is also known as a leading-surrogate. @since 1.5 The maximum value of a Unicode high-surrogate code unit in the UTF-16 encoding, constant {@code '\u005CuDBFF'}. A high-surrogate is also known as a leading-surrogate. @since 1.5 The minimum value of a Unicode low-surrogate code unit in the UTF-16 encoding, constant {@code '\u005CuDC00'}. A low-surrogate is also known as a trailing-surrogate. @since 1.5 The maximum value of a Unicode low-surrogate code unit in the UTF-16 encoding, constant {@code '\u005CuDFFF'}. A low-surrogate is also known as a trailing-surrogate. @since 1.5 Converts the specified surrogate pair to its supplementary code point value. This method does not validate the specified surrogate pair. The caller must validate it using {@link #isSurrogatePair(char, char) isSurrogatePair} if necessary. @param high the high-surrogate code unit @param low the low-surrogate code unit @return the supplementary code point composed from the specified surrogate pair. @since 1.5 Determines the number of {@code char} values needed to represent the specified character (Unicode code point). If the specified character is equal to or greater than 0x10000, then the method returns 2. Otherwise, the method returns 1. This method doesn't validate the specified character to be a valid Unicode code point. The caller must validate the character value using {@link #isValidCodePoint(int) isValidCodePoint} if necessary. @param codePoint the character (Unicode code point) to be tested. @return 2 if the character is a valid supplementary character; 1 otherwise. @see Character#isSupplementaryCodePoint(int) @since 1.5 A logger class that strives to make it as easy as possible for developers to write log calls, while simultaneously making those calls as cheap as possible by performing lazy Evaluation of the log message. @author Marc Johnson (mjohnson at apache dot org) @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) @author Nicola Ken Barozzi (nicolaken at apache.org) Log a message One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL The object to log. Log a message One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL The object to log. This is Converted to a string. An exception to be logged Check if a logger is enabled to log at the specified level One of DEBUG, INFO, WARN, ERROR, FATAL Creates a temporary file. Files are collected into one directory and by default are deleted on exit from the VM. Files can be kept by defining the system property poi.keep.tmp.files. Dont forget to close all files or it might not be possible to delete them. construct the with its offset into its containing byte array The offset. construct the LongField with its offset into its containing byte array and initialize its value offset of the field within its byte array the initial value Construct the class with its offset into its containing byte array and initialize its value from its byte array The offset of the field within its byte array the byte array to read the value from construct the class with its offset into its containing byte array, initialize its value, and write the value to a byte array offset of the field within its byte array the initial value the byte array to write the value to Getg or sets the LongField's current value The current value set the LongField's current value and write it to a byte array value to be set the byte array to write the value to set the value from its offset into an array of bytes the byte array from which the value is to be read set the value from an Stream the Stream from which the value is to be write the value out to an array of bytes at the appropriate offset the array of bytes to which the value is to be written Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . @author Yegor Kozlov Converts a value of type FixedPoint to a decimal number @param fixedPoint @return decimal number @see [MS-OSHARED] - 2.2.1.6 FixedPoint Common interface for Excel text extractors, covering HSSF and XSSF Retreives the text contents of the file Formats a date value. @author Ken Arnold, Industrious Media LLC Creates a new date formatter with the given specification. @param format The format. {@inheritDoc} {@inheritDoc}

For a date, this is "mm/d/y". This class : printing out an elapsed time format. @author Ken Arnold, Industrious Media LLC Creates a elapsed time formatter. @param pattern The pattern to Parse. {@inheritDoc} {@inheritDoc}

For a date, this is "mm/d/y". Format a value according to the standard Excel behavior. This "standard" is not explicitly documented by Microsoft, so the behavior is determined by experimentation; see the tests. An Excel format has up to four parts, Separated by semicolons. Each part specifies what to do with particular kinds of values, depending on the number of parts given: - One part (example: [Green]#.##) If the value is a number, display according to this one part (example: green text, with up to two decimal points). If the value is text, display it as is. - Two parts (example: [Green]#.##;[Red]#.##) If the value is a positive number or zero, display according to the first part (example: green text, with up to two decimal points); if it is a negative number, display according to the second part (example: red text, with up to two decimal points). If the value is text, display it as is. - Three parts (example: [Green]#.##;[Black]#.##;[Red]#.##) If the value is a positive number, display according to the first part (example: green text, with up to two decimal points); if it is zero, display according to the second part (example: black text, with up to two decimal points); if it is a negative number, display according to the third part (example: red text, with up to two decimal points). If the value is text, display it as is. - Four parts (example: [Green]#.##;[Black]#.##;[Red]#.##;[@]) If the value is a positive number, display according to the first part (example: green text, with up to two decimal points); if it is zero, display according to the second part (example: black text, with up to two decimal points); if it is a negative number, display according to the third part (example: red text, with up to two decimal points). If the value is text, display according to the fourth part (example: text in the cell's usual color, with the text value surround by brackets). In Addition to these, there is a general format that is used when no format is specified. This formatting is presented by the {@link #GENERAL_FORMAT} object. @author Ken Arnold, Industrious Media LLC Format a value as it would be were no format specified. This is also used when the format specified is General. Maps a format string to its Parsed version for efficiencies sake. Returns a {@link CellFormat} that applies the given format. Two calls with the same format may or may not return the same object. @param format The format. @return A {@link CellFormat} that applies the given format. Creates a new object. @param format The format. Returns the result of Applying the format to the given value. If the value is a number (a type of {@link Number} object), the correct number format type is chosen; otherwise it is considered a text object. @param value The value @return The result, in a {@link CellFormatResult}. Returns the result of applying the format to the given date. @param date The date. @param numericValue The numeric value for the date. @return The result, in a {@link CellFormatResult}. Fetches the appropriate value from the cell, and returns the result of Applying it to the appropriate format. For formula cells, the computed value is what is used. @param c The cell. @return The result, in a {@link CellFormatResult}. Returns the {@link CellFormatPart} that applies to the value. Result depends on how many parts the cell format has, the cell value and any conditions. The value must be a {@link Number}. @param value The value. @return The {@link CellFormatPart} that applies to the value. Returns the ultimate cell type, following the results of formulas. If the cell is a {@link Cell#CELL_TYPE_FORMULA}, this returns the result of {@link Cell#getCachedFormulaResultType()}. Otherwise this returns the result of {@link Cell#getCellType()}. @param cell The cell. @return The ultimate type of this cell. Returns true if the other object is a {@link CellFormat} object with the same format. @param obj The other object. @return true if the two objects are Equal. Returns a hash code for the format. @return A hash code for the format. This object represents a condition in a cell format. @author Ken Arnold, Industrious Media LLC Returns an instance of a condition object. @param opString The operator as a string. One of "<", "<=", ">", ">=", "=", "==", "!=", or "<>". @param constStr The constant (such as "12"). @return A condition object for the given condition. Returns true if the given value passes the constraint's test. @param value The value to compare against. @return true if the given value passes the constraint's test. Objects of this class represent a single part of a cell format expression. Each cell can have up to four of these for positive, zero, negative, and text values.

Each format part can contain a color, a condition, and will always contain a format specification. For example "[Red][>=10]#" has a color ([Red]), a condition (>=10) and a format specification (#).

This class also Contains patterns for matching the subparts of format specification. These are used internally, but are made public in case other code has use for them. @author Ken Arnold, Industrious Media LLC Pattern for the color part of a cell format part. Pattern for the condition part of a cell format part. Pattern for the format specification part of a cell format part. Pattern for an entire cell single part. Within {@link #FORMAT_PAT}, the group number for the matched color. Within {@link #FORMAT_PAT}, the group number for the operator in the condition. Within {@link #FORMAT_PAT}, the group number for the value in the condition. Within {@link #FORMAT_PAT}, the group number for the format specification. Create an object to represent a format part. @param desc The string to Parse. Returns true if this format part applies to the given value. If the value is a number and this is part has a condition, returns true only if the number passes the condition. Otherwise, this allways return true. @param valueObject The value to Evaluate. @return true if this format part applies to the given value. Returns the number of the first group that is the same as the marker string. The search starts with group 1. @param pat The pattern to use. @param str The string to match against the pattern. @param marker The marker value to find the group of. @return The matching group number. @throws ArgumentException No group matches the marker. Returns the color specification from the matcher, or null if there is none. @param m The matcher for the format part. @return The color specification or null. Returns the condition specification from the matcher, or null if there is none. @param m The matcher for the format part. @return The condition specification or null. Returns the CellFormatType object implied by the format specification for the format part. @param matcher The matcher for the format part. @return The CellFormatType. Returns the formatter object implied by the format specification for the format part. @param matcher The matcher for the format part. @return The formatter. Returns the type of format. @param fdesc The format specification @return The type of format. Returns a version of the original string that has any special characters quoted (or escaped) as appropriate for the cell format type. The format type object is queried to see what is special. @param repl The original string. @param type The format type representation object. @return A version of the string with any special characters Replaced. @see CellFormatType#isSpecial(char) Apply this format part to the given value. This returns a {@link CellFormatResult} object with the results. @param value The value to apply this format part to. @return A {@link CellFormatResult} object Containing the results of Applying the format to the value. Returns the CellFormatType object implied by the format specification for the format part. @return The CellFormatType. Returns true if this format part has a condition. @return true if this format part has a condition. Expands a character. This is only partly done, because we don't have the correct info. In Excel, this would be expanded to fill the rest of the cell, but we don't know, in general, what the "rest of the cell" is1. @param part The character to be repeated is the second character in this string. @return The character repeated three times. Returns the string from the group, or "" if the group is null. @param m The matcher. @param g The group number. @return The group or "". This object Contains the result of Applying a cell format or cell format part to a value. @author Ken Arnold, Industrious Media LLC @see CellFormatPart#Apply(Object) @see CellFormat#Apply(Object) This is true if no condition was given that applied to the value, or if the condition is satisfied. If a condition is relevant, and when applied the value fails the test, this is false. The resulting text. This will never be null. The color the format Sets, or null if the format Sets no color. This will always be null if {@link #applies} is false. Creates a new format result object. @param applies The value for {@link #applies}. @param text The value for {@link #text}. @param textColor The value for {@link #textColor}. This is the abstract supertype for the various cell formatters. @author Ken Arnold, Industrious Media LLC The original specified format. This is the locale used to Get a consistent format result from which to work. Creates a new formatter object, storing the format in {@link #format}. @param format The format. Format a value according the format string. @param toAppendTo The buffer to append to. @param value The value to format. Format a value according to the type, in the most basic way. @param toAppendTo The buffer to append to. @param value The value to format. Formats the value, returning the resulting string. @param value The value to format. @return The value, formatted. Formats the value in the most basic way, returning the resulting string. @param value The value to format. @return The value, formatted. Returns the input string, surrounded by quotes. @param str The string to quote. @return The input string, surrounded by quotes. The different kinds of formats that the formatter understands. @author Ken Arnold, Industrious Media LLC The general (default) format; also used for "General". A numeric format. A date format. An elapsed time format. A text format. Returns true if the format is special and needs to be quoted. @param ch The character to test. @return true if the format is special and needs to be quoted. Returns a new formatter of the appropriate type, for the given pattern. The pattern must be appropriate for the type. @param pattern The pattern to use. @return A new formatter of the appropriate type, for the given pattern. A formatter for the default "General" cell format. @author Ken Arnold, Industrious Media LLC Creates a new general formatter. The general style is not quite the same as any other, or any combination of others. @param toAppendTo The buffer to append to. @param value The value to format. Equivalent to {@link #formatValue(StringBuilder,Object)}. {@inheritDoc}. This class : printing out a value using a number format. @author Ken Arnold, Industrious Media LLC

The CellNumberFormatter.simpleValue() method uses the SIMPLE_NUMBER CellFormatter defined here. The CellFormat.GENERAL_FORMAT CellFormat no longer uses the SIMPLE_NUMBER CellFormatter. Note that the simpleValue()/SIMPLE_NUMBER CellFormatter format ("#" for integer values, and "#.#" for floating-point values) is different from the 'General' format for numbers ("#" for integer values and "#.#########" for floating-point values).
This class is used to mark where the special characters in the format are, as opposed to the other characters that are simply printed. This class represents a single modification to a result string. The way this works is complicated, but so is numeric formatting. In general, for most formats, we use a DecimalFormat object that will Put the string out in a known format, usually with all possible leading and trailing zeros. We then walk through the result and the orginal format, and note any modifications that need to be made. Finally, we go through and apply them all, dealing with overlapping modifications. Creates a new cell number formatter. @param format The format to Parse. {@inheritDoc} {@inheritDoc}

For a number, this is "#" for integer values, and "#.#" for floating-point values. This class : printing out text. @author Ken Arnold, Industrious Media LLC {@inheritDoc} {@inheritDoc}

For text, this is just printing the text. The denominator. The numerator. Create a fraction given a double value and a denominator. @param val double value of fraction @param exactDenom the exact denominator @return a SimpleFraction with the given values set. Create a fraction given the double value and either the maximum error allowed or the maximum number of denominator digits. @param value the double value to convert to a fraction. @param maxDenominator maximum denominator value allowed. @throws RuntimeException if the continued fraction failed to converge. @throws IllegalArgumentException if value > Integer.MAX_VALUE Create a fraction given the double value and either the maximum error allowed or the maximum number of denominator digits.

References:

Based on org.apache.commons.math.fraction.Fraction from Apache Commons-Math. YK: The only reason of having this class is to avoid dependency on the Commons-Math jar. @param value the double value to convert to a fraction. @param epsilon maximum error allowed. The resulting fraction is within epsilon of value, in absolute terms. @param maxDenominator maximum denominator value allowed. @param maxIterations maximum number of convergents @throws RuntimeException if the continued fraction failed to converge. @throws IllegalArgumentException if value > Integer.MAX_VALUE
Create a fraction given a numerator and denominator. @param numerator @param denominator maxDenominator The maximum allowed value for denominator Access the denominator. @return the denominator. Access the numerator. @return the numerator. Returns a collection of ATP function names implemented by POI. @return an array of supported functions @since 3.8 beta6 Returns a collection of ATP function names NOT implemented by POI. @return an array of not supported functions @since 3.8 beta6 Register a ATP function in runtime. @param name the function name @param func the functoin to register @throws ArgumentException if the function is unknown or already registered. @since 3.8 beta6 Evaluator for formula arguments. @author jfaenomoto@gmail.com Evaluate a generic {@link ValueEval} argument to a double value that represents a date in POI. @param arg {@link ValueEval} an argument. @param srcCellRow number cell row. @param srcCellCol number cell column. @return a double representing a date in POI. @throws EvaluationException exception upon argument evaluation. Evaluate a generic {@link ValueEval} argument to an array of double values that represents dates in POI. @param arg {@link ValueEval} an argument. @param srcCellRow number cell row. @param srcCellCol number cell column. @return an array of doubles representing dates in POI. @throws EvaluationException exception upon argument evaluation. Evaluate a generic {@link ValueEval} argument to a double value. @param arg {@link ValueEval} an argument. @param srcCellRow number cell row. @param srcCellCol number cell column. @return a double value. @throws EvaluationException exception upon argument evaluation. Parser for java dates. @author jfaenomoto@gmail.com Parses a date from a string. @param strVal a string with a date pattern. @return a date parsed from argument. @throws EvaluationException exception upon parsing. @param month 1-based Implementation of Excel 'Analysis ToolPak' function MROUND()
Returns a number rounded to the desired multiple.

Syntax
MROUND(number, multiple)

@author Yegor Kozlov Implementation of Excel 'Analysis ToolPak' function NETWORKDAYS()
Returns the number of workdays given a starting and an ending date, considering an interval of holidays. A workday is any non saturday/sunday date.

Syntax
NETWORKDAYS(startDate, endDate, holidays)

@author jfaenomoto@gmail.com Constructor. @param anEvaluator an injected {@link ArgumentsEvaluator}. Evaluate for NETWORKDAYS. Given two dates and a optional date or interval of holidays, determines how many working days are there between those dates. @return {@link ValueEval} for the number of days between two dates. Implementation of Excel 'Analysis ToolPak' function ISEVEN() ISODD()
@author Josh Micich
* Implementation of Excel 'Analysis ToolPak' function RANDBETWEEN()
* * Returns a random integer number between the numbers you specify.

* * Syntax
* RANDBETWEEN(bottom, top)

* * bottom is the smallest integer RANDBETWEEN will return.
* top is the largest integer RANDBETWEEN will return.
* @author Brendan Nolan Evaluate for RANDBETWEEN(). Must be given two arguments. Bottom must be greater than top. Bottom is rounded up and top value is rounded down. After rounding top has to be set greater than top. @see org.apache.poi.ss.formula.functions.FreeRefFunction#evaluate(org.apache.poi.ss.formula.eval.ValueEval[], org.apache.poi.ss.formula.OperationEvaluationContext) A calculator for workdays, considering dates as excel representations. @author jfaenomoto@gmail.com Constructor. Calculate how many workdays are there between a start and an end date, as excel representations, considering a range of holidays. @param start start date. @param end end date. @param holidays an array of holidays. @return number of workdays between start and end dates, including both dates. Calculate the workday past x workdays from a starting date, considering a range of holidays. @param start start date. @param workdays number of workdays to be past from starting date. @param holidays an array of holidays. @return date past x workdays. Calculates how many days of week past between a start and an end date. @param start start date. @param end end date. @param dayOfWeek a day of week as represented by {@link Calendar} constants. @return how many days of week past in this interval. Calculates how many holidays in a list are workdays, considering an interval of dates. @param start start date. @param end end date. @param holidays an array of holidays. @return number of holidays that occur in workdays, between start and end dates. @param aDate a given date. @return true if date is weekend, false otherwise. @param aDate a given date. @param holidays an array of holidays. @return true if date is a holiday, false otherwise. @param aDate a given date. @param holidays an array of holidays. @return 1 is not a workday, 0 otherwise. @param start start date. @param end end date. @param aDate a date to be analyzed. @return true if aDate is between start and end dates, false otherwise. Implementation of Excel 'Analysis ToolPak' function WORKDAY()
Returns the date past a number of workdays beginning at a start date, considering an interval of holidays. A workday is any non saturday/sunday date.

Syntax
WORKDAY(startDate, days, holidays)

@author jfaenomoto@gmail.com Evaluate for WORKDAY. Given a date, a number of days and a optional date or interval of holidays, determines which date it is past number of parametrized workdays. @return {@link ValueEval} with date as its value. Implementation of Excel 'Analysis ToolPak' function YEARFRAC()
Returns the fraction of the year spanned by two dates.

Syntax
YEARFRAC(startDate, endDate, basis)

The basis optionally specifies the behaviour of YEARFRAC as follows:
ValueDays per MonthDays per Year
0 (default)30360
1actualactual
2actual360
3actual365
430360

Internal calculation methods for Excel 'Analysis ToolPak' function YEARFRAC() Algorithm inspired by www.dwheeler.com/yearfrac @author Josh Micich Date Count convention http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Day_count_convention Office Online Help on YEARFRAC http://office.microsoft.com/en-us/excel/HP052093441033.aspx
use UTC time-zone to avoid daylight savings issues the length of normal long months i.e. 31 the length of normal short months i.e. 30 Calculates YEARFRAC() The start date. The end date. The basis value. Basis 0, 30/360 date convention The start date value assumed to be less than or equal to endDateVal. The end date value assumed to be greater than or equal to startDateVal. Basis 1, Actual/Actual date convention The start date value assumed to be less than or equal to endDateVal. The end date value assumed to be greater than or equal to startDateVal. Basis 2, Actual/360 date convention The start date value assumed to be less than or equal to endDateVal. The end date value assumed to be greater than or equal to startDateVal. Basis 3, Actual/365 date convention The start date value assumed to be less than or equal to endDateVal. The end date value assumed to be greater than or equal to startDateVal. Basis 4, European 30/360 date convention The start date value assumed to be less than or equal to endDateVal. The end date value assumed to be greater than or equal to startDateVal. Calculates the adjusted. The start date. The end date. The date1day. The date2day. Determines whether [is last day of month] [the specified date]. The date. true if [is last day of month] [the specified date]; otherwise, false. Gets the last day of month. The date. Assumes dates are no more than 1 year apart. The start. The end. true if dates both within a leap year, or span a period including Feb 29 return the whole number of days between the two time-stamps. Both time-stamps are assumed to represent 12:00 midnight on the respective day. The start date ticks. The end date ticks. Averages the length of the year. The start year. The end year. determine Leap Year the year Determines whether [is greater than one year] [the specified start]. The start date. The end date. true if [is greater than one year] [the specified start]; otherwise, false. Creates the date. The day count. Simple Date Wrapper 1-based month day of month milliseconds since 1970 Stores the parameters that identify the evaluation of one cell.
Calls formulaCell.SetFormulaResult(null, null) recursively all the way up the tree of dependencies. Calls usedCell.ClearConsumingCell(fc) for each child of a cell that Is Cleared along the way. @param formulaCells Identical To {@link #RecurseClearCachedFormulaResults()} except for the listener call-backs Stores details about the current evaluation of a cell.
@param inputCell a cell directly used by the formula of this evaluation frame @return never null, (possibly empty) array of all cells directly used while evaluating the formula of this frame. Manages a collection of {@link WorkbookEvaluator}s, in order To support evaluation of formulas across spreadsheets.

For POI internal use only @author Josh Micich To support Constant Values (2.5.7) as required by the CRN record. This class is also used for two dimensional arrays which are encoded by EXTERNALNAME (5.39) records and Array tokens.

@author Josh Micich @return encoded size without the 'type' code byte

Represents a constant error code value as encoded in a constant values array. This class is a type-safe wrapper for a 16-bit int value performing a similar job to ErrorEval @author Josh Micich
Initializes a new instance of the class. The error code. Gets the error code. The error code. Gets the text. The text. Values the of. The error code. Returns a that represents the current . A that represents the current . Performance optimisation for {@link HSSFFormulaEvaluator}. This class stores previously calculated values of already visited cells, To avoid unnecessary re-calculation when the same cells are referenced multiple times @author Josh Micich only used for testing. null otherwise Should be called whenever there are Changes To input cells in the evaluated workbook. Abstracts a cell for the purpose of formula evaluation. This interface represents both formula and non-formula cells.
Implementors of this class must implement {@link #HashCode()} and {@link #Equals(Object)} To provide an identity relationship based on the underlying HSSF or XSSF cell

For POI internal use only @author Josh Micich Abstracts a name record for formula evaluation.
For POI internal use only @author Josh Micich
Abstracts a sheet for the purpose of formula evaluation.
For POI internal use only @author Josh Micich
@return null if there is no cell at the specified coordinates

Instances of this class keep track of multiple dependent cell evaluations due To recursive calls To The main purpose of this class is To detect an attempt To evaluate a cell that is already being evaluated. In other words, it detects circular references in spreadsheet formulas. @author Josh Micich
Notifies this evaluation tracker that evaluation of the specified cell Is about To start.
In the case of a true return code, the caller should continue evaluation of the specified cell, and also be sure To call endEvaluate() when complete.
In the case of a null return code, the caller should return an evaluation result of ErrorEval.CIRCULAR_REF_ERROR, and not call endEvaluate().
@return false if the specified cell is already being evaluated
Notifies this evaluation tracker that the evaluation of the specified cell is complete.

Every successful call To startEvaluate must be followed by a call To endEvaluate (recommended in a finally block) To enable proper tracking of which cells are being evaluated at any point in time.

Assuming a well behaved client, parameters To this method would not be required. However, they have been included To assert correct behaviour, and form more meaningful error messages. Abstracts a workbook for the purpose of formula evaluation.
For POI internal use only @author Josh Micich
@return -1 if the specified sheet is from a different book HSSF Only - fetch the external-style sheet details

Return will have no workbook set if it's actually in our own workbook

XSSF Only - fetch the external-style sheet details

Return will have no workbook set if it's actually in our own workbook

HSSF Only - convert an external sheet index to an internal sheet index, for an external-style reference to one of this workbook's own sheets HSSF Only - fetch the external-style name details XSSF Only - fetch the external-style name details Evaluation of 2D (Row+Column) and 3D (Sheet+Row+Column) areas returns the 0-based index of the first row in this area. returns the 0-based index of the last row in this area. returns the 0-based index of the first col in this area. returns the 0-based index of the last col in this area. returns true if the cell at row and col specified as absolute indexes in the sheet is contained in this area. @param row @param col returns true if the specified col is in range @param col returns true if the specified row is in range @param row @return the ValueEval from within this area at the specified row and col index. Never null (possibly {@link BlankEval}). The specified indexes should be absolute indexes in the sheet and not relative indexes within the area. @return the ValueEval from within this area at the specified relativeRowIndex and relativeColumnIndex. Never null (possibly {@link BlankEval}). The specified indexes should relative to the top left corner of this area. Creates an {@link AreaEval} offset by a relative amount from from the upper left cell of this area @author Josh Micich @return whether cell at rowIndex and columnIndex is a subtotal. By default return false which means 'don't care about subtotals' @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > This class is a marker class. It is a special value for empty cells. @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Convenience method for the following:
(b ? BoolEval.TRUE : BoolEval.FALSE) @return a BoolEval instance representing b.
@author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > #NULL! - Intersection of two cell ranges is empty #DIV/0! - Division by zero #VALUE! - Wrong type of operand #REF! - Illegal or deleted cell reference #NAME? - Wrong function or range name #NUM! - Value range overflow #N/A - Argument or function not available Translates an Excel internal error code into the corresponding POI ErrorEval instance @param errorCode Converts error codes to text. Handles non-standard error codes OK. For debug/test purposes (and for formatting error messages). @return the String representation of the specified Excel error code. @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > This class is used to simplify error handling logic within operator and function implementations. Note - OperationEval.Evaluate() and Function.Evaluate() method signatures do not throw this exception so it cannot propagate outside.

Here is an example coded without EvaluationException, to show how it can help:

             public Eval Evaluate(Eval[] args, int srcRow, short srcCol) {
            	// ...
            	Eval arg0 = args[0];
            	if(arg0 is ErrorEval) {
            		return arg0;
            	}
            	if(!(arg0 is AreaEval)) {
            		return ErrorEval.VALUE_INVALID;
            	}
            	double temp = 0;
            	AreaEval area = (AreaEval)arg0;
            	ValueEval[] values = area.LittleEndianConstants.BYTE_SIZE;
            	for (int i = 0; i < values.Length; i++) {
            		ValueEval ve = values[i];
            		if(ve is ErrorEval) {
            			return ve;
            		}
            		if(!(ve is NumericValueEval)) {
            			return ErrorEval.VALUE_INVALID;
            		}
            		temp += ((NumericValueEval)ve).NumberValue;
            	}
            	// ...
             }	 
             
In this example, if any error is encountered while Processing the arguments, an error is returned immediately. This code is difficult to refactor due to all the points where errors are returned.
Using EvaluationException allows the error returning code to be consolidated to one place.

             public Eval Evaluate(Eval[] args, int srcRow, short srcCol) {
            	try {
            		// ...
            		AreaEval area = GetAreaArg(args[0]);
            		double temp = sumValues(area.LittleEndianConstants.BYTE_SIZE);
            		// ...
            	} catch (EvaluationException e) {
            		return e.GetErrorEval();
            	}
            }
            
            private static AreaEval GetAreaArg(Eval arg0){
            	if (arg0 is ErrorEval) {
            		throw new EvaluationException((ErrorEval) arg0);
            	}
            	if (arg0 is AreaEval) {
            		return (AreaEval) arg0;
            	}
            	throw EvaluationException.InvalidValue();
            }
            
            private double sumValues(ValueEval[] values){
            	double temp = 0;
            	for (int i = 0; i < values.Length; i++) {
            		ValueEval ve = values[i];
            		if (ve is ErrorEval) {
            			throw new EvaluationException((ErrorEval) ve);
            		}
            		if (!(ve is NumericValueEval)) {
            			throw EvaluationException.InvalidValue();
            		}
            		temp += ((NumericValueEval) ve).NumberValue;
            	}
            	return temp;
            }
             
It is not mandatory to use EvaluationException, doing so might give the following advantages:
- Methods can more easily be extracted, allowing for re-use.
- Type management (typecasting etc) is simpler because error conditions have been Separated from intermediate calculation values.
- Fewer local variables are required. Local variables can have stronger types.
- It is easier to mimic common Excel error handling behaviour (exit upon encountering first error), because exceptions conveniently propagate up the call stack regardless of execution points or the number of levels of nested calls.

Note - Only standard evaluation errors are represented by EvaluationException ( i.e. conditions expected to be encountered when evaluating arbitrary Excel formulas). Conditions that could never occur in an Excel spReadsheet should result in runtime exceptions. Care should be taken to not translate any POI internal error into an Excel evaluation error code. @author Josh Micich #VALUE! - Wrong type of operand #REF! - Illegal or deleted cell reference #NUM! - Value range overflow Evaluation of a Name defined in a Sheet or Workbook scope Represents a cell being used for forked Evaluation that has had a value Set different from the corresponding cell in the shared master workbook. @author Josh Micich corresponding cell from master workbook Represents a sheet being used for forked Evaluation. Initially, objects of this class contain only the cells from the master workbook. By calling {@link #getOrCreateUpdatableCell(int, int)}, the master cell object is logically Replaced with a {@link ForkedEvaluationCell} instance, which will be used in all subsequent Evaluations. @author Josh Micich Only cells which have been split are Put in this map. (This has been done to conserve memory). Represents a workbook being used for forked Evaluation. Most operations are delegated to the shared master workbook, except those that potentially involve cell values that may have been updated After a call to {@link #getOrCreateUpdatableCell(String, int, int)}. @author Josh Micich An alternative workbook Evaluator that saves memory in situations where a single workbook is concurrently and independently Evaluated many times. With standard formula Evaluation, around 90% of memory consumption is due to loading of the {@link HSSFWorkbook} or {@link NPOI.xssf.usermodel.XSSFWorkbook}. This class enables a 'master workbook' to be loaded just once and shared between many Evaluation clients. Each Evaluation client Creates its own {@link ForkedEvaluator} and can Set cell values that will be used for local Evaluations (and don't disturb Evaluations on other Evaluators). @author Josh Micich @deprecated (Sep 2009) (reduce overloading) use {@link #Create(Workbook, IStabilityClassifier, UDFFinder)} @param udfFinder pass null for default (AnalysisToolPak only) Sets the specified cell to the supplied value @param sheetName the name of the sheet Containing the cell @param rowIndex zero based @param columnIndex zero based Copies the values of all updated cells (modified by calls to {@link #updateCell(String, int, int, ValueEval)}) to the supplied workbook.
Typically, the supplied workbook is a writable copy of the 'master workbook', but at the very least it must contain sheets with the same names.
If cell Contains a formula, the formula is Evaluated and returned, else the CellValue simply copies the appropriate cell value from the cell and also its cell type. This method should be preferred over EvaluateInCell() when the call should not modify the contents of the original cell. @param sheetName the name of the sheet Containing the cell @param rowIndex zero based @param columnIndex zero based @return null if the supplied cell is null or blank Coordinates several formula Evaluators together so that formulas that involve external references can be Evaluated. @param workbookNames the simple file names used to identify the workbooks in formulas with external links (for example "MyData.xls" as used in a formula "[MyData.xls]Sheet1!A1") @param Evaluators all Evaluators for the full Set of workbooks required by the formulas. @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Some function IDs that require special treatment 1 78 100 148 255 Register a new function in runtime. @param name the function name @param func the functoin to register @throws ArgumentException if the function is unknown or already registered. @since 3.8 beta6 Returns a collection of function names implemented by POI. @return an array of supported functions @since 3.8 beta6 Returns an array of function names NOT implemented by POI. @return an array of not supported functions @since 3.8 beta6 @author Josh Micich Creates a NameEval representing a function name @author Josh Micich @return simple rectangular {@link AreaEval} which represents the intersection of areas aeA and aeB. If the two areas do not intersect, the result is null. An exception thrown by implementors of {@link FormulaEvaluator} when attempting to evaluate a formula which requires a function that POI does not (yet) support. @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Provides functionality for evaluating arguments to functions and operators. @author Josh Micich Retrieves a single value from a variety of different argument types according to standard Excel rules. Does not perform any type conversion. @param arg the Evaluated argument as passed to the function or operator. @param srcCellRow used when arg is a single column AreaRef @param srcCellCol used when arg is a single row AreaRef @return a NumberEval, StringEval, BoolEval or BlankEval. Never null or ErrorEval. @throws EvaluationException(#VALUE!) if srcCellRow or srcCellCol do not properly index into an AreaEval. If the actual value retrieved is an ErrorEval, a corresponding EvaluationException is thrown. Implements (some perhaps not well known) Excel functionality to select a single cell from an area depending on the coordinates of the calling cell. Here is an example demonstrating both selection from a single row area and a single column area in the same formula.
A B C D
1152025
2 200
3 300
3 400
If the formula "=1000+A1:B1+D2:D3" is put into the 9 cells from A2 to C4, the spReadsheet will look like this:
A B C D
1152025
212151220#VALUE!200
313151320#VALUE!300
4#VALUE!#VALUE!#VALUE!400
Note that the row area (A1:B1) does not include column C and the column area (D2:D3) does not include row 4, so the values in C1(=25) and D4(=400) are not accessible to the formula as written, but in the 4 cells A2:B3, the row and column selection works ok.

The same concept is extended to references across sheets, such that even multi-row, multi-column areas can be useful.

Of course with carefully (or carelessly) chosen parameters, cyclic references can occur and hence this method can throw a 'circular reference' EvaluationException. Note that this method does not attempt to detect cycles. Every cell in the specified Area ae has already been Evaluated prior to this method call. Any cell (or cells) part of ae that would incur a cyclic reference error if selected by this method, will already have the value ErrorEval.CIRCULAR_REF_ERROR upon entry to this method. It is assumed logic exists elsewhere to produce this behaviour. @return whatever the selected cell's Evaluated value Is. Never null. Never ErrorEval. @if there is a problem with indexing into the area, or if the Evaluated cell has an error. @return possibly ErrorEval, and null Applies some conversion rules if the supplied value is not already an integer.
Value is first Coerced to a double ( See CoerceValueTodouble() ).

Excel typically Converts doubles to integers by truncating toward negative infinity.
The equivalent java code Is:
return (int)Math.floor(d);
not:
return (int)d; // wrong - rounds toward zero Applies some conversion rules if the supplied value is not already a number. Note - BlankEval is not supported and must be handled by the caller. @param ev must be a NumberEval, StringEval or BoolEval @return actual, Parsed or interpreted double value (respectively). @throws EvaluationException(#VALUE!) only if a StringEval is supplied and cannot be Parsed as a double (See Parsedouble() for allowable formats). @throws Exception if the supplied parameter is not NumberEval, StringEval or BoolEval Converts a string to a double using standard rules that Excel would use.
Tolerates currency prefixes, commas, leading and trailing spaces.

Some examples:
" 123 " -> 123.0
".123" -> 0.123
These not supported yet:
" $ 1,000.00 " -> 1000.0
"$1.25E4" -> 12500.0
"5**2" -> 500
"250%" -> 2.5
@param text @return null if the specified text cannot be Parsed as a number @param ve must be a NumberEval, StringEval, BoolEval, or BlankEval @return the Converted string value. never null @return null to represent blank values @throws EvaluationException if ve is an ErrorEval, or if a string value cannot be converted @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Implementation of Excel formula token '%'.

@author Josh Micich @author Josh Micich @author Amol S Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > RefEval is the base interface for Ref2D and Ref3DEval. Basically a RefEval impl should contain reference to the original ReferencePtg or Ref3DPtg as well as the "value" resulting from the evaluation of the cell reference. Thus if the HSSFCell has type CELL_TYPE_NUMERIC, the contained value object should be of type NumberEval; if cell type is CELL_TYPE_STRING, contained value object should be of type StringEval The (possibly Evaluated) ValueEval contained in this RefEval. eg. if cell A1 Contains "test" then in a formula referring to cell A1 the RefEval representing A1 will return as the InnerValueEval the object of concrete type StringEval returns the zero based column index. returns the zero based row index. returns the number of sheets this applies to Creates an {@link AreaEval} offset by a relative amount from this RefEval @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo Dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @return never null, possibly empty string. @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > This is a documentation of the observed behaviour of the '+' operator in Excel: - 1+TRUE = 2 - 1+FALSE = 1 - 1+"true" = #VALUE! - 1+"1" = 2 - 1+A1 = #VALUE if A1 Contains "1" - 1+A1 = 2 if A1 Contains ="1" - 1+A1 = 2 if A1 Contains TRUE or =TRUE - 1+A1 = #VALUE! if A1 Contains "TRUE" or ="TRUE" @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Should be implemented by any {@link Ptg} subclass that needs Has an extern sheet index
For POI internal use only @author Josh Micich
Encapsulates an encoded formula token array. @author Josh Micich immutable Convenience method for {@link #read(int, LittleEndianInput, int)} When there are no array constants present, encodedTokenLen==totalEncodedLen @param encodedTokenLen number of bytes in the stream taken by the plain formula tokens @param totalEncodedLen the total number of bytes in the formula (includes trailing encoding for array constants, but does not include 2 bytes for initial ushort encodedTokenLen field. @return A new formula object as read from the stream. Possibly empty, never null. Writes The formula encoding is includes:

  • ushort tokenDataLen
  • tokenData
  • arrayConstantData (if present)
@return total formula encoding length. The formula encoding includes:
  • ushort tokenDataLen
  • tokenData
  • arrayConstantData (optional)
Note - this value is different to tokenDataLength
This method is often used when the formula length does not appear immediately before the encoded token data. @return the encoded length of the plain formula tokens. This does not include the leading ushort field, nor any trailing array constant data. Creates a {@link Formula} object from a supplied {@link Ptg} array. Handles nulls OK. @param ptgs may be null @return Never null (Possibly empty if the supplied ptgs is null) Gets the {@link Ptg} array from the supplied {@link Formula}. Handles nulls OK. @param formula may be null @return possibly null (if the supplied formula is null) Gets the locator for the corresponding {@link SharedFormulaRecord}, {@link ArrayRecord} or {@link TableRecord} if this formula belongs to such a grouping. The {@link CellReference} returned by this method will match the top left corner of the range of that grouping. The return value is usually not the same as the location of the cell containing this formula. @return the firstRow & firstColumn of an array formula or shared formula that this formula belongs to. null if this formula is not part of an array or shared formula. @author Josh Micich @return null if not found Stores the cached result of a formula evaluation, along with the Set of sensititive input cells @author Josh Micich Cells 'used' in the current evaluation of the formula corresponding To this cache entry If any of the following cells Change, this cache entry needs To be Cleared A custom implementation of {@link java.util.HashSet} in order To reduce memory consumption. Profiling tests (Oct 2008) have shown that each element {@link FormulaCellCacheEntry} takes around 32 bytes To store in a HashSet, but around 6 bytes To store here. For Spreadsheets with thousands of formula cells with multiple interdependencies, the savings can be very significant. @author Josh Micich Specific exception thrown when a supplied formula does not Parse properly. Primarily used by test cases when testing for specific parsing exceptions. This class was given package scope until it would become Clear that it is useful to general client code. Lookahead Character. Gets value '\0' when the input string is exhausted Create the formula Parser, with the string that is To be Parsed against the supplied workbook. A later call the Parse() method To return ptg list in rpn order, then call the GetRPNPtg() To retrive the Parse results. This class is recommended only for single threaded use. If you only have a usermodel.HSSFWorkbook, and not a model.Workbook, then use the convenience method on usermodel.HSSFFormulaEvaluator Parse a formula into a array of tokens @param formula the formula to parse @param workbook the parent workbook @param formulaType the type of the formula, see {@link FormulaType} @param sheetIndex the 0-based index of the sheet this formula belongs to. The sheet index is required to resolve sheet-level names. -1 means that the scope of the name will be ignored and the parser will match names only by name @return array of parsed tokens @throws FormulaParseException if the formula is unparsable Read New Character From Input Stream Report What Was Expected Recognize an Alpha Character Recognize a Decimal Digit Recognize an Alphanumeric Recognize White Space Skip Over Leading White Space Consumes the next input character if it is equal To the one specified otherwise throws an unchecked exception. This method does not consume whitespace (before or after the matched character). Get a Number From OOO doc: "Whenever one operand of the reference subexpression is a function, a defined name, a 3D reference, or an external reference (and no error occurs), a tMemFunc token is used" @return true if the specified character may be used in a defined name @param currentParsePosition used to format a potential error message @return false if sub-expression represented the specified ParseNode definitely cannot appear on either side of the range (':') operator Parses area refs (things which could be the operand of ':') and simple factors Examples
               A$1
               $A$1 :  $B1
               A1 .......	C2
               Sheet1 !$A1
               a..b!A1
               'my sheet'!A1
               .my.sheet!A1
               'my sheet':'my alt sheet'!A1
               .my.sheet1:.my.sheet2!$B$2
               my.named..range.
               'my sheet'!my.named.range
               .my.sheet!my.named.range
               foo.bar(123.456, "abc")
               123.456
               "abc"
               true
               [Foo.xls]!$A$1
               [Foo.xls]'my sheet'!$A$1
               [Foo.xls]!my.named.range
             
Parses simple factors that are not primitive ranges or range components i.e. '!', ':'(and equiv '...') do not appear Examples
              my.named...range.
              foo.bar(123.456, "abc")
              123.456
              "abc"
              true
            
@param sheetIden may be null @param part1 @param part2 may be null Parses out a potential LHS or RHS of a ':' intended to produce a plain AreaRef. Normally these are proper cell references but they could also be row or column refs like "$AC" or "10" @return null (and leaves {@link #_pointer} unchanged if a proper range part does not parse out "A1", "B3" -> "A1:B3" "sheet1!A1", "B3" -> "sheet1!A1:B3" @return null if the range expression cannot / shouldn't be reduced. A1, $A1, A$1, $A$1, A, 1 @return true if the two range parts can be combined in an {@link AreaPtg} ( Note - the explicit range operator (:) may still be valid when this method returns false ) Note - caller should reset {@link #_pointer} upon null result @return The sheet name as an identifier null if '!' is not found in the right place If we have something that looks like [book]Sheet1: or Sheet1, see if it's actually a range eg Sheet1:Sheet2! very similar to {@link SheetNameFormatter#isSpecialChar(char)} @return true if the specified name is a valid cell reference Note - Excel Function names are 'case aware but not case sensitive'. This method may end up creating a defined name record in the workbook if the specified name is not an internal Excel Function, and Has not been encountered before. @param name case preserved Function name (as it was entered/appeared in the formula). * Generates the variable Function ptg for the formula. * * For IF Formulas, Additional PTGs are Added To the Tokens * @param name a {@link NamePtg} or {@link NameXPtg} or null * @return Ptg a null is returned if we're in an IF formula, it needs extreme manipulation and is handled in this Function Get arguments To a Function Parse and Translate a Math Factor factors (without ^ or % ) Get a PTG for an integer from its string representation. return Int or Number Ptg based on size of input Parse and Translate a Math Term Parse and Translate an Expression API call To execute the parsing of the formula Abstracts a workbook for the purpose of formula parsing.
For POI internal use only @author Josh Micich
named range name matching is case insensitive The name. Index of the sheet. Gets the name XPTG. The name. Produce the appropriate Ptg for a 3d cell reference Produce the appropriate Ptg for a 3d area reference Gets the externSheet index for a sheet from this workbook Name of the sheet. Gets the externSheet index for a sheet from an external workbook Name of the workbook, e.g. "BudGet.xls" a name of a sheet in that workbook Returns an enum holding spReadhseet properties specific to an Excel version ( max column and row numbers, max arguments to a function, etc.) Common logic for rendering formulas.
For POI internal use only @author Josh Micich
Static method To convert an array of {@link Ptg}s in RPN order To a human readable string format in infix mode. @param book used for defined names and 3D references @param ptgs must not be null @return a human readable String Abstracts a workbook for the purpose of converting formula To text.
For POI internal use only @author Josh Micich
@return null if externSheetIndex refers To a sheet inside the current workbook @return the name of the (first) sheet referred to by the given external sheet index @return the name of the (last) sheet referred to by the given external sheet index Enumeration of various formula types.
For POI internal use only @author Josh Micich
Optimisation - compacts many blank cell references used by a single formula. @author Josh Micich Creates a text reference as text, given specified row and column numbers. @author Aniket Banerjee (banerjee@google.com) ignore nested subtotals. Returns the k-th percentile of values in a range. You can use this function to establish a threshold of acceptance. For example, you can decide to examine candidates who score above the 90th percentile. PERCENTILE(array,k) Array is the array or range of data that defines relative standing. K is the percentile value in the range 0..1, inclusive. Remarks
  • if array is empty or Contains more than 8,191 data points, PERCENTILE returns the #NUM! error value.
  • If k is nonnumeric, PERCENTILE returns the #VALUE! error value.
  • If k is < 0 or if k > 1, PERCENTILE returns the #NUM! error value.
  • If k is not a multiple of 1/(n - 1), PERCENTILE interpolates to determine the value at the k-th percentile.
@author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Implementation for the Excel function SUMIF

Syntax :
AVERAGEIF ( range, criteria, avg_range )
rangeThe range over which criteria is applied. Also used for included values when the third parameter is not present
criteriaThe value or expression used to filter rows from range
avg_rangeLocates the top-left corner of the corresponding range of addends - values to be included (after being selected by the criteria)

@author Josh Micich
Implementation for the Excel function AverageIfs

Syntax :
AverageIfs ( average_range, criteria_range1, criteria1, [criteria_range2, criteria2], ...)

  • average_range Required. One or more cells to get the average, including numbers or names, ranges, or cell references that contain numbers. Blank and text values are ignored.
  • criteria1_range Required. The first range in which to evaluate the associated criteria.
  • criteria1 Required. The criteria in the form of a number, expression, cell reference, or text that define which cells in the criteria_range1 argument will be counted
  • criteria_range2, criteria2, ... Optional. Additional ranges and their associated criteria. Up to 127 range/criteria pairs are allowed.

@author Yegor Kozlov
Verify that each criteriaRanges argument contains the same number of rows and columns as the avgRange argument @throws EvaluationException if @param ranges criteria ranges, each range must be of the same dimensions as aeAvg @param predicates array of predicates, a predicate for each value in ranges @param aeAvg the range to calculate @return the computed value

Some utils for Converting from and to any base

@author cedric dot walter @ gmail dot com
Implementation for Excel Bin2Dec() function.

Syntax:
Bin2Dec (number)

Converts a binary number to decimal.

Number is the binary number you want to convert. Number cannot contain more than 10 characters (10 bits). The most significant bit of number is the sign bit. The remaining 9 bits are magnitude bits. Negative numbers are represented using two's-complement notation.

Remark If number is not a valid binary number, or if number contains more than 10 characters (10 bits), BIN2DEC returns the #NUM! error value. @author cedric dot walter @ gmail dot com Here are the general rules concerning Boolean functions:

  1. Blanks are ignored (not either true or false)
  2. Strings are ignored if part of an area ref or cell ref, otherwise they must be 'true' or 'false'
  3. Numbers: 0 is false. Any other number is TRUE
  4. Areas: *all* cells in area are evaluated according to the above rules
@author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com >
@author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Implementation of Excel functions Date parsing functions: Date - DAY, MONTH and YEAR Time - HOUR, MINUTE and SECOND @author Others (not mentioned in code) @author Thies Wellpott @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Josh Micich Implementation for Excel CODE () function.

Syntax:
CODE (text )

Returns a numeric code for the first character in a text string. The returned code corresponds to the character set used by your computer.

text The text for which you want the code of the first character. @author cedric dot walter @ gmail dot com Implementation for Excel COLUMNS function. @author Josh Micich @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Implementation for Excel COMPLEX () function.

Syntax:
COMPLEX (real_num,i_num,suffix )

Converts real and imaginary coefficients into a complex number of the form x + yi or x + yj.

All complex number functions accept "i" and "j" for suffix, but neither "I" nor "J". Using uppercase results in the #VALUE! error value. All functions that accept two or more complex numbers require that all suffixes match.

real_num The real coefficient of the complex number. If this argument is nonnumeric, this function returns the #VALUE! error value.

i_num The imaginary coefficient of the complex number. If this argument is nonnumeric, this function returns the #VALUE! error value.

suffix The suffix for the imaginary component of the complex number.

  • If omitted, suffix is assumed to be "i".
  • If suffix is neither "i" nor "j", COMPLEX returns the #VALUE! error value.
@author cedric dot walter @ gmail dot com
Counts the number of cells that contain numeric data within the list of arguments. Excel Syntax COUNT(value1,value2,...) Value1, value2, ... are 1 to 30 arguments representing the values or ranges to be Counted. TODO: Check this properly Matches excel on edge cases like formula cells, error cells etc Create an instance of Count to use in {@link Subtotal}

If there are other subtotals within argument refs (or nested subtotals), these nested subtotals are ignored to avoid double counting.

@see Subtotal
Counts the number of cells that contain data within the list of arguments. Excel Syntax COUNTA(value1,value2,...) Value1, value2, ... are 1 to 30 arguments representing the values or ranges to be Counted. @author Josh Micich don't count cells that are subtotals Implementation for the function COUNTBLANK

Syntax: COUNTBLANK ( range )
range is the range of cells to count blanks

@author Mads Mohr Christensen
Implementation for the function COUNTIF

Syntax: COUNTIF ( range, criteria )
range is the range of cells to be Counted based on the criteria
criteriais used to determine which cells to Count

@author Josh Micich @return number of characters used to represent this operator

Translates Excel countif wildcard strings into .NET regex strings Excel wildcard expression return null if the specified value contains no special wildcard characters.
@return the number of evaluated cells in the range that match the specified criteria @return the de-referenced criteria arg (possibly {@link ErrorEval}) When the second argument is a string, many things are possible Creates a criteria predicate object for the supplied criteria arg @return null if the arg evaluates to blank. bool literals ('TRUE', 'FALSE') treated similarly but NOT same as numbers. Implementation for the function COUNTIFS

Syntax: COUNTIFS(criteria_range1, criteria1, [criteria_range2, criteria2])

Common interface for the matching criteria. Common logic for COUNT, COUNTA and COUNTIF @author Josh Micich @return the number of evaluated cells in the range that match the specified criteria @return the number of evaluated cells in the range that match the specified criteria @author Pavel Krupets (pkrupets at palmtreebusiness dot com) * Note - works with Java Calendar months, not Excel months * Java Calendar month = Excel month + 1 Implementation for Excel Bin2Dec() function.

Syntax:
Bin2Dec (number,[places] )

Converts a decimal number to binary.

The DEC2BIN function syntax has the following arguments:

  • Number Required. The decimal integer you want to Convert. If number is negative, valid place values are ignored and DEC2BIN returns a 10-character (10-bit) binary number in which the most significant bit is the sign bit. The remaining 9 bits are magnitude bits. Negative numbers are represented using two's-complement notation.
  • Places Optional. The number of characters to use. If places is omitted, DEC2BIN uses the minimum number of characters necessary. Places is useful for pAdding the return value with leading 0s (zeros).

Remarks

  • If number < -512 or if number > 511, DEC2BIN returns the #NUM! error value.
  • If number is nonnumeric, DEC2BIN returns the #VALUE! error value.
  • If DEC2BIN requires more than places characters, it returns the #NUM! error value.
  • If places is not an integer, it is tRuncated.
  • If places is nonnumeric, DEC2BIN returns the #VALUE! error value.
  • If places is zero or negative, DEC2BIN returns the #NUM! error value.
@author cedric dot walter @ gmail dot com
Implementation for Excel DELTA() function.

Syntax:
DEC2HEX (number,places )

Converts a decimal number to hexadecimal. The decimal integer you want to Convert. If number is negative, places is ignored and this function returns a 10-character (40-bit) hexadecimal number in which the most significant bit is the sign bit. The remaining 39 bits are magnitude bits. Negative numbers are represented using two's-complement notation.

  • If number < -549,755,813,888 or if number > 549,755,813,887, this function returns the #NUM! error value.
  • If number is nonnumeric, this function returns the #VALUE! error value.

places

The number of characters to use. The places argument is useful for pAdding the return value with leading 0s (zeros).
  • If this argument is omitted, this function uses the minimum number of characters necessary.
  • If this function requires more than places characters, it returns the #NUM! error value.
  • If this argument is nonnumeric, this function returns the #VALUE! error value.
  • If this argument is negative, this function returns the #NUM! error value.
  • If this argument Contains a decimal value, this function ignores the numbers to the right side of the decimal point.
@author cedric dot walter @ gmail dot com
@author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Implementation for Excel DELTA() function.

Syntax:
DELTA (number1,number2 )

Tests whether two values are Equal. Returns 1 if number1 = number2; returns 0 otherwise. Use this function to filter a Set of values. For example, by summing several DELTA functions you calculate the count of equal pairs. This function is also known as the Kronecker Delta function.

  • If number1 is nonnumeric, DELTA returns the #VALUE! error value.
  • If number2 is nonnumeric, DELTA returns the #VALUE! error value.
@author cedric dot walter @ gmail dot com
Implementation of the DGet function: Finds the value of a column in an area with given conditions. TODO: - wildcards ? and * in string conditions - functions as conditions Implementation of the DMin function: Finds the minimum value of a column in an area with given conditions. TODO: - wildcards ? and * in string conditions - functions as conditions @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > This class performs a D* calculation. It takes an {@link IDStarAlgorithm} object and uses it for calculating the result value. Iterating a database and Checking the entries against the Set of conditions is done here. Resolve reference(-chains) until we have a normal value. @param field a ValueEval which can be a RefEval. @return a ValueEval which is guaranteed not to be a RefEval @If a multi-sheet reference was found along the way. Returns the first column index that matches the given name. The name can either be a string or an integer, when it's an integer, then the respective column (1 based index) is returned. @param nameValueEval @param db @return the first column index that matches the given name (or int) @ For a given database returns the column number for a column heading. @param db Database. @param name Column heading. @return Corresponding column number. @If it's not possible to turn all headings into strings. Checks a row in a database against a condition database. @param db Database. @param row The row in the database to Check. @param cdb The condition database to use for Checking. @return Whether the row matches the conditions. @If references could not be Resolved or comparison operators and operands didn't match. Test a value against a simple (< > <= >= = starts-with) condition string. @param value The value to Check. @param condition The condition to check for. @return Whether the condition holds. @If comparison operator and operands don't match. Test whether a value matches a numeric condition. @param valueEval Value to Check. @param op Comparator to use. @param condition Value to check against. @return whether the condition holds. @If it's impossible to turn the condition into a number. Takes a ValueEval and tries to retrieve a String value from it. It tries to resolve references if there are any. @param value ValueEval to retrieve the string from. @return String corresponding to the given ValueEval. @If it's not possible to retrieve a String value. Implementation of Excel 'Analysis ToolPak' function EDATE()
Adds a specified number of months to the specified date.

Syntax
EDATE(date, number)

@author Tomas Herceg Implementation for the Excel EOMONTH() function.

EOMONTH() returns the date of the last day of a month..

Syntax:
EOMONTH(start_date,months)

start_date is the starting date of the calculation months is the number of months to be Added to start_date, to give a new date. For this new date, EOMONTH returns the date of the last day of the month. months may be positive (in the future), zero or negative (in the past). Implementation for the ERROR.TYPE() Excel function.

Syntax:
ERROR.TYPE(errorValue)

Returns a number corresponding to the error type of the supplied argument.

errorValueReturn Value
#NULL!1
#DIV/0!2
#VALUE!3
#REF!4
#NAME?5
#NUM!6
#N/A!7
everything else#N/A!
Note - the results of ERROR.TYPE() are different to the constants defined in ErrorConstants.

@author Josh Micich
@author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Implementation for Excel FACTDOUBLE() function.

Syntax:
FACTDOUBLE (number)

Returns the double factorial of a number.

Number is the value for which to return the double factorial. If number is not an integer, it is truncated.

Remarks

  • If number is nonnumeric, FACTDOUBLE returns the #VALUE! error value.
  • If number is negative, FACTDOUBLE returns the #NUM! error value.
Use a cache for more speed of previously calculated factorial @author cedric dot walter @ gmail dot com
Implementation of the financial functions pmt, fv, ppmt, ipmt. @author Mike Argyriou micharg@gmail.com Emulates Excel/Calc's PMT(interest_rate, number_payments, PV, FV, Type) function, which calculates the payments for a loan or the future value of an investment @param r - periodic interest rate represented as a decimal. @param nper - number of total payments / periods. @param pv - present value -- borrowed or invested principal. @param fv - future value of loan or annuity. @param type - when payment is made: beginning of period is 1; end, 0. @return double representing periodic payment amount. Overloaded pmt() call omitting type, which defaults to 0. @see #pmt(double, int, double, double, int) Overloaded pmt() call omitting fv and type, which both default to 0. @see #pmt(double, int, double, double, int) Emulates Excel/Calc's IPMT(interest_rate, period, number_payments, PV, FV, Type) function, which calculates the portion of the payment at a given period that is the interest on previous balance. @param r - periodic interest rate represented as a decimal. @param per - period (payment number) to check value at. @param nper - number of total payments / periods. @param pv - present value -- borrowed or invested principal. @param fv - future value of loan or annuity. @param type - when payment is made: beginning of period is 1; end, 0. @return double representing interest portion of payment. @see #pmt(double, int, double, double, int) @see #fv(double, int, double, double, int) Emulates Excel/Calc's PPMT(interest_rate, period, number_payments, PV, FV, Type) function, which calculates the portion of the payment at a given period that will apply to principal. @param r - periodic interest rate represented as a decimal. @param per - period (payment number) to check value at. @param nper - number of total payments / periods. @param pv - present value -- borrowed or invested principal. @param fv - future value of loan or annuity. @param type - when payment is made: beginning of period is 1; end, 0. @return double representing principal portion of payment. @see #pmt(double, int, double, double, int) @see #ipmt(double, int, int, double, double, bool) Emulates Excel/Calc's FV(interest_rate, number_payments, payment, PV, Type) function, which calculates future value or principal at period N. @param r - periodic interest rate represented as a decimal. @param nper - number of total payments / periods. @param pmt - periodic payment amount. @param pv - present value -- borrowed or invested principal. @param type - when payment is made: beginning of period is 1; end, 0. @return double representing future principal value. Overloaded fv() call omitting type, which defaults to 0. @see #fv(double, int, double, double, int) @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Super class for all Evals for financial function evaluation. @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > This class Is a functon library for common fiscal functions. Glossary of terms/abbreviations:
  • FV: Future Value
  • PV: Present Value
  • NPV: Net Present Value
  • PMT: (Periodic) Payment
For more info on the terms/abbreviations please use the references below (hyperlinks are subject to Change):
Online References:
  1. GNU Emacs Calc 2.02 Manual: http://theory.uwinnipeg.ca/gnu/calc/calc_203.html
  2. Yahoo Financial Glossary: http://biz.yahoo.com/f/g/nn.html#y
  3. MS Excel function reference: http://office.microsoft.com/en-us/assistance/CH062528251033.aspx

Implementation Notes:

Symbols used in the formulae that follow:
  • p: present value
  • f: future value
  • n: number of periods
  • y: payment (in each period)
  • r: rate
  • ^: the power operator (NOT the java bitwise XOR operator!)
[From MS Excel function reference] Following are some of the key formulas that are used in this implementation:
            p(1+r)^n + y(1+rt)((1+r)^n-1)/r + f=0   ...{when r!=0}
            ny + p + f=0                            ...{when r=0}
            
Future value of an amount given the number of payments, rate, amount of individual payment, present value and bool value indicating whether payments are due at the beginning of period (false => payments are due at end of period) @param r rate @param n num of periods @param y pmt per period @param p future value @param t type (true=pmt at end of period, false=pmt at begining of period) Present value of an amount given the number of future payments, rate, amount of individual payment, future value and bool value indicating whether payments are due at the beginning of period (false => payments are due at end of period) @param r @param n @param y @param f @param t calculates the Net Present Value of a principal amount given the disCount rate and a sequence of cash flows (supplied as an array). If the amounts are income the value should be positive, else if they are payments and not income, the value should be negative. @param r @param cfs cashflow amounts @param r @param n @param p @param f @param t @param r @param y @param p @param f @param t Convenience base class for functions that only take zero arguments. @author Josh Micich Convenience base class for functions that must take exactly one argument. @author Josh Micich Convenience base class for functions that must take exactly two arguments. @author Josh Micich Convenience base class for functions that must take exactly three arguments. @author Josh Micich Convenience base class for functions that must take exactly four arguments. @author Josh Micich @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > For most Excel functions, involving references ((cell, area), (2d, 3d)), the references are passed in as arguments, and the exact location remains fixed. However, a select few Excel functions have the ability to access cells that were not part of any reference passed as an argument.
Two important functions with this feature are INDIRECT and OFFSet

In POI, the HSSFFormulaEvaluator Evaluates every cell in each reference argument before calling the function. This means that functions using fixed references do not need access to the rest of the workbook to execute. Hence the Evaluate() method on the common interface Function does not take a workbook parameter. This interface recognises the requirement of some functions to freely Create and Evaluate references beyond those passed in as arguments. @author Josh Micich @param args the pre-Evaluated arguments for this function. args is never null, nor are any of its elements. @param ec primarily used to identify the source cell Containing the formula being Evaluated. may also be used to dynamically create reference evals. @return never null. Possibly an instance of ErrorEval in the case of a specified Excel error (Exceptions are never thrown to represent Excel errors).

Function serves as a marker interface. @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com >
Evaluates the specified args. the evaluated function arguments. Empty values are represented with BlankEval or MissingArgEval row index of the cell containing the formula under evaluation column index of the cell containing the formula under evaluation Implemented by all functions that can be called with zero arguments @author Josh Micich see {@link Function#Evaluate(ValueEval[], int, int)} Implemented by all functions that can be called with one argument @author Josh Micich see {@link Function#Evaluate(ValueEval[], int, int)} Implemented by all functions that can be called with two arguments @author Josh Micich see {@link Function#Evaluate(ValueEval[], int, int)} Implemented by all functions that can be called with three arguments @author Josh Micich see {@link Function#Evaluate(ValueEval[], int, int)} Implemented by all functions that can be called with four arguments @author Josh Micich see {@link Function#Evaluate(ValueEval[], int, int)} Implementation for Excel HEX2DEC() function.

Syntax:
HEX2DEC (number)

Converts a hexadecimal number to decimal.

Number is the hexadecimal number you want to Convert. Number cannot contain more than 10 characters (40 bits). The most significant bit of number is the sign bit. The remaining 39 bits are magnitude bits. Negative numbers are represented using two's-complement notation. Remark If number is not a valid hexadecimal number, HEX2DEC returns the #NUM! error value. @author cedric dot walter @ gmail dot com Implementation of the HLOOKUP() function.

HLOOKUP Finds a column in a lookup table by the first row value and returns the value from another row.
Syntax:
HLOOKUP(lookup_value, table_array, row_index_num, range_lookup)

lookup_value The value to be found in the first column of the table array.
table_array An area reference for the lookup data.
row_index_num a 1 based index specifying which row value of the lookup data will be returned.
range_lookup If TRUE (default), HLOOKUP Finds the largest value less than or equal to the lookup_value. If FALSE, only exact Matches will be considered
@author Josh Micich Returns one column from an AreaEval @(#VALUE!) if colIndex Is negative, (#REF!) if colIndex Is too high Implementation of Excel HYPERLINK function.

In Excel this function has special behaviour - it causes the displayed cell value to behave like a hyperlink in the GUI. From an evaluation perspective however, it is very simple.

Syntax:
HYPERLINK(link_location, friendly_name)

link_location The URL of the hyperlink
friendly_name (optional) the value to display

Returns last argument. Leaves type unchanged (does not convert to {@link org.apache.poi.ss.formula.eval.StringEval}). @author Wayne Clingingsmith Interface specifying how an algorithm to be used by {@link DStarRunner} should look like. Each implementing class should correspond to one of the D* functions. Reset the state of this algorithm. This is called before each run through a database. Process a match that is found during a run through a database. @param eval ValueEval of the cell in the matching row. References will already be Resolved. @return Whether we should continue iterating through the database. Return a result ValueEval that will be the result of the calculation. This is always called at the end of a run through the database. @return a ValueEval @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Implementation for Excel IMAGINARY() function.

Syntax:
IMAGINARY (Inumber)

Returns the imaginary coefficient of a complex number in x + yi or x + yj text format.

Inumber is a complex number for which you want the imaginary coefficient.

Remarks

  • Use COMPLEX to convert real and imaginary coefficients into a complex number.
@author cedric dot walter @ gmail dot com
Implementation for Excel ImReal() function.

Syntax:
ImReal (Inumber)

Returns the real coefficient of a complex number in x + yi or x + yj text format.

Inumber A complex number for which you want the real coefficient.

Remarks

  • If inumber is not in the form x + yi or x + yj, this function returns the #NUM! error value.
  • Use COMPLEX to convert real and imaginary coefficients into a complex number.
@author cedric dot walter @ gmail dot com
Implementation for the Excel function INDEX Syntax :
INDEX ( reference, row_num[, column_num [, area_num]])
INDEX ( array, row_num[, column_num])
referencetypically an area reference, possibly a union of areas
arraya literal array value (currently not supported)
row_numselects the row within the array or area reference
column_numselects column within the array or area reference. default Is 1
area_numused when reference Is a union of areas
@author Josh Micich
@param colArgWasPassed false if the INDEX argument lIst had just 2 items (exactly 1 comma). If anything Is passed for the column_num argument (including {@link BlankEval} or {@link MIssingArgEval}) this parameter will be true. ThIs parameter is needed because error codes are slightly different when only 2 args are passed. @param arg a 1-based index. @return the Resolved 1-based index. Zero if the arg was missing or blank @throws EvaluationException if the arg Is an error value evaluates to a negative numeric value Implementation for Excel function INDIRECT

INDIRECT() returns the cell or area reference denoted by the text argument.

Syntax:
INDIRECT(ref_text,isA1Style)

ref_text a string representation of the desired reference as it would normally be written in a cell formula.
isA1Style (default TRUE) specifies whether the ref_text should be interpreted as A1-style or R1C1-style. @author Josh Micich @return array of length 2: {workbookName, sheetName,}. Second element will always be present. First element may be null if sheetName is unqualified. Returns null if text cannot be parsed. @return null if there is a syntax error in any escape sequence (the typical syntax error is a single quote character not followed by another). @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Implementation of Excel function INTERCEPT()

Calculates the INTERCEPT of the linear regression line that is used to predict y values from x values
(http://introcs.cs.princeton.edu/java/97data/LinearRegression.java.html) Syntax:
INTERCEPT(arrayX, arrayY)

@author Johan Karlsteen Calculates the internal rate of return. Syntax is IRR(values) or IRR(values,guess) @author Marcel May @author Yegor Kozlov @see Wikipedia on IRR @see Excel IRR Computes the internal rate of return using an estimated irr of 10 percent. @param income the income values. @return the irr. Calculates IRR using the Newton-Raphson Method.

Starting with the guess, the method cycles through the calculation until the result is accurate within 0.00001 percent. If IRR can't find a result that works after 20 tries, the Double.NaN is returned.

The implementation is inspired by the NewtonSolver from the Apache Commons-Math library, @see http://commons.apache.org

@param values the income values. @param guess the initial guess of irr. @return the irr value. The method returns Double.NaN if the maximum iteration count is exceeded @see http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Internal_rate_of_return#Numerical_solution @see http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Newton%27s_method
Base class for linear regression functions. Calculates the linear regression line that is used to predict y values from x values
(http://introcs.cs.princeton.edu/java/97data/LinearRegression.java.html) Syntax:
INTERCEPT(arrayX, arrayY)

or SLOPE(arrayX, arrayY)

@author Johan Karlsteen @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > contribute by Pavel Egorov https://github.com/xoposhiy/npoi/commit/27b34a2389030c7115a666ace65daafda40d61af Implementation of Excel ISERR() function.

Syntax:
ISERR(value)

value The value to be tested

Returns the logical value TRUE if value refers to any error value except '#N/A'; otherwise, it returns FALSE. @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @param arg any {@link ValueEval}, potentially {@link BlankEval} or {@link ErrorEval}. Implementation of Excel function LOOKUP.

LOOKUP Finds an index row in a lookup table by the first column value and returns the value from another column. Syntax:
VLOOKUP(lookup_value, lookup_vector, result_vector)

lookup_value The value to be found in the lookup vector.
lookup_vector An area reference for the lookup data.
result_vector Single row or single column area reference from which the result value Is chosen.
@author Josh Micich Common functionality used by VLOOKUP, HLOOKUP, LOOKUP and MATCH @author Josh Micich @return null if the supplied area is neither a single row nor a single colum Processes the third argument to VLOOKUP, or HLOOKUP (col_index_num or row_index_num respectively).
Sample behaviour:
Input ReturnValue Thrown Error
54
2.92
"5"4
"2.18e1"21
"-$2"-3*
FALSE-1*
TRUE0
"TRUE" #REF!
"abc" #REF!
"" #REF!
<blank> #VALUE!

* Note - out of range errors (both too high and too low) are handled by the caller. @return column or row index as a zero-based value
The second argument (table_array) should be an area ref, but can actually be a cell ref, in which case it Is interpreted as a 1x1 area ref. Other scalar values cause #VALUE! error. Resolves the last (optional) parameter (range_lookup) to the VLOOKUP and HLOOKUP functions. @param rangeLookupArg @param srcCellRow @param srcCellCol @return @throws EvaluationException Finds first (lowest index) exact occurrence of specified value. @param lookupComparer the value to be found in column or row vector @param vector the values to be searched. For VLOOKUP this Is the first column of the tableArray. For HLOOKUP this Is the first row of the tableArray. @return zero based index into the vector, -1 if value cannot be found Excel has funny behaviour when the some elements in the search vector are the wrong type. Excel seems to handle mismatched types initially by just stepping 'mid' ix forward to the first compatible value. @param midIx 'mid' index (value which has the wrong type) @return usually -1, signifying that the BinarySearchIndex has been narrowed to the new mid index. Zero or greater signifies that an exact match for the lookup value was found Once the binary search has found a single match, (V/H)LOOKUP steps one by one over subsequent values to choose the last matching item. Enumeration to support 4 valued comparison results.

Excel lookup functions have complex behaviour in the case where the lookup array has mixed types, and/or Is Unordered. Contrary to suggestions in some Excel documentation, there does not appear to be a Universal ordering across types. The binary search algorithm used Changes behaviour when the Evaluated 'mid' value has a different type to the lookup value.

A simple int might have done the same job, but there Is risk in confusion with the well known Comparable.CompareTo() and Comparator.Compare() which both use a ubiquitous 3 value result encoding. Encapsulates some standard binary search functionality so the Unusual Excel behaviour can be clearly distinguished. @return -1 if the search range Is empty Represents a single row or column within an AreaEval. @return one of 4 instances or CompareResult: LESS_THAN, EQUAL, GREATER_THAN or TYPE_MISMATCH used only for debug purposes Implementation for the MATCH() Excel function.

Syntax:
MATCH(lookup_value, lookup_array, match_type)

Returns a 1-based index specifying at what position in the lookup_array the specified lookup_value Is found.

Specific matching behaviour can be modified with the optional match_type parameter.
ValueMatching Behaviour
1(default) Find the largest value that Is less than or equal to lookup_value. The lookup_array must be in ascending order*.
0Find the first value that Is exactly equal to lookup_value. The lookup_array can be in any order.
-1Find the smallest value that Is greater than or equal to lookup_value. The lookup_array must be in descending order*.
* Note regarding order - For the match_type cases that require the lookup_array to be ordered, MATCH() can produce incorrect results if this requirement Is not met. Observed behaviour in Excel Is to return the lowest index value for which every item after that index breaks the match rule.
The (ascending) sort order expected by MATCH() Is:
numbers (low to high), strings (A to Z), bool (FALSE to TRUE)
MATCH() ignores all elements in the lookup_array with a different type to the lookup_value. Type conversion of the lookup_array elements Is never performed. @author Josh Micich @return zero based index @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > This class Is an extension to the standard math library provided by java.lang.Math class. It follows the Math class in that it has a private constructor and all static methods. Returns a value rounded to p digits after decimal. If p Is negative, then the number Is rounded to places to the left of the decimal point. eg. 10.23 rounded to -1 will give: 10. If p Is zero, the returned value Is rounded to the nearest integral value. If n Is negative, the resulting value Is obtained as the round value of absolute value of n multiplied by the sign value of n (@see MathX.sign(double d)). Thus, -0.6666666 rounded to p=0 will give -1 not 0. If n Is NaN, returned value Is NaN. @param n @param p Returns a value rounded-up to p digits after decimal. If p Is negative, then the number Is rounded to places to the left of the decimal point. eg. 10.23 rounded to -1 will give: 20. If p Is zero, the returned value Is rounded to the nearest integral value. If n Is negative, the resulting value Is obtained as the round-up value of absolute value of n multiplied by the sign value of n (@see MathX.sign(double d)). Thus, -0.2 rounded-up to p=0 will give -1 not 0. If n Is NaN, returned value Is NaN. @param n @param p Returns a value rounded to p digits after decimal. If p Is negative, then the number Is rounded to places to the left of the decimal point. eg. 10.23 rounded to -1 will give: 10. If p Is zero, the returned value Is rounded to the nearest integral value. If n Is negative, the resulting value Is obtained as the round-up value of absolute value of n multiplied by the sign value of n (@see MathX.sign(double d)). Thus, -0.8 rounded-down to p=0 will give 0 not -1. If n Is NaN, returned value Is NaN. @param n @param p average of all values @param values sum of all values @param values sum of squares of all values @param values product of all values @param values min of all values. If supplied array Is zero Length, double.POSITIVE_INFINITY Is returned. @param values min of all values. If supplied array Is zero Length, double.NEGATIVE_INFINITY Is returned. @param values Note: this function Is different from java.lang.Math.floor(..). When n and s are "valid" arguments, the returned value Is: Math.floor(n/s) * s;
n and s are invalid if any of following conditions are true:

  • s Is zero
  • n Is negative and s Is positive
  • n Is positive and s Is negative
In all such cases, double.NaN Is returned. @param n @param s
Note: this function Is different from java.lang.Math.ceil(..). When n and s are "valid" arguments, the returned value Is: Math.ceiling(n/s) * s;
n and s are invalid if any of following conditions are true:
  • s Is zero
  • n Is negative and s Is positive
  • n Is positive and s Is negative
In all such cases, double.NaN Is returned. @param n @param s

for all n >= 1; factorial n = n * (n-1) * (n-2) * ... * 1
else if n == 0; factorial n = 1
else if n < 0; factorial n = double.NaN
Loss of precision can occur if n Is large enough. If n Is large so that the resulting value would be greater than double.MAX_VALUE; double.POSITIVE_INFINITY Is returned. If n < 0, double.NaN Is returned. @param n
returns the remainder resulting from operation: n / d.
The result has the sign of the divisor.
Examples:
  • mod(3.4, 2) = 1.4
  • mod(-3.4, 2) = 0.6
  • mod(-3.4, -2) = -1.4
  • mod(3.4, -2) = -0.6
If d == 0, result Is NaN @param n @param d
inverse hyperbolic cosine @param d inverse hyperbolic sine @param d inverse hyperbolic tangent @param d hyperbolic cosine @param d hyperbolic sine @param d hyperbolic tangent @param d returns the sum of product of corresponding double value in each subarray. It Is the responsibility of the caller to Ensure that all the subarrays are of equal Length. If the subarrays are not of equal Length, the return value can be Unpredictable. @param arrays returns the sum of difference of squares of corresponding double value in each subarray: ie. sigma (xarr[i]^2-yarr[i]^2)
It Is the responsibility of the caller to Ensure that the two subarrays are of equal Length. If the subarrays are not of equal Length, the return value can be Unpredictable. @param xarr @param yarr
returns the sum of sum of squares of corresponding double value in each subarray: ie. sigma (xarr[i]^2 + yarr[i]^2)
It Is the responsibility of the caller to Ensure that the two subarrays are of equal Length. If the subarrays are not of equal Length, the return value can be Unpredictable. @param xarr @param yarr
returns the sum of squares of difference of corresponding double value in each subarray: ie. sigma ( (xarr[i]-yarr[i])^2 )
It Is the responsibility of the caller to Ensure that the two subarrays are of equal Length. If the subarrays are not of equal Length, the return value can be Unpredictable. @param xarr @param yarr
returns the total number of combinations possible when k items are chosen out of total of n items. If the number Is too large, loss of precision may occur (since returned value Is double). If the returned value Is larger than double.MAX_VALUE, double.POSITIVE_INFINITY Is returned. If either of the parameters Is negative, double.NaN Is returned. @param n @param k @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Calculates Modified internal rate of return. Syntax is MIRR(cash_flow_values, finance_rate, reinvest_rate)

Returns the modified internal rate of return for a series of periodic cash flows. MIRR considers both the cost of the investment and the interest received on reinvestment of cash.

Values is an array or a reference to cells that contain numbers. These numbers represent a series of payments (negative values) and income (positive values) occurring at regular periods.
  • Values must contain at least one positive value and one negative value to calculate the modified internal rate of return. Otherwise, MIRR returns the #DIV/0! error value.
  • If an array or reference argument Contains text, logical values, or empty cells, those values are ignored; however, cells with the value zero are included.
Finance_rate is the interest rate you pay on the money used in the cash flows. Reinvest_rate is the interest rate you receive on the cash flows as you reinvest them. @author Carlos Delgado (carlos dot del dot est at gmail dot com) @author Cédric Walter (cedric dot walter at gmail dot com) @see Wikipedia on MIRR @see Excel MIRR @see {@link Irr}
@author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > if v is zero length or contains no duplicates, return value is Double.NaN. Else returns the value that occurs most times and if there is a tie, returns the first such value. @param v @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > This Is the base class for all excel function evaluator classes that take variable number of operands, and where the order of operands does not matter Maximum number of operands accepted by this function. Subclasses may override to Change default value. Whether to count nested subtotals. Collects values from a single argument Returns a double array that contains values for the numeric cells from among the list of operands. Blanks and Blank equivalent cells are ignored. Error operands or cells containing operands of type that are considered invalid and would result in #VALUE! error in excel cause this function to return null. @return never null Ensures that a two dimensional array has all sub-arrays present and the same Length @return false if any sub-array Is missing, or Is of different Length Implementation of Excel function NA() @author Josh Micich @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > This Is the default implementation of a Function class. The default behaviour Is to return a non-standard ErrorEval "ErrorEval.FUNCTION_NOT_IMPLEMENTED". This error should alert the user that the formula contained a function that Is not yet implemented. Implementation of Excel NOW() Function @author Frank Taffelt @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Support for hyperbolic trig functions was Added as a part of Java distribution only in JDK1.5. This class uses custom naive implementation based on formulas at: http://www.math2.org/math/trig/hyperbolics.htm These formulas seem to agree with excel's implementation. @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Support for hyperbolic trig functions was Added as a part of Java distribution only in JDK1.5. This class uses custom naive implementation based on formulas at: http://www.math2.org/math/trig/hyperbolics.htm These formulas seem to agree with excel's implementation. @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Support for hyperbolic trig functions was Added as a part of Java distribution only in JDK1.5. This class uses custom naive implementation based on formulas at: http://www.math2.org/math/trig/hyperbolics.htm These formulas seem to agree with excel's implementation. @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Log: LOG(number,[base]) @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at yahoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > This checks is x = 0 and the mean = 0. Excel currently returns the value 1 where as the maths common implementation will error. @param x The number. @param mean The mean. @return If a default value should be returned. All long-representable factorials @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com >

Implementation for Excel Oct2Dec() function.

Converts an octal number to decimal.

Syntax:
Oct2Dec (number )

Number is the octal number you want to Convert. Number may not contain more than 10 octal characters (30 bits). The most significant bit of number is the sign bit. The remaining 29 bits are magnitude bits. Negative numbers are represented using two's-complement notation..

If number is not a valid octal number, OCT2DEC returns the #NUM! error value. @author cedric dot walter @ gmail dot com @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Implementation for Excel function OFFSet()

OFFSet returns an area reference that Is a specified number of rows and columns from a reference cell or area.

Syntax:
OFFSet(reference, rows, cols, height, width)

reference Is the base reference.
rows Is the number of rows up or down from the base reference.
cols Is the number of columns left or right from the base reference.
height (default same height as base reference) Is the row Count for the returned area reference.
width (default same width as base reference) Is the column Count for the returned area reference.
@author Josh Micich Exceptions are used within this class to help simplify flow control when error conditions are enCountered A one dimensional base + offset. Represents either a row range or a column range. Two instances of this class toGether specify an area range. Moves the range by the specified translation amount.

This method also 'normalises' the range: Excel specifies that the width and height parameters (Length field here) cannot be negative. However, OFFSet() does produce sensible results in these cases. That behavior Is replicated here.

@param translationAmount may be zero negative or positive @return the equivalent LinearOffsetRange with a positive Length, moved by the specified translationAmount. Encapsulates either an area or cell reference which may be 2d or 3d. OFFSet's numeric arguments (2..5) have similar Processing rules Fractional values are silently truncated by Excel. Truncation Is toward negative infinity. Implementation for the PMT() Excel function.

Syntax:
PMT(rate, nper, pv, fv, type)

Returns the constant repayment amount required for a loan assuming a constant interest rate.

rate the loan interest rate.
nper the number of loan repayments.
pv the present value of the future payments (or principle).
fv the future value (default zero) surplus cash at the end of the loan lifetime.
type whether payments are due at the beginning(1) or end(0 - default) of each payment period.
@author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Compute the interest portion of a payment. @author Mike Argyriou micharg@gmail.com

Implementation for Excel QUOTIENT () function.

Syntax:
QUOTIENT(Numerator,Denominator)

Numerator is the dividend. Denominator is the divisor. Returns the integer portion of a division. Use this function when you want to discard the remainder of a division.

If either enumerator/denominator is non numeric, QUOTIENT returns the #VALUE! error value. If denominator is Equals to zero, QUOTIENT returns the #DIV/0! error value. @author cedric dot walter @ gmail dot com
@author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > * Returns the rank of a number in a list of numbers. The rank of a number is its size relative to other values in a list. * Syntax: * RANK(number,ref,order) * Number is the number whose rank you want to find. * Ref is an array of, or a reference to, a list of numbers. Nonnumeric values in ref are ignored. * Order is a number specifying how to rank number. * If order is 0 (zero) or omitted, Microsoft Excel ranks number as if ref were a list sorted in descending order. * If order is any nonzero value, Microsoft Excel ranks number as if ref were a list sorted in ascending order. * * @author Rubin Wang Implements the Excel Rate function Excel does not support infinities and NaNs, rather, it gives a #NUM! error in these cases @throws EvaluationException (#NUM!) if result is NaN or Infinity Implementation for Excel REPT () function.

Syntax:
REPT (text,number_times )

Repeats text a given number of times. Use REPT to fill a cell with a number of instances of a text string. text : text The text that you want to repeat. number_times: A positive number specifying the number of times to repeat text. If number_times is 0 (zero), REPT returns "" (empty text). If this argument contains a decimal value, this function ignores the numbers to the right side of the decimal point. The result of the REPT function cannot be longer than 32,767 characters, or REPT returns #VALUE!. @author cedric dot walter @ gmail dot com Implementation for Excel WeekNum() function.

Syntax:
WeekNum (Serial_num,Return_type)

Returns a number that indicates where the week falls numerically within a year.

Serial_num is a date within the week. Dates should be entered by using the DATE function, or as results of other formulas or functions. For example, use DATE(2008,5,23) for the 23rd day of May, 2008. Problems can occur if dates are entered as text. Return_type is a number that determines on which day the week begins. The default is 1. 1 Week begins on Sunday. Weekdays are numbered 1 through 7. 2 Week begins on Monday. Weekdays are numbered 1 through 7. @author cedric dot walter @ gmail dot com Classic conversion. @param number @return Use conversion rule to factor some parts and make them more concise @param result @param form @return Implementation for Excel ROWS function. @author Josh Micich Implementation of Excel function SLOPE()

Calculates the SLOPE of the linear regression line that is used to predict y values from x values
(http://introcs.cs.princeton.edu/java/97data/LinearRegression.java.html) Syntax:
SLOPE(arrayX, arrayY)

@author Johan Karlsteen @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Library for common statistics functions returns the mean of deviations from mean. @param v if v Is zero Length or Contains no duplicates, return value Is double.NaN. Else returns the value that occurs most times and if there Is a tie, returns the first such value. @param v Implementation for the Excel function SUBTOTAL

Syntax :
SUBTOTAL ( functionCode, ref1, ref2 ... )
functionCode(1-11) Selects the underlying aggregate function to be used (see table below)
ref1, ref2 ...Arguments to be passed to the underlying aggregate function

functionCodeAggregate Function
1AVERAGE
2COUNT
3COUNTA
4MAX
5MIN
6PRODUCT
7STDEV
8STDEVP *
9SUM
10VAR *
11VARP *
101-111*

* Not implemented in POI yet. Functions 101-111 are the same as functions 1-11 but with the option 'ignore hidden values'.

@author Paul Tomlin < pault at bulk sms dot com > Implementation for the Excel function SUMIF

Syntax :
SUMIF ( range, criteria, sum_range )
rangeThe range over which criteria is applied. Also used for addend values when the third parameter is not present
criteriaThe value or expression used to filter rows from range
sum_rangeLocates the top-left corner of the corresponding range of addends - values to be added (after being selected by the criteria)

@author Josh Micich
@return a range of the same dimensions as aeRange using eval to define the top left corner. @throws EvaluationException if eval is not a reference Implementation for the Excel function SUMIFS

Syntax :
SUMIFS ( sum_range, criteria_range1, criteria1, [criteria_range2, criteria2], ...)

  • sum_range Required. One or more cells to sum, including numbers or names, ranges, or cell references that contain numbers. Blank and text values are ignored.
  • criteria1_range Required. The first range in which to evaluate the associated criteria.
  • criteria1 Required. The criteria in the form of a number, expression, cell reference, or text that define which cells in the criteria_range1 argument will be added
  • criteria_range2, criteria2, ... Optional. Additional ranges and their associated criteria. Up to 127 range/criteria pairs are allowed.

@author Yegor Kozlov
Verify that each criteriaRanges argument contains the same number of rows and columns as the sumRange argument @throws EvaluationException if @param ranges criteria ranges, each range must be of the same dimensions as aeSum @param predicates array of predicates, a predicate for each value in ranges @param aeSum the range to sum @return the computed value Determines a double value for the specified ValueEval. @param IsScalarProduct false for SUMPRODUCTs over area refs. @throws EvalEx if ve represents an error value.

Note - string values and empty cells are interpreted differently depending on isScalarProduct. For scalar products, if any term Is blank or a string, the error (#VALUE!) Is raised. For area (sum)products, if any term Is blank or a string, the result Is zero. @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com >

An implementation of the MID function MID returns a specific number of Chars from a text string, starting at the specified position. @author Manda Wilson < wilson at c bio dot msk cc dot org;
Implementation of the PROPER function: Normalizes all words (separated by non-word characters) by making the first letter upper and the rest lower case. An implementation of the Replace function: Replaces part of a text string based on the number of Chars you specify, with another text string. @author Manda Wilson < wilson at c bio dot msk cc dot org > Replaces part of a text string based on the number of Chars you specify, with another text string. @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.formula.eval.Eval An implementation of the SUBSTITUTE function: Substitutes text in a text string with new text, some number of times. @author Manda Wilson < wilson at c bio dot msk cc dot org > Substitutes text in a text string with new text, some number of times. @see org.apache.poi.hssf.record.formula.eval.Eval An implementation of the TEXT function TEXT returns a number value formatted with the given number formatting string. This function is not a complete implementation of the Excel function, but handles most of the common cases. All work is passed down to {@link DataFormatter} to be done, as this works much the same as the display focused work that that does. @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Manda Wilson < wilson at c bio dot msk cc dot org > An implementation of the TRIM function: Removes leading and trailing spaces from value if evaluated operand value is string. An implementation of the MID function MID returns a specific number of characters from a text string, starting at the specified position. Syntax: MID(text, start_num, num_chars) @author Torstein Tauno Svendsen (torstei@officenet.no) Implementation of the FIND() function. Syntax: FIND(Find_text, within_text, start_num) FIND returns the character position of the first (case sensitive) occurrence of Find_text inside within_text. The third parameter, start_num, is optional (default=1) and specifies where to start searching from. Character positions are 1-based. Implementation of the FIND() function. SEARCH is a case-insensitive version of FIND() Syntax: SEARCH(Find_text, within_text, start_num) An implementation of the TRIM function: Removes leading and trailing spaces from value if Evaluated operand value Is string. @author Manda Wilson < wilson at c bio dot msk cc dot org > @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Implementation for the Excel function TIME @author Steven Butler (sebutler @ gmail dot com) Based on POI {@link DateFunc} Converts the supplied hours, minutes and seconds to an Excel time value. @param ds array of 3 doubles Containing hours, minutes and seconds. Non-integer inputs are tRuncated to an integer before further calculation of the time value. @return An Excel representation of a time of day. If the time value represents more than a day, the days are Removed from the result, leaving only the time of day component. @throws NPOI.SS.Formula.Eval.EvaluationException If any of the arguments are greater than 32767 or the hours minutes and seconds when combined form a time value less than 0, the function Evaluates to an error. "1,0000" is valid, "1,00" is not TODO see if the same functionality is needed in {@link OperandResolver#parseDouble(String)} @return null if there is any problem converting the text Convenience base class for any function which must take two or three arguments @author Josh Micich Convenience base class for any function which must take two or three arguments @author Josh Micich Convenience base class for any function which must take three or four arguments @author Josh Micich Implementation of the VLOOKUP() function.

VLOOKUP Finds a row in a lookup table by the first column value and returns the value from another column.
Syntax:
VLOOKUP(lookup_value, table_array, col_index_num, range_lookup)

lookup_value The value to be found in the first column of the table array.
table_array An area reference for the lookup data.
col_index_num a 1 based index specifying which column value of the lookup data will be returned.
range_lookup If TRUE (default), VLOOKUP Finds the largest value less than or equal to the lookup_value. If FALSE, only exact Matches will be considered
@author Josh Micich Returns one column from an AreaEval @(#VALUE!) if colIndex Is negative, (#REF!) if colIndex Is too high Implementation for the Excel function WEEKDAY @author Thies Wellpott * Perform WEEKDAY(date, returnOption) function. * Note: Parameter texts are from German EXCEL-2010 help. * Parameters in args[]: * args[0] serialDate * EXCEL-date value * Standardmaessig ist der 1. Januar 1900 die fortlaufende Zahl 1 und * der 1. Januar 2008 die fortlaufende Zahl 39.448, da dieser Tag nach 39.448 Tagen * auf den 01.01.1900 folgt. * @return Option (optional) * Bestimmt den Rueckgabewert: 1 oder nicht angegeben Zahl 1 (Sonntag) bis 7 (Samstag). Verhaelt sich wie fruehere Microsoft Excel-Versionen. 2 Zahl 1 (Montag) bis 7 (Sonntag). 3 Zahl 0 (Montag) bis 6 (Sonntag). 11 Die Zahlen 1 (Montag) bis 7 (Sonntag) 12 Die Zahlen 1 (Dienstag) bis 7 (Montag) 13 Die Zahlen 1 (Mittwoch) bis 7 (Dienstag) 14 Die Zahlen 1 (Donnerstag) bis 7 (Mittwoch) 15 Die Zahlen 1 (Freitag) bis 7 (Donnerstag) 16 Die Zahlen 1 (Samstag) bis 7 (Freitag) 17 Die Zahlen 1 (Sonntag) bis 7 (Samstag) Implementation for Excel WeekNum() function.

Syntax:
WeekNum (Serial_num,Return_type)

Returns a number that indicates where the week falls numerically within a year.

Serial_num is a date within the week. Dates should be entered by using the DATE function, or as results of other formulas or functions. For example, use DATE(2008,5,23) for the 23rd day of May, 2008. Problems can occur if dates are entered as text. Return_type is a number that determines on which day the week begins. The default is 1. 1 Week begins on Sunday. Weekdays are numbered 1 through 7. 2 Week begins on Monday. Weekdays are numbered 1 through 7. @author cedric dot walter @ gmail dot com @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > Constructs a new instance of the Accumulator used to calculated this function Temporarily collects FunctionMetadata instances for creation of a FunctionMetadataRegistry. @author Josh Micich stores indexes of all functions with footnotes (i.e. whose definitions might Change) Holds information about Excel built-in functions. @author Josh Micich Converts the text meta-data file into a FunctionMetadataRegistry @author Josh Micich plain ASCII text metadata file uses three dots for ellipsis Makes sure that footnote digits from the original OOO document have not been accidentally left behind Allows clients to Get FunctionMetadata instances for any built-in function of Excel. @author Josh Micich The name of the IF function (i.e. "IF"). Extracted as a constant for clarity. Resolves a built-in function index. @param name uppercase function name @return a negative value if the function name is not found. This typically occurs for external functions. A (mostly) opaque interface To allow test clients To trace cache values Each spreadsheet cell Gets one unique cache entry instance. These objects are safe To use as keys in {@link java.util.HashMap}s Tests can implement this class To track the internal working of the {@link WorkbookEvaluator}.
For POI internal testing use only @author Josh Micich
Internally, formula {@link ICacheEntry}s are stored in Sets which may Change ordering due To seemingly trivial Changes. This method is provided To make the order of call-backs To {@link #onClearDependentCachedValue(ICacheEntry, int)} more deterministic. Used to help optimise cell evaluation result caching by allowing applications to specify which parts of a workbook are final.
The term final is introduced here to denote immutability or 'having constant definition'. This classification refers to potential actions (on the evaluated workbook) by the evaluating application. It does not refer to operations performed by the evaluator ({@link WorkbookEvaluator}).

General guidelines:

  • a plain value cell can be marked as 'final' if it will not be changed after the first call to {@link WorkbookEvaluator#evaluate(EvaluationCell)}.
  • a formula cell can be marked as 'final' if its formula will not be changed after the first call to {@link WorkbookEvaluator#evaluate(EvaluationCell)}. This remains true even if changes in dependent values may cause the evaluated value to change.
  • plain value cells should be marked as 'not final' if their plain value value may change.
  • formula cells should be marked as 'not final' if their formula definition may change.
  • cells which may switch between plain value and formula should also be marked as 'not final'.
Notes:
  • If none of the spreadsheet cells is expected to have its definition changed after evaluation begins, every cell can be marked as 'final'. This is the most efficient / least resource intensive option.
  • To retain freedom to change any cell definition at any time, an application may classify all cells as 'not final'. This freedom comes at the expense of greater memory consumption.
  • For the purpose of these classifications, setting the cached formula result of a cell (for example in {@link HSSFFormulaEvaluator#evaluateFormulaCell(org.apache.poi.ss.usermodel.Cell)}) does not constitute changing the definition of the cell.
  • Updating cells which have been classified as 'final' will cause the evaluator to behave unpredictably (typically ignoring the update).
@author Josh Micich
Convenience implementation for situations where all cell definitions remain fixed after evaluation begins. Checks if a cell's value(/formula) is fixed - in other words - not expected to be modified between calls to the evaluator. (Note - this is an independent concept from whether a formula cell's evaluated value may change during successive calls to the evaluator). @param sheetIndex zero based index into workbook sheet list @param rowIndex zero based row index of cell @param columnIndex zero based column index of cell @return false if the evaluating application may need to modify the specified cell between calls to the evaluator. Provides Lazy Evaluation to 3D Ranges @return whether cell at rowIndex and columnIndex is a subtotal Provides Lazy Evaluation to a 3D Reference TODO Provide access to multiple sheets where present This class performs 'operand class' transformation. Non-base Tokens are classified into three operand classes:
  • reference
  • value
  • array

The operand class chosen for each Token depends on the formula type and the Token's place in the formula. If POI Gets the operand class wrong, Excel may interpret the formula incorrectly. This condition is typically manifested as a formula cell that displays as '#VALUE!', but resolves correctly when the user presses F2, enter.

The logic implemented here was partially inspired by the description in "OpenOffice.org's Documentation of the Microsoft Excel File Format". The model presented there seems To be inconsistent with observed Excel behaviour (These differences have not been fully investigated). The implementation in this class Has been heavily modified in order To satisfy concrete examples of how Excel performs the same logic (see TestRVA).

Hopefully, as Additional important test cases are identified and Added To the test suite, patterns might become more obvious in this code and allow for simplification. @author Josh Micich Traverses the supplied formula parse tree, calling Ptg.SetClass() for each non-base Token To Set its operand class. @param callerForceArrayFlag true if one of the current node's parents is a function Ptg which Has been Changed from default 'V' To 'A' type (due To requirements on the function return value). Contains all the contextual information required to Evaluate an operation within a formula For POI internal use only @author Josh Micich @return null if either workbook or sheet is not found Resolves a cell or area reference dynamically. @param workbookName the name of the workbook Containing the reference. If null the current workbook is assumed. Note - to Evaluate formulas which use multiple workbooks, a {@link CollaboratingWorkbooksEnvironment} must be set up. @param sheetName the name of the sheet Containing the reference. May be null (when workbookName is also null) in which case the current workbook and sheet is assumed. @param refStrPart1 the single cell reference or first part of the area reference. Must not be null. @param refStrPart2 the second part of the area reference. For single cell references this parameter must be null @param isA1Style specifies the format for refStrPart1 and refStrPart2. Pass true for 'A1' style and false for 'R1C1' style. TODO - currently POI only supports 'A1' reference style @return a {@link RefEval} or {@link AreaEval} This class Creates OperationEval instances To help evaluate OperationPtg formula Tokens. @author Josh Micich returns the OperationEval concrete impl instance corresponding to the supplied operationPtg Represents a syntactic element from a formula by encapsulating the corresponding Ptg Token. Each ParseNode may have child ParseNodes in the case when the wrapped Ptg is non-atomic. @author Josh Micich Collects the array of Ptg Tokens for the specified tree. The IF() function Gets marked up with two or three tAttr Tokens. Similar logic will be required for CHOOSE() when it is supported See excelfileformat.pdf sec 3.10.5 "tAttr (19H) @author Josh Micich Used for non-formula cells, primarily To keep track of the referencing (formula) cells. @author Josh Micich This class provides the base functionality for Excel sheet functions There are two kinds of function Ptgs - tFunc and tFuncVar Therefore, this class will have ONLY two subclasses @author Avik Sengupta @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) The name of the IF function (i.e. "IF"). Extracted as a constant for clarity. All external functions have function index 255 external functions Get some special Processing @return true if this is an external function Used to detect whether a function name found in a formula is one of the standard excel functions The name matching is case insensitive. @return true if the name specifies a standard worksheet function, false if the name should be assumed to be an external function. Resolves internal function names into function indexes. The name matching is case insensitive. @return the standard worksheet function index if found, otherwise FUNCTION_INDEX_EXTERNAL Addition operator PTG the "+" binomial operator. If you need more explanation than that then well...We really can't help you here. @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver@apache.org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) implementation of method from OperationsPtg Common superclass of 2-D area refs

Title: Area 3D Ptg - 3D reference (Sheet + Area)

Description: Defined an area in Extern Sheet.

REFERENCE:

This is HSSF only, as it matches the HSSF file format way of referring to the sheet by an extern index. The XSSF equivalent is {@link Area3DPxg}
@return text representation of this area reference that can be used in text formulas. The sheet name will get properly delimited if required.

Title: XSSF Area 3D Reference (Sheet + Area)

Description: Defined an area in an external or different sheet.

REFERENCE:

This is XSSF only, as it stores the sheet / book references in String form. The HSSF equivalent using indexes is {@link Area3DPtg}

AreaErr - handles deleted cell area references. @author Daniel Noll (daniel at nuix dot com dot au) Common interface for AreaPtg and Area3DPtg, and their child classes. @return the first row in the area @return last row in the range (x2 in x1,y1-x2,y2) @return the first column number in the area. @return lastcolumn in the area Specifies a rectangular area of cells A1:A4 for instance. @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) Specifies a rectangular area of cells A1:A4 for instance. @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) Specifies a rectangular area of cells A1:A4 for instance. @author andy @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) TODO - (May-2008) fix subclasses of AreaPtg 'AreaN~' which are used in shared formulas. see similar comment in ReferencePtg zero based, Unsigned 16 bit zero based, Unsigned 16 bit zero based, Unsigned 8 bit zero based, Unsigned 8 bit @return the first row in the area @return last row in the range (x2 in x1,y1-x2,y2) @return the first column number in the area. @return whether or not the first row is a relative reference or not. @return Isrelative first column to relative or not @return lastcolumn in the area @return last column and bitmask (the raw field) @return last row relative or not @return lastcol relative or not Set the last column irrespective of the bitmasks ArrayPtg - handles arrays The ArrayPtg is a little weird, the size of the Ptg when parsing initially only includes the Ptg sid and the reserved bytes. The next Ptg in the expression then follows. It is only after the "size" of all the Ptgs is met, that the ArrayPtg data is actually held after this. So Ptg.CreateParsedExpression keeps track of the number of ArrayPtg elements and need to Parse the data upto the FORMULA record size. @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) The size of the plain tArray token written within the standard formula tokens (not including the data which comes after all formula tokens) @param values2d array values arranged in rows Note - (2D) array elements are stored column by column @return the index into the internal 1D array for the specified column and row This size includes the size of the array Ptg plus the Array Ptg Token value size Represents the initial plain tArray token (without the constant data that trails the whole formula). Objects of this class are only temporary and cannot be used as {@link Ptg}s. These temporary objects get converted to {@link ArrayPtg} by the {@link #finishReading(LittleEndianInput)} method. Read in the actual token (array) values. This occurs AFTER the last Ptg in the expression. See page 304-305 of Excel97-2007BinaryFileFormat(xls)Specification.pdf "Special Attributes" This seems to be a Misc Stuff and Junk record. One function it serves Is in SUM functions (i.e. SUM(A1:A3) causes an area PTG then an ATTR with the SUM option Set) @author andy @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) only used for tAttrChoose: table of offsets to starts of args only used for tAttrChoose: offset to the tFuncVar for CHOOSE() 00H = Spaces before the next token (not allowed before tParen token) 01H = Carriage returns before the next token (not allowed before tParen token) 02H = Spaces before opening parenthesis (only allowed before tParen token) 03H = Carriage returns before opening parenthesis (only allowed before tParen token) 04H = Spaces before closing parenthesis (only allowed before tParen, tFunc, and tFuncVar tokens) 05H = Carriage returns before closing parenthesis (only allowed before tParen, tFunc, and tFuncVar tokens) 06H = Spaces following the equality sign (only in macro sheets) Creates the space. a constant from SpaceType The count. Creates if. distance (in bytes) to start of either tFuncVar(IF) token (when false parameter is not present). Creates the skip. distance (in bytes) to position behind tFuncVar(IF) token (minus 1). bool (bool) Stores a (java) bool value in a formula. @author Paul Krause (pkrause at soundbite dot com) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @author andy @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) Common baseclass for tExp tTbl tParen tNlr tAttr tSheet tEndSheet An XSSF only representation of a reference to a deleted area Title: Deleted Area 3D Ptg - 3D referecnce (Sheet + Area) Description: Defined a area in Extern Sheet. REFERENCE: @author Patrick Luby @version 1.0-pre Title: Deleted Reference 3D Ptg Description: Defined a cell in extern sheet. REFERENCE: @author Patrick Luby @version 1.0-pre Creates new DeletedRef3DPtg This PTG implements the standard binomial divide "/" @author Andrew C. Oliver acoliver at apache dot org @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @author andy @author Daniel Noll (daniel at nuix dot com dot au) #NULL! - Intersection of two cell ranges is empty #DIV/0! - Division by zero #VALUE! - Wrong type of operand #REF! - Illegal or deleted cell reference #NAME? - Wrong function or range name #NUM! - Value range overflow #N/A - Argument or function not available Creates new ErrPtg @author andy @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @author dmui (save existing implementation) @author aviks @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @author Danny Mui (dmui at apache dot org) (Leftover handling) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) Single instance of this token for 'sum() taking a single argument' Creates new function pointer from a byte array usually called while reading an excel file. Create a function ptg from a string tokenised by the parser PTG class to implement greater or equal to @author fred at stsci dot edu Greater than operator PTG ">" @author Cameron Riley (criley at ekmail.com) Get the number of operands for the Less than operator @return int the number of operands Implementation of method from OperationsPtg @param operands a String array of operands @return String the Formula as a String @author Daniel Noll (daniel at nuix dot com dot au) Implementation of method from Ptg implementation of method from OperationsPtg Integer (unsigned short integer) Stores an Unsigned short value (java int) in a formula @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) Excel represents integers 0..65535 with the tInt token. @return true if the specified value is within the range of values IntPtg can represent. Ptg class to implement less than or equal @author fred at stsci dot edu Less than operator PTG "<". The SID is taken from the Openoffice.orgs Documentation of the Excel File Format, Table 3.5.7 @author Cameron Riley (criley at ekmail.com) the sid for the less than operator as hex identifier for LESS THAN char Get the number of operands for the Less than operator @return int the number of operands Implementation of method from OperationsPtg @param operands a String array of operands @return String the Formula as a String @author Daniel Noll (daniel at nuix dot com dot au) Creates new MemAreaPtg @author andy @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @author Daniel Noll (daniel at nuix dot com dot au) Creates new MemErrPtg @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) Creates new function pointer from a byte array usually called while Reading an excel file. Missing Function Arguments Avik Sengupta <avik at apache.org> @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) Implements the standard mathmatical multiplication - * @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @author andy @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) one-based index to defined name record @param nameIndex zero-based index to name within workbook Creates new NamePtg @return zero based index to a defined name record in the LinkTable A Name, be that a Named Range or a Function / User Defined Function, addressed in the HSSF External Sheet style. This is HSSF only, as it matches the HSSF file format way of referring to the sheet by an extern index. The XSSF equivalent is {@link NameXPxg} index to REF entry in externsheet record index to defined name or externname table(1 based) reserved must be 0 @param sheetRefIndex index to REF entry in externsheet record @param nameIndex index to defined name or externname table A Name, be that a Named Range or a Function / User Defined Function, Addressed in the HSSF External Sheet style.

This is XSSF only, as it stores the sheet / book references in String form. The HSSF equivalent using indexes is {@link NameXPtg}

Ptg class to implement not equal @author fred at stsci dot edu Number Stores a floating point value in a formula value stored in a 8 byte field using IEEE notation @author Avik Sengupta @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) Create a NumberPtg from a byte array Read from disk Create a NumberPtg from a string representation of the number Number format is not checked, it is expected to be validated in the parser that calls this method. @param value : String representation of a floating point number @author Josh Micich All Operand Ptgs are classifed ('relative', 'value', 'array') defines a Ptg that is an operation instead of an operand @author andy returns a string representation of the operations the Length of the input array should equal the number returned by @see #GetNumberOfOperands The number of operands expected by the operations While formula tokens are stored in RPN order and thus do not need parenthesis for precedence reasons, Parenthesis tokens ARE written to Ensure that user entered parenthesis are Displayed as-is on Reading back Avik Sengupta <lists@aviksengupta.com> Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) Percent PTG. @author Daniel Noll (daniel at nuix.com.au) @author andy @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) Ptg represents a syntactic token in a formula. 'PTG' is an acronym for 'parse thing'. Originally, the name referred to the single byte identifier at the start of the token, but in POI, Ptg encapsulates the whole formula token (initial byte + value data). Ptgs are logically arranged in a tree representing the structure of the Parsed formula. However, in BIFF files Ptgs are written/Read in Reverse-Polish Notation order. The RPN ordering also simplifies formula evaluation logic, so POI mostly accesses Ptgs in the same way. @author andy @author avik @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) Reads size bytes of the input stream, to Create an array of Ptgs. Extra data (beyond size) may be Read if and ArrayPtgs are present. @return a distinct copy of this Ptg if the class is mutable, or the same instance if the class is immutable. This method will return the same result as {@link #getEncodedSizeWithoutArrayData(Ptg[])} if there are no array tokens present. @return the full size taken to encode the specified Ptgs Used to calculate value that should be encoded at the start of the encoded Ptg token array; @return the size of the encoded Ptg tokens not including any trailing array data. Writes the ptgs to the data buffer, starting at the specified offset.
The 2 byte encode Length field is not written by this method. @return number of bytes written
@return the encoded Length of this Ptg, including the initial Ptg type identifier byte. @return false if this token is classified as 'reference', 'value', or 'array' Write this Ptg to a byte array return a string representation of this token alone Overridden toString method to Ensure object hash is not printed. This helps Get rid of gratuitous diffs when comparing two dumps Subclasses may output more relevant information by overriding this method @return the 'operand class' (REF/VALUE/ARRAY) for this Ptg Debug / diagnostic method to get this token's 'operand class' type. @return 'R' for 'reference', 'V' for 'value', 'A' for 'array' and '.' for base tokens An XSSF only special kind of Ptg, which stores the sheet / book reference in string form. An XSSF only special kind of Ptg, which stores a range of sheet / book references in string form. @author Daniel Noll (daniel at nuix dot com dot au) implementation of method from OperationsPtg @author Josh Micich Takes in a String representation of a cell reference and fills out the numeric fields. Title: Reference 3D Ptg Description: Defined a cell in extern sheet. REFERENCE: @author Libin Roman (Vista Portal LDT. Developer) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @version 1.0-pre Field 2 - lower 8 bits is the zero based Unsigned byte column index - bit 16 - IsRowRelative - bit 15 - IsColumnRelative Creates new AreaPtg @return text representation of this cell reference that can be used in text formulas. The sheet name will Get properly delimited if required.

Title: XSSF 3D Reference

Description: Defines a cell in an external or different sheet.

REFERENCE:

This is XSSF only, as it stores the sheet / book references in String form. The HSSF equivalent using indexes is {@link Ref3DPtg}

RefError - handles deleted cell reference @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) RefNPtg @author Jason Height (jheight at apache dot com) Creates new ValueReferencePtg ReferencePtg - handles references (such as A1, A2, IA4) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver@apache.org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) Takes in a String representation of a cell reference and Fills out the numeric fields. ReferencePtgBase - handles references (such as A1, A2, IA4) @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver@apache.org) @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) The row index - zero based Unsigned 16 bit value Field 2 - lower 8 bits is the zero based Unsigned byte column index - bit 16 - IsRowRelative - bit 15 - IsColumnRelative Takes in a String representation of a cell reference and Fills out the numeric fields. Returns the row number as a short, which will be wrapped (negative) for values between 32769 and 65535 Returns the row number as an int, between 0 and 65535 @author Josh Micich String Stores a String value in a formula value stored in the format <Length 2 bytes>char[] @author Werner Froidevaux @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) @author Bernard Chesnoy the Char (")used in formulas to delimit string literals NOTE: OO doc says 16bit Length, but BiffViewer says 8 Book says something totally different, so don't look there! Create a StringPtg from a stream Create a StringPtg from a string representation of the number Number format Is not Checked, it Is expected to be Validated in the Parser that calls this method. @param value : String representation of a floating point number @author andy @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) This ptg indicates a data table. It only occurs in a FORMULA record, never in an ARRAY or NAME record. When ptgTbl occurs in a formula, it is the only token in the formula. This indicates that the cell containing the formula is an interior cell in a data table; the table description is found in a TABLE record. Rows and columns which contain input values to be substituted in the table do not contain ptgTbl. See page 811 of the june 08 binary docs. The row number of the upper left corner The column number of the upper left corner Unary Plus operator does not have any effect on the operand @author Avik Sengupta implementation of method from OperationsPtg Unary Plus operator does not have any effect on the operand @author Avik Sengupta implementation of method from OperationsPtg @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) implementation of method from OperationsPtg @author andy @author Jason Height (jheight at chariot dot net dot au) Creates new UnknownPtg Common baseclass of all value operators. Subclasses include all Unary and binary operators except for the reference operators (IntersectionPtg, RangePtg, UnionPtg) @author Josh Micich All Operator Ptgs are base tokens (i.e. are not RVA classified) Encapsulates logic to convert shared formulaa into non shared equivalent Creates a non shared formula from the shared formula counterpart, i.e. Converts the shared formula into the equivalent {@link org.apache.poi.ss.formula.ptg.Ptg} array that it would have, were it not shared. @param ptgs parsed tokens of the shared formula @param formulaRow @param formulaColumn @author Josh Micich Extern sheet index of sheet where moving is occurring Sheet name of the sheet where moving is occurring, used for updating XSSF style 3D references on row shifts. Create an instance for Shifting row. For example, this will be called on {@link NPOI.HSSF.UserModel.HSSFSheet#ShiftRows(int, int, int)} } Create an instance for shifting sheets. For example, this will be called on {@link org.apache.poi.hssf.usermodel.HSSFWorkbook#setSheetOrder(String, int)} @param ptgs - if necessary, will get modified by this method @param currentExternSheetIx - the extern sheet index of the sheet that contains the formula being adjusted @return true if a change was made to the formula tokens @return true if this Ptg needed to be changed Formats sheet names for use in formula expressions. @author Josh Micich Used to format sheet names as they would appear in cell formula expressions. @return the sheet name UnChanged if there is no need for delimiting. Otherwise the sheet name is enclosed in single quotes ('). Any single quotes which were already present in the sheet name will be converted to double single quotes (''). Convenience method for when a StringBuilder is already available @param out - sheet name will be Appended here possibly with delimiting quotes @return true if the presence of the specified Char in a sheet name would require the sheet name to be delimited in formulas. This includes every non-alphanumeric Char besides Underscore '_'. Used to decide whether sheet names like 'AB123' need delimiting due to the fact that they look like cell references.

This code is currently being used for translating formulas represented with Ptg tokens into human readable text form. In formula expressions, a sheet name always has a trailing '!' so there is little chance for ambiguity. It doesn't matter too much what this method returns but it is worth noting the likely consumers of these formula text strings:

  1. POI's own formula parser
  2. Visual reading by human
  3. VBA automation entry into Excel cell contents e.g. ActiveCell.Formula = "=c64!A1"
  4. Manual entry into Excel cell contents
  5. Some third party formula parser
At the time of writing, POI's formula parser tolerates cell-like sheet names in formulas with or without delimiters. The same goes for Excel(2007), both manual and automated entry.

For better or worse this implementation attempts to replicate Excel's formula renderer. Excel uses range checking on the apparent 'row' and 'column' components. Note however that the maximum sheet size varies across versions. @see org.apache.poi.hssf.util.CellReference Note - this method assumes the specified rawSheetName has only letters and digits. It cannot be used to match absolute or range references (using the dollar or colon char). Some notable cases:

Input Result Comments
"A1" true
"a111" true
"AA" false
"aa1" true
"A1A" false
"A1A1" false
"A$1:$C$20" falseNot a plain cell reference
"SALES20080101" true Still needs delimiting even though well out of range
@return true if there is any possible ambiguity that the specified rawSheetName could be interpreted as a valid cell name.
Evaluator for returning cells or sheets for a range of sheets @author Josh Micich @return whether cell at rowIndex and columnIndex is a subtotal @see org.apache.poi.ss.formula.functions.Subtotal Optional Extension to the likes of {@link AreaEval} and {@link NPOI.SS.Formula.Eval.AreaEvalBase}, which allows for looking up 3D (sheet+row+column) Evaluations @param sheetIndex sheet index (zero based) @param rowIndex relative row index (zero based) @param columnIndex relative column index (zero based) @return element at the specified row and column position Common interface of {@link AreaEval} and {@link org.apache.poi.ss.formula.eval.AreaEvalBase}, for 2D (row+column) evaluations @param rowIndex relative row index (zero based) @param columnIndex relative column index (zero based) @return element at the specified row and column position @return true if the area has just a single row, this also includes the trivial case when the area has just a single cell. @return true if the area has just a single column, this also includes the trivial case when the area has just a single cell. @param rowIndex relative row index (zero based) @return a single row {@link TwoDEval} @param columnIndex relative column index (zero based) @return a single column {@link TwoDEval} @return true if the cell at row and col is a subtotal Collects Add-in libraries and VB macro functions toGether into one UDF Finder @author PUdalau Returns executor by specified name. Name of function. Function executor. null if not found Add a new toolpack Default UDF Finder - for Adding your own user defined functions. @author PUdalau A UDFFinder that can retrieve functions both by name and by fake index. @author Yegor Kozlov Common interface for "Add-in" libraries and user defined function libraries. @author PUdalau Returns executor by specified name. Returns null if the function name is unknown. @param name Name of function. @return Function executor. Should be implemented by any {@link Ptg} subclass that needs a workbook To render its formula.
For POI internal use only @author Josh Micich
Evaluates formula cells.

For performance reasons, this class keeps a cache of all previously calculated intermediate cell values. Be sure To call {@link #ClearCache()} if any workbook cells are Changed between calls To evaluate~ methods on this class.
For POI internal use only @author Josh Micich also for debug use. Used in ToString methods Should be called whenever there are Changes To input cells in the evaluated workbook. Failure To call this method after changing cell values will cause incorrect behaviour of the evaluate~ methods of this class Should be called To tell the cell value cache that the specified (value or formula) cell Has Changed. Should be called To tell the cell value cache that the specified cell Has just been deleted. Case-insensitive. @return -1 if sheet with specified name does not exist @return never null, never {@link BlankEval} Adds the current cell reference to the exception for easier debugging. Would be nice to get the formula text as well, but that seems to require too much digging around and casting to get the FormulaRenderingWorkbook. Gets the value from a non-formula cell. @param cell may be null @return {@link BlankEval} if cell is null or blank, never null whether print detailed messages about the next formula evaluation Calculates the number of tokens that the evaluator should skip upon reaching a tAttrSkip. @return the number of tokens (starting from startIndex+1) that need to be skipped to achieve the specified distInBytes skip distance. Dereferences a single value from any AreaEval or RefEval evaluation result. If the supplied evaluationResult is just a plain value, it is returned as-is. @return a NumberEval, StringEval, BoolEval, BlankEval or ErrorEval. Never null. returns an appropriate Eval impl instance for the Ptg. The Ptg must be one of: Area3DPtg, AreaPtg, ReferencePtg, Ref3DPtg, IntPtg, NumberPtg, StringPtg, BoolPtg
special Note: OperationPtg subtypes cannot be passed here!
Used by the lazy ref evals whenever they need To Get the value of a contained cell. Whether to ignore missing references to external workbooks and use cached formula results in the main workbook instead.

In some cases exetrnal workbooks referenced by formulas in the main workbook are not avaiable. With this method you can control how POI handles such missing references:

  • by default ignoreMissingWorkbooks=false and POI throws {@link WorkbookNotFoundException} if an external reference cannot be resolved
  • if ignoreMissingWorkbooks=true then POI uses cached formula result that already exists in the main workbook

@param ignore whether to ignore missing references to external workbooks @see Bug 52575 for details
Return a collection of functions that POI can evaluate @return names of functions supported by POI Return a collection of functions that POI does not support @return names of functions NOT supported by POI Register a ATP function in runtime. @param name the function name @param func the functoin to register @throws IllegalArgumentException if the function is unknown or already registered. @since 3.8 beta6 Register a function in runtime. @param name the function name @param func the functoin to register @throws IllegalArgumentException if the function is unknown or already registered. @since 3.8 beta6 Provides access to a {@link WorkbookEvaluator}, eg for use with {@link CollaboratingWorkbooksEnvironment} For POI internal use only Provide the underlying WorkbookEvaluator This enum allows spReadsheets from multiple Excel versions to be handled by the common code. Properties of this enum correspond to attributes of the spReadsheet that are easily discernable to the user. It is not intended to deal with low-level issues like file formats.

@author Josh Micich @author Yegor Kozlov Excel97 format aka BIFF8

  • The total number of available columns is 256 (2^8)
  • The total number of available rows is 64k (2^16)
  • The maximum number of arguments to a function is 30
  • Number of conditional format conditions on a cell is 3
  • Length of text cell contents is unlimited
  • Length of text cell contents is 32767
Excel2007
  • The total number of available columns is 16K (2^14)
  • The total number of available rows is 1M (2^20)
  • The maximum number of arguments to a function is 255
  • Number of conditional format conditions on a cell is unlimited (actually limited by available memory in Excel)
  • Length of text cell contents is unlimited
@return the default file extension of spReadsheet @return the maximum number of usable rows in each spReadsheet @return the last (maximum) valid row index, equals to GetMaxRows() - 1 @return the maximum number of usable columns in each spReadsheet @return the last (maximum) valid column index, equals to GetMaxColumns() - 1 @return the maximum number arguments that can be passed to a multi-arg function (e.g. COUNTIF) @return the maximum number of conditional format conditions on a cell @return the last valid column index in a ALPHA-26 representation (IV or XFD). @return the maximum number of cell styles per spreadsheet @return the maximum length of a text cell Represents autofiltering for the specified worksheet.

Filtering data is a quick and easy way to find and work with a subset of data in a range of cells or table. For example, you can filter to see only the values that you specify, filter to see the top or bottom values, or filter to quickly see duplicate values.

TODO YK: For now (Aug 2010) POI only supports Setting a basic autofilter on a range of cells. In future, when we support more auto-filter functions like custom criteria, sort, etc. we will add corresponding methods to this interface.
No diagional border Backward diagional border, from left-top to right-bottom Forward diagional border, from right-top to left-bottom Both forward and backward diagional border @author Dmitriy Kumshayev @author Yegor Kozlov The enumeration value indicating the line style of a border in a cell No border Thin border Medium border dash border dot border Thick border double-line border hair-line border Medium dashed border dash-dot border medium dash-dot border dash-dot-dot border medium dash-dot-dot border slanted dash-dot border Utility to identify built-in formats. The following is a list of the formats as returned by this class.

0, "General"
1, "0"
2, "0.00"
3, "#,##0"
4, "#,##0.00"
5, "$#,##0_);($#,##0)"
6, "$#,##0_);[Red]($#,##0)"
7, "$#,##0.00);($#,##0.00)"
8, "$#,##0.00_);[Red]($#,##0.00)"
9, "0%"
0xa, "0.00%"
0xb, "0.00E+00"
0xc, "# ?/?"
0xd, "# ??/??"
0xe, "m/d/yy"
0xf, "d-mmm-yy"
0x10, "d-mmm"
0x11, "mmm-yy"
0x12, "h:mm AM/PM"
0x13, "h:mm:ss AM/PM"
0x14, "h:mm"
0x15, "h:mm:ss"
0x16, "m/d/yy h:mm"

// 0x17 - 0x24 reserved for international and undocumented 0x25, "#,##0_);(#,##0)"
0x26, "#,##0_);[Red](#,##0)"
0x27, "#,##0.00_);(#,##0.00)"
0x28, "#,##0.00_);[Red](#,##0.00)"
0x29, "_(*#,##0_);_(*(#,##0);_(* \"-\"_);_(@_)"
0x2a, "_($*#,##0_);_($*(#,##0);_($* \"-\"_);_(@_)"
0x2b, "_(*#,##0.00_);_(*(#,##0.00);_(*\"-\"??_);_(@_)"
0x2c, "_($*#,##0.00_);_($*(#,##0.00);_($*\"-\"??_);_(@_)"
0x2d, "mm:ss"
0x2e, "[h]:mm:ss"
0x2f, "mm:ss.0"
0x30, "##0.0E+0"
0x31, "@" - This is text format.
0x31 "text" - Alias for "@"

@author Yegor Kozlov Modified 6/17/09 by Stanislav Shor - positive formats don't need starting '(' The first user-defined format starts at 164. @deprecated (May 2009) use {@link #getAll()} @return array of built-in data formats Get the format string that matches the given format index @param index of a built in format @return string represented at index of format or null if there is not a built-in format at that index Get the format index that matches the given format string.

Automatically converts "text" to excel's format string to represent text.

@param pFmt string matching a built-in format @return index of format or -1 if undefined.
High level representation of a cell in a row of a spreadsheet.

Cells can be numeric, formula-based or string-based (text). The cell type specifies this. String cells cannot conatin numbers and numeric cells cannot contain strings (at least according to our model). Client apps should do the conversions themselves. Formula cells have the formula string, as well as the formula result, which can be numeric or string.

Cells should have their number (0 based) before being Added to a row.

zero-based column index of a column in a sheet. zero-based row index of a row in the sheet that contains this cell the sheet this cell belongs to the row this cell belongs to Set the cells type (numeric, formula or string)

If the cell currently contains a value, the value will be converted to match the new type, if possible. Formatting is generally lost in the process however.

If what you want to do is get a String value for your numeric cell, stop!. This is not the way to do it. Instead, for fetching the string value of a numeric or boolean or date cell, use {@link DataFormatter} instead.

Set the cells type (numeric, formula or string) Only valid for formula cells Set a numeric value for the cell the numeric value to set this cell to. For formulas we'll set the precalculated value, for numerics we'll set its value. For other types we will change the cell to a numeric cell and set its value. Set a error value for the cell the error value to set this cell to. For formulas we'll set the precalculated value , for errors we'll set its value. For other types we will change the cell to an error cell and set its value. Converts the supplied date to its equivalent Excel numeric value and Sets that into the cell. the numeric value to set this cell to. For formulas we'll set the precalculated value, for numerics we'll set its value. For other types we will change the cell to a numerics cell and set its value. Set a rich string value for the cell. value to set the cell to. For formulas we'll set the formula string, for String cells we'll set its value. For other types we will change the cell to a string cell and set its value. If value is null then we will change the cell to a Blank cell. Set a string value for the cell. value to set the cell to. For formulas we'll set the formula string, for String cells we'll set its value. For other types we will change the cell to a string cell and set its value. If value is null then we will change the cell to a blank cell. Copy the cell to the target index. If the target cell exists, a new cell will be inserted before the existing cell. target index the new copied cell object Return a formula for the cell if the cell type returned by GetCellType() is not CELL_TYPE_FORMULA Sets formula for this cell. the formula to Set, e.g. "SUM(C4:E4)". Get the value of the cell as a number. if the cell type returned by GetCellType() is CELL_TYPE_STRING if the cell value isn't a parsable double Get the value of the cell as a date. if the cell type returned by GetCellType() is CELL_TYPE_STRING if the cell value isn't a parsable double Get the value of the cell RichTextString Get the value of the cell as an error code. Get the value of the cell as a string Set a bool value for the cell Get the value of the cell as a bool. Return the cell's style. Sets this cell as the active cell for the worksheet comment associated with this cell Removes the comment for this cell, if there is one. hyperlink associated with this cell Removes the hyperlink for this cell, if there is one. Only valid for array formula cells range of the array formula group that the cell belongs to. if this cell is part of group of cells having a common array formula. Gets the number of cells in this range. @return height * width @return the text format of this range. Single cell ranges are formatted like single cell references (e.g. 'A1' instead of 'A1:A1'). @return the cell at relative coordinates (0,0). Never null. @param relativeRowIndex must be between 0 and height-1 @param relativeColumnIndex must be between 0 and width-1 @return the cell at the specified coordinates. Never null. @return a flattened array of all the cells in this {@link CellRange} @return a 2-D array of all the cells in this {@link CellRange}. The first array dimension is the row index (values 0...height-1) and the second dimension is the column index (values 0...width-1) the Cell should be auto-sized to shrink to fit if the text is too long get the index within the Workbook (sequence within the collection of ExtnededFormat objects) @return unique index number of the underlying record this style represents (probably you don't care unless you're comparing which one is which) get the index of the format @see DataFormat Get the format string set the font for this style @param font a font object Created or retreived from the Workbook object @see Workbook#CreateFont() @see Workbook#GetFontAt(short) Gets the index of the font for this style @see Workbook#GetFontAt(short) get whether the cell's using this style are to be hidden @return hidden - whether the cell using this style should be hidden get whether the cell's using this style are to be locked @return hidden - whether the cell using this style should be locked get the type of horizontal alignment for the cell @return align - the type of alignment @see #ALIGN_GENERAL @see #ALIGN_LEFT @see #ALIGN_CENTER @see #ALIGN_RIGHT @see #ALIGN_FILL @see #ALIGN_JUSTIFY @see #ALIGN_CENTER_SELECTION get whether the text should be wrapped @return wrap text or not get the type of vertical alignment for the cell @return align the type of alignment @see #VERTICAL_TOP @see #VERTICAL_CENTER @see #VERTICAL_BOTTOM @see #VERTICAL_JUSTIFY get the degree of rotation for the text in the cell @return rotation degrees (between -90 and 90 degrees) get the number of spaces to indent the text in the cell @return indent - number of spaces get the type of border to use for the left border of the cell @return border type @see #BORDER_NONE @see #BORDER_THIN @see #BORDER_MEDIUM @see #BORDER_DASHED @see #BORDER_DOTTED @see #BORDER_THICK @see #BORDER_DOUBLE @see #BORDER_HAIR @see #BORDER_MEDIUM_DASHED @see #BORDER_DASH_DOT @see #BORDER_MEDIUM_DASH_DOT @see #BORDER_DASH_DOT_DOT @see #BORDER_MEDIUM_DASH_DOT_DOT @see #BORDER_SLANTED_DASH_DOT get the type of border to use for the right border of the cell @return border type @see #BORDER_NONE @see #BORDER_THIN @see #BORDER_MEDIUM @see #BORDER_DASHED @see #BORDER_DOTTED @see #BORDER_THICK @see #BORDER_DOUBLE @see #BORDER_HAIR @see #BORDER_MEDIUM_DASHED @see #BORDER_DASH_DOT @see #BORDER_MEDIUM_DASH_DOT @see #BORDER_DASH_DOT_DOT @see #BORDER_MEDIUM_DASH_DOT_DOT @see #BORDER_SLANTED_DASH_DOT get the type of border to use for the top border of the cell @return border type @see #BORDER_NONE @see #BORDER_THIN @see #BORDER_MEDIUM @see #BORDER_DASHED @see #BORDER_DOTTED @see #BORDER_THICK @see #BORDER_DOUBLE @see #BORDER_HAIR @see #BORDER_MEDIUM_DASHED @see #BORDER_DASH_DOT @see #BORDER_MEDIUM_DASH_DOT @see #BORDER_DASH_DOT_DOT @see #BORDER_MEDIUM_DASH_DOT_DOT @see #BORDER_SLANTED_DASH_DOT get the type of border to use for the bottom border of the cell @return border type @see #BORDER_NONE @see #BORDER_THIN @see #BORDER_MEDIUM @see #BORDER_DASHED @see #BORDER_DOTTED @see #BORDER_THICK @see #BORDER_DOUBLE @see #BORDER_HAIR @see #BORDER_MEDIUM_DASHED @see #BORDER_DASH_DOT @see #BORDER_MEDIUM_DASH_DOT @see #BORDER_DASH_DOT_DOT @see #BORDER_MEDIUM_DASH_DOT_DOT @see #BORDER_SLANTED_DASH_DOT get the color to use for the left border get the color to use for the left border @return the index of the color defInition get the color to use for the top border @return hhe index of the color defInition get the color to use for the left border @return the index of the color defInition get the fill pattern (??) - set to 1 to fill with foreground color @return fill pattern get the background fill color @return fill color get the foreground fill color @return fill color Clones all the style information from another CellStyle, onto this one. This CellStyle will then have all the same properties as the source, but the two may be edited independently. Any stylings on this CellStyle will be lost! The source CellStyle could be from another Workbook if you like. This allows you to copy styles from one Workbook to another. However, both of the CellStyles will need to be of the same type (HSSFCellStyle or XSSFCellStyle) Gets or sets the color to use for the diagional border The index of the color definition. Gets or sets the line type to use for the diagional border The line type. Gets or sets the type of diagional border . The border diagional type. Gets the color object representing the current background fill, resolving indexes using the supplied workbook. This will work for both indexed and rgb defined colors. Gets the color object representing the current foreground fill, resolving indexes using the supplied workbook. This will work for both indexed and rgb defined colors. Mimics the 'data view' of a cell. This allows formula Evaluator to return a CellValue instead of precasting the value to String or Number or bool type. @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @return Returns the boolValue. @return Returns the numberValue. @return Returns the stringValue. @return Returns the cellType. @return Returns the errorValue. High level representation of a chart. @author Roman Kashitsyn @return an appropriate ChartDataFactory implementation @return an appropriate ChartAxisFactory implementation @return chart legend instance Delete current chart legend. @return list of all chart axis Plots specified data on the chart. @param data a data to plot Specifies the possible crossing states of an axis. @author Roman Kashitsyn Specifies the value axis shall cross the category axis between data markers. Specifies the value axis shall cross the category axis at the midpoint of a category. Specifies the possible crossing points for an axis. @author Roman Kashitsyn The category axis crosses at the zero point of the value axis (if possible), or the minimum value (if the minimum is greater than zero) or the maximum (if the maximum is less than zero). The axis crosses at the maximum value. Axis crosses at the minimum value of the chart. Specifies the possible ways to place a picture on a data point, series, wall, or floor. @author Roman Kashitsyn Specifies that the values on the axis shall be reversed so they go from maximum to minimum. Specifies that the axis values shall be in the usual order, minimum to maximum. Enumeration of all possible axis positions. @author Roman Kashitsyn Data for a Bar Chart @return list of all series. @return data source used for category axis data. @return data source used for value axis. High level representation of chart axis. @author Roman Kashitsyn @return axis id get or set axis position get or set axis number format @return true if log base is defined, false otherwise @param logBase a number between 2 and 1000 (inclusive) @return axis log base or 0.0 if not Set @throws ArgumentException if log base not within allowed range @return true if minimum value is defined, false otherwise get or set axis minimum 0.0 if not Set @return true if maximum value is defined, false otherwise get or set axis maximum 0.0 if not Set get or set axis orientation get or set axis cross type Declare this axis cross another axis. @param axis that this axis should cross @return visibility of the axis. @return major tick mark. @return minor tick mark. A factory for different chart axis. @author Roman Kashitsyn returns new value axis A base for all chart data types. @author Roman Kashitsyn Fills a chart with data specified by implementation. a chart to fill in chart axis to use A factory for different chart data types. @author Roman Kashitsyn returns an appropriate ScatterChartData instance Return number of points contained by data source. @return number of points contained by data source Returns point value at specified index. @param index index to value from @return point value at specified index. @throws {@code IndexOutOfBoundsException} if index parameter not in range {@code 0 <= index <= pointCount} Returns {@code true} if charts data source is valid cell range. @return {@code true} if charts data source is valid cell range Returns {@code true} if data source points should be treated as numbers. @return {@code true} if data source points should be treated as numbers Returns formula representation of the data source. It is only applicable for data source that is valid cell range. @return formula representation of the data source @throws {@code UnsupportedOperationException} if the data source is not a reference. High level representation of chart legend. @author Roman Kashitsyn legend position If true the legend is positioned over the chart area otherwise the legend is displayed next to it. Default is no overlay. Sets the title of the series as a string literal. @param title Sets the title of the series as a cell reference. @param titleReference @return title as string literal. @return title as cell reference. @return title type. Specifies the possible ways to store a chart element's position. @author Roman Kashitsyn Specifies that the Width or Height shall be interpreted as the Right or Bottom of the chart element. Specifies that the Width or Height shall be interpreted as the width or Height of the chart element. Specifies whether to layout the plot area by its inside (not including axis and axis labels) or outside (including axis and axis labels). @author Roman Kashitsyn Specifies that the plot area size shall determine the size of the plot area, not including the tick marks and axis labels. Specifies that the plot area size shall determine the size of the plot area, the tick marks, and the axis labels. Enumeration of all possible chart legend positions. @author Roman Kashitsyn Data for a Line Chart @return list of all series. @return data source used for category axis data. @return data source used for value axis. High level representation of chart element manual layout. @author Roman Kashitsyn Sets the layout target. @param target new layout target. Returns current layout target. @return current layout target Sets the x-coordinate layout mode. @param mode new x-coordinate layout mode. Returns current x-coordinnate layout mode. @return current x-coordinate layout mode. Sets the y-coordinate layout mode. @param mode new y-coordinate layout mode. Returns current y-coordinate layout mode. @return current y-coordinate layout mode. Returns the x location of the chart element. @return the x location (left) of the chart element or 0.0 if not Set. Specifies the x location (left) of the chart element as a fraction of the width of the chart. If Left Mode is Factor, then the position is relative to the default position for the chart element. Returns current y location of the chart element. @return the y location (top) of the chart element or 0.0 if not Set. Specifies the y location (top) of the chart element as a fraction of the height of the chart. If Top Mode is Factor, then the position is relative to the default position for the chart element. Specifies how to interpret the Width element for this manual layout. @param mode new width layout mode of this manual layout. Returns current width mode of this manual layout. @return width mode of this manual layout. Specifies how to interpret the Height element for this manual layout. @param mode new height mode of this manual layout. Returns current height mode of this @return height mode of this manual layout. Specifies the width (if Width Mode is Factor) or right (if Width Mode is Edge) of the chart element as a fraction of the width of the chart. @param ratio a fraction of the width of the chart. Returns current fraction of the width of the chart. @return fraction of the width of the chart or 0.0 if not Set. Specifies the height (if Height Mode is Factor) or bottom (if Height Mode is edge) of the chart element as a fraction of the height of the chart. @param ratio a fraction of the height of the chart. Returns current fraction of the height of the chart. @return fraction of the height of the chart or 0.0 if not Set. Abstraction of chart element that can be positioned with manual layout. @author Roman Kashitsyn Returns manual layout for the chart element. @return manual layout for the chart element. Data for a Scatter Chart @param xs data source to be used for X axis values @param ys data source to be used for Y axis values @return a new scatter charts series @return list of all series Represents scatter charts serie. @author Roman Kashitsyn @return data source used for X axis values @return data source used for Y axis values @author Roman Kashitsyn @return cross between type @param crossBetween cross between type Move and Resize With Anchor Cells

Specifies that the current drawing shall move and resize to maintain its row and column anchors (i.e. the object is anchored to the actual from and to row and column)

Move With Cells but Do Not Resize

Specifies that the current drawing shall move with its row and column (i.e. the object is anchored to the actual from row and column), but that the size shall remain absolute.

If Additional rows/columns are Added between the from and to locations of the drawing, the drawing shall move its to anchors as needed to maintain this same absolute size.

Do Not Move or Resize With Underlying Rows/Columns

Specifies that the current start and end positions shall be maintained with respect to the distances from the absolute start point of the worksheet.

If Additional rows/columns are Added before the drawing, the drawing shall move its anchors as needed to maintain this same absolute position.

A client anchor is attached to an excel worksheet. It anchors against a top-left and bottom-right cell. @author Yegor Kozlov Returns the column (0 based) of the first cell. @return 0-based column of the first cell. Returns the column (0 based) of the second cell. @return 0-based column of the second cell. Returns the row (0 based) of the first cell. @return 0-based row of the first cell. Returns the row (0 based) of the second cell. @return 0-based row of the second cell. Returns the x coordinate within the first cell @return the x coordinate within the first cell Returns the y coordinate within the first cell @return the y coordinate within the first cell Sets the y coordinate within the second cell @return the y coordinate within the second cell Returns the x coordinate within the second cell @return the x coordinate within the second cell s the anchor type

0 = Move and size with Cells, 2 = Move but don't size with cells, 3 = Don't move or size with cells.

@return the anchor type @see #MOVE_AND_RESIZE @see #MOVE_DONT_RESIZE @see #DONT_MOVE_AND_RESIZE
Sets whether this comment is visible. @return true if the comment is visible, false otherwise Return the row of the cell that Contains the comment @return the 0-based row of the cell that Contains the comment Return the column of the cell that Contains the comment @return the 0-based column of the cell that Contains the comment Name of the original comment author @return the name of the original author of the comment Fetches the rich text string of the comment Return defines position of this anchor in the sheet. @return defines position of this anchor in the sheet The conditional format operators used for "Highlight Cells That Contain..." rules.

For example, "highlight cells that begin with "M2" and contain "Mountain Gear".

@author Dmitriy Kumshayev @author Yegor Kozlov
'Between' operator 'Not between' operator 'Equal to' operator 'Not equal to' operator 'Greater than' operator 'Less than' operator 'Greater than or equal to' operator 'Less than or equal to' operator The ConditionalFormatting class encapsulates all Settings of Conditional Formatting. The class can be used
  • to make a copy ConditionalFormatting Settings.
  • For example:
                 ConditionalFormatting cf = sheet.GetConditionalFormattingAt(index);
                 newSheet.AddConditionalFormatting(cf);
                 
  • or to modify existing Conditional Formatting Settings (formatting regions and/or rules).
Use {@link NPOI.HSSF.UserModel.Sheet#getSheetConditionalFormatting()} to Get access to an instance of this class. To create a new Conditional Formatting Set use the following approach:
            
             // Define a Conditional Formatting rule, which triggers formatting
             // when cell's value is greater or equal than 100.0 and
             // applies patternFormatting defined below.
             ConditionalFormattingRule rule = sheet.CreateConditionalFormattingRule(
                 ComparisonOperator.GE,
                 "100.0", // 1st formula
                 null     // 2nd formula is not used for comparison operator GE
             );
            
             // Create pattern with red background
             PatternFormatting patternFmt = rule.CretePatternFormatting();
             patternFormatting.FillBackgroundColor(IndexedColor.RED.Index);
            
             // Define a region Containing first column
             Region [] regions =
             {
                 new Region(1,(short)1,-1,(short)1)
             };
            
             // Apply Conditional Formatting rule defined above to the regions
             sheet.AddConditionalFormatting(regions, rule);
             
@author Dmitriy Kumshayev @author Yegor Kozlov
@return array of CellRangeAddresss. Never null Replaces an existing Conditional Formatting rule at position idx. Excel allows to create up to 3 Conditional Formatting rules. This method can be useful to modify existing Conditional Formatting rules. @param idx position of the rule. Should be between 0 and 2. @param cfRule - Conditional Formatting rule Add a Conditional Formatting rule. Excel allows to create up to 3 Conditional Formatting rules. @param cfRule - Conditional Formatting rule @return the Conditional Formatting rule at position idx. @return number of Conditional Formatting rules. Allow accessing the Initial value. This conditional formatting rule Compares a cell value to a formula calculated result, using an operator This conditional formatting rule Contains a formula to Evaluate. When the formula result is true, the cell is highlighted. Represents a description of a conditional formatting rule @author Dmitriy Kumshayev @author Yegor Kozlov Create a new border formatting structure if it does not exist, otherwise just return existing object. @return - border formatting object, never returns null. @return - border formatting object if defined, null otherwise Create a new font formatting structure if it does not exist, otherwise just return existing object. @return - font formatting object, never returns null. @return - font formatting object if defined, null otherwise Create a new pattern formatting structure if it does not exist, otherwise just return existing object. @return - pattern formatting object, never returns null. @return - pattern formatting object if defined, null otherwise Type of conditional formatting rule.

MUST be either {@link #CONDITION_TYPE_CELL_VALUE_IS} or {@link #CONDITION_TYPE_FORMULA}

@return the type of condition
The comparison function used when the type of conditional formatting is Set to {@link #CONDITION_TYPE_CELL_VALUE_IS}

MUST be a constant from {@link ComparisonOperator}

@return the conditional format operator
The formula used to Evaluate the first operand for the conditional formatting rule.

If the condition type is {@link #CONDITION_TYPE_CELL_VALUE_IS}, this field is the first operand of the comparison. If type is {@link #CONDITION_TYPE_FORMULA}, this formula is used to determine if the conditional formatting is applied.

If comparison type is {@link #CONDITION_TYPE_FORMULA} the formula MUST be a Boolean function

@return the first formula
The formula used to Evaluate the second operand of the comparison when comparison type is {@link #CONDITION_TYPE_CELL_VALUE_IS} and operator is either {@link ComparisonOperator#BETWEEN} or {@link ComparisonOperator#NOT_BETWEEN} @return the second formula An object that handles instantiating concrete classes of the various instances one needs for HSSF and XSSF. Works around a major shortcoming in Java, where we can't have static methods on interfaces or abstract classes. This allows you to get the appropriate class for a given interface, without you having to worry about if you're dealing with HSSF or XSSF, despite Java being quite rubbish. Creates a new RichTextString instance @param text The text to Initialise the RichTextString with Creates a new DataFormat instance Creates a new Hyperlink, of the given type Creates FormulaEvaluator - an object that Evaluates formula cells. @return a FormulaEvaluator instance Enum mapping the values of STDataConsolidateFunction get the format index that matches the given format string. Creates a new format if one is not found. Aliases text to the proper format. @param format string matching a built in format @return index of format. get the format string that matches the given format index @param index of a format @return string represented at index of format or null if there is not a format at that index HSSFDataFormatter contains methods for Formatting the value stored in an Cell. This can be useful for reports and GUI presentations when you need to display data exactly as it appears in Excel. Supported Formats include currency, SSN, percentages, decimals, dates, phone numbers, zip codes, etc. Internally, Formats will be implemented using subclasses of such as and . Therefore the Formats used by this class must obey the same pattern rules as these FormatBase subclasses. This means that only legal number pattern characters ("0", "#", ".", "," etc.) may appear in number formats. Other characters can be inserted before or after the number pattern to form a prefix or suffix. For example the Excel pattern "$#,##0.00 "USD"_);($#,##0.00 "USD")" will be correctly Formatted as "$1,000.00 USD" or "($1,000.00 USD)". However the pattern "00-00-00" is incorrectly Formatted by DecimalFormat as "000000--". For Excel Formats that are not compatible with DecimalFormat, you can provide your own custom {@link FormatBase} implementation via HSSFDataFormatter.AddFormat(String,FormatBase). The following custom Formats are already provided by this class:
             
  • SSN "000-00-0000"
  • Phone Number "(###) ###-####"
  • Zip plus 4 "00000-0000"
If the Excel FormatBase pattern cannot be Parsed successfully, then a default FormatBase will be used. The default number FormatBase will mimic the Excel General FormatBase: "#" for whole numbers and "#.##########" for decimal numbers. You can override the default FormatBase pattern with HSSFDataFormatter.setDefaultNumberFormat(FormatBase). Note: the default FormatBase will only be used when a FormatBase cannot be Created from the cell's data FormatBase string. @author James May (james dot may at fmr dot com)
Pattern to find a number FormatBase: "0" or "#" Pattern to find "AM/PM" marker A regex to find patterns like [$$-1009] and [$�-452]. Note that we don't currently process these into locales A regex to identify a fraction pattern. This requires that replaceAll("\\?", "#") has already been called A regex to strip junk out of fraction formats * Cells formatted with a date or time format and which contain invalid date or time values * show 255 pound signs ("#"). General FormatBase for whole numbers. General FormatBase for decimal numbers. A default FormatBase to use when a number pattern cannot be Parsed. Creates a formatter using the {@link Locale#getDefault() default locale}. Constructor Creates a formatter using the given locale. @param emulateCsv whether to emulate CSV output. Return a FormatBase for the given cell if one exists, otherwise try to Create one. This method will return null if the any of the following is true:
  • the cell's style is null
  • the style's data FormatBase string is null or empty
  • the FormatBase string cannot be recognized as either a number or date
@param cell The cell to retrieve a FormatBase for @return A FormatBase for the FormatBase String
Create and return a FormatBase based on the FormatBase string from a cell's style. If the pattern cannot be Parsed, return a default pattern. @param cell The Excel cell @return A FormatBase representing the excel FormatBase. May return null. Return true if the double value represents a whole number @param d the double value to check @return true if d is a whole number Returns a default FormatBase for a cell. @param cell The cell @return a default FormatBase Returns the Formatted value of an Excel date as a String based on the cell's DataFormat. i.e. "Thursday, January 02, 2003" , "01/02/2003" , "02-Jan" , etc. @param cell The cell @return a Formatted date string Returns the Formatted value of an Excel number as a String based on the cell's DataFormat. Supported Formats include currency, percents, decimals, phone number, SSN, etc.: "61.54%", "$100.00", "(800) 555-1234". @param cell The cell @return a Formatted number string Formats the given raw cell value, based on the supplied FormatBase index and string, according to excel style rules. @see #FormatCellValue(Cell) Performs Excel-style date formatting, using the supplied Date and format Formats the given raw cell value, based on the supplied format index and string, according to excel style rules. @see #formatCellValue(Cell) Returns the Formatted value of a cell as a String regardless of the cell type. If the Excel FormatBase pattern cannot be Parsed then the cell value will be Formatted using a default FormatBase. When passed a null or blank cell, this method will return an empty String (""). Formulas in formula type cells will not be evaluated. @param cell The cell @return the Formatted cell value as a String Returns the Formatted value of a cell as a String regardless of the cell type. If the Excel FormatBase pattern cannot be Parsed then the cell value will be Formatted using a default FormatBase. When passed a null or blank cell, this method will return an empty String (""). Formula cells will be evaluated using the given {@link HSSFFormulaEvaluator} if the evaluator is non-null. If the evaluator is null, then the formula String will be returned. The caller is responsible for setting the currentRow on the evaluator @param cell The cell (can be null) @param evaluator The HSSFFormulaEvaluator (can be null) @return a string value of the cell Sets a default number FormatBase to be used when the Excel FormatBase cannot be Parsed successfully. Note: This is a fall back for when an error occurs while parsing an Excel number FormatBase pattern. This will not affect cells with the General FormatBase. The value that will be passed to the FormatBase's FormatBase method (specified by java.text.FormatBase#FormatBase) will be a double value from a numeric cell. Therefore the code in the FormatBase method should expect a Number value. @param FormatBase A FormatBase instance to be used as a default @see java.text.FormatBase#FormatBase Adds a new FormatBase to the available formats. The value that will be passed to the FormatBase's FormatBase method (specified by java.text.FormatBase#FormatBase) will be a double value from a numeric cell. Therefore the code in the FormatBase method should expect a Number value. @param excelformatStr The data FormatBase string @param FormatBase A FormatBase instance Error style constants for error box STOP style WARNING style INFO style get or set the error style for error box Setting this allows an empty object as a valid value. Retrieve the settings for empty cells allowed. @return True if this object should treats empty as valid value , false otherwise true if this object should treats empty as valid value, false otherwise Useful for list validation objects . Useful only list validation objects . This method always returns false if the object isn't a list validation object Sets the behaviour when a cell which belongs to this object is selected true if an prompt box should be displayed , false otherwise Sets the behaviour when an invalid value is entered true if an error box should be displayed , false otherwise Sets the title and text for the prompt box . Prompt box is displayed when the user selects a cell which belongs to this validation object . In order for a prompt box to be displayed you should also use method SetShowPromptBox( bool show ) @param title The prompt box's title @param text The prompt box's text @return Prompt box's title or null @return Prompt box's text or null Sets the title and text for the error box . Error box is displayed when the user enters an invalid value int o a cell which belongs to this validation object . In order for an error box to be displayed you should also use method SetShowErrorBox( bool show ) @param title The error box's title @param text The error box's text @return Error box's title or null @return Error box's text or null @return data validation type of this constraint @see ValidationType @return the operator used for this constraint @see OperatorType get or set then comparison operator for this constraint get or set the formula for expression 1. May be null get or set the formula for expression 2. May be null ValidationType enum 'Any value' type - value not restricted int ('Whole number') type Decimal type List type ( combo box type ) Date type Time type String length type Formula ( 'Custom' ) type Condition operator enum default value to supply when the operator type is not used @author Radhakrishnan J Contains methods for dealing with Excel dates. @author Michael Harhen @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) @author Dan Sherman (dsherman at Isisph.com) @author Hack Kampbjorn (hak at 2mba.dk) @author Alex Jacoby (ajacoby at gmail.com) @author Pavel Krupets (pkrupets at palmtreebusiness dot com) @author Thies Wellpott The following patterns are used in {@link #isADateFormat(int, String)} Given a Calendar, return the number of days since 1899/12/31. the date if set to true [use1904windowing]. number of days since 1899/12/31 Given a Date, Converts it into a double representing its internal Excel representation, which Is the number of days since 1/1/1900. Fractional days represent hours, minutes, and seconds. Excel representation of Date (-1 if error - test for error by Checking for less than 0.1) the Date Gets the excel date. The year. The month. The day. The hour. The minute. The second. Should 1900 or 1904 date windowing be used? Given a Date, Converts it into a double representing its internal Excel representation, which Is the number of days since 1/1/1900. Fractional days represent hours, minutes, and seconds. The date. Should 1900 or 1904 date windowing be used? Excel representation of Date (-1 if error - test for error by Checking for less than 0.1) Given an Excel date with using 1900 date windowing, and converts it to a java.util.Date. Excel Dates and Times are stored without any timezone information. If you know (through other means) that your file uses a different TimeZone to the system default, you can use this version of the getJavaDate() method to handle it. The Excel date. null if date is not a valid Excel date Given an Excel date with either 1900 or 1904 date windowing, Converts it to a Date. NOTE: If the default TimeZone in Java uses Daylight Saving Time then the conversion back to an Excel date may not give the same value, that Is the comparison excelDate == GetExcelDate(GetJavaDate(excelDate,false)) Is not always true. For example if default timezone Is Europe/Copenhagen, on 2004-03-28 the minute after 01:59 CET Is 03:00 CEST, if the excel date represents a time between 02:00 and 03:00 then it Is Converted to past 03:00 summer time @param date The Excel date. @param use1904windowing true if date uses 1904 windowing, or false if using 1900 date windowing. @return Java representation of the date, or null if date Is not a valid Excel date @see TimeZone Given an Excel date with either 1900 or 1904 date windowing, converts it to a java.util.Date. Excel Dates and Times are stored without any timezone information. If you know (through other means) that your file uses a different TimeZone to the system default, you can use this version of the getJavaDate() method to handle it. @param date The Excel date. @param tz The TimeZone to evaluate the date in @param use1904windowing true if date uses 1904 windowing, or false if using 1900 date windowing. @return Java representation of the date, or null if date is not a valid Excel date Given an Excel date with either 1900 or 1904 date windowing, converts it to a java.util.Date. Excel Dates and Times are stored without any timezone information. If you know (through other means) that your file uses a different TimeZone to the system default, you can use this version of the getJavaDate() method to handle it. @param date The Excel date. @param tz The TimeZone to evaluate the date in @param use1904windowing true if date uses 1904 windowing, or false if using 1900 date windowing. @param roundSeconds round to closest second @return Java representation of the date, or null if date is not a valid Excel date Get EXCEL date as Java Calendar with given time zone. @param date The Excel date. @param use1904windowing true if date uses 1904 windowing, or false if using 1900 date windowing. @param timeZone The TimeZone to evaluate the date in @return Java representation of the date, or null if date is not a valid Excel date Get EXCEL date as Java Calendar (with default time zone). This is like GetJavaDate(double, boolean) but returns a Calendar object. The Excel date. true if date uses 1904 windowing, or false if using 1900 date windowing. null if date is not a valid Excel date Converts a string of format "HH:MM" or "HH:MM:SS" to its (Excel) numeric equivalent The time STR. a double between 0 and 1 representing the fraction of the day Converts the time internal. The time STR. Given a format ID and its format String, will Check to see if the format represents a date format or not. Firstly, it will Check to see if the format ID corresponds to an internal excel date format (eg most US date formats) If not, it will Check to see if the format string only Contains date formatting Chars (ymd-/), which covers most non US date formats. The index of the format, eg from ExtendedFormatRecord.GetFormatIndex The format string, eg from FormatRecord.GetFormatString true if [is A date format] [the specified format index]; otherwise, false. Converts a string of format "YYYY/MM/DD" to its (Excel) numeric equivalent The date STR. a double representing the (integer) number of days since the start of the Excel epoch Parses the YYYYMMDD date internal. The time string. Parses the int. The string value. Name of the field. The range max. Parses the int. The STR val. Name of the field. The lower limit. The upper limit. Given a format ID this will Check whether the format represents an internal excel date format or not. The format. Check if a cell Contains a date Since dates are stored internally in Excel as double values we infer it Is a date if it Is formatted as such. The cell. Check if a cell contains a date, Checking only for internal excel date formats. As Excel stores a great many of its dates in "non-internal" date formats, you will not normally want to use this method. The cell. Given a double, Checks if it Is a valid Excel date. the double value. true if [is valid excel date] [the specified value]; otherwise, false. @author Yegor Kozlov Creates a picture. @param anchor the client anchor describes how this picture is attached to the sheet. @param pictureIndex the index of the picture in the workbook collection of pictures. @return the newly created picture. Creates a comment. @param anchor the client anchor describes how this comment is attached to the sheet. @return the newly created comment. Creates a chart. @param anchor the client anchor describes how this chart is attached to the sheet. @return the newly created chart Creates a new client anchor and sets the top-left and bottom-right coordinates of the anchor. @param dx1 the x coordinate in EMU within the first cell. @param dy1 the y coordinate in EMU within the first cell. @param dx2 the x coordinate in EMU within the second cell. @param dy2 the y coordinate in EMU within the second cell. @param col1 the column (0 based) of the first cell. @param row1 the row (0 based) of the first cell. @param col2 the column (0 based) of the second cell. @param row2 the row (0 based) of the second cell. @return the newly created client anchor the type of fill to display with the shape or the background of the slide. A solid fill A patterned fill A textured fill A picture fill A gradient fill that starts and ends with defined endpoints A gradient fill that starts and ends based on the bounds of the shape A gradient fill that starts on the outline of the shape and ends at a point defined within the shape A gradient fill that starts on the outline of the shape and ends at a point defined within the shape. The fill angle is scaled by the aspect ratio of the shape A gradient fill interpreted by the host application A fill that matches the background fill Contains raw Excel error codes (as defined in OOO's excelfileformat.pdf (2.5.6) @author Michael Harhen #NULL! - Intersection of two cell ranges is empty #DIV/0! - Division by zero #VALUE! - Wrong type of operand #REF! - Illegal or deleted cell reference #NAME? - Wrong function or range name #NUM! - Value range overflow #N/A - Argument or function not available @return Standard Excel error literal for the specified error code. @throws ArgumentException if the specified error code is not one of the 7 standard error codes @return true if the specified error code is a standard Excel error code. A wrapper around a {@link SimpleDateFormat} instance, which handles a few Excel-style extensions that are not supported by {@link SimpleDateFormat}. Currently, the extensions are around the handling of elapsed time, eg rendering 1 day 2 hours as 26 hours. Takes a format String, and Replaces Excel specific bits with our detection sequences Used to let us know what the date being formatted is, in Excel terms, which we may wish to use when handling elapsed times. The enumeration value indicating the style of fill pattern being used for a cell format. No background Solidly Filled Small fine dots Wide dots Sparse dots Thick horizontal bands Thick vertical bands Thick backward facing diagonals Thick forward facing diagonals Large spots Brick-like layout Thin horizontal bands Thin vertical bands Thin backward diagonal Thin forward diagonal Squares Diamonds Less Dots Least Dots not underlined single (normal) underline double underlined accounting style single underline accounting style double underline no type Offsetting (not super or subscript) superscript subscript Allow accessing the Initial value. normal type of black color. Dark Red color Allow accessing the Initial value. Normal boldness (not bold) Bold boldness (bold) get the name for the font (i.e. Arial) Get the font height in unit's of 1/20th of a point. Maybe you might want to use the GetFontHeightInPoints which matches to the familiar 10, 12, 14 etc.. Get the font height in points. This will return the same font height that is shown in Excel, such as 10 or 14 or 28. get whether to use italics or not get whether to use a strikeout horizontal line through the text or not get the color for the font @return color to use @see #COLOR_NORMAL @see #COLOR_RED @see NPOI.HSSF.usermodel.HSSFPalette#GetColor(short) get type of text underlining to use get type of text underlining to use get character-set to use. @return character-set @see #ANSI_CHARSET @see #DEFAULT_CHARSET @see #SYMBOL_CHARSET get the index within the XSSFWorkbook (sequence within the collection of Font objects) @return unique index number of the underlying record this Font represents (probably you don't care unless you're comparing which one is which) Copies the style from another font into this one Charset represents the basic set of characters associated with a font (that it can display), and corresponds to the ANSI codepage (8-bit or DBCS) of that character set used by a given language. @author Gisella Bronzetti Returns value of this charset @return value of this charset The font family this font belongs to. A font family is a set of fonts having common stroke width and serif characteristics. The font name overrides when there are conflicting values. @author Gisella Bronzetti Returns index of this font family @return index of this font family High level representation for Font Formatting component of Conditional Formatting Settings @author Dmitriy Kumshayev @author Yegor Kozlov get or set the type of super or subscript for the font get or set font color index get or set the height of the font in 1/20th point units get or set the type of underlining for the font Get whether the font weight is Set to bold or not @return bold - whether the font is bold or not @return true if font style was Set to italic Set font style options. @param italic - if true, Set posture style to italic, otherwise to normal @param bold if true, Set font weight to bold, otherwise to normal Set font style options to default values (non-italic, non-bold) Defines the font scheme to which this font belongs. When a font defInition is part of a theme defInition, then the font is categorized as either a major or minor font scheme component. When a new theme is chosen, every font that is part of a theme defInition is updated to use the new major or minor font defInition for that theme. Usually major fonts are used for styles like headings, and minor fonts are used for body and paragraph text. @author Gisella Bronzetti the different types of possible underline formatting @author Gisella Bronzetti Single-line underlining under each character in the cell. The underline is drawn through the descenders of characters such as g and p.. Double-line underlining under each character in the cell. underlines are drawn through the descenders of characters such as g and p. Single-line accounting underlining under each character in the cell. The underline is drawn under the descenders of characters such as g and p. Double-line accounting underlining under each character in the cell. The underlines are drawn under the descenders of characters such as g and p. No underline. Common defInition of a HSSF or XSSF page footer. For a list of all the different fields that can be placed into a footer, such as page number, bold, underline etc, see Enumerates error values in SpreadsheetML formula calculations. See also OOO's excelfileformat.pdf (2.5.6) Intended to indicate when two areas are required to intersect, but do not.

Example: In the case of SUM(B1 C1), the space between B1 and C1 is treated as the binary intersection operator, when a comma was intended. end example]

Intended to indicate when any number, including zero, is divided by zero. Note: However, any error code divided by zero results in that error code. Intended to indicate when an incompatible type argument is passed to a function, or an incompatible type operand is used with an operator.

Example: In the case of a function argument, text was expected, but a number was provided

Intended to indicate when a cell reference is invalid.

Example: If a formula Contains a reference to a cell, and then the row or column Containing that cell is deleted, a #REF! error results. If a worksheet does not support 20,001 columns, OFFSET(A1,0,20000) will result in a #REF! error.

Intended to indicate when an argument to a function has a compatible type, but has a value that is outside the domain over which that function is defined. (This is known as a domain error.)

Example: Certain calls to ASIN, ATANH, FACT, and SQRT might result in domain errors.

Intended to indicate that the result of a function cannot be represented in a value of the specified type, typically due to extreme magnitude. (This is known as a range error.)

Example: FACT(1000) might result in a range error.

Intended to indicate when a designated value is not available.

Example: Some functions, such as SUMX2MY2, perform a series of operations on corresponding elements in two arrays. If those arrays do not have the same number of elements, then for some elements in the longer array, there are no corresponding elements in the shorter one; that is, one or more values in the shorter array are not available.

This error value can be produced by calling the function NA
POI specific code to indicate that there is a circular reference in the formula POI specific code to indicate that the funcition required is not implemented in POI @return numeric code of the error @return long (internal) numeric code of the error @return string representation of the error Evaluates formula cells.

For performance reasons, this class keeps a cache of all previously calculated intermediate cell values. Be sure to call {@link #ClearAllCachedResultValues()} if any workbook cells are Changed between calls to Evaluate~ methods on this class. @author Amol S. Deshmukh < amolweb at ya hoo dot com > @author Josh Micich Should be called whenever there are Changes to input cells in the Evaluated workbook. Failure to call this method after changing cell values will cause incorrect behaviour of the Evaluate~ methods of this class Should be called to tell the cell value cache that the specified (value or formula) cell has Changed. Failure to call this method after changing cell values will cause incorrect behaviour of the Evaluate~ methods of this class Should be called to tell the cell value cache that the specified cell has just become a formula cell, or the formula text has Changed Should be called to tell the cell value cache that the specified (value or formula) cell has changed. Failure to call this method after changing cell values will cause incorrect behaviour of the evaluate~ methods of this class If cell Contains a formula, the formula is Evaluated and returned, else the CellValue simply copies the appropriate cell value from the cell and also its cell type. This method should be preferred over EvaluateInCell() when the call should not modify the contents of the original cell. @param cell Loops over all cells in all sheets of the associated workbook. For cells that contain formulas, their formulas are evaluated, and the results are saved. These cells remain as formula cells. For cells that do not contain formulas, no changes are made. This is a helpful wrapper around looping over all cells, and calling evaluateFormulaCell on each one. If cell Contains formula, it Evaluates the formula, and saves the result of the formula. The cell remains as a formula cell. Else if cell does not contain formula, this method leaves the cell unChanged. Note that the type of the formula result is returned, so you know what kind of value is also stored with the formula.

            int EvaluatedCellType = Evaluator.evaluateFormulaCell(cell);
            
Be aware that your cell will hold both the formula, and the result. If you want the cell Replaced with the result of the formula, use {@link #EvaluateInCell(Cell)} @param cell The cell to Evaluate @return The type of the formula result, i.e. -1 if the cell is not a formula, or one of Cell.CELL_TYPE_NUMERIC, Cell.CELL_TYPE_STRING, Cell.CELL_TYPE_BOOLEAN, Cell.CELL_TYPE_ERROR Note: the cell's type remains as Cell.CELL_TYPE_FORMULA however.
If cell Contains formula, it Evaluates the formula, and Puts the formula result back into the cell, in place of the old formula. Else if cell does not contain formula, this method leaves the cell unChanged. Note that the same instance of Cell is returned to allow chained calls like:
            int EvaluatedCellType = Evaluator.evaluateInCell(cell).getCellType();
            
Be aware that your cell value will be Changed to hold the result of the formula. If you simply want the formula value comPuted for you, use {@link #EvaluateFormulaCell(Cell)} @param cell
Sets up the Formula Evaluator to be able to reference and resolve links to other workbooks, eg [Test.xls]Sheet1!A1. For a workbook referenced as [Test.xls]Sheet1!A1, you should supply a map containing the key Test.xls (no square brackets), and an open FormulaEvaluator onto that Workbook. @param otherWorkbooks Map of workbook names (no square brackets) to an evaluator on that workbook Whether to ignore missing references to external workbooks and use cached formula results in the main workbook instead.
In some cases external workbooks referenced by formulas in the main workbook are not available. With this method you can control how POI handles such missing references:
  • by default ignoreMissingWorkbooks=false and POI throws {@link org.apache.poi.ss.formula.CollaboratingWorkbooksEnvironment.WorkbookNotFoundException} if an external reference cannot be resolved
  • if ignoreMissingWorkbooks=true then POI uses cached formula result that already exists in the main workbook
@param ignore whether to ignore missing references to external workbooks
* Perform detailed output of formula evaluation for next evaluation only? * Is for developer use only (also developers using POI for their XLS files). * Log-Level WARN is for basic info, INFO for detailed information. These quite * high levels are used because you have to explicitly enable this specific logging. * @param value whether to perform detailed output

Format class that handles Excel style fractions, such as "# #/#" and "#/###"

As of this writing, this is still not 100% accurate, but it does a reasonable job of trying to mimic Excel's fraction calculations. It does not currently maintain Excel's spacing.

This class relies on a method lifted nearly verbatim from org.apache.math.fraction. If further uses for Commons Math are found, we will consider Adding it as a dependency. For now, we have in-lined the one method to keep things simple.

Single parameter ctor @param denomFormatString The format string for the denominator Common defInition of a HSSF or XSSF page header. For a list of all the different fields that can be placed into a header, such as page number, bold, underline etc, see Common interface for NPOI.SS.UserModel.Header and NPOI.SS.UserModel.Footer Gets or sets the left side of the header or footer. The string representing the left side. Gets or sets the center of the header or footer. The string representing the center. Gets or sets the right side of the header or footer. The string representing the right side. The enumeration value indicating horizontal alignment of a cell, i.e., whether it is aligned general, left, right, horizontally centered, Filled (replicated), justified, centered across multiple cells, or distributed. The horizontal alignment is general-aligned. Text data is left-aligned. Numbers, dates, and times are rightaligned. Boolean types are centered. Changing the alignment does not change the type of data. The horizontal alignment is left-aligned, even in Rightto-Left mode. Aligns contents at the left edge of the cell. If an indent amount is specified, the contents of the cell is indented from the left by the specified number of character spaces. The character spaces are based on the default font and font size for the workbook. The horizontal alignment is centered, meaning the text is centered across the cell. The horizontal alignment is right-aligned, meaning that cell contents are aligned at the right edge of the cell, even in Right-to-Left mode. The horizontal alignment is justified (flush left and right). For each line of text, aligns each line of the wrapped text in a cell to the right and left (except the last line). If no single line of text wraps in the cell, then the text is not justified. Indicates that the value of the cell should be Filled across the entire width of the cell. If blank cells to the right also have the fill alignment, they are also Filled with the value, using a convention similar to centerContinuous.

Additional rules:

  1. Only whole values can be Appended, not partial values.
  2. The column will not be widened to 'best fit' the Filled value
  3. If Appending an Additional occurrence of the value exceeds the boundary of the cell left/right edge, don't append the Additional occurrence of the value.
  4. The display value of the cell is Filled, not the underlying raw number.

The horizontal alignment is centered across multiple cells. The information about how many cells to span is expressed in the Sheet Part, in the row of the cell in question. For each cell that is spanned in the alignment, a cell element needs to be written out, with the same style Id which references the centerContinuous alignment. Indicates that each 'word' in each line of text inside the cell is evenly distributed across the width of the cell, with flush right and left margins.

When there is also an indent value to apply, both the left and right side of the cell are pAdded by the indent value.

A 'word' is a set of characters with no space character in them.

Two lines inside a cell are Separated by a carriage return.

Link to an existing file or web page Link to a place in this document Link to an E-mail Address Link to a file Represents an Excel hyperlink. Hyperlink address. Depending on the hyperlink type it can be URL, e-mail, patrh to a file, etc. text label for this hyperlink the type of this hyperlink the row of the first cell that Contains the hyperlink the row of the last cell that Contains the hyperlink the column of the first cell that Contains the hyperlink the column of the last cell that Contains the hyperlink Represents a defined name for a range of cells. A name is a meaningful shorthand that makes it easier to understand the purpose of a cell reference, constant or a formula. Get the sheets name which this named range is referenced to @return sheet name, which this named range refered to Gets the name of the named range @return named range name Returns the formula that the name is defined to refer to. @return the reference for this name, null if it has not been set yet. Never empty string @see #SetRefersToFormula(String) Checks if this name is a function name @return true if this name is a function name Checks if this name points to a cell that no longer exists @return true if the name refers to a deleted cell, false otherwise Returns the sheet index this name applies to. @return the sheet index this name applies to, -1 if this name applies to the entire workbook Returns the comment the user provided when the name was Created. @return the user comment for this named range Indicates that the defined name refers to a user-defined function. This attribute is used when there is an add-in or other code project associated with the file. @param value true indicates the name refers to a function. Specifies printed page order. @author Gisella Bronzetti Order pages vertically first, then move horizontally. Order pages horizontally first, then move vertically The enumeration value indicating the possible paper size for a sheet @author Daniele Montagni Allow accessing the Initial value. A4 Transverse - 210x297 mm A4 Plus - 210x330 mm US Letter Rotated 11 x 8 1/2 in A4 Rotated - 297x210 mm */ @author Yegor Kozlov Allow accessing the Initial value. Extended windows meta file Windows Meta File Mac PICT format JPEG format PNG format Device independent bitmap GIF image format Tag Image File (.tiff) Encapsulated Postscript (.eps) Windows Bitmap (.bmp) WordPerfect graphics (.wpg) Repersents a picture in a SpreadsheetML document @author Yegor Kozlov Reset the image to the dimension of the embedded image @see #resize(double, double) Resize the image proportionally. Resize the image.

Please note, that this method works correctly only for workbooks with the default font size (Arial 10pt for .xls and Calibri 11pt for .xlsx). If the default font is changed the resized image can be streched vertically or horizontally.

resize(1.0,1.0) keeps the original size,
resize(0.5,0.5) resize to 50% of the original,
resize(2.0,2.0) resizes to 200% of the original.
resize({@link Double#MAX_VALUE},{@link Double#MAX_VALUE}) resizes to the dimension of the embedded image.

@param scaleX the amount by which the image width is multiplied relative to the original width. @param scaleY the amount by which the image height is multiplied relative to the original height.
Calculate the preferred size for this picture. @return XSSFClientAnchor with the preferred size for this image Calculate the preferred size for this picture. @param scaleX the amount by which image width is multiplied relative to the original width. @param scaleY the amount by which image height is multiplied relative to the original height. @return ClientAnchor with the preferred size for this image Return the dimension of the embedded image in pixel @return image dimension in pixels Return picture data for this picture @return picture data for this picture @return the anchor that is used by this picture Gets the picture data. @return the picture data. Suggests a file extension for this image. @return the file extension. Returns the mime type for the image @return the POI internal image type, 0 if unknown image type @see Workbook#PICTURE_TYPE_DIB @see Workbook#PICTURE_TYPE_EMF @see Workbook#PICTURE_TYPE_JPEG @see Workbook#PICTURE_TYPE_PICT @see Workbook#PICTURE_TYPE_PNG @see Workbook#PICTURE_TYPE_WMF These enumerations specify how cell comments shall be displayed for paper printing purposes. @author Gisella Bronzetti Do not print cell comments. Print cell comments as displayed. Print cell comments at end of document. The enumeration value indicating the print orientation for a sheet. @author Gisella Bronzetti orientation not specified portrait orientation landscape orientations Used by HSSFPrintSetup.CellError property Returns the paper size. @return paper size Returns the scale. @return scale Returns the page start. @return page start Returns the number of pages wide to fit sheet in. @return number of pages wide to fit sheet in Returns the number of pages high to fit the sheet in. @return number of pages high to fit the sheet in Returns the left to right print order. @return left to right print order Returns the landscape mode. @return landscape mode Returns the valid Settings. @return valid Settings Returns the black and white Setting. @return black and white Setting Returns the draft mode. @return draft mode Returns the print notes. @return print notes Returns the no orientation. @return no orientation Returns the use page numbers. @return use page numbers Returns the horizontal resolution. @return horizontal resolution Returns the vertical resolution. @return vertical resolution Returns the header margin. @return header margin Returns the footer margin. @return footer margin Returns the number of copies. @return number of copies Rich text unicode string. These strings can have fonts applied to arbitary parts of the string. @author Glen Stampoultzis (glens at apache.org) @author Jason Height (jheight at apache.org) Applies a font to the specified characters of a string. @param startIndex The start index to apply the font to (inclusive) @param endIndex The end index to apply the font to (exclusive) @param fontIndex The font to use. Applies a font to the specified characters of a string. @param startIndex The start index to apply the font to (inclusive) @param endIndex The end index to apply to font to (exclusive) @param font The index of the font to use. Sets the font of the entire string. @param font The font to use. Removes any formatting that may have been applied to the string. Returns the plain string representation. @return the number of characters in the font. @return The number of formatting Runs used. The index within the string to which the specified formatting run applies. @param index the index of the formatting run @return the index within the string. Applies the specified font to the entire string. @param fontIndex the font to apply. Used to specify the different possible policies if for the case of null and blank cells Missing cells are returned as null, Blank cells are returned as normal Missing cells are returned as null, as are blank cells A new, blank cell is Created for missing cells. Blank cells are returned as normal High level representation of a row of a spreadsheet. Use this to create new cells within the row and return it. The cell that is returned is a /. The type can be changed either through calling SetCellValue or SetCellType. the column number this cell represents Cell a high level representation of the created cell. ArgumentException if columnIndex < 0 or greater than the maximum number of supported columns (255 for *.xls, 1048576 for *.xlsx) Use this to create new cells within the row and return it. The cell that is returned is a /. The type can be changed either through calling SetCellValue or SetCellType. the column number this cell represents Cell a high level representation of the created cell. ArgumentException if columnIndex < 0 or greater than the maximum number of supported columns (255 for *.xls, 1048576 for *.xlsx) Remove the Cell from this row. the cell to remove Get row number this row represents the row number (0 based) Get the cell representing a given column (logical cell) 0-based. If you ask for a cell that is not defined....you get a null. 0 based column number Cell representing that column or null if undefined. Returns the cell at the given (0 based) index, with the specified {@link NPOI.SS.usermodel.Row.MissingCellPolicy} the cell at the given (0 based) index ArgumentException if cellnum < 0 or the specified MissingCellPolicy is invalid Get the number of the first cell Contained in this row. short representing the first logical cell in the row, or -1 if the row does not contain any cells. Gets the index of the last cell Contained in this row PLUS ONE. The result also happens to be the 1-based column number of the last cell. This value can be used as a standard upper bound when iterating over cells:
            short minColIx = row.GetFirstCellNum();
            short maxColIx = row.GetLastCellNum();
            for(short colIx=minColIx; colIx<maxColIx; colIx++) {
            Cell cell = row.GetCell(colIx);
            if(cell == null) {
            continue;
            }
            //... do something with cell
            }
            
short representing the last logical cell in the row PLUS ONE, or -1 if the row does not contain any cells.
Gets the number of defined cells (NOT number of cells in the actual row!). That is to say if only columns 0,4,5 have values then there would be 3. int representing the number of defined cells in the row. Get whether or not to display this row with 0 height zHeight height is zero or not. Get the row's height measured in twips (1/20th of a point). If the height is not set, the default worksheet value is returned, row height measured in twips (1/20th of a point) Returns row height measured in point size. If the height is not set, the default worksheet value is returned, row height measured in point size Is this row formatted? Most aren't, but some rows do have whole-row styles. For those that do, you can get the formatting from Returns the Sheet this row belongs to the Sheet that owns this row Returns the whole-row cell styles. Most rows won't have one of these, so will return null. Call IsFormmated to check first The row style. Moves the supplied cell to a new column, which must not already have a cell there! The cell to move The new column number (0 based) Copy the current row to the target row row index of the target row the new copied row object Copy the source cell to the target cell. If the target cell exists, the new copied cell will be inserted before the existing one index of the source cell index of the target cell the new copied cell object Get cells in the row Returns the rows outline level. Increased as you put it into more groups (outlines), reduced as you take it out of them. All known types of automatic shapes in DrawingML @author Yegor Kozlov Allow accessing the Initial value. Indicate the position of the margin. One of left, right, top and bottom. referes to the left margin referes to the right margin referes to the top margin referes to the bottom margin Define the position of the pane. One of lower/right, upper/right, lower/left and upper/left. referes to the lower/right corner referes to the upper/right corner referes to the lower/left corner referes to the upper/left corner High level representation of a Excel worksheet. Sheets are the central structures within a workbook, and are where a user does most of his spreadsheet work. The most common type of sheet is the worksheet, which is represented as a grid of cells. Worksheet cells can contain text, numbers, dates, and formulas. Cells can also be formatted. Create a new row within the sheet and return the high level representation The row number. high level Row object representing a row in the sheet RemoveRow(Row) Remove a row from this sheet. All cells Contained in the row are Removed as well a row to Remove. Returns the logical row (not physical) 0-based. If you ask for a row that is not defined you get a null. This is to say row 4 represents the fifth row on a sheet. row to get (0-based). the rownumber or null if its not defined on the sheet Returns the number of physically defined rows (NOT the number of rows in the sheet) the number of physically defined rows in this sheet. Gets the first row on the sheet the number of the first logical row on the sheet (0-based). Gets the last row on the sheet last row contained n this sheet (0-based) whether force formula recalculation. Get the visibility state for a given column the column to get (0-based) the visiblity state of the column Get the hidden state for a given column the column to set (0-based) hidden - false if the column is visible Copy the source row to the target row. If the target row exists, the new copied row will be inserted before the existing one source index target index the new copied row object Set the width (in units of 1/256th of a character width) the column to set (0-based) the width in units of 1/256th of a character width The maximum column width for an individual cell is 255 characters. This value represents the number of characters that can be displayed in a cell that is formatted with the standard font. get the width (in units of 1/256th of a character width ) the column to get (0-based) the width in units of 1/256th of a character width get the width in pixel Please note, that this method works correctly only for workbooks with the default font size (Arial 10pt for .xls and Calibri 11pt for .xlsx). If the default font is changed the column width can be streched Get the default column width for the sheet (if the columns do not define their own width) in characters default column width measured in characters. Get the default row height for the sheet (if the rows do not define their own height) in twips (1/20 of a point) default row height measured in twips (1/20 of a point) Get the default row height for the sheet (if the rows do not define their own height) in points. The default row height in points. Returns the CellStyle that applies to the given (0 based) column, or null if no style has been set for that column The column. Adds a merged region of cells (hence those cells form one) (rowfrom/colfrom-rowto/colto) to merge. index of this region Determine whether printed output for this sheet will be horizontally centered. Determine whether printed output for this sheet will be vertically centered. Removes a merged region of cells (hence letting them free) index of the region to unmerge Returns the number of merged regions Returns the merged region at the specified index The index. Gets the row enumerator. an iterator of the PHYSICAL rows. Meaning the 3rd element may not be the third row if say for instance the second row is undefined. Call on each row if you care which one it is. Get the row enumerator Gets the flag indicating whether the window should show 0 (zero) in cells Containing zero value. When false, cells with zero value appear blank instead of showing the number zero. whether all zero values on the worksheet are displayed. Gets or sets a value indicating whether the sheet displays Automatic Page Breaks. Get whether to display the guts or not, default value is true Flag indicating whether the Fit to Page print option is enabled. Flag indicating whether summary rows appear below detail in an outline, when applying an outline. When true a summary row is inserted below the detailed data being summarized and a new outline level is established on that row. When false a summary row is inserted above the detailed data being summarized and a new outline level is established on that row. true if row summaries appear below detail in the outline Flag indicating whether summary columns appear to the right of detail in an outline, when applying an outline. When true a summary column is inserted to the right of the detailed data being summarized and a new outline level is established on that column. When false a summary column is inserted to the left of the detailed data being summarized and a new outline level is established on that column. true if col summaries appear right of the detail in the outline Gets the flag indicating whether this sheet displays the lines between rows and columns to make editing and reading easier. true if this sheet displays gridlines. Gets the print Setup object. The user model for the print Setup object. Gets the user model for the default document header.

Note that XSSF offers more kinds of document headers than HSSF does

the document header. Never null
Gets the user model for the default document footer.

Note that XSSF offers more kinds of document footers than HSSF does.

the document footer. Never null
Gets the size of the margin in inches. which margin to get the size of the margin Sets the size of the margin in inches. which margin to get the size of the margin Answer whether protection is enabled or disabled true => protection enabled; false => protection disabled Sets the protection enabled as well as the password to set for protection. Pass null to remove protection Answer whether scenario protection is enabled or disabled true => protection enabled; false => protection disabled Gets or sets the tab color of the _sheet Returns the top-level drawing patriach, if there is one. This will hold any graphics or charts for the _sheet. WARNING - calling this will trigger a parsing of the associated escher records. Any that aren't supported (such as charts and complex drawing types) will almost certainly be lost or corrupted when written out. Only use this with simple drawings, otherwise call HSSFSheet#CreateDrawingPatriarch() and start from scratch! The drawing patriarch. Sets the zoom magnication for the sheet. The zoom is expressed as a fraction. For example to express a zoom of 75% use 3 for the numerator and 4 for the denominator. The numerator for the zoom magnification. denominator for the zoom magnification. The top row in the visible view when the sheet is first viewed after opening it in a viewer the rownum (0 based) of the top row. The left col in the visible view when the sheet is first viewed after opening it in a viewer the rownum (0 based) of the top row Sets desktop window pane display area, when the file is first opened in a viewer. the top row to show in desktop window pane the left column to show in desktop window pane Sets desktop window pane display area, when the file is first opened in a viewer. the top row to show in desktop window pane the left column to show in desktop window pane Shifts rows between startRow and endRow n number of rows. If you use a negative number, it will shift rows up. Code ensures that rows don't wrap around. Calls shiftRows(startRow, endRow, n, false, false); Additionally shifts merged regions that are completely defined in these rows (ie. merged 2 cells on a row to be shifted). the row to start shifting the row to end shifting the number of rows to shift Shifts rows between startRow and endRow n number of rows. If you use a negative number, it will shift rows up. Code ensures that rows don't wrap around Additionally shifts merged regions that are completely defined in these rows (ie. merged 2 cells on a row to be shifted). the row to start shifting the row to end shifting the number of rows to shift whether to copy the row height during the shift whether to set the original row's height to the default Creates a split (freezepane). Any existing freezepane or split pane is overwritten. Horizonatal position of split Vertical position of split Top row visible in bottom pane Left column visible in right pane Creates a split (freezepane). Any existing freezepane or split pane is overwritten. Horizonatal position of split. Vertical position of split. Creates a split pane. Any existing freezepane or split pane is overwritten. Horizonatal position of split (in 1/20th of a point) Vertical position of split (in 1/20th of a point) Left column visible in right pane Top row visible in bottom pane Active pane. One of: PANE_LOWER_RIGHT, PANE_UPPER_RIGHT, PANE_LOWER_LEFT, PANE_UPPER_LEFT @see #PANE_LOWER_LEFT @see #PANE_LOWER_RIGHT @see #PANE_UPPER_LEFT @see #PANE_UPPER_RIGHT Returns the information regarding the currently configured pane (split or freeze) if no pane configured returns null else return the pane information. Returns if gridlines are displayed Returns if formulas are displayed Returns if RowColHeadings are displayed. Returns if RowColHeadings are displayed. Determines if there is a page break at the indicated row The row. Removes the page break at the indicated row The row index. Retrieves all the horizontal page breaks all the horizontal page breaks, or null if there are no row page breaks Retrieves all the vertical page breaks all the vertical page breaks, or null if there are no column page breaks. Sets the active cell. The row. The column. Sets the active cell range. The firstrow. The lastrow. The firstcolumn. The lastcolumn. Sets the active cell range. The cellranges. The index of the active range. The active row in the active range The active column in the active range Sets a page break at the indicated column The column. Sets the row break. The row. Determines if there is a page break at the indicated column The column index. Removes a page break at the indicated column The column. Expands or collapses a column group. One of the columns in the group. if set to truecollapse group.falseexpand group. Create an outline for the provided column range. beginning of the column range. end of the column range. Ungroup a range of columns that were previously groupped start column (0-based). end column (0-based). Tie a range of rows toGether so that they can be collapsed or expanded start row (0-based) end row (0-based) Ungroup a range of rows that were previously groupped start row (0-based) end row (0-based) Set view state of a groupped range of rows start row of a groupped range of rows (0-based). whether to expand/collapse the detail rows. Sets the default column style for a given column. POI will only apply this style to new cells Added to the sheet. the column index the style to set Adjusts the column width to fit the contents. the column index This process can be relatively slow on large sheets, so this should normally only be called once per column, at the end of your processing. Adjusts the column width to fit the contents. the column index. whether to use the contents of merged cells when calculating the width of the column. Default is to ignore merged cells. This process can be relatively slow on large sheets, so this should normally only be called once per column, at the end of your processing. Returns cell comment for the specified row and column The row. The column. Creates the top-level drawing patriarch. Gets the parent workbook. Gets the name of the sheet. Gets or sets a value indicating whether this sheet is currently selected. Sets whether sheet is selected. Whether to select the sheet or deselect the sheet. Sets array formula to specified region for result. text representation of the formula Region of array formula for result the of cells affected by this change Remove a Array Formula from this sheet. All cells contained in the Array Formula range are removed as well any cell within Array Formula range the of cells affected by this change Checks if the provided region is part of the merged regions. Region searched in the merged regions true, when the region is contained in at least one of the merged regions Create an instance of a DataValidationHelper. Instance of a DataValidationHelper Returns the list of DataValidation in the sheet. list of DataValidation in the sheet Creates a data validation object The data validation object settings Enable filtering for a range of cells the range of cells to filter The 'Conditional Formatting' facet for this Sheet conditional formatting rule for this sheet Whether the text is displayed in right-to-left mode in the window Get or set the repeating rows used when printing the sheet, as found in File->PageSetup->Sheet.

Repeating rows cover a range of contiguous rows, e.g.:

            Sheet1!$1:$1
            Sheet2!$5:$8
            
The {@link CellRangeAddress} returned contains a column part which spans all columns, and a row part which specifies the contiguous range of repeating rows.

If the Sheet does not have any repeating rows defined, null is returned.

Gets or set the repeating columns used when printing the sheet, as found in File->PageSetup->Sheet.

Repeating columns cover a range of contiguous columns, e.g.:

            Sheet1!$A:$A
            Sheet2!$C:$F
            
The {@link CellRangeAddress} returned contains a row part which spans all rows, and a column part which specifies the contiguous range of repeating columns.

If the Sheet does not have any repeating columns defined, null is returned.

Copy sheet with a new name new sheet name cloned sheet Copy sheet with a new name new sheet name whether to copy styles cloned sheet Returns the column outline level. Increased as you put it into more groups (outlines), reduced as you take it out of them. The 'Conditional Formatting' facet of Sheet @author Dmitriy Kumshayev @author Yegor Kozlov @since 3.8 Add a new Conditional Formatting to the sheet. list of rectangular regions to apply conditional formatting rules the rule to apply index of the newly Created Conditional Formatting object Add a new Conditional Formatting consisting of two rules. list of rectangular regions to apply conditional formatting rules the first rule the second rule index of the newly Created Conditional Formatting object Add a new Conditional Formatting Set to the sheet. list of rectangular regions to apply conditional formatting rules Set of up to three conditional formatting rules index of the newly Created Conditional Formatting object Adds a copy of a ConditionalFormatting object to the sheet the Conditional Formatting to clone index of the new Conditional Formatting object This method could be used to copy ConditionalFormatting object from one sheet to another. For example: ConditionalFormatting cf = sheet.GetConditionalFormattingAt(index); newSheet.AddConditionalFormatting(cf); A factory method allowing to create a conditional formatting rule with a cell comparison operator

The Created conditional formatting rule Compares a cell value to a formula calculated result, using the specified operator. The type of the Created condition is {@link ConditionalFormattingRule#CONDITION_TYPE_CELL_VALUE_IS}

@param comparisonOperation - MUST be a constant value from {@link ComparisonOperator}:

  • BETWEEN
  • NOT_BETWEEN
  • EQUAL
  • NOT_EQUAL
  • GT
  • LT
  • GE
  • LE

@param formula1 - formula for the valued, Compared with the cell @param formula2 - second formula (only used with {@link ComparisonOperator#BETWEEN}) and {@link ComparisonOperator#NOT_BETWEEN} operations)
Create a conditional formatting rule that Compares a cell value to a formula calculated result, using an operator MUST be a constant value from ComparisonOperator except BETWEEN and NOT_BETWEEN the formula to determine if the conditional formatting is applied a conditional formatting rule Create a conditional formatting rule based on a Boolean formula. When the formula result is true, the cell is highlighted. the formula to Evaluate. MUST be a Boolean function. conditional formatting rule Gets Conditional Formatting object at a particular index 0-based index of the Conditional Formatting object to fetch Conditional Formatting object or null if not found throws ArgumentException if the index is outside of the allowable range (0 ... numberOfFormats-1) get the number of conditional formats in this sheet Removes a Conditional Formatting object by index 0-based index of the Conditional Formatting object to remove throws ArgumentException if the index is outside of the allowable range (0 ... numberOfFormats-1) @return the rich text string for this textbox. @return Returns the left margin within the textbox. @return returns the right margin within the textbox. @return returns the top margin within the textbox. s the bottom margin within the textbox. This enumeration value indicates the type of vertical alignment for a cell, i.e., whether it is aligned top, bottom, vertically centered, justified or distributed. The vertical alignment is aligned-to-top. The vertical alignment is centered across the height of the cell. The vertical alignment is aligned-to-bottom.

When text direction is horizontal: the vertical alignment of lines of text is distributed vertically, where each line of text inside the cell is evenly distributed across the height of the cell, with flush top and bottom margins.

When text direction is vertical: similar behavior as horizontal justification. The alignment is justified (flush top and bottom in this case). For each line of text, each line of the wrapped text in a cell is aligned to the top and bottom (except the last line). If no single line of text wraps in the cell, then the text is not justified.

When text direction is horizontal: the vertical alignment of lines of text is distributed vertically, where each line of text inside the cell is evenly distributed across the height of the cell, with flush top

When text direction is vertical: behaves exactly as distributed horizontal alignment. The first words in a line of text (appearing at the top of the cell) are flush with the top edge of the cell, and the last words of a line of text are flush with the bottom edge of the cell, and the line of text is distributed evenly from top to bottom.

Indicates the sheet is visible. Indicates the book window is hidden, but can be shown by the user via the user interface. Indicates the sheet is hidden and cannot be shown in the user interface (UI). In Excel this state is only available programmatically in VBA: ThisWorkbook.Sheets("MySheetName").Visible = xlSheetVeryHidden High level interface of a Excel workbook. This is the first object most users will construct whether they are reading or writing a workbook. It is also the top level object for creating new sheets/etc. This interface is shared between the implementation specific to xls and xlsx. This way it is possible to access Excel workbooks stored in both formats. get the active sheet. The active sheet is is the sheet which is currently displayed when the workbook is viewed in Excel. Gets the first tab that is displayed in the list of tabs in excel. Sets the order of appearance for a given sheet. the name of the sheet to reorder the position that we want to insert the sheet into (0 based) Sets the tab whose data is actually seen when the sheet is opened. This may be different from the "selected sheet" since excel seems to allow you to show the data of one sheet when another is seen "selected" in the tabs (at the bottom). the index of the sheet to select (0 based) set the active sheet. The active sheet is is the sheet which is currently displayed when the workbook is viewed in Excel. index of the active sheet (0-based) Set the sheet name sheet number (0 based) Sheet name Set the sheet name. sheet number (0 based) sheet name Returns the index of the sheet by its name the sheet name index of the sheet (0 based) Returns the index of the given sheet the sheet to look up index of the sheet (0 based) Sreate an Sheet for this Workbook, Adds it to the sheets and returns the high level representation. Use this to create new sheets. Create an Sheet for this Workbook, Adds it to the sheets and returns the high level representation. Use this to create new sheets. sheetname to set for the sheet. Sheet representing the new sheet. Create an Sheet from an existing sheet in the Workbook. Get the number of spreadsheets in the workbook Get the Sheet object at the given index. index of the sheet number (0-based physical & logical) Sheet at the provided index Get sheet with the given name name of the sheet Sheet with the name provided or null if it does not exist Removes sheet at the given index Enumerate sheets To set just repeating columns: workbook.SetRepeatingRowsAndColumns(0,0,1,-1-1); To set just repeating rows: workbook.SetRepeatingRowsAndColumns(0,-1,-1,0,4); To remove all repeating rows and columns for a sheet. workbook.SetRepeatingRowsAndColumns(0,-1,-1,-1,-1); Sets the repeating rows and columns for a sheet (as found in File->PageSetup->Sheet). This is function is included in the workbook because it Creates/modifies name records which are stored at the workbook level. 0 based index to sheet. 0 based start of repeating columns. 0 based end of repeating columns. 0 based start of repeating rows. 0 based end of repeating rows. Create a new Font and add it to the workbook's font table Finds a font that matches the one with the supplied attributes the font with the matched attributes or null Get the number of fonts in the font table Get the font at the given index number index number (0-based) font at the index Create a new Cell style and add it to the workbook's style table the new Cell Style object Get the number of styles the workbook Contains Get the cell style object at the given index index within the set of styles (0-based) CellStyle object at the index Write out this workbook to an OutPutstream. the stream you wish to write to the total number of defined names in this workbook the defined name with the specified name. the name of the defined name the defined name with the specified name. null if not found the defined name at the specified index position of the named range (0-based) Creates a new (unInitialised) defined name in this workbook new defined name object Gets the defined name index by name the name of the defined name zero based index of the defined name. Remove the defined name at the specified index named range index (0 based) Remove a defined name by name the name of the defined name Adds the linking required to allow formulas referencing the specified external workbook to be added to this one. In order for formulas such as "[MyOtherWorkbook]Sheet3!$A$5" to be added to the file, some linking information must first be recorded. Once a given external workbook has been linked, then formulas using it can added. Each workbook needs linking only once.
This linking only applies for writing formulas. To link things for evaluation, see {@link FormulaEvaluator#setupReferencedWorkbooks(java.util.Map)}
The name the workbook will be referenced as in formulas The open workbook to fetch the link required information from
Sets the printarea for the sheet provided Zero-based sheet index Valid name Reference for the Print Area Sets the printarea for the sheet provided Zero-based sheet index (0 = First Sheet) Column to begin printarea Column to end the printarea Row to begin the printarea Row to end the printarea Retrieves the reference for the printarea of the specified sheet, the sheet name is Appended to the reference even if it was not specified. Zero-based sheet index Null if no print area has been defined Delete the printarea for the sheet specified Zero-based sheet index (0 = First Sheet) Retrieves the current policy on what to do when getting missing or blank cells from a row. Returns the instance of DataFormat for this workbook. the DataFormat object Adds a picture to the workbook. The bytes of the picture The format of the picture. the index to this picture (1 based). Gets all pictures from the Workbook. the list of pictures (a list of link PictureData objects.) Return an object that handles instantiating concrete classes of the various instances one needs for HSSF and XSSF. if this workbook is not visible in the GUI Check whether a sheet is hidden. number of sheet true if sheet is hidden Check whether a sheet is very hidden.

This is different from the normal hidden status ({@link #isSheetHidden(int)})

@param sheetIx sheet index to check @return true if sheet is very hidden
Hide or unhide a sheet @param sheetIx the sheet index (0-based) @param hidden True to mark the sheet as hidden, false otherwise Hide or unhide a sheet.
             0 = not hidden
             1 = hidden
             2 = very hidden.
            
@param sheetIx The sheet number @param hidden 0 for not hidden, 1 for hidden, 2 for very hidden
Register a new toolpack in this workbook. the toolpack to register The Char (!) that Separates sheet names from cell references The Char (:) that Separates the two cell references in a multi-cell area reference The Char (') used to quote sheet names when they contain special Chars Create an area ref from a string representation. Sheet names containing special Chars should be delimited and escaped as per normal syntax rules for formulas.
The area reference must be contiguous (i.e. represent a single rectangle, not a Union of rectangles)
Creates an area ref from a pair of Cell References. is the reference for a contiguous (i.e. Unbroken) area, or is it made up of several different parts? (If it Is, you will need to call .... is the reference for a whole-column reference, such as C:C or D:G ? Takes a non-contiguous area reference, and returns an array of contiguous area references. @return false if this area reference involves more than one cell @return the first cell reference which defines this area. Usually this cell is in the upper left corner of the area (but this is not a requirement). Note - if this area reference refers to a single cell, the return value of this method will be identical to that of GetFirstCell() @return the second cell reference which defines this area. For multi-cell areas, this is cell diagonally opposite the 'first cell'. Usually this cell is in the lower right corner of the area (but this is not a requirement). Returns a reference to every cell covered by this area Example return values:
ResultComment
A1:A1Single cell area reference without sheet
A1:$C$1Multi-cell area reference without sheet
Sheet1!A$1:B4Standard sheet name
'O''Brien''s Sales'!B5:C6' Sheet name with special Chars
@return the text representation of this area reference as it would appear in a formula.
Separates Area refs in two parts and returns them as Separate elements in a String array, each qualified with the sheet name (if present) @return array with one or two elements. never null Creates new cell range. Indexes are zero-based. @param firstRow Index of first row @param lastRow Index of last row (inclusive), must be equal to or larger than {@code firstRow} @param firstCol Index of first column @param lastCol Index of last column (inclusive), must be equal to or larger than {@code firstCol} @return the text format of this range using specified sheet name. Creates a CellRangeAddress from a cell range reference string. usually a standard area ref (e.g. "B1:D8"). May be a single cell ref (e.g. "B5") in which case the result is a 1 x 1 cell range. May also be a whole row range (e.g. "3:5"), or a whole column range (e.g. "C:F") a CellRangeAddress object See OOO documentation: excelfileformat.pdf sec 2.5.14 - 'Cell Range Address'

Common subclass of 8-bit and 16-bit versions @author Josh Micich Validate the range limits against the supplied version of Excel @param ssVersion the version of Excel to validate against @throws IllegalArgumentException if the range limits are outside of the allowed range Runs a bounds check for row numbers @param row Runs a bounds check for column numbers @param column @return column number for the upper left hand corner @return row number for the upper left hand corner @return column number for the lower right hand corner @return row number for the lower right hand corner @return the size of the range (number of cells in the area). List of CellRangeAddresses. Each structure represents a cell range Convenience constructor for creating a CellRangeAddressList with a single CellRangeAddress. Other CellRangeAddresses may be Added later. @param in the RecordInputstream to read the record from Get the number of following ADDR structures. The number of this structures is automatically set when reading an Excel file and/or increased when you manually Add a new ADDR structure . This is the reason there isn't a set method for this field . @return number of ADDR structures Add a cell range structure. @param firstRow - the upper left hand corner's row @param firstCol - the upper left hand corner's col @param lastRow - the lower right hand corner's row @param lastCol - the lower right hand corner's col @return the index of this ADDR structure @return CellRangeAddress at the given index @return the total size of for the specified number of ranges, including the initial 2 byte range count

Allow accessing the Initial value.
@author Avik Sengupta @author Dennis doubleday (patch to seperateRowColumns()) The character ($) that signifies a row or column value is absolute instead of relative The character (!) that Separates sheet names from cell references The character (') used to quote sheet names when they contain special characters Matches a run of one or more letters followed by a run of one or more digits. The run of letters is group 1 and the run of digits is group 2. Each group may optionally be prefixed with a single '$'. Matches a run of one or more letters. The run of letters is group 1. The text may optionally be prefixed with a single '$'. Matches a run of one or more digits. The run of digits is group 1. The text may optionally be prefixed with a single '$'. Named range names must start with a letter or underscore. Subsequent characters may include digits or dot. (They can even end in dot). Create an cell ref from a string representation. Sheet names containing special characters should be delimited and escaped as per normal syntax rules for formulas. @return possibly null if this is a 2D reference. Special characters are not escaped or delimited takes in a column reference portion of a CellRef and converts it from ALPHA-26 number format to 0-based base 10. 'A' -> 0 'Z' -> 25 'AA' -> 26 'IV' -> 255 @return zero based column index Takes in a 0-based base-10 column and returns a ALPHA-26 representation. eg column #3 -> D Separates the row from the columns and returns an array of three Strings. The first element is the sheet name. Only the first element may be null. The second element in is the column name still in ALPHA-26 number format. The third element is the row. Example return values:
ResultComment
A1Cell reference without sheet
Sheet1!A1Standard sheet name
'O''Brien''s Sales'!A1'Sheet name with special characters
@return the text representation of this cell reference as it would appear in a formula.
Returns the three parts of the cell reference, the Sheet name (or null if none supplied), the 1 based row number, and the A based column letter. This will not include any markers for absolute references, so use {@link #formatAsString()} to properly turn references into strings. Appends cell reference with '$' markers for absolute values as required. Sheet name is not included. Used to decide whether a name of the form "[A-Z]*[0-9]*" that appears in a formula can be interpreted as a cell reference. Names of that form can be also used for sheets and/or named ranges, and in those circumstances, the question of whether the potential cell reference is valid (in range) becomes important.

Note - that the maximum sheet size varies across Excel versions:

Version File Format Last Column Last Row
97-2003BIFF8"IV" (2^8)65536 (2^14)
2007BIFF12"XFD" (2^14)1048576 (2^20)
POI currently targets BIFF8 (Excel 97-2003), so the following behaviour can be observed for this method:
Input Result
"A", "1"true
"a", "111"true
"A", "65536"true
"A", "65537"false
"iv", "1"true
"IW", "1"false
"AAA", "1"false
"a", "111"true
"Sheet", "1"false
@param colStr a string of only letter characters @param rowStr a string of only digit characters @return true if the row and col parameters are within range of a BIFF8 spreadsheet.
Various utility functions that make working with a cells and rows easier. The various methods that deal with style's allow you to create your CellStyles as you need them. When you apply a style change to a cell, the code will attempt to see if a style already exists that meets your needs. If not, then it will create a new style. This is to prevent creating too many styles. there is an upper limit in Excel on the number of styles that can be supported. @author Eric Pugh epugh@upstate.com @author (secondary) Avinash Kewalramani akewalramani@accelrys.com Get a row from the spreadsheet, and create it if it doesn't exist. @param rowIndex The 0 based row number @param sheet The sheet that the row is part of. @return The row indicated by the rowCounter Get a specific cell from a row. If the cell doesn't exist, then create it. @param row The row that the cell is part of @param columnIndex The column index that the cell is in. @return The cell indicated by the column. Creates a cell, gives it a value, and applies a style if provided @param row the row to create the cell in @param column the column index to create the cell in @param value The value of the cell @param style If the style is not null, then set @return A new Cell Create a cell, and give it a value. @param row the row to create the cell in @param column the column index to create the cell in @param value The value of the cell @return A new Cell. Take a cell, and align it. @param cell the cell to set the alignment for @param workbook The workbook that is being worked with. @param align the column alignment to use. @see CellStyle for alignment options Take a cell, and apply a font to it @param cell the cell to set the alignment for @param workbook The workbook that is being worked with. @param font The Font that you want to set... This method attempt to find an already existing CellStyle that matches what you want the style to be. If it does not find the style, then it creates a new one. If it does create a new one, then it applies the propertyName and propertyValue to the style. This is necessary because Excel has an upper limit on the number of Styles that it supports. @param workbook The workbook that is being worked with. @param propertyName The name of the property that is to be changed. @param propertyValue The value of the property that is to be changed. @param cell The cell that needs it's style changes Returns a map containing the format properties of the given cell style. @param style cell style @return map of format properties (String -> Object) @see #setFormatProperties(org.apache.poi.ss.usermodel.CellStyle, org.apache.poi.ss.usermodel.Workbook, java.util.Map) Sets the format properties of the given style based on the given map. @param style cell style @param workbook parent workbook @param properties map of format properties (String -> Object) @see #getFormatProperties(CellStyle) Utility method that returns the named short value form the given map. @return zero if the property does not exist, or is not a {@link Short}. @param properties map of named properties (String -> Object) @param name property name @return property value, or zero Utility method that returns the named boolean value form the given map. @return false if the property does not exist, or is not a {@link Boolean}. @param properties map of properties (String -> Object) @param name property name @return property value, or false Utility method that puts the named short value to the given map. @param properties map of properties (String -> Object) @param name property name @param value property value Utility method that puts the named boolean value to the given map. @param properties map of properties (String -> Object) @param name property name @param value property value Looks for text in the cell that should be unicode, like an alpha and provides the unicode version of it. @param cell The cell to check for unicode values @return translated to unicode Represents callback for CellWalk traverse method. @author Roman Kashitsyn @param cell current cell @param ctx information about invokation context Traverse cell range. @author Roman Kashitsyn Should we call handler on empty (blank) cells. Default is false. @return true if handler should be called on empty (blank) cells, false otherwise. Sets the traverseEmptyCells property. @param traverseEmptyCells new property value Traverse cell range from top left to bottom right cell. @param handler handler to call on each appropriate cell Inner class to hold walk context. @author Roman Kashitsyn @author Roman Kashitsyn Returns ordinal number of cell in range. Numeration starts from top left cell and ends at bottom right cell. Here is a brief example (number in cell is it's ordinal number):
12
34
@return ordinal number of current cell
Returns number of current row. @return number of current row Returns number of current column. @return number of current column Represents data marker used in charts. @author Roman Kashitsyn constructor the sheet where data located. the range within that sheet. get or set the sheet marker points to. get or set range of the marker. Formats data marker using canonical format, for example 'SheetName!$A$1:$A$5'. formatted data marker Convert DateFormat patterns into Excel custom number formats. For example, to format a date in excel using the "dd MMMM, yyyy" pattern and Japanese locale, use the following code:

                  // returns "[$-0411]dd MMMM, yyyy;@" where the [$-0411] prefix tells Excel to use the Japanese locale
                  String excelFormatPattern = DateFormatConverter.convert(Locale.JAPANESE, "dd MMMM, yyyy");
            
                  CellStyle cellStyle = workbook.createCellStyle();
            
                  DataFormat poiFormat = workbook.createDataFormat();
                  cellStyle.setDataFormat(poiFormat.getFormat(excelFormatPattern));
                  cell.setCellValue(new Date());
                  cell.setCellStyle(cellStyle);  // formats date as '2012\u5e743\u670817\u65e5'
            
              
Always 64 bits long (MSB, bit-63 is '1') Convert to an equivalent {@link NormalisedDecimal} representation having 15 decimal digits of precision in the non-fractional bits of the significand. @return the number of non-fractional bits after the MSB of the significand A substitute class for Format class in Java Format class for Excel's SSN Format. This class mimics Excel's built-in SSN Formatting. @author James May Format a number as an SSN Format class for Excel Zip + 4 Format. This class mimics Excel's built-in Formatting for Zip + 4. @author James May Format a number as Zip + 4 Format class for Excel phone number Format. This class mimics Excel's built-in phone number Formatting. @author James May Format a number as a phone number Format class that does nothing and always returns a constant string. This format is used to simulate Excel's handling of a format string of all # when the value is 0. Excel will output "", Java will output "0". @see DataFormatter#createFormat(double, int, String) The value the exponent field Gets for all NaN and InfInity values @param rawBits the 64 bit binary representation of the double value @return the top 12 bits (sign and biased exponent value) @author Yegor Kozlov Return the dimension of this image @param is the stream Containing the image data @param type type of the picture: {@link NPOI.SS.UserModel.Workbook#PICTURE_TYPE_JPEG}, {@link NPOI.SS.UserModel.Workbook#PICTURE_TYPE_PNG} or {@link NPOI.SS.UserModel.Workbook#PICTURE_TYPE_DIB} @return image dimension in pixels The metadata of PNG and JPEG can contain the width of a pixel in millimeters. Return the the "effective" dpi calculated as 25.4/HorizontalPixelSize and 25.4/VerticalPixelSize. Where 25.4 is the number of mm in inch. @return array of two elements: {horisontalPdi, verticalDpi}. {96, 96} is the default. Calculate and Set the preferred size (anchor) for this picture. @param scaleX the amount by which image width is multiplied relative to the original width. @param scaleY the amount by which image height is multiplied relative to the original height. @return the new Dimensions of the scaled picture in EMUs Calculates the dimensions in EMUs for the anchor of the given picture @param picture the picture Containing the anchor @return the dimensions in EMUs The minimum value in 'Base-10 normalised form'.
When {@link #_binaryExponent} == 46 this is the the minimum {@link #_frac} value (1014-0.05) * 2^17
Values between (1014-0.05) and 1014 will be represented as '1' followed by 14 zeros. Values less than (1014-0.05) will get Shifted by one more power of 10 This frac value rounds to '1' followed by fourteen zeros with an incremented decimal exponent
For 'Base-10 normalised form'
The maximum {@link #_frac} value when {@link #_binaryExponent} == 49 (10^15-0.5) * 2^14
Width of a long Minimum precision after discarding whole 32-bit words from the significand @param nBits number of bits to shift right Holds values for quick multiplication and division by 10 Number of powers of ten Contained in the significand 219 the value of {@link #_fractionalPart} that represents 0.5 1015 Rounds at the digit with value 10decimalExponent The decimal exponent increased by one less than the digit count of {@link #_wholePart} The whole part of the significand (typically 15 digits). 47-50 bits long (MSB may be anywhere from bit 46 to 49) LSB is units bit. The fractional part of the significand. 24 bits (only top 14-17 bits significant): a value between 0x000000 and 0xFFFF80 Convert to an equivalent {@link ExpandedDouble} representation (binary frac and exponent). The resulting transformed object is easily Converted to a 64 bit IEEE double:
  • bits 2-53 of the {@link #GetSignificand()} become the 52 bit 'fraction'.
  • {@link #GetBinaryExponent()} is biased by 1023 to give the 'exponent'.
The sign bit must be obtained from somewhere else. @return a new {@link NormalisedDecimal} normalised to base 2 representation.
@return the significand as a fixed point number (with 24 fraction bits and 47-50 whole bits) Rounds the first whole digit position (considers only units digit, not frational part). Caller should check total digit count of result to see whether the rounding operation caused a carry out of the most significant digit @return the number of powers of 10 which have been extracted from the significand and binary exponent. assumes both this and other are normalised This class attempts to reproduce Excel's behaviour for comparing numbers. Results are mostly the same as those from {@link Double#compare(double, double)} but with some rounding. For numbers that are very close, this code converts to a format having 15 decimal digits of precision and a decimal exponent, before completing the comparison.

In Excel formula evaluation, expressions like "(0.06-0.01)=0.05" evaluate to "TRUE" even though the equivalent java expression is false. In examples like this, Excel achieves the effect by having additional logic for comparison operations.

Note - Excel also gives special treatment to expressions like "0.06-0.01-0.05" which evaluates to "0" (in java, rounding anomalies give a result of 6.9E-18). The special behaviour here is for different reasons to the example above: If the last operator in a cell formula is '+' or '-' and the result is less than 250 times smaller than first operand, the result is rounded to zero. Needless to say, the two rules are not consistent and it is relatively easy to find examples that satisfy
"A=B" is "TRUE" but "A-B" is not "0"
and
"A=B" is "FALSE" but "A-B" is "0"

This rule (for rounding the result of a final addition or subtraction), has not been implemented in POI (as of Jul-2009). @return negative, 0, or positive according to the standard Excel comparison of values a and b. If both numbers are subnormal, Excel seems to use standard comparison rules Usually any normal number is greater (in magnitude) than any subnormal number. However there are some anomalous cases around the threshold where Excel produces screwy results @param isNegative both values are either negative or positive. This parameter affects the sign of the comparison result @return usually isNegative ? -1 : +1 for formatting double values in error messages Converts the supplied value to the text representation that Excel would give if the value were to appear in an unformatted cell, or as a literal number in a formula.
Note - the results from this method differ slightly from those of Double.ToString() In some special cases Excel behaves quite differently. This function attempts to reproduce those results.
Holds information regarding a split plane or freeze plane for a sheet. Constant for active pane being the lower right Constant for active pane being the upper right Constant for active pane being the lower left Constant for active pane being the upper left Returns the vertical position of the split. @return 0 if there is no vertical spilt, or for a freeze pane the number of columns in the TOP pane, or for a split plane the position of the split in 1/20th of a point. Returns the horizontal position of the split. @return 0 if there is no horizontal spilt, or for a freeze pane the number of rows in the LEFT pane, or for a split plane the position of the split in 1/20th of a point. For a horizontal split returns the top row in the BOTTOM pane. @return 0 if there is no horizontal split, or the top row of the bottom pane. For a vertical split returns the left column in the RIGHT pane. @return 0 if there is no vertical split, or the left column in the RIGHT pane. Returns the active pane @see #PANE_LOWER_RIGHT @see #PANE_UPPER_RIGHT @see #PANE_LOWER_LEFT @see #PANE_UPPER_LEFT @return the active pane. Returns true if this is a Freeze pane, false if it is a split pane. Represents a from/to row/col square. This is a object primitive that can be used to represent row,col - row,col just as one would use String to represent a string of characters. Its really only useful for HSSF though. @author Andrew C. Oliver acoliver at apache dot org Creates a new instance of Region (0,0 - 0,0) Get the upper left hand corner column number @return column number for the upper left hand corner Get the upper left hand corner row number @return row number for the upper left hand corner Get the lower right hand corner column number @return column number for the lower right hand corner Get the lower right hand corner row number @return row number for the lower right hand corner Convert a List of CellRange objects to an array of regions @param List of CellRange objects @return regions Various utility functions that make working with a region of cells easier. @author Eric Pugh epugh@upstate.com @author (secondary) Avinash Kewalramani akewalramani@accelrys.com For setting the same property on many cells to the same value Sets the left border for a region of cells by manipulating the cell style of the individual cells on the left @param border The new border @param region The region that should have the border @param workbook The workbook that the region is on. @param sheet The sheet that the region is on. Sets the leftBorderColor attribute of the RegionUtil object @param color The color of the border @param region The region that should have the border @param workbook The workbook that the region is on. @param sheet The sheet that the region is on. Sets the borderRight attribute of the RegionUtil object @param border The new border @param region The region that should have the border @param workbook The workbook that the region is on. @param sheet The sheet that the region is on. Sets the rightBorderColor attribute of the RegionUtil object @param color The color of the border @param region The region that should have the border @param workbook The workbook that the region is on. @param sheet The sheet that the region is on. Sets the borderBottom attribute of the RegionUtil object @param border The new border @param region The region that should have the border @param workbook The workbook that the region is on. @param sheet The sheet that the region is on. Sets the bottomBorderColor attribute of the RegionUtil object @param color The color of the border @param region The region that should have the border @param workbook The workbook that the region is on. @param sheet The sheet that the region is on. Sets the borderBottom attribute of the RegionUtil object @param border The new border @param region The region that should have the border @param workbook The workbook that the region is on. @param sheet The sheet that the region is on. Sets the topBorderColor attribute of the RegionUtil object @param color The color of the border @param region The region that should have the border @param workbook The workbook that the region is on. @param sheet The sheet that the region is on. Class {@code SheetBuilder} provides an easy way of building workbook sheets from 2D array of Objects. It can be used in test cases to improve code readability or in Swing applications with tables. @author Roman Kashitsyn Returns {@code true} if null array elements should be treated as empty cells. @return {@code true} if null objects should be treated as empty cells and {@code false} otherwise Specifies if null array elements should be treated as empty cells. @param shouldCreateEmptyCells {@code true} if null array elements should be treated as empty cells @return {@code this} Specifies name of the sheet to build. If not specified, default name (provided by workbook) will be used instead. @param sheetName sheet name to use @return {@code this} Builds sheet from parent workbook and 2D array with cell values. Creates rows anyway (even if row contains only null cells), creates cells if either corresponding array value is not null or createEmptyCells property is true. The conversion is performed in the following way:

  • Numbers become numeric cells.
  • java.util.Date or java.util.Calendar instances become date cells.
  • String with leading '=' char become formulas (leading '=' will be truncated).
  • Other objects become strings via Object.toString() method call.
@return newly created sheet
Sets the cell value using object type information. @param cell cell to change @param value value to set Holds a collection of Sheet names and their associated reference numbers. @author Andrew C. Oliver (acoliver at apache dot org) Helper methods for when working with Usermodel sheets @author Yegor Kozlov Dummy formula Evaluator that does nothing. YK: The only reason of having this class is that {@link NPOI.SS.UserModel.DataFormatter#formatCellValue(NPOI.SS.UserModel.Cell)} returns formula string for formula cells. Dummy Evaluator Makes it to format the cached formula result. See Bugzilla #50021 Compute width of a single cell @param cell the cell whose width is to be calculated @param defaultCharWidth the width of a single character @param formatter formatter used to prepare the text to be measured @param useMergedCells whether to use merged cells @return the width in pixels Compute width of a column and return the result @param sheet the sheet to calculate @param column 0-based index of the column @param useMergedCells whether to use merged cells @return the width in pixels Convert HSSFFont to Font. The font. Generate a valid sheet name based on the existing one. Used when cloning sheets. @param srcName the original sheet name to @return clone sheet name Return the cell, taking account of merged regions. Allows you to find the cell who's contents are Shown in a given position in the sheet.

If the cell at the given co-ordinates is a merged cell, this will return the primary (top-left) most cell of the merged region.

If the cell at the given co-ordinates is not in a merged region, then will return the cell itself.

If there is no cell defined at the given co-ordinates, will return null.

For POI internal use only @author Josh Micich Helper methods for when working with Usermodel Workbooks Creates a valid sheet name, which is conform to the rules. In any case, the result safely can be used for {@link org.apache.poi.ss.usermodel.Workbook#setSheetName(int, String)}.
Rules:
  • never null
  • minimum length is 1
  • maximum length is 31
  • doesn't contain special chars: 0x0000, 0x0003, / \ ? * ] [
  • Sheet names must not begin or end with ' (apostrophe)
Invalid characters are replaced by one space character ' '. @param nameProposal can be any string, will be truncated if necessary, allowed to be null @return a valid string, "empty" if to short, "null" if null
Creates a valid sheet name, which is conform to the rules. In any case, the result safely can be used for {@link org.apache.poi.ss.usermodel.Workbook#setSheetName(int, String)}.
Rules:
  • never null
  • minimum length is 1
  • maximum length is 31
  • doesn't contain special chars: : 0x0000, 0x0003, / \ ? * ] [
  • Sheet names must not begin or end with ' (apostrophe)
@param nameProposal can be any string, will be truncated if necessary, allowed to be null @param replaceChar the char to replace invalid characters. @return a valid string, "empty" if to short, "null" if null
Validates sheet name.

The character count MUST be greater than or equal to 1 and less than or equal to 31. The string MUST NOT contain the any of the following characters:

  • 0x0000
  • 0x0003
  • colon (:)
  • backslash (\)
  • asterisk (*)
  • question mark (?)
  • forward slash (/)
  • opening square bracket ([)
  • closing square bracket (])
The string MUST NOT begin or end with the single quote (') character.

@param sheetName the name to validate
Base class of all the exceptions that POI throws in the event that it's given a file that isn't supported This class represents a run of text that share common properties. @return The text of the Run, including any tabs/spaces/etc This class represents a paragraph, made up of one or more Runs of text.